1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- 2@c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 3@c 4@c %**start of header 5@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use 6@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o. 7@setfilename gdb.info 8@c 9@c man begin INCLUDE 10@include gdb-cfg.texi 11@c man end 12@c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN} 14@setchapternewpage odd 15@c %**end of header 16 17@iftex 18@c @smallbook 19@c @cropmarks 20@end iftex 21 22@finalout 23@c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when 24@c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a 25@c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the 26@c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest. 27@syncodeindex ky fn 28@syncodeindex tp fn 29 30@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable, 31@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex. 32@syncodeindex vr fn 33 34@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version! 35@c This is updated by GNU Press. 36@set EDITION Tenth 37 38@c !!set GDB edit command default editor 39@set EDITOR /bin/ex 40 41@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER. 42 43@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of 44@c manuals to an info tree. 45@dircategory Software development 46@direntry 47* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger. 48* gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server. 49@end direntry 50 51@copying 52@c man begin COPYRIGHT 53Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 54 55Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document 56under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or 57any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the 58Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs 59Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' 60and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. 61 62(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify 63this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in 64developing GNU and promoting software freedom.'' 65@c man end 66@end copying 67 68@ifnottex 69This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}. 70 71This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with 72@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN} 73@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 74@value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 75@end ifset 76Version @value{GDBVN}. 77 78@insertcopying 79@end ifnottex 80 81@titlepage 82@title Debugging with @value{GDBN} 83@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger 84@sp 1 85@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} 86@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 87@sp 1 88@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 89@end ifset 90@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al. 91@page 92@tex 93{\parskip=0pt 94\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par 95\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par 96\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par 97} 98@end tex 99 100@vskip 0pt plus 1filll 101Published by the Free Software Foundation @* 10251 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, 103Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@* 104ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @* 105 106@insertcopying 107@end titlepage 108@page 109 110@ifnottex 111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir) 112 113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN} 114 115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger. 116 117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} 118@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 119@value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 120@end ifset 121Version @value{GDBVN}. 122 123Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 124 125This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred 126Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free 127software in general. We will miss him. 128 129@menu 130* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN} 131* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session 132 133* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN} 134* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands 135* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN} 136* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing 137* Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward 138* Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it 139* Stack:: Examining the stack 140* Source:: Examining source files 141* Data:: Examining data 142* Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code 143* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros 144* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively 145* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays 146 147* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages 148 149* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table 150* Altering:: Altering execution 151* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files 152* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target 153* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs 154* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information 155* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN} 156* Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN} 157* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters 158* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface 159* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs 160* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface. 161* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface. 162* JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface. 163* In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent 164 165* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN} 166 167@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 168* Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing 169* Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively 170@end ifset 171@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 172* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing 173* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively 174@end ifclear 175* In Memoriam:: In Memoriam 176* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation 177* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB 178* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands 179* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol 180* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism 181* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to 182 @value{GDBN} 183* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from 184 the operating system 185* Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format 186* Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format 187* Man Pages:: Manual pages 188* Copying:: GNU General Public License says 189 how you can copy and share GDB 190* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation 191* Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts 192* Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables, 193 functions, and Python data types 194@end menu 195 196@end ifnottex 197 198@contents 199 200@node Summary 201@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN} 202 203The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is 204going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another 205program was doing at the moment it crashed. 206 207@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of 208these) to help you catch bugs in the act: 209 210@itemize @bullet 211@item 212Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior. 213 214@item 215Make your program stop on specified conditions. 216 217@item 218Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped. 219 220@item 221Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the 222effects of one bug and go on to learn about another. 223@end itemize 224 225You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}. 226For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}. 227For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}. 228 229Support for D is partial. For information on D, see 230@ref{D,,D}. 231 232@cindex Modula-2 233Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see 234@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. 235 236Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see 237@ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}. 238 239@cindex Pascal 240Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or 241nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support 242entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal 243syntax. 244 245@cindex Fortran 246@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although 247it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing 248underscore. 249 250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C, 251using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime. 252 253@menu 254* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software 255* Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation 256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB 257@end menu 258 259@node Free Software 260@unnumberedsec Free Software 261 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu} 263General Public License 264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed 265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the 266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to 267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies. 268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the 269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms. 270 271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that 272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away 273from anyone else. 274 275@node Free Documentation 276@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation 277 278The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in 279the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can 280include with the free software. Many of our most important 281programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory 282texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package; 283when an important free software package does not come with a free 284manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such 285gaps today. 286 287Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people 288normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the 289authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no 290copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude 291them from the free software world. 292 293That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far 294from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a 295manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community, 296only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication 297contract to make it non-free. 298 299Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not 300price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers 301charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free 302Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The 303problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals 304are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and 305modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this. 306 307The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for 308free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of 309commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can 310accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper. 311 312Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too. 313When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they 314are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can 315provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A 316manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document 317a changed version of the program is not really available to our 318community. 319 320Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are 321acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original 322author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of 323authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions 324to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that 325may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal 326with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions 327are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use 328of the manual. 329 330However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical} 331content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual 332media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions 333obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another 334manual to replace it. 335 336Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to 337lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that 338free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps 339the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will 340realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to 341the free software community. 342 343If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under 344the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation 345license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you 346don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers 347will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the 348option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is 349what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please 350try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license 351is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}. 352 353You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted 354manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying 355copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major 356improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation 357at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it, 358and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom. 359Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that 360have paid or pay the authors to work on it. 361 362The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation 363published by other publishers, at 364@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}. 365 366@node Contributors 367@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN} 368 369Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many 370other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its 371development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One 372of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute 373to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The 374file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a 375blow-by-blow account. 376 377Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time. 378 379@quotation 380@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you 381or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly 382omitted from this list, we would like to add your names! 383@end quotation 384 385So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we 386particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major 387releases: 388Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0); 389Jim Blandy (release 4.18); 390Jason Molenda (release 4.17); 391Stan Shebs (release 4.14); 392Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9); 393Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4); 394John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9); 395Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3); 396and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0). 397 398Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris 399Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8. 400 401Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support 402in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per 403Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} 404demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did 405much general update work leading to release 3.0). 406 407@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple 408object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V. 409Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore. 410 411David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did 412the original support for encapsulated COFF. 413 414Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support. 415 416Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support. 417Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS 418support. 419Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support. 420Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support. 421Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support. 422David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support. 423Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support. 424Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support. 425Keith Packard contributed NS32K support. 426Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support. 427Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support. 428Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging). 429Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support. 430Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support. 431Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode. 432Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support. 433Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support. 434Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support. 435 436Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support. 437 438Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared 439libraries. 440 441Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree 442about several machine instruction sets. 443 444Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop 445remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM 446contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI, 447and RDI targets, respectively. 448 449Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing 450command-line editing and command history. 451 452Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the 453Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual. 454 455Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4. 456He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded 457symbols. 458 459Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for 460H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors. 461 462NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors. 463 464Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D 465processors. 466 467Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor. 468 469Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors. 470 471Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors. 472 473Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware 474watchpoints. 475 476Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints. 477 478Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver. 479 480Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made 481nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}. 482 483The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed 484support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0 485(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++} 486compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface): 487Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, 488Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase 489provided HP-specific information in this manual. 490 491DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project. 492Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port. 493 494Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its 495development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN} 496fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin 497Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim 498Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler, 499Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek 500Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In 501addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton, 502JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug 503Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff 504Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner, 505Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin 506Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela 507Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David 508Zuhn have made contributions both large and small. 509 510Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for 511Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface. 512 513Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red 514Hat. 515 516Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many 517people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick 518Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei 519Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason 520Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped 521with the migration of old architectures to this new framework. 522 523Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s 524unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring 525frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark 526Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the 527libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and 528trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a 529complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by 530Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane 531Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel 532Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei 533Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich 534Weigand. 535 536Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from 537Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others 538who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include 539Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner. 540 541Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the 542Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture. 543 544Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration 545was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge 546Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237 547("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme. 548 549@node Sample Session 550@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session 551 552You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}. 553However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the 554debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands. 555 556@iftex 557In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input}, 558to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output. 559@end iftex 560 561@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where 562@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use. 563 564One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro 565processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its 566quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro 567definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4} 568session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we 569then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the 570same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to 571@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same 572procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}: 573 574@smallexample 575$ @b{cd gnu/m4} 576$ @b{./m4} 577@b{define(foo,0000)} 578 579@b{foo} 5800000 581@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))} 582 583@b{bar} 5840000 585@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} 586 587@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} 588@b{baz} 589@b{Ctrl-d} 590m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string 591@end smallexample 592 593@noindent 594Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on. 595 596@smallexample 597$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4} 598@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook 599@c FIXME... format to come out better. 600@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies 601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see 602 the conditions. 603There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty" 604 for details. 605 606@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc... 607(@value{GDBP}) 608@end smallexample 609 610@noindent 611@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the 612rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly. 613We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so 614that examples fit in this manual. 615 616@smallexample 617(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70} 618@end smallexample 619 620@noindent 621We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works. 622Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is 623@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN} 624@code{break} command. 625 626@smallexample 627(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote} 628Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879. 629@end smallexample 630 631@noindent 632Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN} 633control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote} 634subroutine, the program runs as usual: 635 636@smallexample 637(@value{GDBP}) @b{run} 638Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4 639@b{define(foo,0000)} 640 641@b{foo} 6420000 643@end smallexample 644 645@noindent 646To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN} 647suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the 648context where it stops. 649 650@smallexample 651@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} 652 653Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) 654 at builtin.c:879 655879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3)) 656@end smallexample 657 658@noindent 659Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to 660the next line of the current function. 661 662@smallexample 663(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 664882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\ 665 : nil, 666@end smallexample 667 668@noindent 669@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it 670by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}. 671@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any} 672subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}. 673 674@smallexample 675(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 676set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") 677 at input.c:530 678530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 679@end smallexample 680 681@noindent 682The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now 683suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It 684shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace} 685command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are 686in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a 687stack frame for each active subroutine. 688 689@smallexample 690(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt} 691#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") 692 at input.c:530 693#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) 694 at builtin.c:882 695#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242 696#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30) 697 at macro.c:71 698#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40 699#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195 700@end smallexample 701 702@noindent 703We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two 704times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid 705falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine. 706 707@smallexample 708(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 7090x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote) 710(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 7110x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \ 712def_lquote : xstrdup(lq); 713(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 714536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\ 715 : xstrdup(rq); 716(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 717538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); 718@end smallexample 719 720@noindent 721The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables 722@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left 723and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p} 724(@code{print}) to see their values. 725 726@smallexample 727(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote} 728$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>" 729(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote} 730$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>" 731@end smallexample 732 733@noindent 734@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes. 735To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source 736surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command. 737 738@smallexample 739(@value{GDBP}) @b{l} 740533 xfree(rquote); 741534 742535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\ 743 : xstrdup (lq); 744536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\ 745 : xstrdup (rq); 746537 747538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); 748539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); 749540 @} 750541 751542 void 752@end smallexample 753 754@noindent 755Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and 756@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables. 757 758@smallexample 759(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 760539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); 761(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 762540 @} 763(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote} 764$3 = 9 765(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote} 766$4 = 7 767@end smallexample 768 769@noindent 770That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and 771@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and 772@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using 773the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of 774any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and 775assignments. 776 777@smallexample 778(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)} 779$5 = 7 780(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)} 781$6 = 9 782@end smallexample 783 784@noindent 785Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the 786@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue 787executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the 788example that caused trouble initially: 789 790@smallexample 791(@value{GDBP}) @b{c} 792Continuing. 793 794@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} 795 796baz 7970000 798@end smallexample 799 800@noindent 801Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The 802problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong 803lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input: 804 805@smallexample 806@b{Ctrl-d} 807Program exited normally. 808@end smallexample 809 810@noindent 811The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it 812indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN} 813session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command. 814 815@smallexample 816(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit} 817@end smallexample 818 819@node Invocation 820@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN} 821 822This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it. 823The essentials are: 824@itemize @bullet 825@item 826type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}. 827@item 828type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit. 829@end itemize 830 831@menu 832* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN} 833* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN} 834* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN} 835* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file 836@end menu 837 838@node Invoking GDB 839@section Invoking @value{GDBN} 840 841Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started, 842@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit. 843 844You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options, 845to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset. 846 847The command-line options described here are designed 848to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these 849options may effectively be unavailable. 850 851The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument, 852specifying an executable program: 853 854@smallexample 855@value{GDBP} @var{program} 856@end smallexample 857 858@noindent 859You can also start with both an executable program and a core file 860specified: 861 862@smallexample 863@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core} 864@end smallexample 865 866You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want 867to debug a running process: 868 869@smallexample 870@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234 871@end smallexample 872 873@noindent 874would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file 875named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first). 876 877Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly 878complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote 879debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of 880``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN} 881will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps. 882 883You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the 884executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops 885option processing. 886@smallexample 887@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c 888@end smallexample 889This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set 890@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}. 891 892You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes 893@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent} 894(or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}): 895 896@smallexample 897@value{GDBP} --silent 898@end smallexample 899 900@noindent 901You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line 902options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available. 903 904@noindent 905Type 906 907@smallexample 908@value{GDBP} -help 909@end smallexample 910 911@noindent 912to display all available options and briefly describe their use 913(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent). 914 915All options and command line arguments you give are processed 916in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the 917@samp{-x} option is used. 918 919 920@menu 921* File Options:: Choosing files 922* Mode Options:: Choosing modes 923* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup 924@end menu 925 926@node File Options 927@subsection Choosing Files 928 929When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as 930specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is 931the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and 932@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the 933first argument that does not have an associated option flag as 934equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the 935second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as 936equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.) 937If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will 938first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt 939to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with 940a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by 941prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}. 942 943If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support, 944such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second 945argument and ignore it. 946 947Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the 948following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate 949them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous. 950(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather 951than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.) 952 953@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This 954@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find 955@c it. 956 957@table @code 958@item -symbols @var{file} 959@itemx -s @var{file} 960@cindex @code{--symbols} 961@cindex @code{-s} 962Read symbol table from file @var{file}. 963 964@item -exec @var{file} 965@itemx -e @var{file} 966@cindex @code{--exec} 967@cindex @code{-e} 968Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate, 969and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump. 970 971@item -se @var{file} 972@cindex @code{--se} 973Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable 974file. 975 976@item -core @var{file} 977@itemx -c @var{file} 978@cindex @code{--core} 979@cindex @code{-c} 980Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine. 981 982@item -pid @var{number} 983@itemx -p @var{number} 984@cindex @code{--pid} 985@cindex @code{-p} 986Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command. 987 988@item -command @var{file} 989@itemx -x @var{file} 990@cindex @code{--command} 991@cindex @code{-x} 992Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is 993evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would. 994@xref{Command Files,, Command files}. 995 996@item -eval-command @var{command} 997@itemx -ex @var{command} 998@cindex @code{--eval-command} 999@cindex @code{-ex} 1000Execute a single @value{GDBN} command. 1001 1002This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may 1003also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required. 1004 1005@smallexample 1006@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \ 1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out 1008@end smallexample 1009 1010@item -init-command @var{file} 1011@itemx -ix @var{file} 1012@cindex @code{--init-command} 1013@cindex @code{-ix} 1014Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but 1015after loading gdbinit files). 1016@xref{Startup}. 1017 1018@item -init-eval-command @var{command} 1019@itemx -iex @var{command} 1020@cindex @code{--init-eval-command} 1021@cindex @code{-iex} 1022Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but 1023after loading gdbinit files). 1024@xref{Startup}. 1025 1026@item -directory @var{directory} 1027@itemx -d @var{directory} 1028@cindex @code{--directory} 1029@cindex @code{-d} 1030Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files. 1031 1032@item -r 1033@itemx -readnow 1034@cindex @code{--readnow} 1035@cindex @code{-r} 1036Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than 1037the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed. 1038This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster. 1039 1040@end table 1041 1042@node Mode Options 1043@subsection Choosing Modes 1044 1045You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in 1046batch mode or quiet mode. 1047 1048@table @code 1049@anchor{-nx} 1050@item -nx 1051@itemx -n 1052@cindex @code{--nx} 1053@cindex @code{-n} 1054Do not execute commands found in any initialization file. 1055There are three init files, loaded in the following order: 1056 1057@table @code 1058@item @file{system.gdbinit} 1059This is the system-wide init file. 1060Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit} 1061configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). 1062It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options 1063have been processed. 1064@item @file{~/.gdbinit} 1065This is the init file in your home directory. 1066It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before 1067command options have been processed. 1068@item @file{./.gdbinit} 1069This is the init file in the current directory. 1070It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and 1071@code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and 1072@code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded. 1073@end table 1074 1075For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}. 1076For documentation on how to write command files, 1077@xref{Command Files,,Command Files}. 1078 1079@anchor{-nh} 1080@item -nh 1081@cindex @code{--nh} 1082Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file 1083in your home directory. 1084@xref{Startup}. 1085 1086@item -quiet 1087@itemx -silent 1088@itemx -q 1089@cindex @code{--quiet} 1090@cindex @code{--silent} 1091@cindex @code{-q} 1092``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These 1093messages are also suppressed in batch mode. 1094 1095@item -batch 1096@cindex @code{--batch} 1097Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the 1098command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from 1099initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with 1100nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands 1101in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited 1102terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm 1103off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}). 1104 1105Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for 1106example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to 1107make this more useful, the message 1108 1109@smallexample 1110Program exited normally. 1111@end smallexample 1112 1113@noindent 1114(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under 1115@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch 1116mode. 1117 1118@item -batch-silent 1119@cindex @code{--batch-silent} 1120Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All 1121@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is 1122unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless 1123for an interactive session. 1124 1125This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section} 1126messages, for example. 1127 1128Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to 1129writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent. 1130 1131@item -return-child-result 1132@cindex @code{--return-child-result} 1133The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child 1134process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions: 1135 1136@itemize @bullet 1137@item 1138@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an 1139internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been 1140without @samp{-return-child-result}. 1141@item 1142The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}. 1143@item 1144The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case 1145the exit code will be -1. 1146@end itemize 1147 1148This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent}, 1149when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator 1150interface. 1151 1152@item -nowindows 1153@itemx -nw 1154@cindex @code{--nowindows} 1155@cindex @code{-nw} 1156``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface 1157(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line 1158interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect. 1159 1160@item -windows 1161@itemx -w 1162@cindex @code{--windows} 1163@cindex @code{-w} 1164If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be 1165used if possible. 1166 1167@item -cd @var{directory} 1168@cindex @code{--cd} 1169Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory, 1170instead of the current directory. 1171 1172@item -data-directory @var{directory} 1173@itemx -D @var{directory} 1174@cindex @code{--data-directory} 1175@cindex @code{-D} 1176Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory. 1177The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its 1178auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}. 1179 1180@item -fullname 1181@itemx -f 1182@cindex @code{--fullname} 1183@cindex @code{-f} 1184@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a 1185subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line 1186number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is 1187displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This 1188recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by 1189the file name, line number and character position separated by colons, 1190and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two 1191@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the 1192frame. 1193 1194@item -annotate @var{level} 1195@cindex @code{--annotate} 1196This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its 1197effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}} 1198(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much 1199information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of 1200expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the 1201normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of 1202@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs 1203that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated. 1204 1205The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi} 1206(@pxref{GDB/MI}). 1207 1208@item --args 1209@cindex @code{--args} 1210Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the 1211executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior. 1212This option stops option processing. 1213 1214@item -baud @var{bps} 1215@itemx -b @var{bps} 1216@cindex @code{--baud} 1217@cindex @code{-b} 1218Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial 1219interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging. 1220 1221@item -l @var{timeout} 1222@cindex @code{-l} 1223Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN} 1224for remote debugging. 1225 1226@item -tty @var{device} 1227@itemx -t @var{device} 1228@cindex @code{--tty} 1229@cindex @code{-t} 1230Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output. 1231@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate. 1232 1233@c resolve the situation of these eventually 1234@item -tui 1235@cindex @code{--tui} 1236Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User 1237Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing 1238source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs 1239(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this 1240option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, , 1241Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}). 1242 1243@item -interpreter @var{interp} 1244@cindex @code{--interpreter} 1245Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling 1246program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which 1247communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. 1248@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}. 1249 1250@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes 1251@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , 1252The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The 1253previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and 1254selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier 1255@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported. 1256 1257@item -write 1258@cindex @code{--write} 1259Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This 1260is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN} 1261(@pxref{Patching}). 1262 1263@item -statistics 1264@cindex @code{--statistics} 1265This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and 1266memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt. 1267 1268@item -version 1269@cindex @code{--version} 1270This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and 1271no-warranty blurb, and exit. 1272 1273@item -configuration 1274@cindex @code{--configuration} 1275This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time 1276configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be 1277important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}). 1278 1279@end table 1280 1281@node Startup 1282@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup 1283@cindex @value{GDBN} startup 1284 1285Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup: 1286 1287@enumerate 1288@item 1289Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line 1290(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}). 1291 1292@item 1293@cindex init file 1294Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was 1295used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration, 1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in 1297that file. 1298 1299@anchor{Home Directory Init File} 1300@item 1301Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On 1302DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the 1303@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in 1304that file. 1305 1306@anchor{Option -init-eval-command} 1307@item 1308Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and 1309@samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the 1310@samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply 1311settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior 1312gets loaded. 1313 1314@item 1315Processes command line options and operands. 1316 1317@anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup} 1318@item 1319Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current 1320working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to 1321@samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}). 1322This is only done if the current directory is 1323different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one 1324init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific 1325to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke 1326@value{GDBN}. 1327 1328@item 1329If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to 1330attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded 1331scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries. 1332@xref{Auto-loading}. 1333 1334If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup, 1335you must do something like the following: 1336 1337@smallexample 1338$ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram 1339@end smallexample 1340 1341Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned 1342off too late. 1343 1344@item 1345Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and 1346@samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for 1347more details about @value{GDBN} command files. 1348 1349@item 1350Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}. 1351@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the 1352files where @value{GDBN} records it. 1353@end enumerate 1354 1355Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command 1356Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init 1357file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set 1358complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options 1359and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx} 1360option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}). 1361 1362To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you 1363can use @kbd{gdb --help}. 1364 1365@cindex init file name 1366@cindex @file{.gdbinit} 1367@cindex @file{gdb.ini} 1368The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}. 1369The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to 1370the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows 1371port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a 1372@file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that 1373and suggests to rename the file to the standard name. 1374 1375 1376@node Quitting GDB 1377@section Quitting @value{GDBN} 1378@cindex exiting @value{GDBN} 1379@cindex leaving @value{GDBN} 1380 1381@table @code 1382@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]} 1383@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})} 1384@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]} 1385@itemx q 1386To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated 1387@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you 1388do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; 1389otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the 1390error code. 1391@end table 1392 1393@cindex interrupt 1394An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather 1395terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and 1396returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt 1397character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect 1398until a time when it is safe. 1399 1400If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or 1401device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command 1402(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}). 1403 1404@node Shell Commands 1405@section Shell Commands 1406 1407If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your 1408debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can 1409just use the @code{shell} command. 1410 1411@table @code 1412@kindex shell 1413@kindex ! 1414@cindex shell escape 1415@item shell @var{command-string} 1416@itemx !@var{command-string} 1417Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}. 1418Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}. 1419If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which 1420shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell 1421(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.). 1422@end table 1423 1424The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments. 1425You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in 1426@value{GDBN}: 1427 1428@table @code 1429@kindex make 1430@cindex calling make 1431@item make @var{make-args} 1432Execute the @code{make} program with the specified 1433arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}. 1434@end table 1435 1436@node Logging Output 1437@section Logging Output 1438@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output 1439@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file 1440 1441You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file. 1442There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging. 1443 1444@table @code 1445@kindex set logging 1446@item set logging on 1447Enable logging. 1448@item set logging off 1449Disable logging. 1450@cindex logging file name 1451@item set logging file @var{file} 1452Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}. 1453@item set logging overwrite [on|off] 1454By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if 1455you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead. 1456@item set logging redirect [on|off] 1457By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile. 1458Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file. 1459@kindex show logging 1460@item show logging 1461Show the current values of the logging settings. 1462@end table 1463 1464@node Commands 1465@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands 1466 1467You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command 1468name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain 1469@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB} 1470key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to 1471show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility). 1472 1473@menu 1474* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN} 1475* Completion:: Command completion 1476* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help 1477@end menu 1478 1479@node Command Syntax 1480@section Command Syntax 1481 1482A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on 1483how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by 1484arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the 1485command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to 1486step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command 1487with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments. 1488 1489@cindex abbreviation 1490@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is 1491unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the 1492documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous 1493abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as 1494equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose 1495names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as 1496arguments to the @code{help} command. 1497 1498@cindex repeating commands 1499@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)} 1500A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to 1501repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run}) 1502will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional 1503repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to 1504repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see 1505@ref{Define, dont-repeat}. 1506 1507The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with 1508@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating 1509exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory. 1510 1511@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy 1512output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more} 1513(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one 1514@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command 1515repetition after any command that generates this sort of display. 1516 1517@kindex # @r{(a comment)} 1518@cindex comment 1519Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does 1520nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command 1521Files,,Command Files}). 1522 1523@cindex repeating command sequences 1524@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)} 1525The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of 1526commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and 1527then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history 1528for editing. 1529 1530@node Completion 1531@section Command Completion 1532 1533@cindex completion 1534@cindex word completion 1535@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is 1536only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities 1537are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN} 1538commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program. 1539 1540Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest 1541of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the 1542word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to 1543enter it). For example, if you type 1544 1545@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit 1546@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity. 1547@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to 1548@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following... 1549@smallexample 1550(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB} 1551@end smallexample 1552 1553@noindent 1554@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is 1555the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}: 1556 1557@smallexample 1558(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints 1559@end smallexample 1560 1561@noindent 1562You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info 1563breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if 1564@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you 1565were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you 1566might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre}, 1567to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion). 1568 1569If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press 1570@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more 1571characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time; 1572@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For 1573example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name 1574begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN} 1575just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the 1576function names in your program that begin with those characters, for 1577example: 1578 1579@smallexample 1580(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB} 1581@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see: 1582make_a_section_from_file make_environ 1583make_abs_section make_function_type 1584make_blockvector make_pointer_type 1585make_cleanup make_reference_type 1586make_command make_symbol_completion_list 1587(@value{GDBP}) b make_ 1588@end smallexample 1589 1590@noindent 1591After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your 1592partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the 1593command. 1594 1595If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you 1596can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?} 1597means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a 1598key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is 1599one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}. 1600 1601If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will 1602print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message 1603indicating that the list may be truncated. 1604 1605@smallexample 1606(@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB} 1607main 1608<... the rest of the possible completions ...> 1609*** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. *** 1610(@value{GDBP}) b m 1611@end smallexample 1612 1613@noindent 1614This behavior can be controlled with the following commands: 1615 1616@table @code 1617@kindex set max-completions 1618@item set max-completions @var{limit} 1619@itemx set max-completions unlimited 1620Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will 1621stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates. 1622This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting 1623all the possible candidates can be time consuming. 1624The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion. 1625Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make 1626completion slow. 1627@kindex show max-completions 1628@item show max-completions 1629Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show 1630during completion. 1631@end table 1632 1633@cindex quotes in commands 1634@cindex completion of quoted strings 1635Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain 1636parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from 1637its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this 1638situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in 1639@value{GDBN} commands. 1640 1641The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the 1642name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function 1643overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished 1644by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you 1645may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} 1646that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version 1647that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the 1648word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote 1649@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts 1650@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual 1651when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion: 1652 1653@smallexample 1654(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?} 1655bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int) 1656(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( 1657@end smallexample 1658 1659In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using 1660quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while 1661completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first 1662place: 1663 1664@smallexample 1665(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB} 1666@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell: 1667(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( 1668@end smallexample 1669 1670@noindent 1671In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if 1672you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for 1673completion on an overloaded symbol. 1674 1675For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus 1676Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set 1677overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution; 1678see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}. 1679 1680@cindex completion of structure field names 1681@cindex structure field name completion 1682@cindex completion of union field names 1683@cindex union field name completion 1684When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a 1685structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be 1686confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only 1687examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to 1688limit completions to the field names available in the type of the 1689left-hand-side: 1690 1691@smallexample 1692(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?} 1693magic to_fputs to_rewind 1694to_data to_isatty to_write 1695to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe 1696to_flush to_read 1697@end smallexample 1698 1699@noindent 1700This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type 1701@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as 1702follows: 1703 1704@smallexample 1705struct ui_file 1706@{ 1707 int *magic; 1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush; 1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write; 1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe; 1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs; 1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read; 1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete; 1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty; 1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind; 1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put; 1717 void *to_data; 1718@} 1719@end smallexample 1720 1721 1722@node Help 1723@section Getting Help 1724@cindex online documentation 1725@kindex help 1726 1727You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands, 1728using the command @code{help}. 1729 1730@table @code 1731@kindex h @r{(@code{help})} 1732@item help 1733@itemx h 1734You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to 1735display a short list of named classes of commands: 1736 1737@smallexample 1738(@value{GDBP}) help 1739List of classes of commands: 1740 1741aliases -- Aliases of other commands 1742breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points 1743data -- Examining data 1744files -- Specifying and examining files 1745internals -- Maintenance commands 1746obscure -- Obscure features 1747running -- Running the program 1748stack -- Examining the stack 1749status -- Status inquiries 1750support -- Support facilities 1751tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without 1752 stopping the program 1753user-defined -- User-defined commands 1754 1755Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of 1756commands in that class. 1757Type "help" followed by command name for full 1758documentation. 1759Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. 1760(@value{GDBP}) 1761@end smallexample 1762@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull... 1763 1764@item help @var{class} 1765Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a 1766list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the 1767help display for the class @code{status}: 1768 1769@smallexample 1770(@value{GDBP}) help status 1771Status inquiries. 1772 1773List of commands: 1774 1775@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed 1776@c to fit in smallbook page size. 1777info -- Generic command for showing things 1778 about the program being debugged 1779show -- Generic command for showing things 1780 about the debugger 1781 1782Type "help" followed by command name for full 1783documentation. 1784Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. 1785(@value{GDBP}) 1786@end smallexample 1787 1788@item help @var{command} 1789With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a 1790short paragraph on how to use that command. 1791 1792@kindex apropos 1793@item apropos @var{args} 1794The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN} 1795commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in 1796@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example: 1797 1798@smallexample 1799apropos alias 1800@end smallexample 1801 1802@noindent 1803results in: 1804 1805@smallexample 1806@c @group 1807alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command 1808aliases -- Aliases of other commands 1809d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions 1810del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions 1811delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions 1812@c @end group 1813@end smallexample 1814 1815@kindex complete 1816@item complete @var{args} 1817The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions 1818for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the 1819command you want completed. For example: 1820 1821@smallexample 1822complete i 1823@end smallexample 1824 1825@noindent results in: 1826 1827@smallexample 1828@group 1829if 1830ignore 1831info 1832inspect 1833@end group 1834@end smallexample 1835 1836@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs. 1837@end table 1838 1839In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info} 1840and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state 1841of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this 1842manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings 1843under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and 1844Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable 1845Index}. 1846 1847@c @group 1848@table @code 1849@kindex info 1850@kindex i @r{(@code{info})} 1851@item info 1852This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your 1853program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function 1854with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info 1855registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}. 1856You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with 1857@w{@code{help info}}. 1858 1859@kindex set 1860@item set 1861You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with 1862@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with 1863@code{set prompt $}. 1864 1865@kindex show 1866@item show 1867In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of 1868@value{GDBN} itself. 1869You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the 1870related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number 1871system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire 1872which is currently in use with @code{show radix}. 1873 1874@kindex info set 1875To display all the settable parameters and their current 1876values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use 1877@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display. 1878@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of 1879@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else, 1880@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"? 1881@end table 1882@c @end group 1883 1884Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are 1885exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands: 1886 1887@table @code 1888@kindex show version 1889@cindex @value{GDBN} version number 1890@item show version 1891Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this 1892information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of 1893@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which 1894version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new 1895commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many 1896system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are 1897variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well. 1898The version number is the same as the one announced when you start 1899@value{GDBN}. 1900 1901@kindex show copying 1902@kindex info copying 1903@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright 1904@item show copying 1905@itemx info copying 1906Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}. 1907 1908@kindex show warranty 1909@kindex info warranty 1910@item show warranty 1911@itemx info warranty 1912Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty, 1913if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one. 1914 1915@kindex show configuration 1916@item show configuration 1917Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured 1918when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the 1919@file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected 1920automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN} 1921bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in 1922your report. 1923 1924@end table 1925 1926@node Running 1927@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN} 1928 1929When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate 1930debugging information when you compile it. 1931 1932You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment 1933of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect 1934your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or 1935kill a child process. 1936 1937@menu 1938* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging 1939* Starting:: Starting your program 1940* Arguments:: Your program's arguments 1941* Environment:: Your program's environment 1942 1943* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory 1944* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output 1945* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process 1946* Kill Process:: Killing the child process 1947 1948* Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs 1949* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads 1950* Forks:: Debugging forks 1951* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later 1952@end menu 1953 1954@node Compilation 1955@section Compiling for Debugging 1956 1957In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate 1958debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information 1959is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each 1960variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers 1961and addresses in the executable code. 1962 1963To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run 1964the compiler. 1965 1966Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with 1967optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some 1968compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options 1969together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized 1970executables containing debugging information. 1971 1972@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or 1973without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We 1974recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a 1975program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense 1976in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}. 1977 1978Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option 1979@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this 1980format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it. 1981 1982@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their 1983expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information 1984about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify 1985the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, 1986the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using 1987the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}. 1988 1989@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC, 1990gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more 1991information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information. 1992 1993You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest 1994version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports. 1995DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging 1996format in @value{GDBN}. 1997 1998@need 2000 1999@node Starting 2000@section Starting your Program 2001@cindex starting 2002@cindex running 2003 2004@table @code 2005@kindex run 2006@kindex r @r{(@code{run})} 2007@item run 2008@itemx r 2009Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}. 2010You must first specify the program name with an argument to 2011@value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of 2012@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} 2013command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 2014 2015@end table 2016 2017If you are running your program in an execution environment that 2018supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes 2019that process run your program. In some environments without processes, 2020@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets, 2021like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error 2022message like this one: 2023 2024@smallexample 2025The "remote" target does not support "run". 2026Try "help target" or "continue". 2027@end smallexample 2028 2029@noindent 2030then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load} 2031first (@pxref{load}). 2032 2033The execution of a program is affected by certain information it 2034receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this 2035information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You 2036can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect 2037your program the next time you start it.) This information may be 2038divided into four categories: 2039 2040@table @asis 2041@item The @emph{arguments.} 2042Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the 2043@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell 2044is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions 2045(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing 2046the arguments. 2047In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the 2048@code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, 2049@value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable 2050use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see 2051below for details). 2052 2053@item The @emph{environment.} 2054Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can 2055use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset 2056environment} to change parts of the environment that affect 2057your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}. 2058 2059@item The @emph{working directory.} 2060Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set 2061the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}. 2062@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}. 2063 2064@item The @emph{standard input and output.} 2065Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and 2066standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output 2067in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to 2068set a different device for your program. 2069@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}. 2070 2071@cindex pipes 2072@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use 2073pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another 2074program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the 2075wrong program. 2076@end table 2077 2078When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute 2079immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion 2080of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has 2081stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print} 2082or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}. 2083 2084If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last 2085time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol 2086table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain 2087your current breakpoints. 2088 2089@table @code 2090@kindex start 2091@item start 2092@cindex run to main procedure 2093The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language. 2094With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but 2095other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their 2096main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the 2097execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main 2098procedure, depending on the language used. 2099 2100The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary 2101breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking 2102the @samp{run} command. 2103 2104@cindex elaboration phase 2105Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is 2106executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the 2107languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance, 2108constructors for static and global objects are executed before 2109@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops 2110before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint 2111will remain to halt execution. 2112 2113Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the 2114@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the 2115underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be 2116reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to 2117@samp{start} or @samp{run}. 2118 2119It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In 2120these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of 2121your program too late, as the program would have already completed the 2122elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your 2123elaboration code before running your program. 2124 2125@anchor{set exec-wrapper} 2126@kindex set exec-wrapper 2127@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper} 2128@itemx show exec-wrapper 2129@itemx unset exec-wrapper 2130When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to 2131launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program 2132with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper} 2133@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its 2134arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if 2135appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes 2136your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control. 2137 2138You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with 2139its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do 2140this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending 2141with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work. 2142 2143For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to 2144the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's 2145environment: 2146 2147@smallexample 2148(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so' 2149(@value{GDBP}) run 2150@end smallexample 2151 2152This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding 2153@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino. 2154 2155@kindex set startup-with-shell 2156@item set startup-with-shell 2157@itemx set startup-with-shell on 2158@itemx set startup-with-shell off 2159@itemx show set startup-with-shell 2160On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target, 2161@value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the 2162@code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable 2163substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of 2164I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a 2165shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing 2166startup failures such as: 2167 2168@smallexample 2169(@value{GDBP}) run 2170Starting program: ./a.out 2171During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault. 2172@end smallexample 2173 2174@noindent 2175which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with 2176@samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is 2177caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode 2178initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, 2179$@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the 2180@samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH. 2181 2182@anchor{set auto-connect-native-target} 2183@kindex set auto-connect-native-target 2184@item set auto-connect-native-target 2185@itemx set auto-connect-native-target on 2186@itemx set auto-connect-native-target off 2187@itemx show auto-connect-native-target 2188 2189By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with 2190@code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a 2191native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're 2192sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can 2193tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically 2194with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command. 2195 2196If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not 2197connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly 2198connects to the native target, if one is available. 2199 2200If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target 2201already, the @code{run} command fails with an error: 2202 2203@smallexample 2204(@value{GDBP}) run 2205Don't know how to run. Try "help target". 2206@end smallexample 2207 2208If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always 2209uses it with the @code{run} command. 2210 2211In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the 2212@code{target native} command. For example, 2213 2214@smallexample 2215(@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off 2216(@value{GDBP}) run 2217Don't know how to run. Try "help target". 2218(@value{GDBP}) target native 2219(@value{GDBP}) run 2220Starting program: ./a.out 2221[Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally] 2222@end smallexample 2223 2224In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target, 2225@value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for 2226the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to 2227disconnect. 2228 2229Examples of other commands that likewise respect the 2230@code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info 2231proc}, @code{info os}. 2232 2233@kindex set disable-randomization 2234@item set disable-randomization 2235@itemx set disable-randomization on 2236This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native 2237randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option 2238is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better 2239reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions. 2240 2241This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux. 2242On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using 2243 2244@smallexample 2245(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R 2246@end smallexample 2247 2248@item set disable-randomization off 2249Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their 2250ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug 2251disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because 2252@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such 2253as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set 2254disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs. 2255 2256On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization 2257protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these 2258cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable 2259code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing 2260a code at its expected addresses. 2261 2262Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it 2263makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by 2264having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared 2265library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code 2266misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new 2267random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the 2268startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at 2269a randomly chosen address. 2270 2271Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code 2272similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at 2273a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even 2274already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such 2275executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}. 2276 2277Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly 2278(as long as the randomization is enabled). 2279 2280@item show disable-randomization 2281Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of 2282the virtual address space of the started program. 2283 2284@end table 2285 2286@node Arguments 2287@section Your Program's Arguments 2288 2289@cindex arguments (to your program) 2290The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the 2291@code{run} command. 2292They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and 2293performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your 2294@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell 2295@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses 2296the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix). 2297 2298On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by 2299@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system 2300calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of 2301the program, not by the shell. 2302 2303@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous 2304@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command. 2305 2306@table @code 2307@kindex set args 2308@item set args 2309Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If 2310@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program 2311with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments, 2312using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run 2313it again without arguments. 2314 2315@kindex show args 2316@item show args 2317Show the arguments to give your program when it is started. 2318@end table 2319 2320@node Environment 2321@section Your Program's Environment 2322 2323@cindex environment (of your program) 2324The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and 2325their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as 2326your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search 2327path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with 2328the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When 2329debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified 2330environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again. 2331 2332@table @code 2333@kindex path 2334@item path @var{directory} 2335Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable 2336(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program. 2337The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change. 2338You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a 2339system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on 2340MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it 2341is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner. 2342 2343You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current 2344working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you 2345use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the 2346@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the 2347@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding 2348@var{directory} to the search path. 2349@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to 2350@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op. 2351 2352@kindex show paths 2353@item show paths 2354Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH} 2355environment variable). 2356 2357@kindex show environment 2358@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]} 2359Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to 2360your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname}, 2361print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to 2362your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}. 2363 2364@kindex set environment 2365@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]} 2366Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value 2367changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch 2368it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the 2369values of environment variables are just strings, and any 2370interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value} 2371parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a 2372null value. 2373@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing 2374@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care? 2375 2376For example, this command: 2377 2378@smallexample 2379set env USER = foo 2380@end smallexample 2381 2382@noindent 2383tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named 2384@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they 2385are not actually required.) 2386 2387Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell, 2388which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}. 2389If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a 2390wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set 2391exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that. 2392 2393@kindex unset environment 2394@item unset environment @var{varname} 2395Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your 2396program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =}; 2397@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment, 2398rather than assigning it an empty value. 2399@end table 2400 2401@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using 2402the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it 2403exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable 2404names a shell that runs an initialization file when started 2405non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv} 2406for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV} 2407environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file 2408affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment 2409variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as 2410@file{.login} or @file{.profile}. 2411 2412@node Working Directory 2413@section Your Program's Working Directory 2414 2415@cindex working directory (of your program) 2416Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its 2417working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}. 2418The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited 2419from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new 2420working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command. 2421 2422The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands 2423that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to 2424Specify Files}. 2425 2426@table @code 2427@kindex cd 2428@cindex change working directory 2429@item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]} 2430Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not 2431given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}. 2432 2433@kindex pwd 2434@item pwd 2435Print the @value{GDBN} working directory. 2436@end table 2437 2438It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of 2439the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory 2440during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is 2441configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info 2442proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the 2443current working directory of the debuggee. 2444 2445@node Input/Output 2446@section Your Program's Input and Output 2447 2448@cindex redirection 2449@cindex i/o 2450@cindex terminal 2451By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to 2452the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal 2453to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal 2454modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue 2455running your program. 2456 2457@table @code 2458@kindex info terminal 2459@item info terminal 2460Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your 2461program is using. 2462@end table 2463 2464You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell 2465redirection with the @code{run} command. For example, 2466 2467@smallexample 2468run > outfile 2469@end smallexample 2470 2471@noindent 2472starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}. 2473 2474@kindex tty 2475@cindex controlling terminal 2476Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is 2477with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as 2478argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run} 2479commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child 2480process, for future @code{run} commands. For example, 2481 2482@smallexample 2483tty /dev/ttyb 2484@end smallexample 2485 2486@noindent 2487directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands 2488default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have 2489that as their controlling terminal. 2490 2491An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's 2492effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling 2493terminal. 2494 2495When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run} 2496command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input 2497for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias 2498for @code{set inferior-tty}. 2499 2500@cindex inferior tty 2501@cindex set inferior controlling terminal 2502You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to 2503display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your 2504program. 2505 2506@table @code 2507@item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ] 2508@kindex set inferior-tty 2509Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty} 2510restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as 2511@value{GDBN}. 2512 2513@item show inferior-tty 2514@kindex show inferior-tty 2515Show the current tty for the program being debugged. 2516@end table 2517 2518@node Attach 2519@section Debugging an Already-running Process 2520@kindex attach 2521@cindex attach 2522 2523@table @code 2524@item attach @var{process-id} 2525This command attaches to a running process---one that was started 2526outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active 2527targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to 2528find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility, 2529or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command. 2530 2531@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after 2532executing the command. 2533@end table 2534 2535To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment 2536which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for 2537programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must 2538also have permission to send the process a signal. 2539 2540When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in 2541the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if 2542the program is not found) by using the source file search path 2543(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use 2544the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to 2545Specify Files}. 2546 2547The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified 2548process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process 2549with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when 2550you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you 2551can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the 2552process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after 2553attaching @value{GDBN} to the process. 2554 2555@table @code 2556@kindex detach 2557@item detach 2558When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the 2559@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching 2560the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command, 2561that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you 2562are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}. 2563@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after 2564executing the command. 2565@end table 2566 2567If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach 2568that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process. 2569By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these 2570things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the 2571@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 2572Messages}). 2573 2574@node Kill Process 2575@section Killing the Child Process 2576 2577@table @code 2578@kindex kill 2579@item kill 2580Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}. 2581@end table 2582 2583This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a 2584running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program 2585is running. 2586 2587On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN} 2588while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the 2589@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program 2590outside the debugger. 2591 2592The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and 2593relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an 2594executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you 2595next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and 2596reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current 2597breakpoint settings). 2598 2599@node Inferiors and Programs 2600@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs 2601 2602@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single 2603session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run 2604several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one 2605before starting another). In the most general case, you can have 2606multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched 2607from multiple executables. 2608 2609@cindex inferior 2610@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an 2611object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to 2612a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not 2613have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and 2614may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique 2615identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each 2616inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some 2617embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts 2618of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple 2619threads running in it. 2620 2621To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info 2622inferiors}}: 2623 2624@table @code 2625@kindex info inferiors 2626@item info inferiors 2627Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}. 2628 2629@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order): 2630 2631@enumerate 2632@item 2633the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2634 2635@item 2636the target system's inferior identifier 2637 2638@item 2639the name of the executable the inferior is running. 2640 2641@end enumerate 2642 2643@noindent 2644An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number 2645indicates the current inferior. 2646 2647For example, 2648@end table 2649@c end table here to get a little more width for example 2650 2651@smallexample 2652(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2653 Num Description Executable 2654 2 process 2307 hello 2655* 1 process 3401 goodbye 2656@end smallexample 2657 2658To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command: 2659 2660@table @code 2661@kindex inferior @var{infno} 2662@item inferior @var{infno} 2663Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument 2664@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown 2665in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display. 2666@end table 2667 2668@vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable} 2669The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the 2670number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing 2671breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. 2672@xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general 2673information on convenience variables. 2674 2675You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the 2676@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some 2677systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session 2678automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To 2679remove inferiors from the debugging session use the 2680@w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command. 2681 2682@table @code 2683@kindex add-inferior 2684@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ] 2685Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the 2686executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified, 2687the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or 2688change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the 2689@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument. 2690 2691@kindex clone-inferior 2692@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ] 2693Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior 2694@var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the 2695number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you 2696want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging. 2697 2698@smallexample 2699(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2700 Num Description Executable 2701* 1 process 29964 helloworld 2702(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior 2703Added inferior 2. 27041 inferiors added. 2705(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2706 Num Description Executable 2707 2 <null> helloworld 2708* 1 process 29964 helloworld 2709@end smallexample 2710 2711You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it. 2712 2713@kindex remove-inferiors 2714@item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2715Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not 2716possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For 2717those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first. 2718 2719@end table 2720 2721To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current 2722inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach 2723inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it 2724using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command: 2725 2726@table @code 2727@kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2728@item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{} 2729Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} 2730inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry 2731still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, 2732but its Description will show @samp{<null>}. 2733 2734@kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2735@item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2736Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior 2737number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still 2738stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its 2739Description will show @samp{<null>}. 2740@end table 2741 2742After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach}, 2743@code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after 2744a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with 2745@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted. 2746 2747 2748To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s 2749control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}: 2750 2751@table @code 2752@kindex set print inferior-events 2753@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit 2754@item set print inferior-events 2755@itemx set print inferior-events on 2756@itemx set print inferior-events off 2757The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or 2758disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new 2759inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been 2760detached. By default, these messages will not be printed. 2761 2762@kindex show print inferior-events 2763@item show print inferior-events 2764Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that 2765inferiors have started, exited or have been detached. 2766@end table 2767 2768Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a 2769single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the 2770value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior. 2771 2772 2773Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to 2774get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address 2775spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint 2776info program-spaces}} command. 2777 2778@table @code 2779@kindex maint info program-spaces 2780@item maint info program-spaces 2781Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by 2782@value{GDBN}. 2783 2784@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order): 2785 2786@enumerate 2787@item 2788the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2789 2790@item 2791the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g., 2792the @code{file} command. 2793 2794@end enumerate 2795 2796@noindent 2797An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number 2798indicates the current program space. 2799 2800In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra 2801information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For 2802example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space. 2803 2804@smallexample 2805(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces 2806 Id Executable 2807* 1 hello 2808 2 goodbye 2809 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561) 2810@end smallexample 2811 2812Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello}, 2813while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On 2814some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the 2815same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both 2816the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example, 2817 2818@smallexample 2819(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces 2820 Id Executable 2821* 1 vfork-test 2822 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045) 2823@end smallexample 2824 2825Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program 2826space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call. 2827@end table 2828 2829@node Threads 2830@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads 2831 2832@cindex threads of execution 2833@cindex multiple threads 2834@cindex switching threads 2835In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program 2836may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics 2837of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general 2838the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except 2839that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and 2840modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own 2841registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory. 2842 2843@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread 2844programs: 2845 2846@itemize @bullet 2847@item automatic notification of new threads 2848@item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads 2849@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads 2850@item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}}, 2851a command to apply a command to a list of threads 2852@item thread-specific breakpoints 2853@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of 2854messages on thread start and exit. 2855@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets 2856the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice 2857isn't compatible with the program. 2858@end itemize 2859 2860@cindex focus of debugging 2861@cindex current thread 2862The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all 2863threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes 2864control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging. 2865This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show 2866program information from the perspective of the current thread. 2867 2868@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message 2869@cindex thread identifier (system) 2870@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message 2871@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that 2872@c thread without first checking `info threads'. 2873Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays 2874the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the 2875form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier 2876whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on 2877@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see 2878 2879@smallexample 2880[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)] 2881@end smallexample 2882 2883@noindent 2884when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems, 2885the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no 2886further qualifier. 2887 2888@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first 2889@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the 2890@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread 2891@c program? 2892@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some 2893@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple 2894@c threads ab initio? 2895 2896@anchor{thread numbers} 2897@cindex thread number, per inferior 2898@cindex thread identifier (GDB) 2899For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number 2900---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This 2901number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique 2902between threads of different inferiors. 2903 2904@cindex qualified thread ID 2905You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified 2906@var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as 2907@dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior 2908number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given 2909inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of 2910inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}), 2911then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current 2912inferior. 2913 2914Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the 2915@var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use 2916the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads 2917of inferior 1, the initial inferior. 2918 2919@anchor{thread ID lists} 2920@cindex thread ID lists 2921Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as 2922argument. A list element can be: 2923 2924@enumerate 2925@item 2926A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} 2927display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or 2928@samp{1}. 2929 2930@item 2931A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior 2932qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or 2933@var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}. 2934 2935@item 2936All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or 2937without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g., 2938@samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the 2939given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier 2940refers to all threads of the current inferior. 2941 2942@end enumerate 2943 2944For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one 2945thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*} 2946includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads 29477 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in 2948expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9 29497.1}. 2950 2951 2952@anchor{global thread numbers} 2953@cindex global thread number 2954@cindex global thread identifier (GDB) 2955In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also 2956assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global 2957thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of 2958the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when 2959you're debugging multiple inferiors. 2960 2961From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one 2962thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the 2963program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded. 2964 2965@vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable} 2966@vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable} 2967The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and 2968@samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number 2969and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this 2970useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, 2971and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for 2972general information on convenience variables. 2973 2974If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the 2975usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of 2976the thread that hit the breakpoint. 2977 2978@smallexample 2979Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68 2980@end smallexample 2981 2982Likewise when the program receives a signal: 2983 2984@smallexample 2985Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt. 2986@end smallexample 2987 2988@table @code 2989@kindex info threads 2990@item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]} 2991 2992Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments 2993displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of 2994threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax 2995(@pxref{thread ID lists}). 2996 2997@value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order): 2998 2999@enumerate 3000@item 3001the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN} 3002 3003@item 3004the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid} 3005option was specified 3006 3007@item 3008the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag}) 3009 3010@item 3011the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by 3012the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the 3013program itself. 3014 3015@item 3016the current stack frame summary for that thread 3017@end enumerate 3018 3019@noindent 3020An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number 3021indicates the current thread. 3022 3023For example, 3024@end table 3025@c end table here to get a little more width for example 3026 3027@smallexample 3028(@value{GDBP}) info threads 3029 Id Target Id Frame 3030* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 3031 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3032 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3033 at threadtest.c:68 3034@end smallexample 3035 3036If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread 3037IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format. 3038Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown. 3039 3040If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column 3041indicating each thread's global thread ID: 3042 3043@smallexample 3044(@value{GDBP}) info threads 3045 Id GId Target Id Frame 3046 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 3047 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3048 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3049* 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 3050@end smallexample 3051 3052On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a 3053Solaris-specific command: 3054 3055@table @code 3056@item maint info sol-threads 3057@kindex maint info sol-threads 3058@cindex thread info (Solaris) 3059Display info on Solaris user threads. 3060@end table 3061 3062@table @code 3063@kindex thread @var{thread-id} 3064@item thread @var{thread-id} 3065Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command 3066argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in 3067the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an 3068inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}). 3069 3070@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the 3071thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary: 3072 3073@smallexample 3074(@value{GDBP}) thread 2 3075[Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))] 3076#0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8 30778 printf ("hello\n"); 3078@end smallexample 3079 3080@noindent 3081As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after 3082@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying 3083threads. 3084 3085@kindex thread apply 3086@cindex apply command to several threads 3087@item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command} 3088The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named 3089@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you 3090want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID 3091lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a 3092command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all 3093@var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order, 3094type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}. 3095 3096 3097@kindex thread name 3098@cindex name a thread 3099@item thread name [@var{name}] 3100This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is 3101given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name 3102appears in the @samp{info threads} display. 3103 3104On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to 3105determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these 3106systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the 3107system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause 3108@value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name. 3109 3110@kindex thread find 3111@cindex search for a thread 3112@item thread find [@var{regexp}] 3113Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag} 3114matches the supplied regular expression. 3115 3116As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command, 3117this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target 3118@var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag} 3119is the LWP id. 3120 3121@smallexample 3122(@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688 3123Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)' 3124(@value{GDBN}) info thread 4 3125 Id Target Id Frame 3126 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select () 3127@end smallexample 3128 3129@kindex set print thread-events 3130@cindex print messages on thread start and exit 3131@item set print thread-events 3132@itemx set print thread-events on 3133@itemx set print thread-events off 3134The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or 3135disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have 3136started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will 3137be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target. 3138Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets. 3139 3140@kindex show print thread-events 3141@item show print thread-events 3142Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads 3143have started and exited. 3144@end table 3145 3146@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for 3147more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start 3148programs with multiple threads. 3149 3150@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about 3151watchpoints in programs with multiple threads. 3152 3153@anchor{set libthread-db-search-path} 3154@table @code 3155@kindex set libthread-db-search-path 3156@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db} 3157@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]} 3158If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 3159directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}. 3160If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to 3161its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems). 3162Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH} 3163macro. 3164 3165On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper'' 3166@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the 3167inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 3168to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior 3169specific thread debugging library loading is enabled 3170by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}). 3171 3172A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 3173refers to the default system directories that are 3174normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry 3175is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} 3176(@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}). 3177 3178A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 3179refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread} 3180was loaded in the inferior process. 3181 3182For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories, 3183@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process. 3184If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version 3185mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN} 3186will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory. 3187If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully, 3188@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled. 3189 3190Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented 3191only on some platforms. 3192 3193@kindex show libthread-db-search-path 3194@item show libthread-db-search-path 3195Display current libthread_db search path. 3196 3197@kindex set debug libthread-db 3198@kindex show debug libthread-db 3199@cindex debugging @code{libthread_db} 3200@item set debug libthread-db 3201@itemx show debug libthread-db 3202Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events. 3203Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable. 3204@end table 3205 3206@node Forks 3207@section Debugging Forks 3208 3209@cindex fork, debugging programs which call 3210@cindex multiple processes 3211@cindex processes, multiple 3212On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging 3213programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork} 3214function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the 3215parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have 3216set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child 3217will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal) 3218will cause it to terminate. 3219 3220However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround 3221which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which 3222the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep 3223only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists, 3224so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN} 3225on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to 3226get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of 3227@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to 3228the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug 3229the child process just like any other process which you attached to. 3230 3231On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs 3232that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} 3233functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported 3234with kernel version 2.5.46 and later. 3235 3236The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when 3237connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or 3238@code{target extended-remote} mode. 3239 3240By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug 3241the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. 3242 3243If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process, 3244use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}. 3245 3246@table @code 3247@kindex set follow-fork-mode 3248@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode} 3249Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or 3250@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new 3251process. The @var{mode} argument can be: 3252 3253@table @code 3254@item parent 3255The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs 3256unimpeded. This is the default. 3257 3258@item child 3259The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs 3260unimpeded. 3261 3262@end table 3263 3264@kindex show follow-fork-mode 3265@item show follow-fork-mode 3266Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call. 3267@end table 3268 3269@cindex debugging multiple processes 3270On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the 3271command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}. 3272 3273@table @code 3274@kindex set detach-on-fork 3275@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode} 3276Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or 3277retain debugger control over them both. 3278 3279@table @code 3280@item on 3281The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of 3282@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run 3283independently. This is the default. 3284 3285@item off 3286Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}. 3287One process (child or parent, depending on the value of 3288@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other 3289is held suspended. 3290 3291@end table 3292 3293@kindex show detach-on-fork 3294@item show detach-on-fork 3295Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off. 3296@end table 3297 3298If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN} 3299will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks). 3300You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by 3301using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork 3302to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and 3303Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}). 3304 3305To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach 3306from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it 3307to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} 3308command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors 3309and Programs}. 3310 3311If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an 3312@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first 3313breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on 3314@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on 3315the child process's @code{main}. 3316 3317On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you 3318cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes. 3319 3320If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec} 3321call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent 3322process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name 3323as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes, 3324@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image. 3325You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}} 3326command. 3327 3328@table @code 3329@kindex set follow-exec-mode 3330@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode} 3331 3332Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An 3333@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process. 3334 3335@code{follow-exec-mode} can be: 3336 3337@table @code 3338@item new 3339@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this 3340new inferior. The program the process was running before the 3341@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the 3342original inferior. 3343 3344For example: 3345 3346@smallexample 3347(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3348(gdb) info inferior 3349 Id Description Executable 3350* 1 <null> prog1 3351(@value{GDBP}) run 3352process 12020 is executing new program: prog2 3353Program exited normally. 3354(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3355 Id Description Executable 3356 1 <null> prog1 3357* 2 <null> prog2 3358@end smallexample 3359 3360@item same 3361@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new 3362executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the 3363inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with 3364e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was 3365running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode. 3366 3367For example: 3368 3369@smallexample 3370(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3371 Id Description Executable 3372* 1 <null> prog1 3373(@value{GDBP}) run 3374process 12020 is executing new program: prog2 3375Program exited normally. 3376(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3377 Id Description Executable 3378* 1 <null> prog2 3379@end smallexample 3380 3381@end table 3382@end table 3383 3384@code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and 3385@code{target extended-remote} mode. 3386 3387You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever 3388a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set 3389Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}. 3390 3391@node Checkpoint/Restart 3392@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later 3393 3394@cindex checkpoint 3395@cindex restart 3396@cindex bookmark 3397@cindex snapshot of a process 3398@cindex rewind program state 3399 3400On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only 3401@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a 3402program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it 3403later. 3404 3405Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has 3406happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This 3407includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits) 3408system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the 3409moment when the checkpoint was saved. 3410 3411Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're 3412getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save 3413a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss 3414the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program 3415from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and 3416start again from there. 3417 3418This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or 3419steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs. 3420 3421To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging: 3422 3423@table @code 3424@kindex checkpoint 3425@item checkpoint 3426Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state. 3427The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint 3428is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id. 3429 3430@kindex info checkpoints 3431@item info checkpoints 3432List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging 3433session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be 3434listed: 3435 3436@table @code 3437@item Checkpoint ID 3438@item Process ID 3439@item Code Address 3440@item Source line, or label 3441@end table 3442 3443@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id} 3444@item restart @var{checkpoint-id} 3445Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number 3446@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames 3447etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint 3448was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point 3449in time when the checkpoint was saved. 3450 3451Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc. 3452are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint 3453only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in 3454the debugger. 3455 3456@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id} 3457@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id} 3458Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}. 3459 3460@end table 3461 3462Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state 3463of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system 3464(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from 3465a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location, 3466so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files 3467opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the 3468previously read data can be read again. 3469 3470Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other 3471external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received 3472from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers, 3473but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to 3474be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have 3475been changed cannot be restored (at this time). 3476 3477However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your 3478program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it 3479again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a 3480different execution path this time. 3481 3482@cindex checkpoints and process id 3483Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be 3484different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process 3485id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}), 3486and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}. 3487If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could 3488potentially pose a problem. 3489 3490@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints 3491 3492On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization 3493is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it 3494difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an 3495absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the 3496absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the 3497next. 3498 3499A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process. 3500Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main, 3501and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the 3502process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and 3503your symbols will all stay in the same place. 3504 3505@node Stopping 3506@chapter Stopping and Continuing 3507 3508The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your 3509program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into 3510trouble, you can investigate and find out why. 3511 3512Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons, 3513such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a 3514@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and 3515change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then 3516continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide 3517ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also 3518explicitly request this information at any time. 3519 3520@table @code 3521@kindex info program 3522@item info program 3523Display information about the status of your program: whether it is 3524running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped. 3525@end table 3526 3527@menu 3528* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints 3529* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution 3530* Skipping Over Functions and Files:: 3531 Skipping over functions and files 3532* Signals:: Signals 3533* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs 3534@end menu 3535 3536@node Breakpoints 3537@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints 3538 3539@cindex breakpoints 3540A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in 3541the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to 3542control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set 3543breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set 3544Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program 3545should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the 3546program. 3547 3548On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before 3549the executable is run. 3550 3551@cindex watchpoints 3552@cindex data breakpoints 3553@cindex memory tracing 3554@cindex breakpoint on memory address 3555@cindex breakpoint on variable modification 3556A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program 3557when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value 3558of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables 3559combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called 3560@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set 3561watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside 3562from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you 3563enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the 3564same commands. 3565 3566You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically 3567whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,, 3568Automatic Display}. 3569 3570@cindex catchpoints 3571@cindex breakpoint on events 3572A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program 3573when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++} 3574exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a 3575different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting 3576Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any 3577other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the 3578@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.) 3579 3580@cindex breakpoint numbers 3581@cindex numbers for breakpoints 3582@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or 3583catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers 3584starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various 3585features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which 3586breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or 3587@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you 3588enable it again. 3589 3590@cindex breakpoint ranges 3591@cindex breakpoint lists 3592@cindex ranges of breakpoints 3593@cindex lists of breakpoints 3594Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints 3595on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number, 3596like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}. 3597When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list 3598are operated on. 3599 3600@menu 3601* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints 3602* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints 3603* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints 3604* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints 3605* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints 3606* Conditions:: Break conditions 3607* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists 3608* Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf 3609* Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file 3610* Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points 3611* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' 3612* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...'' 3613@end menu 3614 3615@node Set Breaks 3616@subsection Setting Breakpoints 3617 3618@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt? 3619@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization. 3620@c 3621@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init? 3622 3623@kindex break 3624@kindex b @r{(@code{break})} 3625@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable} 3626@cindex latest breakpoint 3627Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated 3628@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the 3629number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience 3630Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with 3631convenience variables. 3632 3633@table @code 3634@item break @var{location} 3635Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a 3636function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction. 3637(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to 3638specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just 3639before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}. 3640 3641When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as 3642C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break. 3643@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of 3644that situation. 3645 3646It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program 3647only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints}) 3648or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint. 3649 3650@item break 3651When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at 3652the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame 3653(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the 3654innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control 3655returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a 3656@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except 3657that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use 3658@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops 3659the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful 3660inside loops. 3661 3662@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at 3663least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you 3664would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the 3665breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already 3666existed when your program stopped. 3667 3668@item break @dots{} if @var{cond} 3669Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression 3670@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the 3671value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. 3672@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described 3673above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions, 3674,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions. 3675 3676@kindex tbreak 3677@item tbreak @var{args} 3678Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the 3679same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same 3680way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your 3681program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}. 3682 3683@kindex hbreak 3684@cindex hardware breakpoints 3685@item hbreak @var{args} 3686Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the 3687@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the 3688breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not 3689have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code 3690debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without 3691changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation 3692provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets 3693will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction 3694address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware 3695breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For 3696example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and 3697@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete 3698or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones 3699(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}). 3700@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}. 3701For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware 3702breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote 3703hardware-breakpoint-limit}. 3704 3705@kindex thbreak 3706@item thbreak @var{args} 3707Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} 3708are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in 3709the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command, 3710the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the 3711first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak} 3712command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware 3713may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}. 3714See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}. 3715 3716@kindex rbreak 3717@cindex regular expression 3718@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp 3719@cindex set breakpoints in many functions 3720@item rbreak @var{regex} 3721Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression 3722@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all 3723matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these 3724breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with 3725the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make 3726them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint. 3727 3728The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools 3729like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by 3730shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include 3731an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit 3732@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to 3733match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}. 3734 3735@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in 3736When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting 3737breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special 3738classes. 3739 3740@cindex set breakpoints on all functions 3741The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in 3742@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this: 3743 3744@smallexample 3745(@value{GDBP}) rbreak . 3746@end smallexample 3747 3748@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex} 3749If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits 3750the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the 3751specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on 3752every function in a given file: 3753 3754@smallexample 3755(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:. 3756@end smallexample 3757 3758The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may 3759optionally be surrounded by spaces. 3760 3761@kindex info breakpoints 3762@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints} 3763@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 3764@itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 3765Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and 3766not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only 3767about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)). 3768For each breakpoint, following columns are printed: 3769 3770@table @emph 3771@item Breakpoint Numbers 3772@item Type 3773Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint. 3774@item Disposition 3775Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit. 3776@item Enabled or Disabled 3777Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints 3778that are not enabled. 3779@item Address 3780Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a 3781pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will 3782contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared 3783library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded. 3784See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will 3785have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details. 3786@item What 3787Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and 3788line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to 3789the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until 3790the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future. 3791@end table 3792 3793@noindent 3794If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and 3795``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by 3796@value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition 3797is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows 3798the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with 3799its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses. 3800 3801Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is 3802allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for 3803validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending 3804breakpoint to resolve to a valid location. 3805 3806@noindent 3807@code{info break} with a breakpoint 3808number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The 3809convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for 3810the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint 3811listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). 3812 3813@noindent 3814@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint 3815has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the 3816@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint 3817hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint 3818was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This 3819will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint. 3820 3821@noindent 3822For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1, 3823@code{info break} also displays that count. 3824 3825@end table 3826 3827@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in 3828your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When 3829the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful 3830(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 3831 3832@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints 3833@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations 3834It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations 3835in your program. Examples of this situation are: 3836 3837@itemize @bullet 3838@item 3839Multiple functions in the program may have the same name. 3840 3841@item 3842For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several 3843instances of the function body, used in different cases. 3844 3845@item 3846For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can 3847correspond to any number of instantiations. 3848 3849@item 3850For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to 3851several places where that function is inlined. 3852@end itemize 3853 3854In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all 3855the relevant locations. 3856 3857A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint 3858table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for 3859each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the 3860address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual 3861addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those 3862locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form 3863@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}. 3864 3865For example: 3866 3867@smallexample 3868Num Type Disp Enb Address What 38691 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE> 3870 stop only if i==1 3871 breakpoint already hit 1 time 38721.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8 38731.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8 3874@end smallexample 3875 3876Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing 3877@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the 3878@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot 3879delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the 3880entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with 3881the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of 3882the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling 3883the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations 3884that belong to that breakpoint. 3885 3886@cindex pending breakpoints 3887It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library. 3888Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly, 3889and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support 3890this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever 3891any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would 3892set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your 3893debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the 3894symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set 3895breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set 3896a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address 3897is not yet resolved. 3898 3899After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded, 3900@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded 3901shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some 3902pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an 3903ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints 3904that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again. 3905 3906This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For 3907example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and 3908a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template, 3909a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint. 3910 3911Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not 3912differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands, 3913enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations. 3914 3915@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what 3916happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint 3917address specification to an address: 3918 3919@kindex set breakpoint pending 3920@kindex show breakpoint pending 3921@table @code 3922@item set breakpoint pending auto 3923This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint 3924location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created. 3925 3926@item set breakpoint pending on 3927This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically 3928result in a pending breakpoint being created. 3929 3930@item set breakpoint pending off 3931This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any 3932unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does 3933not affect any pending breakpoints previously created. 3934 3935@item show breakpoint pending 3936Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints. 3937@end table 3938 3939The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its 3940variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated 3941as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded. 3942 3943@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints 3944For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or 3945software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the 3946breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to 3947breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal 3948breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For 3949breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware 3950breakpoints. 3951 3952You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands: 3953 3954@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw 3955@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw 3956@table @code 3957@item set breakpoint auto-hw on 3958This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it 3959will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware 3960breakpoint must be used. 3961 3962@item set breakpoint auto-hw off 3963This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint 3964type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when 3965trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address. 3966@end table 3967 3968@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code 3969at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when 3970executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program 3971code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as 3972the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This 3973behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the 3974target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote 3975targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance. 3976This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:: 3977 3978@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted 3979@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted 3980@table @code 3981@item set breakpoint always-inserted off 3982All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in 3983the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are 3984removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode. 3985 3986@item set breakpoint always-inserted on 3987Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If 3988the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the 3989breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is 3990removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted. 3991@end table 3992 3993@value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions 3994when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being 3995debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed. 3996 3997If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may 3998download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it. 3999 4000This feature can be controlled via the following commands: 4001 4002@kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation 4003@kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation 4004@table @code 4005@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host 4006This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint 4007conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to 4008the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB 4009for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode. 4010 4011@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target 4012This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions 4013to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target 4014is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting 4015breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition 4016is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions 4017cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data 4018that is only known to the host. Examples include 4019conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types 4020that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions 4021that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the 4022target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be 4023evaluated by @value{GDBN}. 4024 4025@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto 4026This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint 4027conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to 4028the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does 4029not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback 4030to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side. 4031@end table 4032 4033 4034@cindex negative breakpoint numbers 4035@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints 4036@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for 4037special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C 4038programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, 4039starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them. 4040You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command 4041@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}). 4042 4043 4044@node Set Watchpoints 4045@subsection Setting Watchpoints 4046 4047@cindex setting watchpoints 4048You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an 4049expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where 4050this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.) 4051The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or 4052as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include: 4053 4054@itemize @bullet 4055@item 4056A reference to the value of a single variable. 4057 4058@item 4059An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example, 4060@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified 4061address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes). 4062 4063@item 4064An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The 4065expression can use any operators valid in the program's native 4066language (@pxref{Languages}). 4067@end itemize 4068 4069You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can 4070not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on 4071@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized. 4072@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and 4073the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes 4074valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory 4075pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a 4076@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time 4077the expression changes. 4078 4079@cindex software watchpoints 4080@cindex hardware watchpoints 4081Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or 4082hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your 4083program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of 4084times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to 4085catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the 4086culprit.) 4087 4088On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets, 4089@value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not 4090slow down the running of your program. 4091 4092@table @code 4093@kindex watch 4094@item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} 4095Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the 4096expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value 4097changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is 4098to watch the value of a single variable: 4099 4100@smallexample 4101(@value{GDBP}) watch foo 4102@end smallexample 4103 4104If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}} 4105argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by 4106@var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads 4107change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note 4108that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work 4109with Hardware Watchpoints. 4110 4111Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr} 4112(see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to 4113instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case, 4114@value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result, 4115and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used 4116to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's 4117result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an 4118error. 4119 4120The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation 4121of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this 4122feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC 4123Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition 4124to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address 4125(the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching 4126the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address. 4127Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those 4128addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the 4129watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}. 4130Examples: 4131 4132@smallexample 4133(@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff 4134(@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00 4135@end smallexample 4136 4137@kindex rwatch 4138@item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} 4139Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read 4140by the program. 4141 4142@kindex awatch 4143@item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} 4144Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from 4145or written into by the program. 4146 4147@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 4148@item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 4149This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as 4150@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}). 4151@end table 4152 4153If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to 4154dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will 4155never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches 4156a never-changing value: 4157 4158@smallexample 4159(@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850 4160Cannot watch constant value 0x600850. 4161(@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850 4162Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584 4163@end smallexample 4164 4165@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware 4166watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in 4167value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN} 4168cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which 4169executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next 4170@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs. 4171 4172@cindex use only software watchpoints 4173You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the 4174@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to 4175zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if 4176the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted 4177watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting 4178@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware 4179mechanism of watching expression values.) 4180 4181@table @code 4182@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints 4183@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints 4184Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints. 4185 4186@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints 4187@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints 4188Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints. 4189@end table 4190 4191For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware 4192watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote 4193hardware-breakpoint-limit}. 4194 4195When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports 4196 4197@smallexample 4198Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr} 4199@end smallexample 4200 4201@noindent 4202if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint. 4203 4204Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set 4205hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the 4206value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining 4207every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do 4208that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a 4209hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it 4210will print a message like this: 4211 4212@smallexample 4213Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint. 4214@end smallexample 4215 4216Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the 4217data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware 4218watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems 4219can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you 4220cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a 4221double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes 4222wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region 4223into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints. 4224 4225If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable 4226to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program. 4227Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such 4228time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be 4229able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the 4230warning will be printed only when the program is resumed: 4231 4232@smallexample 4233Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint 4234@end smallexample 4235 4236@noindent 4237If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints. 4238 4239Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also 4240exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints. 4241That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the 4242expression with separately allocated resources. 4243 4244If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call}, 4245any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another 4246kind of breakpoint or the call completes. 4247 4248@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local 4249(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when 4250they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in 4251which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program 4252being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope, 4253and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you 4254rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One 4255way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the 4256@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints. 4257 4258@cindex watchpoints and threads 4259@cindex threads and watchpoints 4260In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the 4261watched expression from every thread. 4262 4263@quotation 4264@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints 4265have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software 4266watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a 4267single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only 4268change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also 4269confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use 4270software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice 4271when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware 4272watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.) 4273@end quotation 4274 4275@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}. 4276 4277@node Set Catchpoints 4278@subsection Setting Catchpoints 4279@cindex catchpoints, setting 4280@cindex exception handlers 4281@cindex event handling 4282 4283You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain 4284kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a 4285shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint. 4286 4287@table @code 4288@kindex catch 4289@item catch @var{event} 4290Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following: 4291 4292@table @code 4293@item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 4294@itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 4295@itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 4296@kindex catch throw 4297@kindex catch rethrow 4298@kindex catch catch 4299@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions 4300The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception. 4301 4302If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the 4303regular expression will be caught. 4304 4305@vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable} 4306The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an 4307exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the 4308exception being thrown. 4309 4310There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in 4311@value{GDBN}: 4312 4313@itemize @bullet 4314@item 4315The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only 4316systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are 4317supported. 4318 4319@item 4320The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience 4321variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}. 4322If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used. 4323These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether 4324or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was 4325built. 4326 4327@item 4328The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the 4329instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set. 4330 4331@item 4332When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a 4333location in the system library which implements runtime exception 4334support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up} 4335(@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code. 4336 4337@item 4338If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns 4339control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call 4340raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that 4341returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to 4342simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal 4343that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if 4344you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are 4345disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on 4346controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}. 4347 4348@item 4349You cannot raise an exception interactively. 4350 4351@item 4352You cannot install an exception handler interactively. 4353@end itemize 4354 4355@item exception 4356@kindex catch exception 4357@cindex Ada exception catching 4358@cindex catch Ada exceptions 4359An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified 4360at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}), 4361the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised. 4362Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised. 4363 4364When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose 4365name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the 4366fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise, 4367@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception 4368rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception 4369called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then 4370the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception 4371Pck.Constraint_Error}. 4372 4373@item exception unhandled 4374@kindex catch exception unhandled 4375An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program. 4376 4377@item assert 4378@kindex catch assert 4379A failed Ada assertion. 4380 4381@item exec 4382@kindex catch exec 4383@cindex break on fork/exec 4384A call to @code{exec}. 4385 4386@item syscall 4387@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{} 4388@kindex catch syscall 4389@cindex break on a system call. 4390A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A 4391syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service 4392from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services. 4393@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the 4394debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no 4395argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls 4396will be caught. 4397 4398@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the 4399underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On 4400GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall 4401names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}. 4402 4403@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers 4404@c can be found, e.g., on this URL: 4405@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html 4406@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet. 4407 4408Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for 4409each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion 4410facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the 4411available choices. 4412 4413You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's 4414number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to 4415identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its 4416name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name 4417into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly 4418may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete 4419list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags 4420behind the OS upgrades). 4421 4422You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using 4423the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For 4424instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all 4425network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network} 4426to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are 4427available in every system. You can use the command completion 4428facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the 4429syscall groups available on your environment. 4430 4431The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide 4432arguments to it: 4433 4434@smallexample 4435(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 4436Catchpoint 1 (syscall) 4437(@value{GDBP}) r 4438Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4439 4440Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \ 4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4442(@value{GDBP}) c 4443Continuing. 4444 4445Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \ 4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4447(@value{GDBP}) 4448@end smallexample 4449 4450Here is an example of catching a system call by name: 4451 4452@smallexample 4453(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot 4454Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61]) 4455(@value{GDBP}) r 4456Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4457 4458Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \ 4459 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4460(@value{GDBP}) c 4461Continuing. 4462 4463Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \ 4464 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4465(@value{GDBP}) 4466@end smallexample 4467 4468An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case 4469below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML 4470file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it: 4471 4472@smallexample 4473(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252 4474Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group') 4475(@value{GDBP}) r 4476Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4477 4478Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \ 4479 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4480(@value{GDBP}) c 4481Continuing. 4482 4483Program exited normally. 4484(@value{GDBP}) 4485@end smallexample 4486 4487Here is an example of catching a syscall group: 4488 4489@smallexample 4490(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process 4491Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7] 4492'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190] 4493'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310]) 4494(@value{GDBP}) r 4495Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4496 4497Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 () 4498 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2 4499 4500(@value{GDBP}) c 4501Continuing. 4502@end smallexample 4503 4504However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name 4505in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints 4506a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name, 4507but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below: 4508 4509@smallexample 4510(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764 4511warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall. 4512Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764) 4513(@value{GDBP}) 4514@end smallexample 4515 4516If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option, 4517it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your 4518architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls, 4519you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to 4520notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall 4521name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this: 4522 4523@smallexample 4524(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 4525warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml" 4526warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'. 4527GDB will not be able to display syscall names. 4528Catchpoint 1 (syscall) 4529(@value{GDBP}) 4530@end smallexample 4531 4532Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system. 4533 4534Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its 4535number. In this case, you would see something like: 4536 4537@smallexample 4538(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252 4539Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252) 4540@end smallexample 4541 4542Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names. 4543 4544@item fork 4545@kindex catch fork 4546A call to @code{fork}. 4547 4548@item vfork 4549@kindex catch vfork 4550A call to @code{vfork}. 4551 4552@item load @r{[}regexp@r{]} 4553@itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]} 4554@kindex catch load 4555@kindex catch unload 4556The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is 4557given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression 4558matches one of the affected libraries. 4559 4560@item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]} 4561@kindex catch signal 4562The delivery of a signal. 4563 4564With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not 4565used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except 4566@samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}. 4567 4568With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by 4569@value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other 4570signal names. 4571 4572Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to 4573@code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list 4574will be caught. 4575 4576One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than 4577@code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the 4578catchpoint. 4579 4580When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and 4581@code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored. 4582However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends 4583on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's 4584commands. 4585 4586@end table 4587 4588@item tcatch @var{event} 4589@kindex tcatch 4590Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is 4591automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught. 4592 4593@end table 4594 4595Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints. 4596 4597 4598@node Delete Breaks 4599@subsection Deleting Breakpoints 4600 4601@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints 4602@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints 4603It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or 4604catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program 4605to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A 4606breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten. 4607 4608With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to 4609where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can 4610delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying 4611their breakpoint numbers. 4612 4613It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN} 4614automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed 4615when you continue execution without changing the execution address. 4616 4617@table @code 4618@kindex clear 4619@item clear 4620Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the 4621selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When 4622the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a 4623breakpoint where your program just stopped. 4624 4625@item clear @var{location} 4626Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}. 4627@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the 4628most useful ones are listed below: 4629 4630@table @code 4631@item clear @var{function} 4632@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function} 4633Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}. 4634 4635@item clear @var{linenum} 4636@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum} 4637Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified 4638@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}. 4639@end table 4640 4641@cindex delete breakpoints 4642@kindex delete 4643@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})} 4644@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 4645Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint 4646list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all 4647breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set 4648confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}. 4649@end table 4650 4651@node Disabling 4652@subsection Disabling Breakpoints 4653 4654@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint 4655Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might 4656prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if 4657it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so 4658that you can @dfn{enable} it again later. 4659 4660You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with 4661the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying 4662one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to 4663print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you 4664do not know which numbers to use. 4665 4666Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations 4667affects all of its locations. 4668 4669A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several 4670different states of enablement: 4671 4672@itemize @bullet 4673@item 4674Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set 4675with the @code{break} command starts out in this state. 4676@item 4677Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program. 4678@item 4679Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes 4680disabled. 4681@item 4682Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next 4683N times, then becomes disabled. 4684@item 4685Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but 4686immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint 4687set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state. 4688@end itemize 4689 4690You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints, 4691watchpoints, and catchpoints: 4692 4693@table @code 4694@kindex disable 4695@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})} 4696@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 4697Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are 4698listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All 4699options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in 4700case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate 4701@code{disable} as @code{dis}. 4702 4703@kindex enable 4704@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 4705Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They 4706become effective once again in stopping your program. 4707 4708@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{} 4709Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any 4710of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program. 4711 4712@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{} 4713Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records 4714@var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a 4715breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0, 4716@value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore 4717count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be 4718decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected. 4719 4720@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{} 4721Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN} 4722deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there. 4723Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state. 4724@end table 4725 4726@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is 4727@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled. 4728Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks, 4729,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled; 4730subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of 4731the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a 4732breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other 4733breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and 4734Stepping}.) 4735 4736@node Conditions 4737@subsection Break Conditions 4738@cindex conditional breakpoints 4739@cindex breakpoint conditions 4740 4741@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted? 4742@c in particular for a watchpoint? 4743The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a 4744specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a 4745breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your 4746programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with 4747a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it, 4748and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}. 4749 4750This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that 4751situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is, 4752when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed 4753by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition 4754@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint. 4755 4756Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them, 4757since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but 4758it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name, 4759and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting 4760one. 4761 4762Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in 4763your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions 4764that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to 4765format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable 4766unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In 4767that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your 4768program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that 4769breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break 4770conditions for the 4771purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached 4772(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}). 4773 4774Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if 4775the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally, 4776@value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression 4777(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target, 4778independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory 4779locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth. 4780 4781In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger 4782when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster 4783response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target 4784since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about 4785every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions. 4786 4787Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using 4788@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set 4789Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time 4790with the @code{condition} command. 4791 4792You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command. 4793The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword; 4794@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a 4795catchpoint. 4796 4797@table @code 4798@kindex condition 4799@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression} 4800Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint, 4801watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition, 4802breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of 4803@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use 4804@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for 4805syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have 4806referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses 4807symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN} 4808prints an error message: 4809 4810@smallexample 4811No symbol "foo" in current context. 4812@end smallexample 4813 4814@noindent 4815@value{GDBN} does 4816not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition} 4817command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like 4818@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 4819 4820@item condition @var{bnum} 4821Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes 4822an ordinary unconditional breakpoint. 4823@end table 4824 4825@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint) 4826A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the 4827breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so 4828useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore 4829count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which 4830is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and 4831therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose 4832ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements 4833the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count 4834value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times 4835your program reaches it. 4836 4837@table @code 4838@kindex ignore 4839@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count} 4840Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}. 4841The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's 4842execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN} 4843takes no action. 4844 4845To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify 4846a count of zero. 4847 4848When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a 4849breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to 4850@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and 4851Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}. 4852 4853If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the 4854condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero, 4855@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition. 4856 4857You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such 4858as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that 4859is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 4860Variables}. 4861@end table 4862 4863Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints. 4864 4865 4866@node Break Commands 4867@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists 4868 4869@cindex breakpoint commands 4870You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of 4871commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For 4872example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or 4873enable other breakpoints. 4874 4875@table @code 4876@kindex commands 4877@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)} 4878@item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]} 4879@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{} 4880@itemx end 4881Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands 4882themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just 4883@code{end} to terminate the commands. 4884 4885To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and 4886follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands. 4887 4888With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint, 4889watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently 4890encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single 4891command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints 4892set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by 4893@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command 4894creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous 4895Expressions}). 4896@end table 4897 4898Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is 4899disabled within a @var{command-list}. 4900 4901You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply 4902use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command 4903that resumes execution. 4904 4905Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes 4906execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution 4907(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter 4908another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to 4909ambiguities about which list to execute. 4910 4911@kindex silent 4912If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the 4913usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may 4914be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and 4915then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you 4916see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is 4917meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list. 4918 4919The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to 4920print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent 4921breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}. 4922 4923For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the 4924value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive. 4925 4926@smallexample 4927break foo if x>0 4928commands 4929silent 4930printf "x is %d\n",x 4931cont 4932end 4933@end smallexample 4934 4935One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so 4936you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line 4937of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something 4938erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values 4939to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command 4940so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent} 4941command so that no output is produced. Here is an example: 4942 4943@smallexample 4944break 403 4945commands 4946silent 4947set x = y + 4 4948cont 4949end 4950@end smallexample 4951 4952@node Dynamic Printf 4953@subsection Dynamic Printf 4954 4955@cindex dynamic printf 4956@cindex dprintf 4957The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with 4958formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of 4959inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without 4960having to recompile it. 4961 4962In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However, 4963you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling. 4964For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your 4965program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the 4966characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in 4967redirects to files and so forth. 4968 4969If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also 4970ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to 4971ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along 4972with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that 4973the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote 4974target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do 4975everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}. 4976 4977@table @code 4978@kindex dprintf 4979@item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}] 4980Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or 4981more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}. 4982To print several values, separate them with commas. 4983 4984@item set dprintf-style @var{style} 4985Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different 4986styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing 4987dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the 4988print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with 4989explicitly-supplied command lists.) 4990 4991@table @code 4992@item gdb 4993@kindex dprintf-style gdb 4994Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command. 4995 4996@item call 4997@kindex dprintf-style call 4998Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally 4999@code{printf}). 5000 5001@item agent 5002@kindex dprintf-style agent 5003Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle 5004the output itself. This style is only available for agents that 5005support running commands on the target. 5006@end table 5007 5008@item set dprintf-function @var{function} 5009Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By 5010default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression. 5011that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call} 5012command. 5013 5014@item set dprintf-channel @var{channel} 5015Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value, 5016@value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as 5017a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of 5018@code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format 5019string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}. 5020 5021As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile 5022that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog}, 5023you could do the following: 5024 5025@example 5026(gdb) set dprintf-style call 5027(gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf 5028(gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog 5029(gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob 5030Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25. 5031(gdb) info break 50321 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25 5033 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob) 5034 continue 5035(gdb) 5036@end example 5037 5038Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands 5039as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of 5040the variable settings. 5041 5042@item set disconnected-dprintf on 5043@itemx set disconnected-dprintf off 5044@kindex set disconnected-dprintf 5045Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if 5046@value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies 5047if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}. 5048 5049@item show disconnected-dprintf off 5050@kindex show disconnected-dprintf 5051Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}. 5052 5053@end table 5054 5055@value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel, 5056relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts 5057in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel 5058may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then 5059all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of 5060those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error. 5061 5062@node Save Breakpoints 5063@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file 5064 5065To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save 5066breakpoints}} command. 5067 5068@table @code 5069@kindex save breakpoints 5070@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions 5071@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}] 5072This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with 5073their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}} 5074suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all 5075types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints, 5076tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the 5077@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints 5078with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated 5079because it may not be possible to access the context where the 5080watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions 5081are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the 5082breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program, 5083and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or 5084that can no longer be recreated. 5085@end table 5086 5087@node Static Probe Points 5088@subsection Static Probe Points 5089 5090@cindex static probe point, SystemTap 5091@cindex static probe point, DTrace 5092@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands 5093for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny 5094runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. 5095 5096Currently, the following types of probes are supported on 5097ELF-compatible systems: 5098 5099@itemize @bullet 5100 5101@item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/}) 5102@acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See 5103@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps} 5104for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} 5105probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable 5106from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See 5107@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation} 5108for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}. 5109 5110@item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace}) 5111@acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and 5112C@t{++} languages. 5113@end itemize 5114 5115@cindex semaphores on static probe points 5116Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable; 5117for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe 5118using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, 5119@value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a 5120breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a 5121breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g., 5122@code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set 5123the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores. 5124 5125You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info 5126probes}, with optional arguments: 5127 5128@table @code 5129@kindex info probes 5130@item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]} 5131If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing 5132@code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace} 5133probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types. 5134 5135If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider 5136names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all 5137probes from all providers are listed. 5138 5139If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names 5140when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not 5141considered when deciding whether to display them. 5142 5143If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which 5144object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not 5145given, all object files are considered. 5146 5147@item info probes all 5148List the available static probes, from all types. 5149@end table 5150 5151@cindex enabling and disabling probes 5152Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of 5153enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being 5154handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or 5155disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled. 5156 5157You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following 5158commands, with optional arguments: 5159 5160@table @code 5161@kindex enable probes 5162@item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]} 5163If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against 5164provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, 5165all probes from all providers are enabled. 5166 5167If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe 5168names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names 5169are not considered when deciding whether to enable them. 5170 5171If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which 5172object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not 5173given, all object files are considered. 5174 5175@kindex disable probes 5176@item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]} 5177See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the 5178optional arguments accepted by this command. 5179@end table 5180 5181@vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable} 5182A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the 5183point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is 5184at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the 5185convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) 5186@code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap} 5187probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size; 5188types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved 5189provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise 5190the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The 5191convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments 5192at the current probe point. 5193 5194These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at 5195any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give 5196an error message. 5197 5198 5199@c @ifclear BARETARGET 5200@node Error in Breakpoints 5201@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' 5202 5203If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and 5204watchpoints, you will see this error message: 5205 5206@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant 5207@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999). 5208@smallexample 5209Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints. 5210You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints. 5211@end smallexample 5212 5213@noindent 5214This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since 5215only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and 5216watchpoints it needs to insert. 5217 5218When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the 5219hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue. 5220 5221@node Breakpoint-related Warnings 5222@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...'' 5223@cindex breakpoint address adjusted 5224 5225Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at 5226which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained, 5227@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply 5228with the constraints dictated by the architecture. 5229 5230One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is 5231a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be 5232bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture 5233constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a 5234bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN} 5235honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the 5236first in the bundle. 5237 5238It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain 5239instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that 5240a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to 5241another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s 5242breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is 5243printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint 5244is hit. 5245 5246A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint 5247that's been subject to address adjustment: 5248 5249@smallexample 5250warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410. 5251@end smallexample 5252 5253Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s 5254internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should 5255verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the 5256desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and 5257other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior. 5258E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later 5259instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some 5260cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often. 5261 5262@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these 5263adjusted breakpoints: 5264 5265@smallexample 5266warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414 5267to 0x00010410. 5268@end smallexample 5269 5270When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial 5271action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more 5272frequently than expected. 5273 5274@node Continuing and Stepping 5275@section Continuing and Stepping 5276 5277@cindex stepping 5278@cindex continuing 5279@cindex resuming execution 5280@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program 5281completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just 5282one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one 5283line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what 5284particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping, 5285your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If 5286it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use 5287@samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}), 5288or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal 5289handlers}).) 5290 5291@table @code 5292@kindex continue 5293@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})} 5294@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)} 5295@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5296@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5297@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5298Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped; 5299any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument 5300@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to 5301ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of 5302@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 5303 5304The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program 5305stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to 5306@code{continue} is ignored. 5307 5308The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the 5309debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided 5310purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as 5311@code{continue}. 5312@end table 5313 5314To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return} 5315(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the 5316calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a 5317Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program. 5318 5319A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint 5320(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the 5321beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem 5322is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint, 5323and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are 5324interesting, until you see the problem happen. 5325 5326@table @code 5327@kindex step 5328@kindex s @r{(@code{step})} 5329@item step 5330Continue running your program until control reaches a different source 5331line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is 5332abbreviated @code{s}. 5333 5334@quotation 5335@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line 5336@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but 5337@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that 5338@c distinction here. 5339@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is 5340within a function that was compiled without debugging information, 5341execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have 5342debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which 5343is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions 5344without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described 5345below. 5346@end quotation 5347 5348The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source 5349line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in 5350@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues 5351to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within 5352the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions 5353called within the line. 5354 5355Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line 5356number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the 5357@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl} 5358on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there 5359was any debugging information about the routine. 5360 5361@item step @var{count} 5362Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a 5363breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before 5364@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away. 5365 5366@kindex next 5367@kindex n @r{(@code{next})} 5368@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 5369Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame. 5370This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within 5371the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when 5372control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level 5373that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command 5374is abbreviated @code{n}. 5375 5376An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}. 5377 5378 5379@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with 5380@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria 5381@c 5382@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like 5383@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the 5384@c function are executed without stopping. 5385 5386The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a 5387source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in 5388@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. 5389 5390@kindex set step-mode 5391@item set step-mode 5392@cindex functions without line info, and stepping 5393@cindex stepping into functions with no line info 5394@itemx set step-mode on 5395The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to 5396stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line 5397information rather than stepping over it. 5398 5399This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the 5400machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not 5401want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function. 5402 5403@item set step-mode off 5404Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no 5405debug information. This is the default. 5406 5407@item show step-mode 5408Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without 5409source line debug information. 5410 5411@kindex finish 5412@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})} 5413@item finish 5414Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame 5415returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be 5416abbreviated as @code{fin}. 5417 5418Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning, 5419,Returning from a Function}). 5420 5421@kindex until 5422@kindex u @r{(@code{until})} 5423@cindex run until specified location 5424@item until 5425@itemx u 5426Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the 5427current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single 5428stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next} 5429command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it 5430automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater 5431than the address of the jump. 5432 5433This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping 5434though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it 5435exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop 5436simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step 5437through the next iteration. 5438 5439@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current 5440stack frame. 5441 5442@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order 5443of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For 5444example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f} 5445(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line 5446@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}: 5447 5448@smallexample 5449(@value{GDBP}) f 5450#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206 5451206 expand_input(); 5452(@value{GDBP}) until 5453195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{ 5454@end smallexample 5455 5456This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had 5457generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the 5458start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is 5459written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared 5460to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this 5461expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier 5462statement---not in terms of the actual machine code. 5463 5464@code{until} with no argument works by means of single 5465instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an 5466argument. 5467 5468@item until @var{location} 5469@itemx u @var{location} 5470Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is 5471reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of 5472the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}. 5473This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and 5474hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified 5475location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This 5476implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function 5477invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is 5478line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to 5479line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner 5480invocations have returned. 5481 5482@smallexample 548394 int factorial (int value) 548495 @{ 548596 if (value > 1) @{ 548697 value *= factorial (value - 1); 548798 @} 548899 return (value); 5489100 @} 5490@end smallexample 5491 5492 5493@kindex advance @var{location} 5494@item advance @var{location} 5495Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is 5496required, which should be of one of the forms described in 5497@ref{Specify Location}. 5498Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack 5499frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will 5500not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't 5501have to be in the same frame as the current one. 5502 5503 5504@kindex stepi 5505@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})} 5506@item stepi 5507@itemx stepi @var{arg} 5508@itemx si 5509Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger. 5510 5511It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine 5512instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next 5513instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto 5514Display,, Automatic Display}. 5515 5516An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}. 5517 5518@need 750 5519@kindex nexti 5520@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})} 5521@item nexti 5522@itemx nexti @var{arg} 5523@itemx ni 5524Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call, 5525proceed until the function returns. 5526 5527An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}. 5528 5529@end table 5530 5531@anchor{range stepping} 5532@cindex range stepping 5533@cindex target-assisted range stepping 5534By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of 5535target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you 5536use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN} 5537tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction 5538addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up 5539line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should 5540be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's 5541possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for 5542remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line 5543stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is 5544enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping 5545if necessary: 5546 5547@table @code 5548@kindex set range-stepping 5549@kindex show range-stepping 5550@item set range-stepping 5551@itemx show range-stepping 5552Control whether range stepping is enabled. 5553 5554If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the 5555target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing 5556multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues 5557single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The 5558default is @code{on}. 5559 5560@end table 5561 5562@node Skipping Over Functions and Files 5563@section Skipping Over Functions and Files 5564@cindex skipping over functions and files 5565 5566The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are 5567uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to 5568skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in 5569a particular file when stepping. 5570 5571For example, consider the following C function: 5572 5573@smallexample 5574101 int func() 5575102 @{ 5576103 foo(boring()); 5577104 bar(boring()); 5578105 @} 5579@end smallexample 5580 5581@noindent 5582Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you 5583are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step} 5584at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll 5585step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}! 5586 5587One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish} 5588command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring} 5589is called from many places. 5590 5591A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs 5592@value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute 5593@code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into 5594@code{foo}. 5595 5596Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec 5597(@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's 5598name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name. 5599 5600On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is 5601``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex} 5602on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular 5603expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of 5604the underlying system. 5605See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a 5606description of @code{glob}-style patterns. 5607 5608@table @code 5609@kindex skip 5610@item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]} 5611The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options 5612that specify what to skip. 5613The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following: 5614 5615@table @code 5616@item -file @var{file} 5617@itemx -fi @var{file} 5618Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping. 5619 5620@item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern} 5621@itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern} 5622@cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns 5623Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped 5624over when stepping. 5625 5626@smallexample 5627(gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c 5628@end smallexample 5629 5630@item -function @var{linespec} 5631@itemx -fu @var{linespec} 5632Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line 5633named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping. 5634@xref{Specify Location}. 5635 5636@item -rfunction @var{regexp} 5637@itemx -rfu @var{regexp} 5638@cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions 5639Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping. 5640 5641This form is useful for complex function names. 5642For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string} 5643constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to 5644write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what 5645the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a 5646regular expression makes this easier. 5647 5648@smallexample 5649(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\( 5650@end smallexample 5651 5652If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor 5653in the @code{std} namespace you can do: 5654 5655@smallexample 5656(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\( 5657@end smallexample 5658@end table 5659 5660If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging 5661will be skipped. 5662 5663@kindex skip function 5664@item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]} 5665After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the 5666function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when 5667stepping. @xref{Specify Location}. 5668 5669If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging 5670will be skipped. 5671 5672(If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use 5673@kbd{skip function file}.) 5674 5675@kindex skip file 5676@item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 5677After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename} 5678will be skipped over when stepping. 5679 5680@smallexample 5681(gdb) skip file boring.c 5682File boring.c will be skipped when stepping. 5683@end smallexample 5684 5685If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file 5686you're currently debugging will be skipped. 5687@end table 5688 5689Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints. 5690These are the commands for managing your list of skips: 5691 5692@table @code 5693@kindex info skip 5694@item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5695Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, 5696print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping. 5697@code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip: 5698 5699@table @emph 5700@item Identifier 5701A number identifying this skip. 5702@item Enabled or Disabled 5703Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. 5704Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}. 5705@item Glob 5706If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}. 5707Otherwise it is @samp{n}. 5708@item File 5709The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped. 5710If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}. 5711@item RE 5712If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}. 5713Otherwise it is @samp{n}. 5714@item Function 5715The name or regular expression of the function to skip. 5716If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}. 5717@end table 5718 5719@kindex skip delete 5720@item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5721Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all 5722skips. 5723 5724@kindex skip enable 5725@item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5726Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all 5727skips. 5728 5729@kindex skip disable 5730@item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5731Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all 5732skips. 5733 5734@end table 5735 5736@node Signals 5737@section Signals 5738@cindex signals 5739 5740A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The 5741operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each 5742kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the 5743signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}); 5744@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in 5745memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when 5746the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has 5747requested an alarm). 5748 5749@cindex fatal signals 5750Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the 5751functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate 5752errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the 5753program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal. 5754@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally 5755fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program. 5756 5757@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your 5758program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of 5759signal. 5760 5761@cindex handling signals 5762Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like 5763@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program 5764(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning) 5765but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens. 5766You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command. 5767 5768@table @code 5769@kindex info signals 5770@kindex info handle 5771@item info signals 5772@itemx info handle 5773Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to 5774handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all 5775the defined types of signals. 5776 5777@item info signals @var{sig} 5778Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number. 5779 5780@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}. 5781 5782@item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]} 5783Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints}, 5784for details about this command. 5785 5786@kindex handle 5787@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]} 5788Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} 5789can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the 5790@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form 5791@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the 5792known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below, 5793say what change to make. 5794@end table 5795 5796@c @group 5797The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated. 5798Their full names are: 5799 5800@table @code 5801@item nostop 5802@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may 5803still print a message telling you that the signal has come in. 5804 5805@item stop 5806@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies 5807the @code{print} keyword as well. 5808 5809@item print 5810@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens. 5811 5812@item noprint 5813@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This 5814implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well. 5815 5816@item pass 5817@itemx noignore 5818@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program 5819can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal 5820and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms. 5821 5822@item nopass 5823@itemx ignore 5824@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal. 5825@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms. 5826@end table 5827@c @end group 5828 5829When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the 5830program until you 5831continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in 5832effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words, 5833after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle} 5834command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your 5835program sees that signal when you continue. 5836 5837The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for 5838non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and 5839@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the 5840erroneous signals. 5841 5842You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from 5843seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see, 5844or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped 5845due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct 5846values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more 5847execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as 5848a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this, 5849you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your 5850Program a Signal}. 5851 5852@cindex stepping and signal handlers 5853@anchor{stepping and signal handlers} 5854 5855@value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal 5856that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while 5857a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is 5858in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes 5859stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other 5860words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents 5861signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle 5862nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that 5863the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another 5864signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event 5865that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also 5866note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a 5867signal if @code{handle print} is set. 5868 5869@anchor{stepping into signal handlers} 5870 5871If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a 5872handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step} 5873or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will 5874step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that). 5875 5876Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal 5877to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread 5878resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a 5879stepping command will step into the signal handler. 5880 5881Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction 5882of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler: 5883 5884@smallexample 5885(@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1 5886Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description 5887SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1 5888(@value{GDBP}) c 5889Continuing. 5890 5891Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1. 5892main () sigusr1.c:28 589328 p = 0; 5894(@value{GDBP}) si 5895sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9 58969 @{ 5897@end smallexample 5898 5899The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the 5900program to receive the signal first: 5901 5902@smallexample 5903(@value{GDBP}) n 590428 p = 0; 5905(@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1 5906(@value{GDBP}) si 5907sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9 59089 @{ 5909(@value{GDBP}) 5910@end smallexample 5911 5912@cindex extra signal information 5913@anchor{extra signal information} 5914 5915On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information 5916associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually 5917delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported 5918by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data 5919that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the 5920receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is 5921target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype 5922$_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the 5923standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h} 5924system header. 5925 5926Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray 5927referenced address that raised a segmentation fault. 5928 5929@smallexample 5930@group 5931(@value{GDBP}) continue 5932Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault. 59330x0000000000400766 in main () 593469 *(int *)p = 0; 5935(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo 5936type = struct @{ 5937 int si_signo; 5938 int si_errno; 5939 int si_code; 5940 union @{ 5941 int _pad[28]; 5942 struct @{...@} _kill; 5943 struct @{...@} _timer; 5944 struct @{...@} _rt; 5945 struct @{...@} _sigchld; 5946 struct @{...@} _sigfault; 5947 struct @{...@} _sigpoll; 5948 @} _sifields; 5949@} 5950(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault 5951type = struct @{ 5952 void *si_addr; 5953@} 5954(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr 5955$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000 5956@end group 5957@end smallexample 5958 5959Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable. 5960 5961@cindex Intel MPX boundary violations 5962@cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX 5963On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary 5964violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range. 5965In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information, 5966depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal. 5967With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation 5968kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the 5969bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional 5970information is displayed. 5971 5972The usual output of a segfault is: 5973@smallexample 5974Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault 59750x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68 597668 value = *(p + len); 5977@end smallexample 5978 5979While a bound violation is presented as: 5980@smallexample 5981Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault 5982Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3 5983Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3] 59840x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68 598568 value = *(p + len); 5986@end smallexample 5987 5988@node Thread Stops 5989@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs 5990 5991@cindex stopped threads 5992@cindex threads, stopped 5993 5994@cindex continuing threads 5995@cindex threads, continuing 5996 5997@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads 5998(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There 5999are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the 6000debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode}, 6001when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint 6002or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by 6003@value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports 6004@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while 6005you examine the stopped thread in the debugger. 6006 6007@menu 6008* All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control 6009* Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute 6010* Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously 6011* Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints 6012* Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls 6013* Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior 6014@end menu 6015 6016@node All-Stop Mode 6017@subsection All-Stop Mode 6018 6019@cindex all-stop mode 6020 6021In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason, 6022@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This 6023allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including 6024switching between threads, without worrying that things may change 6025underfoot. 6026 6027Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start 6028executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands 6029like @code{step} or @code{next}. 6030 6031In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep. 6032Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating 6033system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may 6034execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a 6035single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a 6036statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program 6037stops. 6038 6039You might even find your program stopped in another thread after 6040continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other 6041thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the 6042first thread completes whatever you requested. 6043 6044@cindex automatic thread selection 6045@cindex switching threads automatically 6046@cindex threads, automatic switching 6047Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a 6048signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or 6049signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a 6050message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the 6051thread. 6052 6053On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by 6054locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run. 6055 6056@table @code 6057@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode} 6058@cindex scheduler locking mode 6059@cindex lock scheduler 6060Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution, 6061record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no 6062locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only 6063the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The 6064@code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other 6065threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so 6066that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other 6067threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are 6068completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue}, 6069@samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a 6070breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the 6071current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The 6072@code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like 6073@code{on} in replay mode. 6074 6075@item show scheduler-locking 6076Display the current scheduler locking mode. 6077@end table 6078 6079@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously 6080By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as 6081@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only 6082threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN} 6083is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the 6084@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current 6085inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that 6086forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance, 6087it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other 6088situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state 6089of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want 6090to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case, 6091you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the 6092inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command. 6093 6094@table @code 6095@kindex set schedule-multiple 6096@item set schedule-multiple 6097Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed 6098when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of 6099all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads 6100of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The 6101@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on}, 6102or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}. 6103 6104@item show schedule-multiple 6105Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of 6106multiple processes. 6107@end table 6108 6109@node Non-Stop Mode 6110@subsection Non-Stop Mode 6111 6112@cindex non-stop mode 6113 6114@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded 6115@c with more details. 6116 6117For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional 6118mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in 6119the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This 6120minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs 6121where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to 6122respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode. 6123 6124In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event, 6125@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other 6126threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally, 6127execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default 6128only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as 6129in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in 6130ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping 6131one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping 6132one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads 6133independently and simultaneously. 6134 6135To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run 6136or attach to your program: 6137 6138@smallexample 6139# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop. 6140set pagination off 6141 6142# Finally, turn it on! 6143set non-stop on 6144@end smallexample 6145 6146You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting: 6147 6148@table @code 6149@kindex set non-stop 6150@item set non-stop on 6151Enable selection of non-stop mode. 6152@item set non-stop off 6153Disable selection of non-stop mode. 6154@kindex show non-stop 6155@item show non-stop 6156Show the current non-stop enablement setting. 6157@end table 6158 6159Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled, 6160not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode. 6161In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when 6162@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally 6163not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore, 6164since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled 6165non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by 6166default. 6167 6168In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread 6169by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread. 6170To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}. 6171 6172You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands 6173(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background 6174while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}. 6175The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are 6176always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode. 6177 6178Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when 6179running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution. 6180In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process; 6181but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread. 6182To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}. 6183 6184Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option. 6185 6186In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make 6187that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the 6188thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s 6189command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly 6190changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the 6191previously current thread. 6192 6193@node Background Execution 6194@subsection Background Execution 6195 6196@cindex foreground execution 6197@cindex background execution 6198@cindex asynchronous execution 6199@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous 6200 6201@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal 6202foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background 6203(asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for 6204the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for 6205another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives 6206a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs. 6207 6208If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error 6209message if you attempt to use the background execution commands. 6210 6211To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example, 6212the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or 6213just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution 6214are: 6215 6216@table @code 6217@kindex run& 6218@item run 6219@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}. 6220 6221@item attach 6222@kindex attach& 6223@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}. 6224 6225@item step 6226@kindex step& 6227@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}. 6228 6229@item stepi 6230@kindex stepi& 6231@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}. 6232 6233@item next 6234@kindex next& 6235@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}. 6236 6237@item nexti 6238@kindex nexti& 6239@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}. 6240 6241@item continue 6242@kindex continue& 6243@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}. 6244 6245@item finish 6246@kindex finish& 6247@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}. 6248 6249@item until 6250@kindex until& 6251@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}. 6252 6253@end table 6254 6255Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop 6256mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. 6257However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with 6258the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the 6259previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop 6260mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}. 6261 6262You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by 6263using the @code{interrupt} command. 6264 6265@table @code 6266@kindex interrupt 6267@item interrupt 6268@itemx interrupt -a 6269 6270Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode, 6271@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops 6272only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode, 6273use @code{interrupt -a}. 6274@end table 6275 6276@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints 6277@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints 6278 6279When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging 6280Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set 6281breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread. 6282 6283@table @code 6284@cindex breakpoints and threads 6285@cindex thread breakpoints 6286@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id} 6287@item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} 6288@itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{} 6289@var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of 6290writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to 6291specify some source line. 6292 6293Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command 6294to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a 6295particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier 6296is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown 6297in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display. 6298 6299If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a 6300breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your 6301program. 6302 6303You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as 6304well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or 6305after the breakpoint condition, like this: 6306 6307@smallexample 6308(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim 6309@end smallexample 6310 6311@end table 6312 6313Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when 6314@value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the 6315thread list. For example: 6316 6317@smallexample 6318(@value{GDBP}) c 6319Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list. 6320@end smallexample 6321 6322There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular 6323thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the 6324@code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running 6325Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection 6326(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets, 6327@value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user 6328explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads} 6329command. 6330 6331@node Interrupted System Calls 6332@subsection Interrupted System Calls 6333 6334@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls 6335@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints 6336@cindex premature return from system calls 6337There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug 6338multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a 6339breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a 6340system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a 6341consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals 6342that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that 6343stop execution. 6344 6345To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of 6346each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming 6347style anyways. 6348 6349For example, do not write code like this: 6350 6351@smallexample 6352 sleep (10); 6353@end smallexample 6354 6355The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops 6356at a breakpoint or for some other reason. 6357 6358Instead, write this: 6359 6360@smallexample 6361 int unslept = 10; 6362 while (unslept > 0) 6363 unslept = sleep (unslept); 6364@end smallexample 6365 6366A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still 6367conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your 6368multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without 6369@value{GDBN}. 6370 6371Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to 6372monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction. 6373When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return 6374prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop. 6375 6376@node Observer Mode 6377@subsection Observer Mode 6378 6379If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior 6380without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set 6381variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state, 6382whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate 6383at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands. 6384 6385When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to 6386be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable 6387@code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop 6388mode. 6389 6390Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical 6391combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled 6392@code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory}, 6393then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code 6394stream will still not be able to be placed. 6395 6396@table @code 6397 6398@kindex observer 6399@item set observer on 6400@itemx set observer off 6401When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables 6402below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables 6403non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to 6404normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode. 6405 6406@item show observer 6407Show whether observer mode is on or off. 6408 6409@kindex may-write-registers 6410@item set may-write-registers on 6411@itemx set may-write-registers off 6412This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of 6413registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the 6414@code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}. 6415 6416@item show may-write-registers 6417Show the current permission to write registers. 6418 6419@kindex may-write-memory 6420@item set may-write-memory on 6421@itemx set may-write-memory off 6422This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents 6423of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It 6424defaults to @code{on}. 6425 6426@item show may-write-memory 6427Show the current permission to write memory. 6428 6429@kindex may-insert-breakpoints 6430@item set may-insert-breakpoints on 6431@itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off 6432This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints. 6433This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined 6434by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6435 6436@item show may-insert-breakpoints 6437Show the current permission to insert breakpoints. 6438 6439@kindex may-insert-tracepoints 6440@item set may-insert-tracepoints on 6441@itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off 6442This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular) 6443tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only 6444non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of 6445@code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6446 6447@item show may-insert-tracepoints 6448Show the current permission to insert tracepoints. 6449 6450@kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints 6451@item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on 6452@itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off 6453This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast 6454tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only 6455fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the 6456control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6457 6458@item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints 6459Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints. 6460 6461@kindex may-interrupt 6462@item set may-interrupt on 6463@itemx set may-interrupt off 6464This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop 6465program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the 6466@code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will 6467@kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6468 6469@item show may-interrupt 6470Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program. 6471 6472@end table 6473 6474@node Reverse Execution 6475@chapter Running programs backward 6476@cindex reverse execution 6477@cindex running programs backward 6478 6479When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that 6480you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened. 6481If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to 6482``rewind'' the program by running it backward. 6483 6484A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able 6485to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the 6486program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should 6487revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great 6488deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not 6489all target environments can support reverse execution. 6490 6491When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that 6492have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse 6493order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous 6494thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'', 6495the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that 6496instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing 6497a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code 6498should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their 6499prior values@footnote{ 6500Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance, 6501memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some 6502targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not. 6503 6504The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target 6505requires only that the target do something reasonable when 6506@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the 6507results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to 6508@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN} 6509assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a 6510consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given. 6511}. 6512 6513If you are debugging in a target environment that supports 6514reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands. 6515 6516@table @code 6517@kindex reverse-continue 6518@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})} 6519@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 6520@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 6521Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing 6522in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous 6523exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of 6524asynchronous signals depends on the target environment. 6525 6526@kindex reverse-step 6527@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})} 6528@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6529Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a 6530different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}. 6531 6532Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop 6533at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously 6534executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to 6535debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into 6536the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last} 6537statement in the called function (typically a return statement). 6538 6539Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are 6540called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping. 6541 6542@kindex reverse-stepi 6543@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})} 6544@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6545Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction 6546to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program 6547counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance, 6548if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you 6549back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself. 6550 6551@kindex reverse-next 6552@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})} 6553@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6554Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in 6555the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function 6556calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from 6557the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back 6558to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called, 6559just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last 6560line of a function back to its return to its caller 6561@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}. 6562 6563@kindex reverse-nexti 6564@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})} 6565@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6566Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction 6567in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically. 6568That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from 6569another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute 6570in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack 6571frame) is reached. 6572 6573@kindex reverse-finish 6574@item reverse-finish 6575Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the 6576current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point 6577where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current 6578function invocation, you end up at the beginning. 6579 6580@kindex set exec-direction 6581@item set exec-direction 6582Set the direction of target execution. 6583@item set exec-direction reverse 6584@cindex execute forward or backward in time 6585@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the 6586exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include 6587@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return} 6588command cannot be used in reverse mode. 6589@item set exec-direction forward 6590@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion. 6591This is the default. 6592@end table 6593 6594 6595@node Process Record and Replay 6596@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It 6597@cindex process record and replay 6598@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it 6599 6600On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record 6601and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and 6602replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands. 6603 6604@cindex replay mode 6605When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record 6606for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay 6607mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code 6608instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during 6609code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not 6610really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the 6611program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still 6612changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the 6613execution log. 6614 6615@cindex record mode 6616If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log, 6617@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the 6618inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log 6619for future replay. 6620 6621The process record and replay target supports reverse execution 6622(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the 6623inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in 6624this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution 6625log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't 6626support it directly can only be done in the replay mode. 6627 6628When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in 6629replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the 6630previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the 6631platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not. 6632 6633For architecture environments that support process record and replay, 6634@value{GDBN} provides the following commands: 6635 6636@table @code 6637@kindex target record 6638@kindex target record-full 6639@kindex target record-btrace 6640@kindex record 6641@kindex record full 6642@kindex record btrace 6643@kindex record btrace bts 6644@kindex record btrace pt 6645@kindex record bts 6646@kindex record pt 6647@kindex rec 6648@kindex rec full 6649@kindex rec btrace 6650@kindex rec btrace bts 6651@kindex rec btrace pt 6652@kindex rec bts 6653@kindex rec pt 6654@item record @var{method} 6655This command starts the process record and replay target. The 6656recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter 6657the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following 6658recording methods are available: 6659 6660@table @code 6661@item full 6662Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and 6663replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse 6664execution. 6665 6666@item btrace @var{format} 6667Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record 6668data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will 6669be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse 6670execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse 6671execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect. 6672Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may 6673be stopped using @code{record stop}. 6674 6675The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter 6676the command chooses the recording format. The following recording 6677formats are available: 6678 6679@table @code 6680@item bts 6681@cindex branch trace store 6682Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In 6683this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed 6684branch in the btrace ring buffer. 6685 6686@item pt 6687@cindex Intel Processor Trace 6688Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this 6689format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form 6690that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}. 6691 6692The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed 6693trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big 6694number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}. 6695 6696Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more 6697expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the 6698increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the 6699buffer-size with care. 6700@end table 6701 6702Not all recording formats may be available on all processors. 6703@end table 6704 6705The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is 6706already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with 6707the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording 6708with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command. 6709 6710@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay 6711Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping}) 6712will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target 6713is started. That's because the process record and replay target 6714doesn't support displaced stepping. 6715 6716@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay 6717@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay 6718If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in 6719the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not 6720all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method 6721does not support these two modes. 6722 6723@kindex record stop 6724@kindex rec s 6725@item record stop 6726Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and 6727replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the 6728inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state. 6729 6730When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at 6731the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the 6732next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if 6733you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process 6734will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened. 6735 6736On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped 6737while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log, 6738but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live'' 6739at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the 6740usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state. 6741 6742When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it, 6743process record and replay target will automatically stop itself. 6744 6745@kindex record goto 6746@item record goto 6747Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several 6748ways to specify the location to go to: 6749 6750@table @code 6751@item record goto begin 6752@itemx record goto start 6753Go to the beginning of the execution log. 6754 6755@item record goto end 6756Go to the end of the execution log. 6757 6758@item record goto @var{n} 6759Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log. 6760@end table 6761 6762@kindex record save 6763@item record save @var{filename} 6764Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}. 6765Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where 6766@var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior. 6767 6768This command may not be available for all recording methods. 6769 6770@kindex record restore 6771@item record restore @var{filename} 6772Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}. 6773File must have been created with @code{record save}. 6774 6775@kindex set record full 6776@item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit} 6777@itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited 6778Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full} 6779recording method. Default value is 200000. 6780 6781If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start 6782deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record 6783instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded 6784instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded 6785instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit. 6786(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN} 6787lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of 6788the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.) 6789 6790If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never 6791delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of 6792recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory. 6793 6794@kindex show record full 6795@item show record full insn-number-max 6796Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full} 6797recording method. 6798 6799@item set record full stop-at-limit 6800Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the 6801number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the 6802default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the 6803first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or 6804continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide 6805to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the 6806oldest one to be deleted. 6807 6808If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the 6809oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking. 6810 6811@item show record full stop-at-limit 6812Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}. 6813 6814@item set record full memory-query 6815Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory 6816changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method. 6817If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that 6818case. 6819 6820If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically 6821ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when 6822@value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this 6823instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay 6824results. 6825 6826@item show record full memory-query 6827Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}. 6828 6829@kindex set record btrace 6830The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a 6831convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off 6832the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the 6833read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to 6834disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables. 6835In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful. 6836You can use the following command for that: 6837 6838@item set record btrace replay-memory-access 6839Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when 6840accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default), 6841@value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory. 6842If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only 6843and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds 6844to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay 6845position. 6846 6847@kindex show record btrace 6848@item show record btrace replay-memory-access 6849Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}. 6850 6851@kindex set record btrace bts 6852@item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size} 6853@itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited 6854Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS} 6855format. Default is 64KB. 6856 6857If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to 6858allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread 6859that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format. 6860The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested 6861@var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual 6862buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and 6863the @acronym{BTS} format. 6864 6865If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to 6866allocate a buffer of 4MB. 6867 6868Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will 6869also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used. 6870 6871@item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size} 6872Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch 6873tracing in @acronym{BTS} format. 6874 6875@kindex set record btrace pt 6876@item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size} 6877@itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited 6878Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel 6879Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB. 6880 6881If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to 6882allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread 6883that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace 6884format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the 6885requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the 6886actual buffer size for each thread. 6887 6888If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to 6889allocate a buffer of 4MB. 6890 6891Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will 6892also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used. 6893 6894@item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size} 6895Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch 6896tracing in Intel Processor Trace format. 6897 6898@kindex info record 6899@item info record 6900Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording 6901method: 6902 6903@table @code 6904@item full 6905For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process 6906record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including: 6907 6908@itemize @bullet 6909@item 6910Whether in record mode or replay mode. 6911@item 6912Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions). 6913@item 6914Highest recorded instruction number. 6915@item 6916Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode). 6917@item 6918Number of instructions contained in the execution log. 6919@item 6920Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log. 6921@end itemize 6922 6923@item btrace 6924For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows: 6925 6926@itemize @bullet 6927@item 6928Recording format. 6929@item 6930Number of instructions that have been recorded. 6931@item 6932Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded 6933instructions. 6934@item 6935Whether in record mode or replay mode. 6936@end itemize 6937 6938For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows: 6939@itemize @bullet 6940@item 6941Size of the perf ring buffer. 6942@end itemize 6943 6944For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows: 6945@itemize @bullet 6946@item 6947Size of the perf ring buffer. 6948@end itemize 6949@end table 6950 6951@kindex record delete 6952@kindex rec del 6953@item record delete 6954When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the 6955subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting 6956from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously 6957recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''. 6958 6959@kindex record instruction-history 6960@kindex rec instruction-history 6961@item record instruction-history 6962Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By 6963default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using 6964the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions 6965are printed in execution order. 6966 6967It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the 6968@code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex 6969as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier. 6970 6971The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the 6972current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple 6973times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed 6974every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the 6975@code{/p} modifier. 6976 6977To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains 6978instructions from more than one function, the function name may be 6979omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier. 6980 6981Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This 6982feature is not available for all recording formats. 6983 6984There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to 6985disassemble: 6986 6987@table @code 6988@item record instruction-history @var{insn} 6989Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number 6990@var{insn}. 6991 6992@item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n} 6993Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number 6994@var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles 6995@var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If 6996@var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n} 6997instructions before instruction number @var{insn}. 6998 6999@item record instruction-history 7000Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly. 7001 7002@item record instruction-history - 7003Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly. 7004 7005@item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end} 7006Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number 7007@var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction 7008number @var{end} is included. 7009@end table 7010 7011This command may not be available for all recording methods. 7012 7013@kindex set record 7014@item set record instruction-history-size @var{size} 7015@itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited 7016Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record 7017instruction-history} command. The default value is 10. 7018A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions. 7019 7020@kindex show record 7021@item show record instruction-history-size 7022Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record 7023instruction-history} command. 7024 7025@kindex record function-call-history 7026@kindex rec function-call-history 7027@item record function-call-history 7028Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one 7029line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same 7030function giving the name of that function, the source lines 7031for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is 7032specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if 7033the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented 7034to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is 7035specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be 7036given together. 7037 7038@smallexample 7039(@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10} 70401 void foo (void) 70412 @{ 70423 @} 70434 70445 void bar (void) 70456 @{ 70467 ... 70478 foo (); 70489 ... 704910 @} 7050(@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc} 70511 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8 70522 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3 70533 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10 7054@end smallexample 7055 7056By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the 7057@code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are 7058printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what 7059to print: 7060 7061@table @code 7062@item record function-call-history @var{func} 7063Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}. 7064 7065@item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n} 7066Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If 7067@var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after 7068function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, 7069prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}. 7070 7071@item record function-call-history 7072Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print. 7073 7074@item record function-call-history - 7075Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print. 7076 7077@item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end} 7078Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until 7079function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included. 7080@end table 7081 7082This command may not be available for all recording methods. 7083 7084@item set record function-call-history-size @var{size} 7085@itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited 7086Define how many lines to print in the 7087@code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10. 7088A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines. 7089 7090@item show record function-call-history-size 7091Show how many lines to print in the 7092@code{record function-call-history} command. 7093@end table 7094 7095 7096@node Stack 7097@chapter Examining the Stack 7098 7099When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it 7100stopped and how it got there. 7101 7102@cindex call stack 7103Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call 7104is generated. 7105That information includes the location of the call in your program, 7106the arguments of the call, 7107and the local variables of the function being called. 7108The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}. 7109The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call 7110stack}. 7111 7112When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the 7113stack allow you to see all of this information. 7114 7115@cindex selected frame 7116One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many 7117@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In 7118particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in 7119your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are 7120special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are 7121interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 7122 7123When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the 7124currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the 7125@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}). 7126 7127@menu 7128* Frames:: Stack frames 7129* Backtrace:: Backtraces 7130* Selection:: Selecting a frame 7131* Frame Info:: Information on a frame 7132* Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters 7133 7134@end menu 7135 7136@node Frames 7137@section Stack Frames 7138 7139@cindex frame, definition 7140@cindex stack frame 7141The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack 7142frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated 7143with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given 7144to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at 7145which the function is executing. 7146 7147@cindex initial frame 7148@cindex outermost frame 7149@cindex innermost frame 7150When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the 7151function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the 7152@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is 7153made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation 7154is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for 7155the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is 7156actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most 7157recently created of all the stack frames that still exist. 7158 7159@cindex frame pointer 7160Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A 7161stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each 7162kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose 7163address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept 7164in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} 7165(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame. 7166 7167@cindex frame number 7168@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with 7169zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it, 7170and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program; 7171they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack 7172frames in @value{GDBN} commands. 7173 7174@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow 7175@c underflow problems. 7176@cindex frameless execution 7177Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate 7178without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option 7179@smallexample 7180@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} 7181@end smallexample 7182generates functions without a frame.) 7183This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save 7184the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing 7185with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation 7186has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though 7187it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing 7188correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has 7189no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack. 7190 7191@node Backtrace 7192@section Backtraces 7193 7194@cindex traceback 7195@cindex call stack traces 7196A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one 7197line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing 7198frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the 7199stack. 7200 7201@anchor{backtrace-command} 7202@table @code 7203@kindex backtrace 7204@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})} 7205@item backtrace 7206@itemx bt 7207Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all 7208frames in the stack. 7209 7210You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt 7211character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}. 7212 7213@item backtrace @var{n} 7214@itemx bt @var{n} 7215Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames. 7216 7217@item backtrace -@var{n} 7218@itemx bt -@var{n} 7219Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames. 7220 7221@item backtrace full 7222@itemx bt full 7223@itemx bt full @var{n} 7224@itemx bt full -@var{n} 7225Print the values of the local variables also. As described above, 7226@var{n} specifies the number of frames to print. 7227 7228@item backtrace no-filters 7229@itemx bt no-filters 7230@itemx bt no-filters @var{n} 7231@itemx bt no-filters -@var{n} 7232@itemx bt no-filters full 7233@itemx bt no-filters full @var{n} 7234@itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n} 7235Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame 7236Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable 7237frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only 7238relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python} 7239support. 7240@end table 7241 7242@kindex where 7243@kindex info stack 7244The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s}) 7245are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}. 7246 7247@cindex multiple threads, backtrace 7248In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the 7249backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for 7250several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply} 7251(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread 7252apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all 7253the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a 7254multi-threaded program. 7255 7256Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name. 7257The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set 7258print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and 7259line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program 7260counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that 7261line number. 7262 7263Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command 7264@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames. 7265 7266@smallexample 7267@group 7268#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) 7269 at builtin.c:993 7270#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242 7271#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08) 7272 at macro.c:71 7273(More stack frames follow...) 7274@end group 7275@end smallexample 7276 7277@noindent 7278The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter 7279value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the 7280code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}. 7281 7282@noindent 7283The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by 7284@code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter 7285only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command 7286@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details 7287on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed. 7288 7289@cindex optimized out, in backtrace 7290@cindex function call arguments, optimized out 7291If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will 7292optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are 7293never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that 7294passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments 7295in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such 7296arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what 7297such a backtrace might look like: 7298 7299@smallexample 7300@group 7301#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) 7302 at builtin.c:993 7303#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242 7304#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08) 7305 at macro.c:71 7306(More stack frames follow...) 7307@end group 7308@end smallexample 7309 7310@noindent 7311The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are 7312shown as @samp{<optimized out>}. 7313 7314If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments, 7315either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one 7316you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations. 7317 7318@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function 7319@cindex program entry point 7320@cindex startup code, and backtrace 7321Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system 7322libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is 7323@code{main}@footnote{ 7324Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing'' 7325environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the 7326entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}. 7327When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace 7328it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly 7329system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code. 7330 7331If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels 7332in a backtrace, you can change this behavior: 7333 7334@table @code 7335@item set backtrace past-main 7336@itemx set backtrace past-main on 7337@kindex set backtrace 7338Backtraces will continue past the user entry point. 7339 7340@item set backtrace past-main off 7341Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the 7342default. 7343 7344@item show backtrace past-main 7345@kindex show backtrace 7346Display the current user entry point backtrace policy. 7347 7348@item set backtrace past-entry 7349@itemx set backtrace past-entry on 7350Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application. 7351This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built, 7352and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called. 7353 7354@item set backtrace past-entry off 7355Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an 7356application. This is the default. 7357 7358@item show backtrace past-entry 7359Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy. 7360 7361@item set backtrace limit @var{n} 7362@itemx set backtrace limit 0 7363@itemx set backtrace limit unlimited 7364@cindex backtrace limit 7365Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited} 7366or zero means unlimited levels. 7367 7368@item show backtrace limit 7369Display the current limit on backtrace levels. 7370@end table 7371 7372You can control how file names are displayed. 7373 7374@table @code 7375@item set filename-display 7376@itemx set filename-display relative 7377@cindex filename-display 7378Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default. 7379 7380@item set filename-display basename 7381Display only basename of a filename. 7382 7383@item set filename-display absolute 7384Display an absolute filename. 7385 7386@item show filename-display 7387Show the current way to display filenames. 7388@end table 7389 7390@node Selection 7391@section Selecting a Frame 7392 7393Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on 7394whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for 7395selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description 7396of the stack frame just selected. 7397 7398@table @code 7399@kindex frame@r{, selecting} 7400@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})} 7401@item frame @var{n} 7402@itemx f @var{n} 7403Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost 7404(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the 7405innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for 7406@code{main}. 7407 7408@item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ] 7409@itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ] 7410Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the 7411chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it 7412impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In 7413addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and 7414switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to 7415specify the value of PC for the stack frame. 7416 7417@kindex up 7418@item up @var{n} 7419Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive 7420numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher 7421frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer. 7422 7423@kindex down 7424@kindex do @r{(@code{down})} 7425@item down @var{n} 7426Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For 7427positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to 7428lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently. 7429You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}. 7430@end table 7431 7432All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the 7433frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the 7434arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that 7435frame. The second line shows the text of that source line. 7436 7437@need 1000 7438For example: 7439 7440@smallexample 7441@group 7442(@value{GDBP}) up 7443#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc) 7444 at env.c:10 744510 read_input_file (argv[i]); 7446@end group 7447@end smallexample 7448 7449After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments 7450prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame. 7451You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite 7452editing program by typing @code{edit}. 7453@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines}, 7454for details. 7455 7456@table @code 7457@kindex select-frame 7458@item select-frame 7459The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does 7460not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is 7461intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the 7462output might be unnecessary and distracting. 7463 7464@kindex down-silently 7465@kindex up-silently 7466@item up-silently @var{n} 7467@itemx down-silently @var{n} 7468These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down}, 7469respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without 7470causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use 7471in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and 7472distracting. 7473@end table 7474 7475@node Frame Info 7476@section Information About a Frame 7477 7478There are several other commands to print information about the selected 7479stack frame. 7480 7481@table @code 7482@item frame 7483@itemx f 7484When used without any argument, this command does not change which 7485frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently 7486selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an 7487argument, this command is used to select a stack frame. 7488@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 7489 7490@kindex info frame 7491@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})} 7492@item info frame 7493@itemx info f 7494This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame, 7495including: 7496 7497@itemize @bullet 7498@item 7499the address of the frame 7500@item 7501the address of the next frame down (called by this frame) 7502@item 7503the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame) 7504@item 7505the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written 7506@item 7507the address of the frame's arguments 7508@item 7509the address of the frame's local variables 7510@item 7511the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame) 7512@item 7513which registers were saved in the frame 7514@end itemize 7515 7516@noindent The verbose description is useful when 7517something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit 7518the usual conventions. 7519 7520@item info frame @var{addr} 7521@itemx info f @var{addr} 7522Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without 7523selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this 7524command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some 7525architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command. 7526@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 7527 7528@kindex info args 7529@item info args 7530Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line. 7531 7532@item info locals 7533@kindex info locals 7534Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate 7535line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic) 7536accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame. 7537 7538@end table 7539 7540@node Frame Filter Management 7541@section Management of Frame Filters. 7542@cindex managing frame filters 7543 7544Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the 7545output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information. 7546 7547Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available 7548within @value{GDBN}, detailed here. 7549 7550@table @code 7551@kindex info frame-filter 7552@item info frame-filter 7553Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing 7554their name, priority and enabled status. 7555 7556@kindex disable frame-filter 7557@anchor{disable frame-filter all} 7558@item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} 7559Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7560@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The 7561@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global}, 7562@code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7563dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters 7564across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name 7565of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for 7566@var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it 7567may be enabled again later. 7568 7569@kindex enable frame-filter 7570@item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} 7571Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7572@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The 7573@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global}, 7574@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7575dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across 7576all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame 7577filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for 7578@var{filter-dictionary}. 7579 7580Example: 7581 7582@smallexample 7583(gdb) info frame-filter 7584 7585global frame-filters: 7586 Priority Enabled Name 7587 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter 7588 100 Yes Reverse 7589 7590progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7591 Priority Enabled Name 7592 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7593 7594objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7595 Priority Enabled Name 7596 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter 7597 7598(gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter 7599(gdb) info frame-filter 7600 7601global frame-filters: 7602 Priority Enabled Name 7603 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter 7604 100 Yes Reverse 7605 7606progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7607 Priority Enabled Name 7608 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7609 7610objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7611 Priority Enabled Name 7612 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7613 7614(gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter 7615(gdb) info frame-filter 7616 7617global frame-filters: 7618 Priority Enabled Name 7619 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter 7620 100 Yes Reverse 7621 7622progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7623 Priority Enabled Name 7624 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7625 7626objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7627 Priority Enabled Name 7628 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7629@end smallexample 7630 7631@kindex set frame-filter priority 7632@item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority} 7633Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7634@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching 7635@var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global}, 7636@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7637dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer. 7638 7639@kindex show frame-filter priority 7640@item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} 7641Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7642@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching 7643@var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global}, 7644@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7645dictionary resides. 7646 7647Example: 7648 7649@smallexample 7650(gdb) info frame-filter 7651 7652global frame-filters: 7653 Priority Enabled Name 7654 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter 7655 100 Yes Reverse 7656 7657progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7658 Priority Enabled Name 7659 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7660 7661objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7662 Priority Enabled Name 7663 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7664 7665(gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50 7666(gdb) info frame-filter 7667 7668global frame-filters: 7669 Priority Enabled Name 7670 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter 7671 50 Yes Reverse 7672 7673progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7674 Priority Enabled Name 7675 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7676 7677objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7678 Priority Enabled Name 7679 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7680@end smallexample 7681@end table 7682 7683@node Source 7684@chapter Examining Source Files 7685 7686@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging 7687information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were 7688used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints 7689the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame 7690(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where 7691execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of 7692source files by explicit command. 7693 7694If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may 7695prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using 7696@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}. 7697 7698@menu 7699* List:: Printing source lines 7700* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations 7701* Edit:: Editing source files 7702* Search:: Searching source files 7703* Source Path:: Specifying source directories 7704* Machine Code:: Source and machine code 7705@end menu 7706 7707@node List 7708@section Printing Source Lines 7709 7710@kindex list 7711@kindex l @r{(@code{list})} 7712To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command 7713(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed. 7714There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to 7715print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list. 7716 7717Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used: 7718 7719@table @code 7720@item list @var{linenum} 7721Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the 7722current source file. 7723 7724@item list @var{function} 7725Print lines centered around the beginning of function 7726@var{function}. 7727 7728@item list 7729Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a 7730@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines 7731printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed 7732as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the 7733Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line. 7734 7735@item list - 7736Print lines just before the lines last printed. 7737@end table 7738 7739@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display 7740By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of 7741the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}: 7742 7743@table @code 7744@kindex set listsize 7745@item set listsize @var{count} 7746@itemx set listsize unlimited 7747Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless 7748the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number). 7749Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit. 7750 7751@kindex show listsize 7752@item show listsize 7753Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints. 7754@end table 7755 7756Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument, 7757so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful 7758than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an 7759argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that 7760each repetition moves up in the source file. 7761 7762In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two 7763@dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways 7764of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always 7765to specify some source line. 7766 7767Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}: 7768 7769@table @code 7770@item list @var{location} 7771Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}. 7772 7773@item list @var{first},@var{last} 7774Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are 7775locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the 7776source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to 7777the same source file as the first location. 7778 7779@item list ,@var{last} 7780Print lines ending with @var{last}. 7781 7782@item list @var{first}, 7783Print lines starting with @var{first}. 7784 7785@item list + 7786Print lines just after the lines last printed. 7787 7788@item list - 7789Print lines just before the lines last printed. 7790 7791@item list 7792As described in the preceding table. 7793@end table 7794 7795@node Specify Location 7796@section Specifying a Location 7797@cindex specifying location 7798@cindex location 7799@cindex source location 7800 7801@menu 7802* Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations 7803* Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations 7804* Address Locations:: Address locations 7805@end menu 7806 7807Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location 7808of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level 7809debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code. 7810Locations may be specified using three different formats: 7811linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations. 7812 7813@node Linespec Locations 7814@subsection Linespec Locations 7815@cindex linespec locations 7816 7817A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such 7818as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of 7819specifying a linespec: 7820 7821@table @code 7822@item @var{linenum} 7823Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file. 7824 7825@item -@var{offset} 7826@itemx +@var{offset} 7827Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current 7828line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one 7829printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which 7830execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame} 7831(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When 7832used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command, 7833this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first 7834linespec. 7835 7836@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum} 7837Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}. 7838If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any 7839source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if 7840@var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file 7841name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not 7842@file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}. 7843 7844@item @var{function} 7845Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}. 7846For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace. 7847 7848@item @var{function}:@var{label} 7849Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}. 7850 7851@item @var{filename}:@var{function} 7852Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function} 7853in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a 7854function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named 7855functions in different source files. 7856 7857@item @var{label} 7858Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears 7859in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame. 7860If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior 7861is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label. 7862 7863@cindex breakpoint at static probe point 7864@item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name} 7865The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for 7866applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more 7867information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec 7868specifies the location of such a static probe. 7869 7870If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library 7871or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered. 7872If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered. 7873If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at 7874each one of those probes. 7875@end table 7876 7877@node Explicit Locations 7878@subsection Explicit Locations 7879@cindex explicit locations 7880 7881@dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source 7882location's parameters using option-value pairs. 7883 7884Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or 7885file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's 7886sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source 7887line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using 7888explicit locations might be faster in large programs. 7889 7890For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar} 7891defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function 7892named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or 7893the symbol table to know. 7894 7895The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the 7896following table: 7897 7898@table @code 7899@item -source @var{filename} 7900The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between 7901files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary 7902to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise 7903@value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base 7904name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}. 7905 7906@item -function @var{function} 7907The value specifies the name of a function. Operations 7908on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label} 7909or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function. 7910In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace. 7911 7912@item -label @var{label} 7913The value specifies the name of a label. When the function 7914name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently 7915selected stack frame. 7916 7917@item -line @var{number} 7918The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either 7919be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on 7920the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is 7921relative to the current line. 7922@end table 7923 7924Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique 7925trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}. 7926 7927@node Address Locations 7928@subsection Address Locations 7929@cindex address locations 7930 7931@dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have 7932the generalized form *@var{address}. 7933 7934For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this 7935specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and 7936other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in 7937parts of your program which do not have debugging information or 7938source files. 7939 7940Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working 7941language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code 7942address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the 7943semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations 7944that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms 7945of @var{address}: 7946 7947@table @code 7948@item @var{expression} 7949Any expression valid in the current working language. 7950 7951@item @var{funcaddr} 7952An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C, 7953C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is 7954simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case 7955of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is 7956@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address} 7957(although the Pascal form also works). 7958 7959This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction, 7960before the stack frame and arguments have been set up. 7961 7962@item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr} 7963Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source 7964file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not 7965specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several 7966functions with identical names in different source files. 7967@end table 7968 7969@node Edit 7970@section Editing Source Files 7971@cindex editing source files 7972 7973@kindex edit 7974@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})} 7975To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command. 7976The editing program of your choice 7977is invoked with the current line set to 7978the active line in the program. 7979Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you 7980want to print if you want to see other parts of the program: 7981 7982@table @code 7983@item edit @var{location} 7984Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at 7985that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the 7986specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms 7987of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit} 7988command most commonly used: 7989 7990@table @code 7991@item edit @var{number} 7992Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number. 7993 7994@item edit @var{function} 7995Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition. 7996@end table 7997 7998@end table 7999 8000@subsection Choosing your Editor 8001You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want 8002@footnote{ 8003The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the 8004following command-line syntax: 8005@smallexample 8006ex +@var{number} file 8007@end smallexample 8008The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in 8009the file where to start editing.}. 8010By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this 8011by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using 8012@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the 8013@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell: 8014@smallexample 8015EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi 8016export EDITOR 8017gdb @dots{} 8018@end smallexample 8019or in the @code{csh} shell, 8020@smallexample 8021setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi 8022gdb @dots{} 8023@end smallexample 8024 8025@node Search 8026@section Searching Source Files 8027@cindex searching source files 8028 8029There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a 8030regular expression. 8031 8032@table @code 8033@kindex search 8034@kindex forward-search 8035@kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})} 8036@item forward-search @var{regexp} 8037@itemx search @var{regexp} 8038The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, 8039starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for 8040@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the 8041synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as 8042@code{fo}. 8043 8044@kindex reverse-search 8045@item reverse-search @var{regexp} 8046The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting 8047with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match 8048for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate 8049this command as @code{rev}. 8050@end table 8051 8052@node Source Path 8053@section Specifying Source Directories 8054 8055@cindex source path 8056@cindex directories for source files 8057Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source 8058files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do, 8059the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging 8060session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files; 8061this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file, 8062it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present 8063in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. 8064 8065For example, suppose an executable references the file 8066@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is 8067@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this 8068fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this 8069fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error 8070message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the 8071source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. 8072Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if 8073the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to 8074@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under 8075@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}. 8076 8077Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file 8078names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for 8079instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file 8080is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try 8081@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after 8082that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}. 8083 8084Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the 8085source files. 8086 8087Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out 8088any information it has cached about where source files are found and where 8089each line is in the file. 8090 8091@kindex directory 8092@kindex dir 8093When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir} 8094and @samp{cwd}, in that order. 8095To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command. 8096 8097The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN} 8098script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command). 8099 8100In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands 8101that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution 8102rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's 8103debug information in case the sources were moved to a different 8104directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of 8105two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in 8106the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten. 8107In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and 8108@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement 8109of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the 8110source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file 8111name to look up the sources. 8112 8113Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been 8114moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell 8115@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with 8116@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be 8117@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location 8118of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path 8119substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command 8120(@pxref{set substitute-path}). 8121 8122To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the 8123@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator. 8124For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into 8125@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but 8126not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution 8127is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will 8128not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either. 8129 8130In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory} 8131command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in 8132the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple 8133subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each 8134subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while 8135preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path} 8136allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single 8137command. 8138 8139@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command. 8140The source path is only used if the file at the original location no 8141longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies 8142the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if 8143for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is 8144located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only 8145method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location. 8146 8147@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources} 8148@cindex default source path substitution 8149You can configure a default source path substitution rule by 8150configuring @value{GDBN} with the 8151@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir} 8152should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured 8153prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and 8154directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted 8155automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 8156location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables 8157with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved 8158together. 8159 8160@table @code 8161@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{} 8162@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{} 8163Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several 8164directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:} 8165(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as 8166part of absolute file names) or 8167whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source 8168path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner. 8169 8170@kindex cdir 8171@kindex cwd 8172@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable} 8173@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable} 8174@cindex compilation directory 8175@cindex current directory 8176@cindex working directory 8177@cindex directory, current 8178@cindex directory, compilation 8179You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation 8180directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current 8181working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former 8182tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN} 8183session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current 8184directory at the time you add an entry to the source path. 8185 8186@item directory 8187Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation. 8188 8189@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since 8190@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS) 8191 8192@item set directories @var{path-list} 8193@kindex set directories 8194Set the source path to @var{path-list}. 8195@samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing. 8196 8197@item show directories 8198@kindex show directories 8199Print the source path: show which directories it contains. 8200 8201@anchor{set substitute-path} 8202@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to} 8203@kindex set substitute-path 8204Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the 8205current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same 8206@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted. 8207 8208For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to 8209@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command 8210 8211@smallexample 8212(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross 8213@end smallexample 8214 8215@noindent 8216will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with 8217@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file 8218@file{baz.c} even though it was moved. 8219 8220In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined, 8221the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been 8222defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform 8223the substitution. 8224 8225For instance, if we had entered the following commands: 8226 8227@smallexample 8228(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include 8229(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src 8230@end smallexample 8231 8232@noindent 8233@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into 8234@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would 8235use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into 8236@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}. 8237 8238 8239@item unset substitute-path [path] 8240@kindex unset substitute-path 8241If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules 8242for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found. 8243A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found. 8244 8245If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted. 8246 8247@item show substitute-path [path] 8248@kindex show substitute-path 8249If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule 8250which would rewrite that path, if any. 8251 8252If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution 8253rules. 8254 8255@end table 8256 8257If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of 8258interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong 8259versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows: 8260 8261@enumerate 8262@item 8263Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value. 8264 8265@item 8266Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the 8267directories you want in the source path. You can add all the 8268directories in one command. 8269@end enumerate 8270 8271@node Machine Code 8272@section Source and Machine Code 8273@cindex source line and its code address 8274 8275You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program 8276addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display 8277a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command 8278@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next 8279source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs 8280mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the 8281line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as 8282well as hex. 8283 8284@table @code 8285@kindex info line 8286@item info line @var{location} 8287Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for 8288source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of 8289the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. 8290@end table 8291 8292For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of 8293the object code for the first line of function 8294@code{m4_changequote}: 8295 8296@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in 8297@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed. 8298@smallexample 8299(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote 8300Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350. 8301@end smallexample 8302 8303@noindent 8304@cindex code address and its source line 8305We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for 8306@var{location}) what source line covers a particular address: 8307@smallexample 8308(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff 8309Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404. 8310@end smallexample 8311 8312@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line} 8313@cindex @code{x} command, default address 8314@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line 8315After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command 8316is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is 8317sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory, 8318,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the 8319convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 8320Variables}). 8321 8322@table @code 8323@kindex disassemble 8324@cindex assembly instructions 8325@cindex instructions, assembly 8326@cindex machine instructions 8327@cindex listing machine instructions 8328@item disassemble 8329@itemx disassemble /m 8330@itemx disassemble /s 8331@itemx disassemble /r 8332This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine 8333instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying 8334the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex 8335as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier. 8336The default memory range is the function surrounding the 8337program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this 8338command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function 8339surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should 8340be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The 8341arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms: 8342 8343@table @code 8344@item @var{start},@var{end} 8345the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive) 8346@item @var{start},+@var{length} 8347the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to 8348@code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive). 8349@end table 8350 8351@noindent 8352When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also 8353printed (since there could be several functions in the given range). 8354 8355The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as 8356@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}. 8357 8358If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter, 8359the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker. 8360@end table 8361 8362The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of 8363HP PA-RISC 2.0 code: 8364 8365@smallexample 8366(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4 8367Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4: 8368 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp 8369 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26 8370 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31 8371 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31) 8372 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp 8373 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp 8374 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26 8375 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31 8376End of assembler dump. 8377@end smallexample 8378 8379Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86 8380with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after 8381function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code. 8382 8383@smallexample 8384(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main 8385Dump of assembler code for function main: 83865 @{ 8387 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp 8388 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp 8389 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp 8390 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp 8391 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp 8392 83936 printf ("Hello.\n"); 8394=> 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp) 8395 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt> 8396 83977 return 0; 83988 @} 8399 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax 8400 0x0804834d <+29>: leave 8401 0x0804834e <+30>: ret 8402 8403End of assembler dump. 8404@end smallexample 8405 8406The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when 8407there is either inlined code or re-ordered code. 8408The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice. 8409Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between 8410@code{/m} output and @code{/s} output. 8411This example has one inline function defined in a header file, 8412and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization. 8413Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of 8414several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output. 8415 8416@file{foo.h}: 8417 8418@smallexample 8419int 8420foo (int a) 8421@{ 8422 if (a < 0) 8423 return a * 2; 8424 if (a == 0) 8425 return 1; 8426 return a + 10; 8427@} 8428@end smallexample 8429 8430@file{foo.c}: 8431 8432@smallexample 8433#include "foo.h" 8434volatile int x, y; 8435int 8436main () 8437@{ 8438 x = foo (y); 8439 return 0; 8440@} 8441@end smallexample 8442 8443@smallexample 8444(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main 8445Dump of assembler code for function main: 84465 @{ 8447 84486 x = foo (y); 8449 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y> 8450 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x> 8451 84527 return 0; 84538 @} 8454 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax 8455 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq 8456 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax 8457 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23> 8458 8459End of assembler dump. 8460(@value{GDBP}) disas /s main 8461Dump of assembler code for function main: 8462foo.c: 84635 @{ 84646 x = foo (y); 8465 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y> 8466 8467foo.h: 84684 if (a < 0) 8469 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax 8470 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32> 8471 84726 if (a == 0) 84737 return 1; 84748 return a + 10; 8475 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx 8476 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax 8477 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax 8478 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax 8479 8480foo.c: 84816 x = foo (y); 8482 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x> 8483 84847 return 0; 84858 @} 8486 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax 8487 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq 8488 8489foo.h: 84905 return a * 2; 8491 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax 8492 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23> 8493End of assembler dump. 8494@end smallexample 8495 8496Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64, 8497 8498@smallexample 8499(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10 8500Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b: 8501 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi) 8502 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax 8503 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx) 8504 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al 8505End of assembler dump. 8506@end smallexample 8507 8508Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}). 8509So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar} 8510in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar} 8511and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}. 8512 8513Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction 8514mnemonics or other syntax. 8515 8516For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries, 8517instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared 8518libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a 8519location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN} 8520might be able to resolve these to actual function names. 8521 8522@table @code 8523@kindex set disassembler-options 8524@cindex disassembler options 8525@item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}] 8526This command controls the passing of target specific information to 8527the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the 8528@code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump} 8529manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help} 8530(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}). 8531The default value is the empty string. 8532 8533If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then 8534multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list. 8535Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC 8536and S/390. 8537 8538@kindex show disassembler-options 8539@item show disassembler-options 8540Show the current setting of the disassembler options. 8541@end table 8542 8543@table @code 8544@kindex set disassembly-flavor 8545@cindex Intel disassembly flavor 8546@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor 8547@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set} 8548Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the 8549program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands. 8550 8551Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You 8552can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}. 8553The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix 8554assemblers for x86-based targets. 8555 8556@kindex show disassembly-flavor 8557@item show disassembly-flavor 8558Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor. 8559@end table 8560 8561@table @code 8562@kindex set disassemble-next-line 8563@kindex show disassemble-next-line 8564@item set disassemble-next-line 8565@itemx show disassemble-next-line 8566Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source 8567line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will 8568display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the 8569program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to 8570displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if 8571possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason 8572(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line 8573info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the 8574next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If 8575AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only 8576if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes 8577@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function 8578with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is 8579OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or 8580instruction. 8581@end table 8582 8583 8584@node Data 8585@chapter Examining Data 8586 8587@cindex printing data 8588@cindex examining data 8589@kindex print 8590@kindex inspect 8591The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print} 8592command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It 8593evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your 8594program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with 8595Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a 8596Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). 8597 8598@table @code 8599@item print @var{expr} 8600@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr} 8601@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the 8602value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type; 8603you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where 8604@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output 8605Formats}. 8606 8607@item print 8608@itemx print /@var{f} 8609@cindex reprint the last value 8610If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the 8611@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to 8612conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format. 8613@end table 8614 8615A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command. 8616It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a 8617specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}. 8618 8619If you are interested in information about types, or about how the 8620fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}} 8621command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol 8622Table}. 8623 8624@cindex exploring hierarchical data structures 8625@kindex explore 8626Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is 8627through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if 8628the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It 8629offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most 8630abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type 8631itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields 8632embedded in the higher level data types. 8633 8634@table @code 8635@item explore @var{arg} 8636@var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type 8637visible in the current context of the program being debugged. 8638@end table 8639 8640The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an 8641example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your 8642C program as 8643 8644@smallexample 8645struct SimpleStruct 8646@{ 8647 int i; 8648 double d; 8649@}; 8650 8651struct ComplexStruct 8652@{ 8653 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p; 8654 int arr[10]; 8655@}; 8656@end smallexample 8657 8658@noindent 8659followed by variable declarations as 8660 8661@smallexample 8662struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @}; 8663struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @}; 8664@end smallexample 8665 8666@noindent 8667then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the 8668@code{explore} command as follows. 8669 8670@smallexample 8671(gdb) explore cs 8672The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with 8673the following fields: 8674 8675 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'> 8676 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'> 8677 8678Enter the field number of choice: 8679@end smallexample 8680 8681@noindent 8682Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being 8683prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose 8684the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a 8685pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From 8686the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single 8687value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will 8688be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this 8689field will be explored as if it were an array. 8690 8691@smallexample 8692`cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct' 8693Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y 8694The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct 8695SimpleStruct' with the following fields: 8696 8697 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int') 8698 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double') 8699 8700Press enter to return to parent value: 8701@end smallexample 8702 8703@noindent 8704If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by 8705entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be 8706prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want 8707to explore. 8708 8709@smallexample 8710`cs.arr' is an array of `int'. 8711Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5 8712 8713`(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'. 8714 8715(cs.arr)[5] = 4 8716 8717Press enter to return to parent value: 8718@end smallexample 8719 8720In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the 8721leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the 8722return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher} 8723level data structure). 8724 8725Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to 8726explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a 8727variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the 8728program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the 8729same example as above, your can explore the type 8730@code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument 8731@code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command. 8732 8733@smallexample 8734(gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct 8735@end smallexample 8736 8737@noindent 8738By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive 8739session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a 8740manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above 8741example. 8742 8743The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands, 8744@code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is 8745a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is 8746being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type 8747exploration of the argument is being invoked. 8748 8749@table @code 8750@item explore value @var{expr} 8751@cindex explore value 8752This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the 8753expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the 8754current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this 8755command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore} 8756command being passed the argument @var{expr}. 8757 8758@item explore type @var{arg} 8759@cindex explore type 8760This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if 8761@var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being 8762debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg} 8763is an expression valid in the current context of the program being 8764debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is 8765identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the 8766argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of 8767this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command 8768being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument. 8769@end table 8770 8771@menu 8772* Expressions:: Expressions 8773* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions 8774* Variables:: Program variables 8775* Arrays:: Artificial arrays 8776* Output Formats:: Output formats 8777* Memory:: Examining memory 8778* Auto Display:: Automatic display 8779* Print Settings:: Print settings 8780* Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing 8781* Value History:: Value history 8782* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables 8783* Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions 8784* Registers:: Registers 8785* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware 8786* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit 8787* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system 8788* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes 8789* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file 8790* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core 8791* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different 8792 character set than GDB does 8793* Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets 8794* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes 8795* Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values 8796@end menu 8797 8798@node Expressions 8799@section Expressions 8800 8801@cindex expressions 8802@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and 8803compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined 8804by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in 8805@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, 8806casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if 8807you compiled your program to include this information; see 8808@ref{Compilation}. 8809 8810@cindex arrays in expressions 8811@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by 8812the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example, 8813you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array 8814of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it 8815to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that 8816is @code{malloc}ed in the target program. 8817 8818Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in 8819this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different 8820Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other 8821languages. 8822 8823In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN} 8824expressions regardless of your programming language. 8825 8826@cindex casts, in expressions 8827Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so 8828useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure 8829at that address in memory. 8830@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true? 8831 8832@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common 8833to programming languages: 8834 8835@table @code 8836@item @@ 8837@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays. 8838@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information. 8839 8840@item :: 8841@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or 8842function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}. 8843 8844@cindex @{@var{type}@} 8845@cindex type casting memory 8846@cindex memory, viewing as typed object 8847@cindex casts, to view memory 8848@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr} 8849Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in 8850memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is 8851an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary 8852operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless 8853of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}. 8854@end table 8855 8856@node Ambiguous Expressions 8857@section Ambiguous Expressions 8858@cindex ambiguous expressions 8859 8860Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance, 8861some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit 8862a single function name to be defined several times, for application in 8863different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example 8864involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++} 8865templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in 8866the same function name being defined in different contexts. 8867 8868In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust 8869the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you 8870can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in 8871@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully 8872qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous 8873as well. 8874 8875When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger 8876has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each 8877possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}. 8878The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}} 8879aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was 8880used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the 8881menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible 8882choices. 8883 8884For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a 8885breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}. 8886We choose three particular definitions of that function name: 8887 8888@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least 8889@smallexample 8890@group 8891(@value{GDBP}) b String::after 8892[0] cancel 8893[1] all 8894[2] file:String.cc; line number:867 8895[3] file:String.cc; line number:860 8896[4] file:String.cc; line number:875 8897[5] file:String.cc; line number:853 8898[6] file:String.cc; line number:846 8899[7] file:String.cc; line number:735 8900> 2 4 6 8901Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867. 8902Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875. 8903Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846. 8904Multiple breakpoints were set. 8905Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted 8906 breakpoints. 8907(@value{GDBP}) 8908@end group 8909@end smallexample 8910 8911@table @code 8912@kindex set multiple-symbols 8913@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode} 8914@cindex multiple-symbols menu 8915 8916This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression 8917is ambiguous. 8918 8919By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which 8920the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN} 8921automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting 8922a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint 8923inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made, 8924then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression. 8925For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result 8926in the use of the menu. 8927 8928When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu 8929when an ambiguity is detected. 8930 8931Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports 8932an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted. 8933 8934@kindex show multiple-symbols 8935@item show multiple-symbols 8936Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting. 8937@end table 8938 8939@node Variables 8940@section Program Variables 8941 8942The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable 8943in your program. 8944 8945Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame 8946(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either: 8947 8948@itemize @bullet 8949@item 8950global (or file-static) 8951@end itemize 8952 8953@noindent or 8954 8955@itemize @bullet 8956@item 8957visible according to the scope rules of the 8958programming language from the point of execution in that frame 8959@end itemize 8960 8961@noindent This means that in the function 8962 8963@smallexample 8964foo (a) 8965 int a; 8966@{ 8967 bar (a); 8968 @{ 8969 int b = test (); 8970 bar (b); 8971 @} 8972@} 8973@end smallexample 8974 8975@noindent 8976you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is 8977executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or 8978examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside 8979the block where @code{b} is declared. 8980 8981@cindex variable name conflict 8982There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose 8983scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not 8984in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or 8985function with the same name (in different source files). If that 8986happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish, 8987you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by 8988using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation: 8989 8990@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions 8991@ifnotinfo 8992@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers? 8993@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions 8994@end ifnotinfo 8995@smallexample 8996@var{file}::@var{variable} 8997@var{function}::@var{variable} 8998@end smallexample 8999 9000@noindent 9001Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the 9002static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to 9003make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example, 9004to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}: 9005 9006@smallexample 9007(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x 9008@end smallexample 9009 9010The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to 9011static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables 9012in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the 9013simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation 9014to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame: 9015 9016@smallexample 9017void 9018foo (int a) 9019@{ 9020 if (a < 10) 9021 bar (a); 9022 else 9023 process (a); /* Stop here */ 9024@} 9025 9026int 9027bar (int a) 9028@{ 9029 foo (a + 5); 9030@} 9031@end smallexample 9032 9033@noindent 9034For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line, 9035here is what you might see 9036when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}: 9037 9038@smallexample 9039(@value{GDBP}) p a 9040$1 = 10 9041(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a 9042$2 = 5 9043(@value{GDBP}) up 2 9044#2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12 9045(@value{GDBP}) p a 9046$3 = 5 9047(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a 9048$4 = 0 9049@end smallexample 9050 9051@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution 9052These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very 9053similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in 9054conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be 9055overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes. 9056 9057For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class 9058that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an 9059include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable, 9060@code{some_global}. 9061 9062@smallexample 9063(@value{GDBP}) p includefile 9064$1 = 23 9065(@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global 9066A syntax error in expression, near `'. 9067(@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global 9068$2 = 27 9069@end smallexample 9070 9071@cindex wrong values 9072@cindex variable values, wrong 9073@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables 9074@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables 9075@quotation 9076@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the 9077wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new 9078scope, and just before exit. 9079@end quotation 9080You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions. 9081This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to 9082set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are 9083stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong 9084values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually 9085also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame; 9086after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local 9087variable definitions may be gone. 9088 9089This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations. 9090To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization 9091when compiling. 9092 9093@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context'' 9094Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize 9095unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as 9096opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases 9097offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN} 9098might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that 9099happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this: 9100 9101@smallexample 9102No symbol "foo" in current context. 9103@end smallexample 9104 9105To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a 9106different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such 9107formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler 9108options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug 9109info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs. 9110 9111If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to 9112@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified 9113by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete 9114type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this. 9115 9116If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its 9117value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an 9118error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers. 9119Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according 9120to @ref{set print entry-values}. 9121 9122@smallexample 9123Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29 912429 i++; 9125(gdb) next 912630 e (i); 9127(gdb) print i 9128$1 = 31 9129(gdb) print i@@entry 9130$2 = 30 9131@end smallexample 9132 9133Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified 9134signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get 9135printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or 9136@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN} 9137defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign. 9138For program code 9139 9140@smallexample 9141char var0[] = "A"; 9142signed char var1[] = "A"; 9143@end smallexample 9144 9145You get during debugging 9146@smallexample 9147(gdb) print var0 9148$1 = "A" 9149(gdb) print var1 9150$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@} 9151@end smallexample 9152 9153@node Arrays 9154@section Artificial Arrays 9155 9156@cindex artificial array 9157@cindex arrays 9158@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array} 9159It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the 9160same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of 9161dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the 9162program. 9163 9164You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an 9165@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left 9166operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array 9167and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length 9168of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of 9169the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left 9170argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately 9171following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an 9172example. If a program says 9173 9174@smallexample 9175int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int)); 9176@end smallexample 9177 9178@noindent 9179you can print the contents of @code{array} with 9180 9181@smallexample 9182p *array@@len 9183@end smallexample 9184 9185The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made 9186with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of 9187subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions. 9188Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history 9189(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out. 9190 9191Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast. 9192This re-interprets a value as if it were an array. 9193The value need not be in memory: 9194@smallexample 9195(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678 9196$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@} 9197@end smallexample 9198 9199As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in 9200@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill 9201the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}: 9202@smallexample 9203(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678 9204$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@} 9205@end smallexample 9206 9207Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in 9208moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not 9209actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values 9210of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is 9211to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 9212Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first 9213interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For 9214instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to 9215structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv} 9216in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type: 9217 9218@smallexample 9219set $i = 0 9220p dtab[$i++]->fv 9221@key{RET} 9222@key{RET} 9223@dots{} 9224@end smallexample 9225 9226@node Output Formats 9227@section Output Formats 9228 9229@cindex formatted output 9230@cindex output formats 9231By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes 9232this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number 9233in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory 9234at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do 9235these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value. 9236 9237The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value 9238already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the 9239@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format 9240letters supported are: 9241 9242@table @code 9243@item x 9244Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in 9245hexadecimal. 9246 9247@item d 9248Print as integer in signed decimal. 9249 9250@item u 9251Print as integer in unsigned decimal. 9252 9253@item o 9254Print as integer in octal. 9255 9256@item t 9257Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''. 9258@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also 9259used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte''; 9260see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.} 9261 9262@item a 9263@cindex unknown address, locating 9264@cindex locate address 9265Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from 9266the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover 9267where (in what function) an unknown address is located: 9268 9269@smallexample 9270(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320 9271$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396> 9272@end smallexample 9273 9274@noindent 9275The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results. 9276@xref{Symbols, info symbol}. 9277 9278@item c 9279Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This 9280prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The 9281character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn} 9282for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range. 9283 9284Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char}, 9285@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character 9286constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer 9287data. 9288 9289@item f 9290Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print 9291using typical floating point syntax. 9292 9293@item s 9294@cindex printing strings 9295@cindex printing byte arrays 9296Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte 9297data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data 9298are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their 9299natural types. 9300 9301Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of 9302@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as 9303strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer 9304array. 9305 9306@item z 9307Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and 9308printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value 9309to the size of the integer type. 9310 9311@item r 9312@cindex raw printing 9313Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will 9314use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty 9315Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the 9316value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python 9317pretty-printer which might exist. 9318@end table 9319 9320For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type 9321 9322@smallexample 9323p/x $pc 9324@end smallexample 9325 9326@noindent 9327Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command 9328names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash. 9329 9330To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format, 9331you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no 9332expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex. 9333 9334@node Memory 9335@section Examining Memory 9336 9337You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in 9338any of several formats, independently of your program's data types. 9339 9340@cindex examining memory 9341@table @code 9342@kindex x @r{(examine memory)} 9343@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr} 9344@itemx x @var{addr} 9345@itemx x 9346Use the @code{x} command to examine memory. 9347@end table 9348 9349@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how 9350much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an 9351expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory. 9352If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}. 9353Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}. 9354 9355@table @r 9356@item @var{n}, the repeat count 9357The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies 9358how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative 9359number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}. 9360@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB 9361@c 4.1.2. 9362 9363@item @var{f}, the display format 9364The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print} 9365(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c}, 9366@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions). 9367The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes 9368each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}. 9369 9370@item @var{u}, the unit size 9371The unit size is any of 9372 9373@table @code 9374@item b 9375Bytes. 9376@item h 9377Halfwords (two bytes). 9378@item w 9379Words (four bytes). This is the initial default. 9380@item g 9381Giant words (eight bytes). 9382@end table 9383 9384Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the 9385default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format, 9386the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format, 9387the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given. 9388Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display 938932-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings. 9390Note that the results depend on the programming language of the 9391current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s} 9392modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use 9393UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot 9394be altered. 9395 9396@item @var{addr}, starting display address 9397@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying 9398memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may); 9399it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory. 9400@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for 9401@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several 9402other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to 9403the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the 9404starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display 9405a value from memory). 9406@end table 9407 9408For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords 9409(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}), 9410starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four 9411words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp}; 9412@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}). 9413 9414You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward 9415from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three 9416halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}. 9417 9418Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the 9419letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether 9420unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output 9421specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing. 9422(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.) 9423 9424Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s} 9425and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example, 9426@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions, 9427including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with 9428the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay 9429slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately 9430follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command 9431@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine 9432instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}. 9433 9434If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i}, 9435the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given 9436address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i} 9437format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate 9438instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not 9439available, the command stops examining memory with an error message. 9440 9441All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it 9442easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time 9443you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine 9444instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven 9445with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command, 9446the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as 9447for successive uses of @code{x}. 9448 9449When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program 9450counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example: 9451 9452@smallexample 9453(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6 9454 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp 9455 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx 9456 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp 9457=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp) 9458 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt> 9459@end smallexample 9460 9461@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history 9462The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved 9463in the value history because there is often too much of them and they 9464would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for 9465subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables 9466@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address 9467examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable 9468@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in 9469the convenience variable @code{$__}. 9470 9471If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved 9472are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last 9473address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output. 9474 9475@anchor{addressable memory unit} 9476@cindex addressable memory unit 9477Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means 9478that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some 9479targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes. 9480Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term 9481@dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used 9482when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word 9483@dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of 9484the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems, 9485addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte. 9486 9487@cindex remote memory comparison 9488@cindex target memory comparison 9489@cindex verify remote memory image 9490@cindex verify target memory image 9491When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine 9492(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image 9493in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you 9494downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check 9495whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The 9496@code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations. 9497 9498@table @code 9499@kindex compare-sections 9500@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]} 9501Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the 9502executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in 9503the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no 9504arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of 9505@code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections. 9506 9507Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the 9508target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory 9509(@pxref{qCRC packet}). 9510@end table 9511 9512@node Auto Display 9513@section Automatic Display 9514@cindex automatic display 9515@cindex display of expressions 9516 9517If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently 9518(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic 9519display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops. 9520Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it; 9521to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number. 9522The automatic display looks like this: 9523 9524@smallexample 95252: foo = 38 95263: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804 9527@end smallexample 9528 9529@noindent 9530This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with 9531displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can 9532specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides 9533whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format 9534specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i} 9535or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}. 9536 9537@table @code 9538@kindex display 9539@item display @var{expr} 9540Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display 9541each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 9542 9543@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. 9544 9545@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr} 9546For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or 9547count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but 9548arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}. 9549@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}. 9550 9551@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr} 9552For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a 9553number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to 9554be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect 9555doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}. 9556@end table 9557 9558For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine 9559instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc} 9560is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}). 9561 9562@table @code 9563@kindex delete display 9564@kindex undisplay 9565@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{} 9566@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{} 9567Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the 9568numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command 9569argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the 9570numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display; 9571or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 9572 9573@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 9574(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.) 9575 9576@kindex disable display 9577@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{} 9578Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display 9579item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be 9580enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you 9581want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a 9582single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of 9583the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display 9584numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 9585 9586@kindex enable display 9587@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{} 9588Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once 9589again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise. 9590Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the 9591command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one 9592of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} 9593display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 9594 9595@item display 9596Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is 9597done when your program stops. 9598 9599@kindex info display 9600@item info display 9601Print the list of expressions previously set up to display 9602automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the 9603values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such. 9604It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now 9605because they refer to automatic variables not currently available. 9606@end table 9607 9608@cindex display disabled out of scope 9609If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make 9610sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an 9611expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its 9612variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command 9613@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument 9614@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program 9615continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where 9616there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled 9617automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char} 9618is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again. 9619 9620@node Print Settings 9621@section Print Settings 9622 9623@cindex format options 9624@cindex print settings 9625@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures, 9626and symbols are printed. 9627 9628@noindent 9629These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language: 9630 9631@table @code 9632@kindex set print 9633@item set print address 9634@itemx set print address on 9635@cindex print/don't print memory addresses 9636@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack 9637traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth, 9638even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default 9639is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with 9640@code{set print address on}: 9641 9642@smallexample 9643@group 9644(@value{GDBP}) f 9645#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>") 9646 at input.c:530 9647530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 9648@end group 9649@end smallexample 9650 9651@item set print address off 9652Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example, 9653this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}: 9654 9655@smallexample 9656@group 9657(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off 9658(@value{GDBP}) f 9659#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530 9660530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 9661@end group 9662@end smallexample 9663 9664You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine 9665dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with 9666@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on 9667all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments. 9668 9669@kindex show print 9670@item show print address 9671Show whether or not addresses are to be printed. 9672@end table 9673 9674When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the 9675closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely 9676identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single 9677source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with 9678@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately, 9679you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when 9680it prints a symbolic address: 9681 9682@table @code 9683@item set print symbol-filename on 9684@cindex source file and line of a symbol 9685@cindex symbol, source file and line 9686Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a 9687symbol in the symbolic form of an address. 9688 9689@item set print symbol-filename off 9690Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the 9691default. 9692 9693@item show print symbol-filename 9694Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and 9695line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address. 9696@end table 9697 9698Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line 9699numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line 9700number and source file that corresponds to each instruction. 9701 9702Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being 9703printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol: 9704 9705@table @code 9706@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset} 9707@itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited 9708@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol 9709Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the 9710offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than 9711@var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN} 9712to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes 9713it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}. 9714 9715@item show print max-symbolic-offset 9716Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a 9717symbolic address. 9718@end table 9719 9720@cindex wild pointer, interpreting 9721@cindex pointer, finding referent 9722If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try 9723@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name 9724and source file location of the variable where it points, using 9725@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form. 9726For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points 9727at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}: 9728 9729@smallexample 9730(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on 9731(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt 9732$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c> 9733@end smallexample 9734 9735@quotation 9736@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a} 9737does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with 9738the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on. 9739@end quotation 9740 9741You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using 9742@samp{set print symbol on}: 9743 9744@table @code 9745@item set print symbol on 9746Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if 9747one exists. 9748 9749@item set print symbol off 9750Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an 9751address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol 9752corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default. 9753 9754@item show print symbol 9755Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an 9756address. 9757@end table 9758 9759Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed: 9760 9761@table @code 9762@item set print array 9763@itemx set print array on 9764@cindex pretty print arrays 9765Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read, 9766but uses more space. The default is off. 9767 9768@item set print array off 9769Return to compressed format for arrays. 9770 9771@item show print array 9772Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying 9773arrays. 9774 9775@cindex print array indexes 9776@item set print array-indexes 9777@itemx set print array-indexes on 9778Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more 9779convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the 9780index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off. 9781 9782@item set print array-indexes off 9783Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays. 9784 9785@item show print array-indexes 9786Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying 9787arrays. 9788 9789@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements} 9790@itemx set print elements unlimited 9791@cindex number of array elements to print 9792@cindex limit on number of printed array elements 9793Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print. 9794If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has 9795printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command. 9796This limit also applies to the display of strings. 9797When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200. 9798Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means 9799that the number of elements to print is unlimited. 9800 9801@item show print elements 9802Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print. 9803If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited. 9804 9805@item set print frame-arguments @var{value} 9806@kindex set print frame-arguments 9807@cindex printing frame argument values 9808@cindex print all frame argument values 9809@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only 9810@cindex do not print frame argument values 9811This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed 9812when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible 9813values are: 9814 9815@table @code 9816@item all 9817The values of all arguments are printed. 9818 9819@item scalars 9820Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more 9821complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced 9822by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where 9823only scalar arguments are shown: 9824 9825@smallexample 9826#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green) 9827 at frame-args.c:23 9828@end smallexample 9829 9830@item none 9831None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument 9832is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes: 9833 9834@smallexample 9835#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{}) 9836 at frame-args.c:23 9837@end smallexample 9838@end table 9839 9840By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used 9841to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless 9842of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value 9843of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of 9844information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable. 9845Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because 9846the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive, 9847especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments} 9848to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation, 9849thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame. 9850 9851@item show print frame-arguments 9852Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame. 9853 9854@item set print raw frame-arguments on 9855Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form. 9856 9857@item set print raw frame-arguments off 9858Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer 9859for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}), 9860otherwise print the value in raw form. 9861This is the default. 9862 9863@item show print raw frame-arguments 9864Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form. 9865 9866@anchor{set print entry-values} 9867@item set print entry-values @var{value} 9868@kindex set print entry-values 9869Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases 9870@value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by 9871the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function 9872and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be 9873unavailable, but the entry value may still be known. 9874 9875The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older 9876@value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting 9877this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the 9878@code{no} setting. 9879 9880This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and 9881the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With 9882@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get 9883this information. 9884 9885The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following: 9886 9887@table @code 9888@item no 9889Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry 9890point. 9891@smallexample 9892#0 equal (val=5) 9893#0 different (val=6) 9894#0 lost (val=<optimized out>) 9895#0 born (val=10) 9896#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9897@end smallexample 9898 9899@item only 9900Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter 9901values are never printed. 9902@smallexample 9903#0 equal (val@@entry=5) 9904#0 different (val@@entry=5) 9905#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9906#0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9907#0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9908@end smallexample 9909 9910@item preferred 9911Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function 9912entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual 9913value for such parameter. 9914@smallexample 9915#0 equal (val@@entry=5) 9916#0 different (val@@entry=5) 9917#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9918#0 born (val=10) 9919#0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9920@end smallexample 9921 9922@item if-needed 9923Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while 9924value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such 9925parameter. 9926@smallexample 9927#0 equal (val=5) 9928#0 different (val=6) 9929#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9930#0 born (val=10) 9931#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9932@end smallexample 9933 9934@item both 9935Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry 9936point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler 9937optimizations. 9938@smallexample 9939#0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5) 9940#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5) 9941#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5) 9942#0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9943#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9944@end smallexample 9945 9946@item compact 9947Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from 9948function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual 9949value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both 9950values are known and identical, print the shortened 9951@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation. 9952@smallexample 9953#0 equal (val=val@@entry=5) 9954#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5) 9955#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9956#0 born (val=10) 9957#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9958@end smallexample 9959 9960@item default 9961Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function 9962entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and 9963if both values are known and identical, print the shortened 9964@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation. 9965@smallexample 9966#0 equal (val=val@@entry=5) 9967#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5) 9968#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5) 9969#0 born (val=10) 9970#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9971@end smallexample 9972@end table 9973 9974For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function 9975entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}. 9976 9977@item show print entry-values 9978Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function 9979entry. 9980 9981@item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats} 9982@itemx set print repeats unlimited 9983@cindex repeated array elements 9984Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array 9985elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an 9986array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string 9987@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of 9988identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements 9989themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will 9990cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold 9991is 10. 9992 9993@item show print repeats 9994Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical 9995elements. 9996 9997@item set print null-stop 9998@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays 9999Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first 10000@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually 10001contain only short strings. 10002The default is off. 10003 10004@item show print null-stop 10005Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first 10006@sc{null} character. 10007 10008@item set print pretty on 10009@cindex print structures in indented form 10010@cindex indentation in structure display 10011Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member 10012per line, like this: 10013 10014@smallexample 10015@group 10016$1 = @{ 10017 next = 0x0, 10018 flags = @{ 10019 sweet = 1, 10020 sour = 1 10021 @}, 10022 meat = 0x54 "Pork" 10023@} 10024@end group 10025@end smallexample 10026 10027@item set print pretty off 10028Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this: 10029 10030@smallexample 10031@group 10032$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \ 10033meat = 0x54 "Pork"@} 10034@end group 10035@end smallexample 10036 10037@noindent 10038This is the default format. 10039 10040@item show print pretty 10041Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures. 10042 10043@item set print sevenbit-strings on 10044@cindex eight-bit characters in strings 10045@cindex octal escapes in strings 10046Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set, 10047@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or 10048character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is 10049best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the 10050high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit. 10051 10052@item set print sevenbit-strings off 10053Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more 10054international character sets, and is the default. 10055 10056@item show print sevenbit-strings 10057Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters. 10058 10059@item set print union on 10060@cindex unions in structures, printing 10061Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures 10062and other unions. This is the default setting. 10063 10064@item set print union off 10065Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in 10066structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"} 10067instead. 10068 10069@item show print union 10070Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in 10071structures and other unions. 10072 10073For example, given the declarations 10074 10075@smallexample 10076typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species; 10077typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms; 10078typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@} 10079 Bug_forms; 10080 10081struct thing @{ 10082 Species it; 10083 union @{ 10084 Tree_forms tree; 10085 Bug_forms bug; 10086 @} form; 10087@}; 10088 10089struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@}; 10090@end smallexample 10091 10092@noindent 10093with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print 10094 10095@smallexample 10096$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@} 10097@end smallexample 10098 10099@noindent 10100and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print 10101 10102@smallexample 10103$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@} 10104@end smallexample 10105 10106@noindent 10107@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages 10108and in Pascal. 10109@end table 10110 10111@need 1000 10112@noindent 10113These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs: 10114 10115@table @code 10116@cindex demangling C@t{++} names 10117@item set print demangle 10118@itemx set print demangle on 10119Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded 10120(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe 10121linkage. The default is on. 10122 10123@item show print demangle 10124Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form. 10125 10126@item set print asm-demangle 10127@itemx set print asm-demangle on 10128Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even 10129in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies. 10130The default is off. 10131 10132@item show print asm-demangle 10133Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled 10134or demangled form. 10135 10136@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style 10137@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++} 10138@kindex set demangle-style 10139@item set demangle-style @var{style} 10140Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to 10141represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently: 10142 10143@table @code 10144@item auto 10145Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program. 10146This is the default. 10147 10148@item gnu 10149Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm. 10150 10151@item hp 10152Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm. 10153 10154@item lucid 10155Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm. 10156 10157@item arm 10158Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}. 10159@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow 10160debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would 10161require further enhancement to permit that. 10162 10163@end table 10164If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats. 10165 10166@item show demangle-style 10167Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols. 10168 10169@item set print object 10170@itemx set print object on 10171@cindex derived type of an object, printing 10172@cindex display derived types 10173When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual} 10174(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using 10175the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is 10176required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time 10177type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared 10178type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when 10179working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}). 10180 10181@item set print object off 10182Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the 10183virtual function table. This is the default setting. 10184 10185@item show print object 10186Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed. 10187 10188@item set print static-members 10189@itemx set print static-members on 10190@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects 10191Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on. 10192 10193@item set print static-members off 10194Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. 10195 10196@item show print static-members 10197Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not. 10198 10199@item set print pascal_static-members 10200@itemx set print pascal_static-members on 10201@cindex static members of Pascal objects 10202@cindex Pascal objects, static members display 10203Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on. 10204 10205@item set print pascal_static-members off 10206Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object. 10207 10208@item show print pascal_static-members 10209Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not. 10210 10211@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet. 10212@item set print vtbl 10213@itemx set print vtbl on 10214@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables 10215@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display 10216@cindex VTBL display 10217Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off. 10218(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP 10219ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).) 10220 10221@item set print vtbl off 10222Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. 10223 10224@item show print vtbl 10225Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not. 10226@end table 10227 10228@node Pretty Printing 10229@section Pretty Printing 10230 10231@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using 10232Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This 10233mechanism works for both MI and the CLI. 10234 10235@menu 10236* Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers 10237* Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer 10238* Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands 10239@end menu 10240 10241@node Pretty-Printer Introduction 10242@subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction 10243 10244When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer 10245registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the 10246pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally. 10247 10248Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage. 10249The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed 10250pretty-printers with their names. 10251If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its 10252@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types. 10253Each such subprinter has its own name. 10254The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}. 10255 10256Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}. 10257Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding 10258debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to 10259do anything special. 10260 10261There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered. 10262 10263@itemize @bullet 10264@item 10265Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging 10266all inferiors. 10267 10268@item 10269Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only 10270when debugging that program. 10271@xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python. 10272 10273@item 10274Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded 10275with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library). 10276@xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python. 10277@end itemize 10278 10279@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how 10280pretty-printers are selected, 10281 10282@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers 10283for new types. 10284 10285@node Pretty-Printer Example 10286@subsection Pretty-Printer Example 10287 10288Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer: 10289 10290@smallexample 10291(@value{GDBP}) print s 10292$1 = @{ 10293 static npos = 4294967295, 10294 _M_dataplus = @{ 10295 <std::allocator<char>> = @{ 10296 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{ 10297 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields> 10298 @}, 10299 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>, 10300 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider: 10301 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd" 10302 @} 10303@} 10304@end smallexample 10305 10306With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed: 10307 10308@smallexample 10309(@value{GDBP}) print s 10310$2 = "abcd" 10311@end smallexample 10312 10313@node Pretty-Printer Commands 10314@subsection Pretty-Printer Commands 10315@cindex pretty-printer commands 10316 10317@table @code 10318@kindex info pretty-printer 10319@item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 10320Print the list of installed pretty-printers. 10321This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such. 10322 10323@var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects 10324whose pretty-printers to list. 10325Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file 10326(@pxref{Progspaces In Python}), 10327and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). 10328@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN} 10329looks up a printer from these three objects. 10330 10331@var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers 10332to list. 10333 10334@kindex disable pretty-printer 10335@item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 10336Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}. 10337A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later. 10338 10339@kindex enable pretty-printer 10340@item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 10341Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}. 10342@end table 10343 10344Example: 10345 10346Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so 10347named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and 10348another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects, 10349@code{bar1} and @code{bar2}. 10350 10351@smallexample 10352(gdb) info pretty-printer 10353library1.so: 10354 foo 10355library2.so: 10356 bar 10357 bar1 10358 bar2 10359(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 10360library2.so: 10361 bar 10362 bar1 10363 bar2 10364(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1 103651 printer disabled 103662 of 3 printers enabled 10367(gdb) info pretty-printer 10368library1.so: 10369 foo [disabled] 10370library2.so: 10371 bar 10372 bar1 10373 bar2 10374(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1 103751 printer disabled 103761 of 3 printers enabled 10377(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 10378library1.so: 10379 foo [disabled] 10380library2.so: 10381 bar 10382 bar1 [disabled] 10383 bar2 10384(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar 103851 printer disabled 103860 of 3 printers enabled 10387(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 10388library1.so: 10389 foo [disabled] 10390library2.so: 10391 bar [disabled] 10392 bar1 [disabled] 10393 bar2 10394@end smallexample 10395 10396Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled, 10397as can each individual subprinter. 10398 10399@node Value History 10400@section Value History 10401 10402@cindex value history 10403@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN} 10404Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN} 10405@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions. 10406Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded 10407(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands). 10408When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded, 10409since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the 10410symbol table. 10411 10412@cindex @code{$} 10413@cindex @code{$$} 10414@cindex history number 10415The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can 10416refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one. 10417@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by 10418printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the 10419history number. 10420 10421To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's 10422history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to 10423remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in 10424the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that. 10425@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2} 10426is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to 10427@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}. 10428 10429For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and 10430want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type 10431 10432@smallexample 10433p *$ 10434@end smallexample 10435 10436If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points 10437to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this: 10438 10439@smallexample 10440p *$.next 10441@end smallexample 10442 10443@noindent 10444You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this 10445command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}. 10446 10447Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of 10448@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands: 10449 10450@smallexample 10451print x 10452set x=5 10453@end smallexample 10454 10455@noindent 10456then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command 10457remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed. 10458 10459@table @code 10460@kindex show values 10461@item show values 10462Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers. 10463This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show 10464values} does not change the history. 10465 10466@item show values @var{n} 10467Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}. 10468 10469@item show values + 10470Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more 10471values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display. 10472@end table 10473 10474Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the 10475same effect as @samp{show values +}. 10476 10477@node Convenience Vars 10478@section Convenience Variables 10479 10480@cindex convenience variables 10481@cindex user-defined variables 10482@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within 10483@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables 10484exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and 10485setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution 10486of your program. That is why you can use them freely. 10487 10488Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by 10489@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of 10490the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}). 10491(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded 10492by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.) 10493 10494You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment 10495expression, just as you would set a variable in your program. 10496For example: 10497 10498@smallexample 10499set $foo = *object_ptr 10500@end smallexample 10501 10502@noindent 10503would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by 10504@code{object_ptr}. 10505 10506Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its 10507value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the 10508value with another assignment at any time. 10509 10510Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience 10511variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if 10512that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience 10513variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value. 10514 10515@table @code 10516@kindex show convenience 10517@cindex show all user variables and functions 10518@item show convenience 10519Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values, 10520as well as a list of the convenience functions. 10521Abbreviated @code{show conv}. 10522 10523@kindex init-if-undefined 10524@cindex convenience variables, initializing 10525@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression} 10526Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful 10527for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept, 10528to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that 10529convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to 10530override default values used in a command script. 10531 10532If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so 10533any side-effects do not occur. 10534@end table 10535 10536One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be 10537incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print 10538a field from successive elements of an array of structures: 10539 10540@smallexample 10541set $i = 0 10542print bar[$i++]->contents 10543@end smallexample 10544 10545@noindent 10546Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}. 10547 10548Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given 10549values likely to be useful. 10550 10551@table @code 10552@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable} 10553@item $_ 10554The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to 10555the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other 10556commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also 10557set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line} 10558and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *} 10559except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer 10560to the type of @code{$__}. 10561 10562@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable} 10563@item $__ 10564The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command 10565to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen 10566to match the format in which the data was printed. 10567 10568@item $_exitcode 10569@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable} 10570When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN} 10571automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and 10572resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}. 10573 10574@item $_exitsignal 10575@vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable} 10576When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal, 10577@value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number, 10578and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}. 10579 10580To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited 10581(i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e., 10582@code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function 10583@code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience 10584Functions}). For example, considering the following source code: 10585 10586@smallexample 10587#include <signal.h> 10588 10589int 10590main (int argc, char *argv[]) 10591@{ 10592 raise (SIGALRM); 10593 return 0; 10594@} 10595@end smallexample 10596 10597A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited 10598or signalled would be: 10599 10600@smallexample 10601(@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled 10602Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''. 10603End with a line saying just ``end''. 10604>if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal) 10605 >echo The program has exited\n 10606 >else 10607 >echo The program has signalled\n 10608 >end 10609>end 10610(@value{GDBP}) run 10611Starting program: 10612 10613Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock. 10614The program no longer exists. 10615(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled 10616The program has signalled 10617@end smallexample 10618 10619As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being 10620debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a 10621@code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called 10622@code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit: 10623 10624@smallexample 10625(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled 10626The program has exited 10627@end smallexample 10628 10629@item $_exception 10630The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being 10631thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}. 10632 10633@item $_probe_argc 10634@itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11 10635Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}. 10636 10637@item $_sdata 10638@vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable} 10639The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint 10640data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that 10641@code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or 10642if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected. 10643 10644@item $_siginfo 10645@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable} 10646The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information 10647(@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo} 10648could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals. 10649For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command. 10650 10651@item $_tlb 10652@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable} 10653The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging 10654applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to 10655gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request. 10656@xref{General Query Packets}. 10657This variable contains the address of the thread information block. 10658 10659@item $_inferior 10660The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and 10661Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}. 10662 10663@item $_thread 10664The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}. 10665 10666@item $_gthread 10667The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}. 10668 10669@end table 10670 10671@node Convenience Funs 10672@section Convenience Functions 10673 10674@cindex convenience functions 10675@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These 10676have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience 10677function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function; 10678however, a convenience function is implemented internally to 10679@value{GDBN}. 10680 10681These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with 10682@code{Python} support, which means that they are always available. 10683 10684@table @code 10685 10686@item $_isvoid (@var{expr}) 10687@findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function} 10688Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it 10689returns zero. 10690 10691A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result 10692is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable 10693(see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether 10694it is @code{void}: 10695 10696@smallexample 10697(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode 10698$1 = void 10699(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode) 10700$2 = 1 10701(@value{GDBP}) run 10702Starting program: ./a.out 10703[Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally] 10704(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode 10705$3 = 0 10706(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode) 10707$4 = 0 10708@end smallexample 10709 10710In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether 10711@code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the 10712program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to 10713be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the 10714execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore 10715@code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void} 10716anymore. 10717 10718The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the 10719program being debugged. For example, given the following function: 10720 10721@smallexample 10722void 10723foo (void) 10724@{ 10725@} 10726@end smallexample 10727 10728The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}: 10729 10730@smallexample 10731(@value{GDBP}) print foo () 10732$1 = void 10733(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ()) 10734$2 = 1 10735(@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo () 10736(@value{GDBP}) print $v 10737$3 = void 10738(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v) 10739$4 = 1 10740@end smallexample 10741 10742@end table 10743 10744These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with 10745@code{Python} support. 10746 10747@table @code 10748 10749@item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length}) 10750@findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function} 10751Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by 10752@var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal. 10753Otherwise it returns zero. 10754 10755@item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex}) 10756@findex $_regex@r{, convenience function} 10757Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression 10758@var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero. 10759The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s 10760regular expression support. 10761 10762@item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2}) 10763@findex $_streq@r{, convenience function} 10764Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal. 10765Otherwise it returns zero. 10766 10767@item $_strlen(@var{str}) 10768@findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function} 10769Returns the length of string @var{str}. 10770 10771@item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10772@findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function} 10773Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}. 10774Otherwise it returns zero. 10775 10776If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10777it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10778The default is 1. 10779 10780Example: 10781 10782@smallexample 10783(gdb) backtrace 10784#0 bottom_func () 10785 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21 10786#1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func () 10787 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27 10788#2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func () 10789 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33 10790#3 0x00000000004005b6 in main () 10791 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39 10792(gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func") 10793$1 = 1 10794(gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2) 10795$1 = 1 10796@end smallexample 10797 10798@item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10799@findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function} 10800Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression 10801@var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero. 10802 10803If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10804it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10805The default is 1. 10806 10807@item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10808@findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function} 10809Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}. 10810Otherwise it returns zero. 10811 10812If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10813it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10814The default is 1. 10815 10816This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function 10817checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified 10818by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the 10819frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}. 10820 10821@item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10822@findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function} 10823Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression 10824@var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero. 10825 10826If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10827it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10828The default is 1. 10829 10830This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function 10831checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified 10832by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the 10833frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}. 10834 10835@item $_as_string(@var{value}) 10836@findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function} 10837Return the string representation of @var{value}. 10838 10839This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an 10840enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of 10841an enumerated type: 10842 10843@smallexample 10844(gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node) 10845Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER 10846@end smallexample 10847 10848@end table 10849 10850@value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on 10851convenience functions. 10852 10853@table @code 10854@item help function 10855@kindex help function 10856@cindex show all convenience functions 10857Print a list of all convenience functions. 10858@end table 10859 10860@node Registers 10861@section Registers 10862 10863@cindex registers 10864You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables 10865with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different 10866for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on 10867your machine. 10868 10869@table @code 10870@kindex info registers 10871@item info registers 10872Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point 10873and vector registers (in the selected stack frame). 10874 10875@kindex info all-registers 10876@cindex floating point registers 10877@item info all-registers 10878Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point 10879and vector registers (in the selected stack frame). 10880 10881@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{} 10882Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}. 10883As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to 10884the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on 10885the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}. 10886@end table 10887 10888@anchor{standard registers} 10889@cindex stack pointer register 10890@cindex program counter register 10891@cindex process status register 10892@cindex frame pointer register 10893@cindex standard registers 10894@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in 10895expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an 10896architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names 10897@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and 10898the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a 10899pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a 10900register that contains the processor status. For example, 10901you could print the program counter in hex with 10902 10903@smallexample 10904p/x $pc 10905@end smallexample 10906 10907@noindent 10908or print the instruction to be executed next with 10909 10910@smallexample 10911x/i $pc 10912@end smallexample 10913 10914@noindent 10915or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing 10916one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in 10917memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost 10918stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other 10919stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack, 10920regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return}; 10921see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with 10922 10923@smallexample 10924set $sp += 4 10925@end smallexample 10926 10927Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on 10928your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics, 10929so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command 10930shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info 10931registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you 10932can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps} 10933is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register. 10934 10935@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an 10936integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have 10937special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these 10938registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way 10939to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value 10940(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with 10941@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}). 10942 10943Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This 10944means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by 10945the operating system is not the same one that your program normally 10946sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point 10947coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C 10948programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such 10949cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format 10950that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command 10951prints the data in both formats. 10952 10953@cindex SSE registers (x86) 10954@cindex MMX registers (x86) 10955Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted 10956in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines 10957have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed 10958together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such 10959registers in @code{struct} notation: 10960 10961@smallexample 10962(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1 10963$1 = @{ 10964 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@}, 10965 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@}, 10966 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000", 10967 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@}, 10968 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@}, 10969 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@}, 10970 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000 10971@} 10972@end smallexample 10973 10974@noindent 10975To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which 10976view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning 10977value to a @code{struct} member: 10978 10979@smallexample 10980 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF 10981@end smallexample 10982 10983Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame 10984(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the 10985value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in 10986were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the 10987true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost 10988frame (with @samp{frame 0}). 10989 10990@cindex caller-saved registers 10991@cindex call-clobbered registers 10992@cindex volatile registers 10993@cindex <not saved> values 10994Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the 10995callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile'' 10996registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know 10997the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer 10998frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee. 10999@value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved 11000(``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the 11001machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not 11002saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via 11003its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info 11004explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN} 11005displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets 11006that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention, 11007if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location 11008in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame. 11009This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered, 11010the caller either does not care what is in the register after the 11011call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note, 11012however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you 11013may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the 11014frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered 11015register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually 11016represent the value the register had just before the call. 11017 11018@node Floating Point Hardware 11019@section Floating Point Hardware 11020@cindex floating point 11021 11022Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give 11023you more information about the status of the floating point hardware. 11024 11025@table @code 11026@kindex info float 11027@item info float 11028Display hardware-dependent information about the floating 11029point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the 11030floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on 11031the ARM and x86 machines. 11032@end table 11033 11034@node Vector Unit 11035@section Vector Unit 11036@cindex vector unit 11037 11038Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you 11039more information about the status of the vector unit. 11040 11041@table @code 11042@kindex info vector 11043@item info vector 11044Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and 11045layout vary depending on the hardware. 11046@end table 11047 11048@node OS Information 11049@section Operating System Auxiliary Information 11050@cindex OS information 11051 11052@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help 11053you debug your program. 11054 11055@cindex auxiliary vector 11056@cindex vector, auxiliary 11057Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at 11058startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you 11059specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of 11060binary values that tell system libraries important details about the 11061hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is 11062identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific. 11063Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities, 11064@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote 11065targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's 11066support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see 11067@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}. 11068 11069@table @code 11070@kindex info auxv 11071@item info auxv 11072Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a 11073live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value 11074numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized 11075tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some 11076pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the 11077most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for 11078an unrecognized tag. 11079@end table 11080 11081On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific 11082information and show it to you. The types of information available 11083will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the 11084target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in 11085@ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this 11086functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the 11087@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}. 11088 11089@table @code 11090@kindex info os 11091@item info os @var{infotype} 11092 11093Display OS information of the requested type. 11094 11095On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid: 11096 11097@anchor{linux info os infotypes} 11098@table @code 11099@kindex info os cpus 11100@item cpus 11101Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints 11102the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture 11103different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives 11104CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during 11105kernel initialization. 11106 11107@kindex info os files 11108@item files 11109Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each 11110file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process 11111owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value 11112of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor. 11113 11114@kindex info os modules 11115@item modules 11116Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each 11117module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in 11118bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the 11119module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module 11120in memory. 11121 11122@kindex info os msg 11123@item msg 11124Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each 11125message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message 11126queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes 11127on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes 11128that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group 11129of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a 11130message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which 11131the message queue was last changed. 11132 11133@kindex info os processes 11134@item processes 11135Display the list of processes on the target. For each process, 11136@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the 11137command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores 11138that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these 11139properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult 11140the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.) 11141 11142@kindex info os procgroups 11143@item procgroups 11144Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process, 11145@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs 11146to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process 11147identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted 11148first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier, 11149so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together 11150and the process group leader is listed first. 11151 11152@kindex info os semaphores 11153@item semaphores 11154Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each 11155semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore 11156set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the 11157set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set, 11158and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed. 11159 11160@kindex info os shm 11161@item shm 11162Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target. 11163For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key, 11164the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the 11165region, the process that created the region, the process that last 11166attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live 11167attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last 11168attached to, detach from, and changed. 11169 11170@kindex info os sockets 11171@item sockets 11172Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each 11173socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and 11174remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of 11175the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the 11176connection. 11177 11178@kindex info os threads 11179@item threads 11180Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread, 11181@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread 11182belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the 11183processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a 11184process is not listed. 11185@end table 11186 11187@item info os 11188If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for 11189@var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each 11190@var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible 11191types, this command will report an error. 11192@end table 11193 11194@node Memory Region Attributes 11195@section Memory Region Attributes 11196@cindex memory region attributes 11197 11198@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling 11199required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses 11200attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory 11201accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache 11202target memory. By default the description of memory regions is 11203fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the 11204user can override the fetched regions. 11205 11206Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a 11207memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when 11208accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have 11209been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing 11210all memory. 11211 11212When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it; 11213to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number. 11214 11215@table @code 11216@kindex mem 11217@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{} 11218Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with 11219attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions 11220monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special 11221case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address. 11222(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.) 11223 11224@item mem auto 11225Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied 11226regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support. 11227 11228@kindex delete mem 11229@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{} 11230Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions 11231monitored by @value{GDBN}. 11232 11233@kindex disable mem 11234@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{} 11235Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}. 11236A disabled memory region is not forgotten. 11237It may be enabled again later. 11238 11239@kindex enable mem 11240@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{} 11241Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}. 11242 11243@kindex info mem 11244@item info mem 11245Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns 11246for each region: 11247 11248@table @emph 11249@item Memory Region Number 11250@item Enabled or Disabled. 11251Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}. 11252Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}. 11253 11254@item Lo Address 11255The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region. 11256 11257@item Hi Address 11258The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region. 11259 11260@item Attributes 11261The list of attributes set for this memory region. 11262@end table 11263@end table 11264 11265 11266@subsection Attributes 11267 11268@subsubsection Memory Access Mode 11269The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or 11270write accesses to a memory region. 11271 11272While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid 11273memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA, 11274etc.@: from accessing memory. 11275 11276@table @code 11277@item ro 11278Memory is read only. 11279@item wo 11280Memory is write only. 11281@item rw 11282Memory is read/write. This is the default. 11283@end table 11284 11285@subsubsection Memory Access Size 11286The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized 11287accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers 11288require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is 11289specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size. 11290 11291@table @code 11292@item 8 11293Use 8 bit memory accesses. 11294@item 16 11295Use 16 bit memory accesses. 11296@item 32 11297Use 32 bit memory accesses. 11298@item 64 11299Use 64 bit memory accesses. 11300@end table 11301 11302@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints 11303@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN} 11304@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints 11305@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands. 11306@c 11307@c @table @code 11308@c @item hwbreak 11309@c Always use hardware breakpoints 11310@c @item swbreak (default) 11311@c @end table 11312 11313@subsubsection Data Cache 11314The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target 11315memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug 11316protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN} 11317does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device 11318registers. 11319 11320@table @code 11321@item cache 11322Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory. 11323@item nocache 11324Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default. 11325@end table 11326 11327@subsection Memory Access Checking 11328@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is 11329not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such 11330regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide 11331better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour. 11332 11333@table @code 11334@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default 11335@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off] 11336If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not 11337explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses 11338to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one 11339memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN} 11340treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM. 11341The default value is @code{on}. 11342@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default 11343@item show mem inaccessible-by-default 11344Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory. 11345@end table 11346 11347 11348@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification 11349@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN} 11350@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful. 11351@c 11352@c @table @code 11353@c @item verify 11354@c @item noverify (default) 11355@c @end table 11356 11357@node Dump/Restore Files 11358@section Copy Between Memory and a File 11359@cindex dump/restore files 11360@cindex append data to a file 11361@cindex dump data to a file 11362@cindex restore data from a file 11363 11364You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and 11365@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The 11366@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the 11367@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's 11368memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, 11369Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only 11370append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files. 11371 11372@table @code 11373 11374@kindex dump 11375@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr} 11376@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr} 11377Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr}, 11378or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format. 11379 11380The @var{format} parameter may be any one of: 11381@table @code 11382@item binary 11383Raw binary form. 11384@item ihex 11385Intel hex format. 11386@item srec 11387Motorola S-record format. 11388@item tekhex 11389Tektronix Hex format. 11390@item verilog 11391Verilog Hex format. 11392@end table 11393 11394@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the 11395@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If 11396@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary 11397form. 11398 11399@kindex append 11400@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr} 11401@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr} 11402Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr}, 11403or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form. 11404(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.) 11405 11406@kindex restore 11407@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end} 11408Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The 11409@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd} 11410file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you 11411must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename. 11412 11413If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses 11414contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so 11415they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have 11416a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias} 11417from that location. 11418 11419If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between 11420file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored. 11421These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before 11422the @var{bias} argument is applied. 11423 11424@end table 11425 11426@node Core File Generation 11427@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program 11428@cindex dump core from inferior 11429 11430A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory 11431image of a running process and its process status (register values 11432etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that 11433crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes 11434automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by 11435the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in 11436the post-mortem debugging mode. 11437 11438Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you 11439are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state. 11440@value{GDBN} has a special command for that. 11441 11442@table @code 11443@kindex gcore 11444@kindex generate-core-file 11445@item generate-core-file [@var{file}] 11446@itemx gcore [@var{file}] 11447Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument 11448@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not 11449specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where 11450@var{pid} is the inferior process ID. 11451 11452Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of 11453this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390). 11454 11455On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the 11456file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core 11457dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}). 11458 11459@kindex set use-coredump-filter 11460@anchor{set use-coredump-filter} 11461@item set use-coredump-filter on 11462@itemx set use-coredump-filter off 11463Enable or disable the use of the file 11464@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump 11465files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of 11466memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump 11467file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. 11468 11469To make use of this feature, you have to write in the 11470@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal, 11471which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit 11472is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding 11473types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This 11474configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information 11475about the bits that can be set in the 11476@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the 11477manpage of @code{core(5)}. 11478 11479By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned 11480@code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file 11481and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order 11482to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This 11483value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0} 11484(anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings), 11485@code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active. 11486This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically. 11487@end table 11488 11489@node Character Sets 11490@section Character Sets 11491@cindex character sets 11492@cindex charset 11493@cindex translating between character sets 11494@cindex host character set 11495@cindex target character set 11496 11497If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to 11498represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself, 11499@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for 11500you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host 11501character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the 11502@dfn{target character set}. 11503 11504For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which 11505uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s 11506remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program 11507running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set, 11508then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is 11509@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set 11510target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between 11511@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use 11512character and string literals in expressions. 11513 11514@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set 11515the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set 11516target-charset} command, described below. 11517 11518Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set 11519support: 11520 11521@table @code 11522@item set target-charset @var{charset} 11523@kindex set target-charset 11524Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the 11525list of supported target character sets, type 11526@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}. 11527 11528@item set host-charset @var{charset} 11529@kindex set host-charset 11530Set the current host character set to @var{charset}. 11531 11532By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the 11533system it is running on; you can override that default using the 11534@code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot 11535automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this 11536case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}. 11537 11538@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character 11539set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}, 11540@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports. 11541 11542@item set charset @var{charset} 11543@kindex set charset 11544Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As 11545above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}, 11546@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used 11547for both host and target. 11548 11549@item show charset 11550@kindex show charset 11551Show the names of the current host and target character sets. 11552 11553@item show host-charset 11554@kindex show host-charset 11555Show the name of the current host character set. 11556 11557@item show target-charset 11558@kindex show target-charset 11559Show the name of the current target character set. 11560 11561@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset} 11562@kindex set target-wide-charset 11563Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is 11564the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To 11565display the list of supported wide character sets, type 11566@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}. 11567 11568@item show target-wide-charset 11569@kindex show target-wide-charset 11570Show the name of the current target's wide character set. 11571@end table 11572 11573Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action. 11574Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file 11575@file{charset-test.c}: 11576 11577@smallexample 11578#include <stdio.h> 11579 11580char ascii_hello[] 11581 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119, 11582 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@}; 11583char ibm1047_hello[] 11584 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166, 11585 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@}; 11586 11587main () 11588@{ 11589 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 11590@} 11591@end smallexample 11592 11593In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays 11594containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline, 11595encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets. 11596 11597We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it: 11598 11599@smallexample 11600$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test 11601$ gdb -nw charset-test 11602GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs 11603Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 11604@dots{} 11605(@value{GDBP}) 11606@end smallexample 11607 11608We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets 11609@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and 11610strings: 11611 11612@smallexample 11613(@value{GDBP}) show charset 11614The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'. 11615(@value{GDBP}) 11616@end smallexample 11617 11618For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our 11619initial character set: 11620@smallexample 11621(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII 11622(@value{GDBP}) show charset 11623The current host and target character set is `ASCII'. 11624(@value{GDBP}) 11625@end smallexample 11626 11627Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our 11628host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints 11629characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display 11630them properly. Since our current target character set is also 11631@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly: 11632 11633@smallexample 11634(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello 11635$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n" 11636(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0] 11637$2 = 72 'H' 11638(@value{GDBP}) 11639@end smallexample 11640 11641@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string 11642literals you use in expressions: 11643 11644@smallexample 11645(@value{GDBP}) print '+' 11646$3 = 43 '+' 11647(@value{GDBP}) 11648@end smallexample 11649 11650The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+} 11651character. 11652 11653@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the 11654target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target 11655character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish: 11656 11657@smallexample 11658(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello 11659$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%" 11660(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0] 11661$5 = 200 '\310' 11662(@value{GDBP}) 11663@end smallexample 11664 11665If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, 11666@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports: 11667 11668@smallexample 11669(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset 11670ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1 11671(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset 11672@end smallexample 11673 11674We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the 11675program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but 11676@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the 11677target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set, 11678@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly: 11679 11680@smallexample 11681(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047 11682(@value{GDBP}) show charset 11683The current host character set is `ASCII'. 11684The current target character set is `IBM1047'. 11685(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello 11686$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012" 11687(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0] 11688$7 = 72 '\110' 11689(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello 11690$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n" 11691(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0] 11692$9 = 200 'H' 11693(@value{GDBP}) 11694@end smallexample 11695 11696As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and 11697string literals you use in expressions: 11698 11699@smallexample 11700(@value{GDBP}) print '+' 11701$10 = 78 '+' 11702(@value{GDBP}) 11703@end smallexample 11704 11705The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+} 11706character. 11707 11708@node Caching Target Data 11709@section Caching Data of Targets 11710@cindex caching data of targets 11711 11712@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target. 11713Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior. 11714@xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space. 11715Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging 11716(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the 11717remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. 11718Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results, 11719since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile 11720values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode 11721(@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command 11722is executing. 11723Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data 11724known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately 11725rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread 11726in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of 11727stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or 11728in the code segment. 11729Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as 11730cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}. 11731 11732@table @code 11733@kindex set remotecache 11734@item set remotecache on 11735@itemx set remotecache off 11736This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility 11737with old scripts. 11738 11739@kindex show remotecache 11740@item show remotecache 11741Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag. 11742 11743@kindex set stack-cache 11744@item set stack-cache on 11745@itemx set stack-cache off 11746Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use 11747caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. 11748 11749@kindex show stack-cache 11750@item show stack-cache 11751Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses. 11752 11753@kindex set code-cache 11754@item set code-cache on 11755@itemx set code-cache off 11756Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on}, 11757use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves 11758performance of disassembly in remote debugging. 11759 11760@kindex show code-cache 11761@item show code-cache 11762Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment 11763accesses. 11764 11765@kindex info dcache 11766@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]} 11767Print the information about the performance of data cache of the 11768current inferior's address space. The information displayed 11769includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its 11770number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This 11771command is useful for debugging the data cache operation. 11772 11773If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be 11774printed in hex. 11775 11776@item set dcache size @var{size} 11777@cindex dcache size 11778@kindex set dcache size 11779Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above). 11780 11781@item set dcache line-size @var{line-size} 11782@cindex dcache line-size 11783@kindex set dcache line-size 11784Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above). 11785Must be a power of 2. 11786 11787@item show dcache size 11788@kindex show dcache size 11789Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}. 11790 11791@item show dcache line-size 11792@kindex show dcache line-size 11793Show default size of dcache lines. 11794 11795@end table 11796 11797@node Searching Memory 11798@section Search Memory 11799@cindex searching memory 11800 11801Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the 11802@code{find} command. 11803 11804@table @code 11805@kindex find 11806@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]} 11807@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]} 11808Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2}, 11809etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either 11810@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive. 11811@end table 11812 11813@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters. 11814They may be specified in either order, apart or together. 11815 11816@table @r 11817@item @var{s}, search query size 11818The size of each search query value. 11819 11820@table @code 11821@item b 11822bytes 11823@item h 11824halfwords (two bytes) 11825@item w 11826words (four bytes) 11827@item g 11828giant words (eight bytes) 11829@end table 11830 11831All values are interpreted in the current language. 11832This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++} 11833then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'. 11834 11835If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the 11836value's type in the current language. 11837This is useful when one wants to specify the search 11838pattern as a mixture of types. 11839Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages 11840a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42} 11841which is typically four bytes. 11842 11843@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds 11844The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds. 11845@end table 11846 11847You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes 11848 (@code{"}). 11849The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte, 11850regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification. 11851 11852The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the 11853number of matches found. 11854 11855The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable 11856@samp{$_}. 11857A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}. 11858 11859For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function: 11860 11861@smallexample 11862void 11863hello () 11864@{ 11865 static char hello[] = "hello-hello"; 11866 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @} 11867 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed 11868 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @}; 11869 printf ("%s\n", hello); 11870@} 11871@end smallexample 11872 11873@noindent 11874you get during debugging: 11875 11876@smallexample 11877(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello" 118780x804956d <hello.1620+6> 118791 pattern found 11880(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o' 118810x8049567 <hello.1620> 118820x804956d <hello.1620+6> 118832 patterns found 11884(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l' 118850x8049567 <hello.1620> 118861 pattern found 11887(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321 118880x8049560 <mixed.1625> 118891 pattern found 11890(gdb) print $numfound 11891$1 = 1 11892(gdb) print $_ 11893$2 = (void *) 0x8049560 11894@end smallexample 11895 11896@node Value Sizes 11897@section Value Sizes 11898 11899Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within 11900@value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in 11901some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program 11902may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause 11903@value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory. 11904 11905@table @code 11906@kindex set max-value-size 11907@item set max-value-size @var{bytes} 11908@itemx set max-value-size unlimited 11909Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the 11910contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that 11911requires more memory than that will result in an error. 11912 11913Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been 11914allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations. 11915 11916There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in 11917order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is 11918currently 16 bytes. 11919 11920The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to 11921complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple 11922integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of 11923@var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand, 11924@value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where 11925@var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally 11926succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component 11927size is less than @var{bytes}. 11928 11929The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k. 11930 11931@kindex show max-value-size 11932@item show max-value-size 11933Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will 11934allocate for the contents of a value. 11935@end table 11936 11937@node Optimized Code 11938@chapter Debugging Optimized Code 11939@cindex optimized code, debugging 11940@cindex debugging optimized code 11941 11942Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization 11943disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds 11944directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler 11945applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code 11946diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging 11947information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from 11948the running program back to constructs from your original source. 11949 11950@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you 11951can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the 11952progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases 11953where you may need to debug an optimized version. 11954 11955When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the 11956optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is 11957really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not 11958exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a 11959variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that 11960variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence. 11961 11962Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just 11963@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in 11964doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem, 11965please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!). 11966@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code. 11967 11968@menu 11969* Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining 11970* Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions 11971@end menu 11972 11973@node Inline Functions 11974@section Inline Functions 11975@cindex inline functions, debugging 11976 11977@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function 11978body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared 11979routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like 11980non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their 11981arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip 11982them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}. 11983You can check whether a function was inlined by using the 11984@code{info frame} command. 11985 11986For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must 11987record information about inlining in the debug information --- 11988@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several 11989other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions 11990when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1 11991do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and 11992@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined 11993function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead 11994displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as 11995local variables in the caller. 11996 11997The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site; 11998unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to 11999the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the 12000start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to 12001the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows 12002the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional 12003instructions are executed. 12004 12005This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the 12006context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by 12007a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do 12008this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body. 12009 12010There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined 12011function calls are the same as normal calls: 12012 12013@itemize @bullet 12014@item 12015Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not 12016work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN} 12017may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing 12018function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future 12019version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line 12020or inside the inlined function instead. 12021 12022@item 12023@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after 12024using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated 12025debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line 12026and print a variable where your program stored the return value. 12027 12028@end itemize 12029 12030@node Tail Call Frames 12031@section Tail Call Frames 12032@cindex tail call frames, debugging 12033 12034Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In 12035unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return 12036instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the 12037call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C} 12038instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}. 12039 12040During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the 12041function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function 12042@code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C}, 12043then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in 12044some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from 12045@code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the 12046return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally. 12047 12048This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and 12049the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With 12050@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get 12051this information. 12052 12053@kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame 12054kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output: 12055 12056@smallexample 12057(gdb) x/i $pc - 2 12058 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)> 12059(gdb) info frame 12060Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30: 12061 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5 12062 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30 12063 source language c++. 12064 Arglist at unknown address. 12065 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30 12066@end smallexample 12067 12068The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous. 12069There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never 12070used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known 12071callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still 12072tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the 12073unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any. 12074 12075@table @code 12076@anchor{set debug entry-values} 12077@item set debug entry-values 12078@kindex set debug entry-values 12079When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument 12080values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid 12081tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection 12082of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path 12083result. 12084 12085@item show debug entry-values 12086@kindex show debug entry-values 12087Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument 12088values at function entry and tail calls. 12089@end table 12090 12091The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail 12092call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect 12093reference by variable @code{x}): 12094 12095@smallexample 12096static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void); 12097void (*x) (void) = c; 12098static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @} 12099static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @} 12100int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @} 12101 12102Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find 12103DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main 12104a () at t.c:3 121053 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @} 12106(gdb) bt 12107#0 a () at t.c:3 12108#1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5 12109@end smallexample 12110 12111Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution: 12112 12113@smallexample 12114int i; 12115static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @} 12116static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @} 12117static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @} 12118static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @} 12119static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void) 12120@{ if (i) c (); else e (); @} 12121static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @} 12122int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @} 12123 12124tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d) 12125tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e) 12126tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) | 12127(gdb) bt 12128#0 f () at t.c:2 12129#1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8 12130#2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9 12131@end smallexample 12132 12133@set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f} 12134@set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f} 12135 12136@c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK. 12137@ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK 12138@set ARROW @click{} 12139@set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}} 12140@set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}} 12141@end ifset 12142@ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK 12143@set ARROW -> 12144@set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A} 12145@set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A} 12146@end ifclear 12147 12148Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame. 12149The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or 12150@value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state. 12151 12152@code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN} 12153has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is 12154prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is 12155printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many 12156futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain 12157any non-ambiguous sequence entries. 12158 12159For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible 12160@code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is 12161also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a}, 12162therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are 12163omitted. 12164 12165There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function 12166entry may fail: 12167 12168@smallexample 12169int v; 12170static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @} 12171static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i); 12172static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @} 12173static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i) 12174@{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @} 12175int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @} 12176 12177(gdb) bt 12178#0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2 12179#1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found 12180function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls 12181i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6 12182#2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7 12183@end smallexample 12184 12185@value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did 12186function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be 12187tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore 12188@value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN} 12189prints @code{<optimized out>} instead. 12190 12191@node Macros 12192@chapter C Preprocessor Macros 12193 12194Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke 12195``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens. 12196@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show 12197the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including 12198where it was defined. 12199 12200You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN} 12201with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not 12202include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile 12203with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}. 12204 12205A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later, 12206and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different 12207points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have 12208no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN} 12209uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise, 12210@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location; 12211see @ref{List}. 12212 12213Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any 12214macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides 12215the following commands for working with macros explicitly. 12216 12217@table @code 12218 12219@kindex macro expand 12220@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor 12221@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of 12222@cindex expanding preprocessor macros 12223@item macro expand @var{expression} 12224@itemx macro exp @var{expression} 12225Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in 12226@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does 12227not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; 12228it can be any string of tokens. 12229 12230@kindex macro exp1 12231@item macro expand-once @var{expression} 12232@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression} 12233@cindex expand macro once 12234@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of 12235expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in 12236@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are 12237left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a 12238particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further 12239expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not 12240parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it 12241can be any string of tokens. 12242 12243@kindex info macro 12244@cindex macro definition, showing 12245@cindex definition of a macro, showing 12246@cindex macros, from debug info 12247@item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro} 12248Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro}, 12249and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that 12250definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of 12251argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where 12252the macro may begin with a hyphen. 12253 12254@kindex info macros 12255@item info macros @var{location} 12256Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified 12257by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler 12258command-line where those definitions were established. 12259 12260@kindex macro define 12261@cindex user-defined macros 12262@cindex defining macros interactively 12263@cindex macros, user-defined 12264@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list} 12265@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list} 12266Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, 12267invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in 12268@var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an 12269``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form 12270defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in 12271@var{arglist}. 12272 12273A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every 12274expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the 12275@code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides 12276all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, 12277as well as any previous user-supplied definition. 12278 12279@kindex macro undef 12280@item macro undef @var{macro} 12281Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}. 12282This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro 12283define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present 12284in the program being debugged. 12285 12286@kindex macro list 12287@item macro list 12288List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command. 12289@end table 12290 12291@cindex macros, example of debugging with 12292Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we 12293show our source files: 12294 12295@smallexample 12296$ cat sample.c 12297#include <stdio.h> 12298#include "sample.h" 12299 12300#define M 42 12301#define ADD(x) (M + x) 12302 12303main () 12304@{ 12305#define N 28 12306 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 12307#undef N 12308 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 12309#define N 1729 12310 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n"); 12311@} 12312$ cat sample.h 12313#define Q < 12314$ 12315@end smallexample 12316 12317Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, 12318@value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the 12319minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3} 12320and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent 12321version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler 12322includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging 12323information. 12324 12325@smallexample 12326$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample 12327$ 12328@end smallexample 12329 12330Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program: 12331 12332@smallexample 12333$ gdb -nw sample 12334GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs 12335Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 12336GDB is free software, @dots{} 12337(@value{GDBP}) 12338@end smallexample 12339 12340We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the 12341program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position 12342to decide which macro definitions are in scope: 12343 12344@smallexample 12345(@value{GDBP}) list main 123463 123474 #define M 42 123485 #define ADD(x) (M + x) 123496 123507 main () 123518 @{ 123529 #define N 28 1235310 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 1235411 #undef N 1235512 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 12356(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD 12357Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5 12358#define ADD(x) (M + x) 12359(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q 12360Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1 12361 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2 12362#define Q < 12363(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1) 12364expands to: (42 + 1) 12365(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1) 12366expands to: once (M + 1) 12367(@value{GDBP}) 12368@end smallexample 12369 12370In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only 12371the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of 12372@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M}, 12373which was introduced by @code{ADD}. 12374 12375Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in 12376force at the source line of the current stack frame: 12377 12378@smallexample 12379(@value{GDBP}) break main 12380Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10. 12381(@value{GDBP}) run 12382Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample 12383 12384Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10 1238510 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 12386(@value{GDBP}) 12387@end smallexample 12388 12389At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force: 12390 12391@smallexample 12392(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 12393Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9 12394#define N 28 12395(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M 12396expands to: 28 < 42 12397(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M 12398$1 = 1 12399(@value{GDBP}) 12400@end smallexample 12401 12402As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then 12403give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack 12404thereof) in force at each point: 12405 12406@smallexample 12407(@value{GDBP}) next 12408Hello, world! 1240912 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 12410(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 12411The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro 12412at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12 12413(@value{GDBP}) next 12414We're so creative. 1241514 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n"); 12416(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 12417Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13 12418#define N 1729 12419(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M 12420expands to: 1729 < 42 12421(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M 12422$2 = 0 12423(@value{GDBP}) 12424@end smallexample 12425 12426In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command 12427line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in 12428such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero 12429of the source file submitted to the compiler. 12430 12431@smallexample 12432(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__ 12433Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0 12434-D__STDC__=1 12435(@value{GDBP}) 12436@end smallexample 12437 12438 12439@node Tracepoints 12440@chapter Tracepoints 12441@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael 12442@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni. 12443 12444@cindex tracepoints 12445In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt 12446the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn 12447anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness 12448depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger 12449might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps 12450fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able 12451to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it. 12452 12453Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can 12454specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and 12455arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached. 12456Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values 12457those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The 12458expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays, 12459for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting 12460a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were 12461in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these 12462values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and 12463unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior. 12464 12465The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote 12466targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know 12467how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the 12468remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} 12469support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote 12470packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint 12471Packets}. 12472 12473It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent 12474of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search 12475through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details. 12476 12477This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features. 12478 12479@menu 12480* Set Tracepoints:: 12481* Analyze Collected Data:: 12482* Tracepoint Variables:: 12483* Trace Files:: 12484@end menu 12485 12486@node Set Tracepoints 12487@section Commands to Set Tracepoints 12488 12489Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of 12490tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of 12491breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using 12492standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints, 12493tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many 12494of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number 12495as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on. 12496 12497For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set 12498of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when 12499it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers, 12500local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN} 12501commands to examine the values these data had at the time the 12502tracepoint was hit. 12503 12504Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on 12505tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} 12506commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific 12507either. 12508 12509@cindex fast tracepoints 12510Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in 12511a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is 12512faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed. 12513 12514@cindex static tracepoints 12515@cindex markers, static tracepoints 12516@cindex probing markers, static tracepoints 12517Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning 12518that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location 12519in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static 12520tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of 12521instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in 12522the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or 12523address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate 12524investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s 12525support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation 12526points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level 12527tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of 12528@value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting 12529registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation 12530point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables. 12531The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an 12532instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a 12533static tracepoint marker. 12534 12535@code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems. 12536@xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}. 12537 12538This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated 12539conditions and actions. 12540 12541@menu 12542* Create and Delete Tracepoints:: 12543* Enable and Disable Tracepoints:: 12544* Tracepoint Passcounts:: 12545* Tracepoint Conditions:: 12546* Trace State Variables:: 12547* Tracepoint Actions:: 12548* Listing Tracepoints:: 12549* Listing Static Tracepoint Markers:: 12550* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments:: 12551* Tracepoint Restrictions:: 12552@end menu 12553 12554@node Create and Delete Tracepoints 12555@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints 12556 12557@table @code 12558@cindex set tracepoint 12559@kindex trace 12560@item trace @var{location} 12561The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command. 12562Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location. 12563@xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, 12564which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop, 12565collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint 12566or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub 12567supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint 12568in tracing}). 12569If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all 12570these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart} 12571command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will 12572not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition, 12573@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose 12574address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.) 12575Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed 12576until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires 12577@value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and 12578@value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected 12579tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to 12580the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected. 12581 12582Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command: 12583 12584@smallexample 12585(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number 12586 12587(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward 12588 12589(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function 12590 12591(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function 12592 12593(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address 12594@end smallexample 12595 12596@noindent 12597You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}. 12598 12599@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond} 12600Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression 12601@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only 12602if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. 12603@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more 12604information on tracepoint conditions. 12605 12606@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ] 12607@cindex set fast tracepoint 12608@cindex fast tracepoints, setting 12609@kindex ftrace 12610The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that 12611support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly 12612less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump 12613instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It 12614may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired 12615location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory 12616message. 12617 12618@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for 12619@code{trace}. 12620 12621On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to 12622be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be 12623placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target 12624program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems, 12625such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's 12626address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible 12627to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command 12628to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in 12629 12630@example 12631sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768 12632@end example 12633 12634@noindent 12635which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for 12636trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary. 12637 12638@item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ] 12639@cindex set static tracepoint 12640@cindex static tracepoints, setting 12641@cindex probe static tracepoint marker 12642@kindex strace 12643The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that 12644support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static 12645instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not 12646be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in 12647which case the command will exit with an explanatory message. 12648 12649@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for 12650@code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify 12651@code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker 12652identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier 12653depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is 12654using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field 12655of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output. 12656@xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint 12657Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST 12658tracing engine: 12659 12660@smallexample 12661main () 12662@{ 12663 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ"); 12664@} 12665@end smallexample 12666 12667@noindent 12668the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the 12669@code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to: 12670 12671@smallexample 12672(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers 12673Cnt Enb ID Address What 126741 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22 12675 Data: "str %s" 12676[etc...] 12677@end smallexample 12678 12679@noindent 12680so you may probe the marker above with: 12681 12682@smallexample 12683(@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33 12684@end smallexample 12685 12686Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect 12687$_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point 12688call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see 12689that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format 12690string. The user data is then the result of running that formating 12691string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info 12692static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in 12693the @samp{Data:} field. 12694 12695You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing 12696the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to 12697@value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. 12698 12699@vindex $tpnum 12700@cindex last tracepoint number 12701@cindex recent tracepoint number 12702@cindex tracepoint number 12703The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number 12704of the most recently set tracepoint. 12705 12706@kindex delete tracepoint 12707@cindex tracepoint deletion 12708@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12709Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the 12710default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular 12711@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also. 12712 12713Examples: 12714 12715@smallexample 12716(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints 12717 12718(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints 12719@end smallexample 12720 12721@noindent 12722You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}. 12723@end table 12724 12725@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints 12726@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints 12727 12728These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}. 12729 12730@table @code 12731@kindex disable tracepoint 12732@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12733Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument 12734@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during 12735a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable 12736a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command. 12737If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target 12738has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the 12739change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the 12740next trace experiment. 12741 12742@kindex enable tracepoint 12743@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12744Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is 12745issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling 12746tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will 12747become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the 12748next time a trace experiment is run. 12749@end table 12750 12751@node Tracepoint Passcounts 12752@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts 12753 12754@table @code 12755@kindex passcount 12756@cindex tracepoint pass count 12757@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]} 12758Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to 12759automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is 12760@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on 12761the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number 12762@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the 12763passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is 12764given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the 12765user. 12766 12767Examples: 12768 12769@smallexample 12770(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of 12771@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2} 12772 12773(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the 12774@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.} 12775(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo} 12776(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3} 12777(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar} 12778(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2} 12779(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz} 12780(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been 12781@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has} 12782@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times} 12783@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.} 12784@end smallexample 12785@end table 12786 12787@node Tracepoint Conditions 12788@subsection Tracepoint Conditions 12789@cindex conditional tracepoints 12790@cindex tracepoint conditions 12791 12792The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program 12793reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for 12794a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your 12795programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A 12796tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your 12797program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition 12798is true. 12799 12800Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by 12801using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command. 12802@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can 12803also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command, 12804just as with breakpoints. 12805 12806Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate 12807the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the 12808expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) 12809suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}. 12810Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack 12811accesses, and so forth. 12812 12813For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called 12814frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You 12815could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls 12816of that function that happen while the error code is propagating 12817through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up 12818collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to 12819search through. 12820 12821@smallexample 12822(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0} 12823@end smallexample 12824 12825@node Trace State Variables 12826@subsection Trace State Variables 12827@cindex trace state variables 12828 12829A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is 12830created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as 12831that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''), 12832but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly, 12833using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed 12834integers. 12835 12836Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded 12837to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace 12838experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of 12839trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target. 12840 12841@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables 12842Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use 12843them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience 12844variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target 12845while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share 12846the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you 12847cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or 12848@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience 12849variable with the same name. 12850 12851@table @code 12852 12853@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ] 12854@kindex tvariable 12855The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named 12856@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of 12857@var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is 12858entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible, 12859otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent 12860@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a 12861variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the 12862existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial 12863value. The default initial value is 0. 12864 12865@item info tvariables 12866@kindex info tvariables 12867List all the trace state variables along with their initial values. 12868Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is 12869currently running. 12870 12871@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]} 12872@kindex delete tvariable 12873Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments 12874are specified. 12875 12876@end table 12877 12878@node Tracepoint Actions 12879@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists 12880 12881@table @code 12882@kindex actions 12883@cindex tracepoint actions 12884@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12885This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the 12886tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not 12887specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most 12888recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say 12889@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the 12890actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and 12891terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So 12892far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and 12893@code{while-stepping}. 12894 12895@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break 12896Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined 12897actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected. 12898 12899@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint 12900To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}} 12901and follow it immediately with @samp{end}. 12902 12903@smallexample 12904(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data 12905 12906(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data 12907 12908(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions. 12909@end smallexample 12910 12911In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect} 12912commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is 12913hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data 12914following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used, 12915followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a 12916sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is 12917terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action 12918list is terminated by an @code{end} command. 12919 12920@smallexample 12921(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo} 12922(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 12923Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line: 12924> collect bar,baz 12925> collect $regs 12926> while-stepping 12 12927 > collect $pc, arr[i] 12928 > end 12929end 12930@end smallexample 12931 12932@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)} 12933@item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 12934Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. 12935This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions. 12936In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following 12937special arguments are supported: 12938 12939@table @code 12940@item $regs 12941Collect all registers. 12942 12943@item $args 12944Collect all function arguments. 12945 12946@item $locals 12947Collect all local variables. 12948 12949@item $_ret 12950Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more 12951of a backtrace. 12952 12953@emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably 12954determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up 12955collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher 12956for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite. 12957When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is 12958found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it). 12959 12960@item $_probe_argc 12961Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the 12962tracepoint is located. 12963@xref{Static Probe Points}. 12964 12965@item $_probe_arg@var{n} 12966@var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument 12967from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located. 12968@xref{Static Probe Points}. 12969 12970@item $_sdata 12971@vindex $_sdata@r{, collect} 12972Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for 12973static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action 12974Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an 12975instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The 12976tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a 12977character string using the format provided by the programmer that 12978instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms. 12979Here's an example of a UST marker call: 12980 12981@smallexample 12982 const char master_name[] = "$your_name"; 12983 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name) 12984@end smallexample 12985 12986In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string 12987@samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can 12988inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to 12989@value{GDBN}. 12990@end table 12991 12992You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one 12993with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several 12994arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same. 12995 12996The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments. 12997@code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in 12998particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up 12999to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the 13000@code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal 13001number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance 13002@samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at 13003@samp{mystr}. 13004 13005The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is 13006particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect. 13007 13008@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)} 13009@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 13010Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This 13011command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results 13012are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace 13013state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those 13014values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect} 13015action were used. 13016 13017@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)} 13018@item while-stepping @var{n} 13019Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint, 13020collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping} 13021command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping 13022(followed by its own @code{end} command): 13023 13024@smallexample 13025> while-stepping 12 13026 > collect $regs, myglobal 13027 > end 13028> 13029@end smallexample 13030 13031@noindent 13032Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by 13033@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if 13034you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or 13035@code{stepping}. 13036 13037@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 13038@kindex set default-collect 13039@cindex default collection action 13040This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint 13041hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended 13042to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed 13043individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named 13044@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a 13045local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location. 13046 13047@item show default-collect 13048@kindex show default-collect 13049Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each 13050tracepoint hit. 13051 13052@end table 13053 13054@node Listing Tracepoints 13055@subsection Listing Tracepoints 13056 13057@table @code 13058@kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 13059@kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 13060@cindex information about tracepoints 13061@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]} 13062Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't 13063specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the 13064tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for 13065@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same 13066command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints. 13067 13068A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to 13069tracing: 13070 13071@itemize @bullet 13072@item 13073its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command 13074 13075@item 13076the state about installed on target of each location 13077@end itemize 13078 13079@smallexample 13080(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace} 13081Num Type Disp Enb Address What 130821 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7 13083 while-stepping 20 13084 collect globfoo, $regs 13085 end 13086 collect globfoo2 13087 end 13088 pass count 1200 130892 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE> 13090 collect $eip 130912.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35 13092 installed on target 130932.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35 13094 installed on target 130952.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint 130963 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29 13097 not installed on target 13098(@value{GDBP}) 13099@end smallexample 13100 13101@noindent 13102This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}. 13103@end table 13104 13105@node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers 13106@subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers 13107 13108@table @code 13109@kindex info static-tracepoint-markers 13110@cindex information about static tracepoint markers 13111@item info static-tracepoint-markers 13112Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the 13113program. 13114 13115For each marker, the following columns are printed: 13116 13117@table @emph 13118@item Count 13119An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a 13120stable identifier. 13121@item ID 13122The marker ID, as reported by the target. 13123@item Enabled or Disabled 13124Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks 13125that are not enabled. 13126@item Address 13127Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address. 13128@item What 13129Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line 13130number. If the debug information included in the program does not 13131allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column 13132will be left blank. 13133@end table 13134 13135@noindent 13136In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker: 13137 13138@table @emph 13139@item Data 13140User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the 13141UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the 13142marker call. 13143@item Static tracepoints probing the marker 13144The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker. 13145@end table 13146 13147@smallexample 13148(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers 13149Cnt ID Enb Address What 131501 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25 13151 Data: number1 %d number2 %d 13152 Probed by static tracepoints: #2 131532 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24 13154 Data: str %s 13155(@value{GDBP}) 13156@end smallexample 13157@end table 13158 13159@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments 13160@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments 13161 13162@table @code 13163@kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ] 13164@cindex start a new trace experiment 13165@cindex collected data discarded 13166@item tstart 13167This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data. 13168It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the 13169trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments 13170are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace 13171experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are 13172especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context; 13173the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact 13174information, and so forth. 13175 13176@kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ] 13177@cindex stop a running trace experiment 13178@item tstop 13179This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are 13180supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is 13181useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for 13182instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and 13183needs to be stopped quickly. 13184 13185@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop 13186automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached 13187(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full. 13188 13189@kindex tstatus 13190@cindex status of trace data collection 13191@cindex trace experiment, status of 13192@item tstatus 13193This command displays the status of the current trace data 13194collection. 13195@end table 13196 13197Here is an example of the commands we described so far: 13198 13199@smallexample 13200(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test} 13201(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 13202Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line. 13203> collect $regs,$locals,$args 13204> while-stepping 11 13205 > collect $regs 13206 > end 13207> end 13208(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart} 13209 [time passes @dots{}] 13210(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop} 13211@end smallexample 13212 13213@anchor{disconnected tracing} 13214@cindex disconnected tracing 13215You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if 13216@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or 13217involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will 13218ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected 13219terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be 13220unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable 13221@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should 13222continue running without @value{GDBN}. 13223 13224@table @code 13225@item set disconnected-tracing on 13226@itemx set disconnected-tracing off 13227@kindex set disconnected-tracing 13228Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN} 13229has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or 13230@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no 13231matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful 13232for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network. 13233 13234@item show disconnected-tracing 13235@kindex show disconnected-tracing 13236Show the current choice for disconnected tracing. 13237 13238@end table 13239 13240When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not 13241still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the 13242meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running, 13243it will continue after reconnection. 13244 13245Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the 13246tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that 13247information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt 13248to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may 13249have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of 13250the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the 13251debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with 13252which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is 13253necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being 13254created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use. 13255 13256@cindex circular trace buffer 13257If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you 13258can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace 13259buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace 13260frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue 13261collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being 13262hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the 13263buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set 13264@samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time, 13265including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change 13266buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until 13267the next run. 13268 13269@table @code 13270@item set circular-trace-buffer on 13271@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off 13272@kindex set circular-trace-buffer 13273Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer 13274for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may 13275fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace 13276data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits. 13277 13278@item show circular-trace-buffer 13279@kindex show circular-trace-buffer 13280Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not 13281match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to 13282match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run, 13283for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file. 13284 13285@end table 13286 13287@table @code 13288@item set trace-buffer-size @var{n} 13289@itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited 13290@kindex set trace-buffer-size 13291Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all 13292targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for 13293the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of 13294@code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it 13295likes. This is also the default. 13296 13297@item show trace-buffer-size 13298@kindex show trace-buffer-size 13299Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this 13300will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting, 13301and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the 13302target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will 13303not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus} 13304to get a report of the actual buffer size. 13305@end table 13306 13307@table @code 13308@item set trace-user @var{text} 13309@kindex set trace-user 13310 13311@item show trace-user 13312@kindex show trace-user 13313 13314@item set trace-notes @var{text} 13315@kindex set trace-notes 13316Set the trace run's notes. 13317 13318@item show trace-notes 13319@kindex show trace-notes 13320Show the trace run's notes. 13321 13322@item set trace-stop-notes @var{text} 13323@kindex set trace-stop-notes 13324Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for 13325@code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a 13326stop note that is mistaken or incomplete. 13327 13328@item show trace-stop-notes 13329@kindex show trace-stop-notes 13330Show the trace run's stop notes. 13331 13332@end table 13333 13334@node Tracepoint Restrictions 13335@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions 13336 13337@cindex tracepoint restrictions 13338There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As 13339described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target 13340without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of 13341the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data 13342examination time, you will be limited by only having what was 13343collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it 13344is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not 13345mentioned here. 13346 13347@itemize @bullet 13348 13349@item 13350Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus 13351the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available. 13352You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access 13353convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace 13354state variables). Some language features may implicitly call 13355functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore 13356cannot be collected either. 13357 13358@item 13359Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with 13360@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may 13361behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for 13362instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable 13363may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The 13364tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the 13365variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the 13366tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine 13367where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the 13368program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped. 13369 13370@item 13371Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object 13372may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays 13373in a misleading way. 13374 13375@item 13376When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically 13377dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string 13378being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does 13379not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly 13380dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to 13381collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example, 13382@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to 13383by @code{ptr}. 13384 13385@item 13386It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a 13387tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred 13388bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300} 13389(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your 13390target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture). 13391Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when 13392using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined 13393depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that 13394if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the 13395stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an 13396invalid address. 13397 13398@item 13399If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can 13400infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of 13401the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame 13402for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has 13403multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was 13404inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases 13405@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default 13406it to zero. 13407 13408@end itemize 13409 13410@node Analyze Collected Data 13411@section Using the Collected Data 13412 13413After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands 13414for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint 13415collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another 13416snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are 13417consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can 13418examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a 13419specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace 13420snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and 13421registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot, 13422rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being 13423debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands 13424(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will 13425behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was 13426when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in 13427the buffer will fail. 13428 13429@menu 13430* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot 13431* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot 13432* save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run 13433@end menu 13434 13435@node tfind 13436@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}} 13437 13438@kindex tfind 13439@cindex select trace snapshot 13440@cindex find trace snapshot 13441The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is 13442@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n}, 13443counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next 13444snapshot is selected. 13445 13446Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command. 13447 13448@table @code 13449@item tfind start 13450Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for 13451@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot). 13452 13453@item tfind none 13454Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging. 13455 13456@item tfind end 13457Same as @samp{tfind none}. 13458 13459@item tfind 13460No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first 13461one if no trace snapshot is selected. 13462 13463@item tfind - 13464Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits 13465retracing earlier steps. 13466 13467@item tfind tracepoint @var{num} 13468Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search 13469proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no 13470argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected 13471for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot. 13472 13473@item tfind pc @var{addr} 13474Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the 13475program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace 13476snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next 13477snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot. 13478 13479@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2} 13480Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of 13481addresses (exclusive). 13482 13483@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2} 13484Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and 13485@var{addr2} (inclusive). 13486 13487@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n} 13488Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If 13489the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in 13490that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined 13491trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the 13492next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying 13493@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as 13494stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session. 13495@end table 13496 13497The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically 13498designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For 13499instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace 13500snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous 13501trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then 13502simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace 13503snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting 13504@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order. 13505The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot 13506for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with 13507no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter 13508(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with 13509no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same 13510tracepoint as the current one. 13511 13512In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually, 13513these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that 13514scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data 13515you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP 13516registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this: 13517 13518@smallexample 13519(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 13520(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)} 13521> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \ 13522 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp 13523> tfind 13524> end 13525 13526Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44 13527Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44 13528Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44 13529Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44 13530Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44 13531Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44 13532Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44 13533Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44 13534Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44 13535Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44 13536Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14 13537@end smallexample 13538 13539Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in 13540the buffer: 13541 13542@smallexample 13543(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 13544(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)} 13545> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X 13546> tfind line 13547> end 13548 13549Frame 0, X = 1 13550Frame 7, X = 2 13551Frame 13, X = 255 13552@end smallexample 13553 13554@node tdump 13555@subsection @code{tdump} 13556@kindex tdump 13557@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint 13558@cindex tracepoint data, display 13559 13560This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at 13561the current trace snapshot. 13562 13563@smallexample 13564(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444} 13565(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 13566Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line: 13567> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test 13568> end 13569 13570(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart} 13571 13572(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444} 13573#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66) 13574at gdb_test.c:444 13575444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", ) 13576 13577(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump} 13578Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1: 13579d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707 13580d1 0x18 24 13581d2 0x80 128 13582d3 0x33 51 13583d4 0x71aea3d 119204413 13584d5 0x22 34 13585d6 0xe0 224 13586d7 0x380035 3670069 13587a0 0x19e24a 1696330 13588a1 0x3000668 50333288 13589a2 0x100 256 13590a3 0x322000 3284992 13591a4 0x3000698 50333336 13592a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156 13593fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c 13594sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34 13595ps 0x0 0 13596pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8 13597fpcontrol 0x0 0 13598fpstatus 0x0 0 13599fpiaddr 0x0 0 13600p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test" 13601p1 = (void *) 0x11 13602p2 = (void *) 0x22 13603p3 = (void *) 0x33 13604p4 = (void *) 0x44 13605p5 = (void *) 0x55 13606p6 = (void *) 0x66 13607gdb_long_test = 17 '\021' 13608 13609(@value{GDBP}) 13610@end smallexample 13611 13612@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection 13613actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So 13614@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's 13615actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run. 13616 13617Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump} 13618uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace 13619frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were 13620collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether 13621to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the 13622body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected, 13623then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection 13624list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the 13625same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit. 13626@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good. 13627 13628@node save tracepoints 13629@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}} 13630@kindex save tracepoints 13631@kindex save-tracepoints 13632@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions 13633 13634This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with 13635their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}} 13636suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved 13637tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command 13638Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated 13639alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}} 13640 13641@node Tracepoint Variables 13642@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints 13643@cindex tracepoint variables 13644@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints 13645 13646@table @code 13647@vindex $trace_frame 13648@item (int) $trace_frame 13649The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no 13650snapshot is selected. 13651 13652@vindex $tracepoint 13653@item (int) $tracepoint 13654The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot. 13655 13656@vindex $trace_line 13657@item (int) $trace_line 13658The line number for the current trace snapshot. 13659 13660@vindex $trace_file 13661@item (char []) $trace_file 13662The source file for the current trace snapshot. 13663 13664@vindex $trace_func 13665@item (char []) $trace_func 13666The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}. 13667@end table 13668 13669Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf}, 13670use @code{output} instead. 13671 13672Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for 13673stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their 13674data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables, 13675which are managed by the target. 13676 13677@smallexample 13678(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 13679 13680(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1} 13681> output $trace_file 13682> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint 13683> tfind 13684> end 13685@end smallexample 13686 13687@node Trace Files 13688@section Using Trace Files 13689@cindex trace files 13690 13691In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no 13692longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed 13693for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to 13694dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source 13695of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command. 13696 13697@table @code 13698 13699@kindex tsave 13700@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename} 13701@itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname} 13702Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command 13703assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if 13704necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and 13705then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the 13706optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save 13707the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be 13708more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that 13709@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.) 13710By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format. 13711You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF 13712format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format 13713that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to 13714@indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information. 13715 13716@kindex target tfile 13717@kindex tfile 13718@kindex target ctf 13719@kindex ctf 13720@item target tfile @var{filename} 13721@itemx target ctf @var{dirname} 13722Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as 13723a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with 13724a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments. 13725@code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment 13726the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining. 13727Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to 13728the host. 13729 13730@smallexample 13731(@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf 13732(@value{GDBP}) tfind 13733Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2 1373439 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */ 13735(@value{GDBP}) tdump 13736Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0: 13737i = 0 13738a = 0 13739b = 1 '\001' 13740c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@} 13741d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@} 13742(@value{GDBP}) p b 13743$1 = 1 13744@end smallexample 13745 13746@end table 13747 13748@node Overlays 13749@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays 13750@cindex overlays 13751 13752If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's 13753memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this 13754problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that 13755use overlays. 13756 13757@menu 13758* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays. 13759* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}. 13760* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are 13761 mapped by asking the inferior. 13762* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays. 13763@end menu 13764 13765@node How Overlays Work 13766@section How Overlays Work 13767@cindex mapped overlays 13768@cindex unmapped overlays 13769@cindex load address, overlay's 13770@cindex mapped address 13771@cindex overlay area 13772 13773Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64 13774kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by 13775other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory 13776management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to 13777adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system. 13778 13779One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively 13780independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules 13781@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place 13782their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in 13783instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the 13784largest overlay as well. 13785 13786Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that 13787overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside 13788for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point 13789there. 13790 13791@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the 13792@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer 13793@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size. 13794 13795@smallexample 13796@group 13797 Data Instruction Larger 13798Address Space Address Space Address Space 13799+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+ 13800| | | | | | 13801+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1 13802| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address 13803| variables | | program | | +-----------+ 13804| and heap | | | | | | 13805+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2 13806| | +-----------+ | | | load address 13807+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 | 13808 | | | | | | 13809 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+ 13810 address | | | | | | 13811 | overlay | <-' | | | 13812 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3 13813 | | <---. | | load address 13814 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 | 13815 | | | | 13816 +-----------+ | | 13817 +-----------+ 13818 | | 13819 +-----------+ 13820 13821 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay 13822@end group 13823@end smallexample 13824 13825The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data 13826and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies 13827its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space. 13828Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one 13829may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for 13830data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the 13831program variables and heap would share an address space with the main 13832program and the overlay area. 13833 13834An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a 13835@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the 13836instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present) 13837in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address} 13838is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called 13839the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also 13840called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}. 13841 13842Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a 13843program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of 13844global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program: 13845 13846@itemize @bullet 13847 13848@item 13849Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program 13850must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or 13851return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong 13852overlay, and your program will probably crash. 13853 13854@item 13855If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you 13856will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on 13857your program's performance. 13858 13859@item 13860The executable file you load onto your system must contain each 13861overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its 13862mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated 13863and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address. 13864You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation 13865addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,, 13866ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}. 13867 13868@item 13869The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able 13870to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the 13871instruction and data spaces. 13872 13873@end itemize 13874 13875The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be 13876improved in many ways: 13877 13878@itemize @bullet 13879 13880@item 13881If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management 13882hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area 13883contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space. 13884This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped 13885area in the usual way. 13886 13887@item 13888If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one 13889overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time. 13890 13891@item 13892You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In 13893general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than 13894code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or 13895return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access 13896the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you 13897must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a 13898different data overlay into the same mapped area. 13899 13900@end itemize 13901 13902 13903@node Overlay Commands 13904@section Overlay Commands 13905 13906To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must 13907correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's 13908virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's 13909mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows 13910@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or 13911variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not. 13912 13913@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay}; 13914you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are: 13915 13916@table @code 13917@item overlay off 13918@kindex overlay 13919Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is 13920disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are 13921always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s 13922overlay support is disabled. 13923 13924@item overlay manual 13925@cindex manual overlay debugging 13926Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN} 13927relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not, 13928using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay} 13929commands described below. 13930 13931@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay} 13932@itemx overlay map @var{overlay} 13933@cindex map an overlay 13934Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must 13935be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an 13936overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's 13937functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes 13938that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of 13939@var{overlay} are now unmapped. 13940 13941@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay} 13942@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay} 13943@cindex unmap an overlay 13944Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay} 13945must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. 13946When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the 13947overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses. 13948 13949@item overlay auto 13950Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN} 13951consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior 13952to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic 13953Overlay Debugging}. 13954 13955@item overlay load-target 13956@itemx overlay load 13957@cindex reloading the overlay table 13958Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN} 13959re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior 13960stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the 13961overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only 13962useful when using automatic overlay debugging. 13963 13964@item overlay list-overlays 13965@itemx overlay list 13966@cindex listing mapped overlays 13967Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped 13968addresses, load addresses, and sizes. 13969 13970@end table 13971 13972Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name 13973of the function the address falls in: 13974 13975@smallexample 13976(@value{GDBP}) print main 13977$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main> 13978@end smallexample 13979@noindent 13980When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in 13981unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with 13982asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an 13983unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way: 13984 13985@smallexample 13986(@value{GDBP}) overlay list 13987No sections are mapped. 13988(@value{GDBP}) print foo 13989$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*> 13990@end smallexample 13991@noindent 13992When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's 13993name normally: 13994 13995@smallexample 13996(@value{GDBP}) overlay list 13997Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034, 13998 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a 13999(@value{GDBP}) print foo 14000$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo> 14001@end smallexample 14002 14003When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct 14004address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the 14005overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like 14006@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped 14007code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations: 14008 14009@itemize @bullet 14010@item 14011@cindex breakpoints in overlays 14012@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in 14013You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as 14014@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address. 14015@item 14016@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in 14017unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your 14018overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if 14019you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its 14020breakpoints properly. 14021@end itemize 14022 14023 14024@node Automatic Overlay Debugging 14025@section Automatic Overlay Debugging 14026@cindex automatic overlay debugging 14027 14028@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which 14029are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the 14030inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the 14031@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN} 14032looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the 14033current state of the overlays. 14034 14035Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support 14036@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging: 14037 14038@table @asis 14039 14040@item @code{_ovly_table}: 14041This variable must be an array of the following structures: 14042 14043@smallexample 14044struct 14045@{ 14046 /* The overlay's mapped address. */ 14047 unsigned long vma; 14048 14049 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */ 14050 unsigned long size; 14051 14052 /* The overlay's load address. */ 14053 unsigned long lma; 14054 14055 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped; 14056 zero otherwise. */ 14057 unsigned long mapped; 14058@} 14059@end smallexample 14060 14061@item @code{_novlys}: 14062This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total 14063number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}. 14064 14065@end table 14066 14067To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN} 14068looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and 14069@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the 14070executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults 14071the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is 14072currently mapped. 14073 14074In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called 14075@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN} 14076will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then 14077calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this 14078will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays 14079are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set 14080in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the 14081overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they 14082are not being executed. 14083 14084@node Overlay Sample Program 14085@section Overlay Sample Program 14086@cindex overlay example program 14087 14088When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays 14089at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped 14090addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay 14091Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately, 14092since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target 14093architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide 14094portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. 14095 14096However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid 14097program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test 14098suite. The program consists of the following files from 14099@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}: 14100 14101@table @file 14102@item overlays.c 14103The main program file. 14104@item ovlymgr.c 14105A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}. 14106@item foo.c 14107@itemx bar.c 14108@itemx baz.c 14109@itemx grbx.c 14110Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}. 14111@item d10v.ld 14112@itemx m32r.ld 14113Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf} 14114and @code{m32r-elf} targets. 14115@end table 14116 14117You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC 14118cross-compiler like this: 14119 14120@smallexample 14121$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c 14122$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c 14123$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c 14124$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c 14125$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c 14126$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c 14127$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \ 14128 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays 14129@end smallexample 14130 14131The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that 14132you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the 14133target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}. 14134 14135 14136@node Languages 14137@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages 14138@cindex languages 14139 14140Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are 14141rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C, 14142dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in 14143Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be 14144represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as 14145@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}. 14146 14147@cindex working language 14148Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages, 14149allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's 14150native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner 14151consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The 14152language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working 14153language}. 14154 14155@menu 14156* Setting:: Switching between source languages 14157* Show:: Displaying the language 14158* Checks:: Type and range checks 14159* Supported Languages:: Supported languages 14160* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages 14161@end menu 14162 14163@node Setting 14164@section Switching Between Source Languages 14165 14166There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN} 14167set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the 14168@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN} 14169defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is 14170used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values 14171are printed, etc. 14172 14173In addition to the working language, every source file that 14174@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object 14175file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular 14176source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the 14177language from the name of the file. The language of a source file 14178controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can 14179show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to 14180set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can 14181set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, , 14182Displaying the Language}. 14183 14184This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such 14185as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in 14186another language. In that case, make the 14187program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way 14188@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original 14189program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code. 14190 14191@menu 14192* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages. 14193* Manually:: Setting the working language manually 14194* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language 14195@end menu 14196 14197@node Filenames 14198@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages 14199 14200If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then 14201@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated. 14202 14203@table @file 14204@item .ada 14205@itemx .ads 14206@itemx .adb 14207@itemx .a 14208Ada source file. 14209 14210@item .c 14211C source file 14212 14213@item .C 14214@itemx .cc 14215@itemx .cp 14216@itemx .cpp 14217@itemx .cxx 14218@itemx .c++ 14219C@t{++} source file 14220 14221@item .d 14222D source file 14223 14224@item .m 14225Objective-C source file 14226 14227@item .f 14228@itemx .F 14229Fortran source file 14230 14231@item .mod 14232Modula-2 source file 14233 14234@item .s 14235@itemx .S 14236Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but 14237@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping. 14238@end table 14239 14240In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename 14241extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}. 14242 14243@node Manually 14244@subsection Setting the Working Language 14245 14246If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, 14247expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and 14248your program. 14249 14250@kindex set language 14251If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the 14252command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of 14253a language, such as 14254@code{c} or @code{modula-2}. 14255For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}. 14256 14257Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working 14258language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try 14259to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the 14260source language, when an expression is acceptable to both 14261languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current 14262source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a 14263command such as: 14264 14265@smallexample 14266print a = b + c 14267@end smallexample 14268 14269@noindent 14270might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add 14271@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result 14272printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare 14273@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value. 14274 14275@node Automatically 14276@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language 14277 14278To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use 14279@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN} 14280then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a 14281frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the 14282working language to the language recorded for the function in that 14283frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function 14284or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that 14285does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is 14286not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning. 14287 14288This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written 14289entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries 14290written in one source language can be used by a main program written in 14291a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this 14292case frees you from having to set the working language manually. 14293 14294@node Show 14295@section Displaying the Language 14296 14297The following commands help you find out which language is the 14298working language, and also what language source files were written in. 14299 14300@table @code 14301@item show language 14302@anchor{show language} 14303@kindex show language 14304Display the current working language. This is the 14305language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to 14306build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program. 14307 14308@item info frame 14309@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language} 14310Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the 14311working language if you use an identifier from this frame. 14312@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other 14313information listed here. 14314 14315@item info source 14316@kindex info source@r{, show the source language} 14317Display the source language of this source file. 14318@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other 14319information listed here. 14320@end table 14321 14322In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions 14323not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated 14324with a language explicitly: 14325 14326@table @code 14327@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language} 14328@kindex set extension-language 14329Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be 14330assumed as written in the source language @var{language}. 14331 14332@item info extensions 14333@kindex info extensions 14334List all the filename extensions and the associated languages. 14335@end table 14336 14337@node Checks 14338@section Type and Range Checking 14339 14340Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common 14341errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include 14342checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making 14343sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as 14344these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled 14345by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range 14346errors when your program is running. 14347 14348By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the 14349rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check 14350the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly 14351into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. 14352 14353@menu 14354* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking 14355* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking 14356@end menu 14357 14358@cindex type checking 14359@cindex checks, type 14360@node Type Checking 14361@subsection An Overview of Type Checking 14362 14363Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the 14364arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type, 14365otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch 14366errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example, 14367 14368@smallexample 14369int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @} 14370 14371(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0) 14372$1 = 2 14373@exdent but 14374(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234) 14375Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance 14376@end smallexample 14377 14378The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant 14379@samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type. 14380 14381For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell 14382@value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or 14383to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression; 14384When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates 14385expressions like the second example above. 14386 14387Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons 14388related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression. 14389For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and 14390a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do 14391with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make 14392little sense to evaluate anyway. 14393 14394@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking: 14395 14396@kindex set check type 14397@kindex show check type 14398@table @code 14399@item set check type on 14400@itemx set check type off 14401Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in 14402evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a 14403message and aborts evaluation of the expression. 14404 14405@item show check type 14406Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN} 14407is enforcing strict type checking rules. 14408@end table 14409 14410@cindex range checking 14411@cindex checks, range 14412@node Range Checking 14413@subsection An Overview of Range Checking 14414 14415In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the 14416bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range 14417checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure 14418computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do 14419not exceed the bounds of the array. 14420 14421For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell 14422@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them, 14423always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue 14424warnings but evaluate the expression anyway. 14425 14426A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an 14427array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member 14428of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an 14429error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the 14430result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is 14431the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then 14432 14433@smallexample 14434@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s} 14435@end smallexample 14436 14437This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases 14438specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, , 14439Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages. 14440 14441@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker: 14442 14443@kindex set check range 14444@kindex show check range 14445@table @code 14446@item set check range auto 14447Set range checking on or off based on the current working language. 14448@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for 14449each language. 14450 14451@item set check range on 14452@itemx set check range off 14453Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the 14454current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not 14455match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on, 14456then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted. 14457 14458@item set check range warn 14459Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error, 14460but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the 14461expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing 14462memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix 14463systems). 14464 14465@item show range 14466Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is 14467being set automatically by @value{GDBN}. 14468@end table 14469 14470@node Supported Languages 14471@section Supported Languages 14472 14473@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, 14474OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada. 14475@c This is false ... 14476Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the 14477language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators, 14478and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions, 14479,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported 14480language. 14481 14482The following sections detail to what degree each source language is 14483supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language 14484tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the 14485@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output 14486formats should look like for different languages. There are many good 14487books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a 14488language reference or tutorial. 14489 14490@menu 14491* C:: C and C@t{++} 14492* D:: D 14493* Go:: Go 14494* Objective-C:: Objective-C 14495* OpenCL C:: OpenCL C 14496* Fortran:: Fortran 14497* Pascal:: Pascal 14498* Rust:: Rust 14499* Modula-2:: Modula-2 14500* Ada:: Ada 14501@end menu 14502 14503@node C 14504@subsection C and C@t{++} 14505 14506@cindex C and C@t{++} 14507@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++} 14508 14509Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply 14510to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages 14511together. 14512 14513@cindex C@t{++} 14514@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler 14515@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++} 14516The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++} 14517compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code 14518effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported 14519C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++} 14520compiler (@code{aCC}). 14521 14522@menu 14523* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators 14524* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants 14525* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions 14526* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++} 14527* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks 14528* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C 14529* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++} 14530* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format 14531@end menu 14532 14533@node C Operators 14534@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators 14535 14536@cindex C and C@t{++} operators 14537 14538Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 14539@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are 14540often defined on groups of types. 14541 14542For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold: 14543 14544@itemize @bullet 14545 14546@item 14547@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class 14548specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}. 14549 14550@item 14551@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and 14552@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform). 14553 14554@item 14555@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}. 14556 14557@item 14558@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above. 14559 14560@end itemize 14561 14562@noindent 14563The following operators are supported. They are listed here 14564in order of increasing precedence: 14565 14566@table @code 14567@item , 14568The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list 14569are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire 14570expression being the last expression evaluated. 14571 14572@item = 14573Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value 14574assigned. Defined on scalar types. 14575 14576@item @var{op}= 14577Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}}, 14578and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}. 14579@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator 14580@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&}, 14581@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}. 14582 14583@item ?: 14584The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought 14585of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a} 14586should be of an integral type. 14587 14588@item || 14589Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 14590 14591@item && 14592Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types. 14593 14594@item | 14595Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 14596 14597@item ^ 14598Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 14599 14600@item & 14601Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types. 14602 14603@item ==@r{, }!= 14604Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these 14605expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true. 14606 14607@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>= 14608Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal. 14609Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false 14610and non-zero for true. 14611 14612@item <<@r{, }>> 14613left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types. 14614 14615@item @@ 14616The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). 14617 14618@item +@r{, }- 14619Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and 14620pointer types. 14621 14622@item *@r{, }/@r{, }% 14623Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are 14624defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on 14625integral types. 14626 14627@item ++@r{, }-- 14628Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the 14629operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression; 14630when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the 14631operation takes place. 14632 14633@item * 14634Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as 14635@code{++}. 14636 14637@item & 14638Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}. 14639 14640For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is 14641allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})} 14642to examine the address 14643where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is 14644stored. 14645 14646@item - 14647Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same 14648precedence as @code{++}. 14649 14650@item ! 14651Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as 14652@code{++}. 14653 14654@item ~ 14655Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as 14656@code{++}. 14657 14658 14659@item .@r{, }-> 14660Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience, 14661@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a 14662pointer based on the stored type information. 14663Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data. 14664 14665@item .*@r{, }->* 14666Dereferences of pointers to members. 14667 14668@item [] 14669Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as 14670@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}. 14671 14672@item () 14673Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}. 14674 14675@item :: 14676C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union}, 14677and @code{class} types. 14678 14679@item :: 14680Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator 14681(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::}, 14682above. 14683@end table 14684 14685If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually 14686attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's 14687predefined meaning. 14688 14689@node C Constants 14690@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants 14691 14692@cindex C and C@t{++} constants 14693 14694@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the 14695following ways: 14696 14697@itemize @bullet 14698@item 14699Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are 14700specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants 14701by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter 14702@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a 14703@code{long} value. 14704 14705@item 14706Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal 14707point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an 14708exponent. An exponent is of the form: 14709@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another 14710sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents. 14711A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or 14712@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of 14713the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with 14714a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double} 14715constant. 14716 14717@item 14718Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their 14719integral equivalents. 14720 14721@item 14722Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes 14723(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character 14724(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may 14725be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of 14726the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation 14727of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where 14728@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example, 14729@samp{\n} for newline. 14730 14731Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character 14732constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide 14733form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when 14734computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}). 14735 14736@item 14737String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by 14738double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described 14739above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by 14740a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five 14741characters. 14742 14743Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant 14744with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when 14745computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}). 14746 14747@item 14748Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers 14749to constants using the C operator @samp{&}. 14750 14751@item 14752Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{} 14753and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of 14754integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array, 14755and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers. 14756@end itemize 14757 14758@node C Plus Plus Expressions 14759@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions 14760 14761@cindex expressions in C@t{++} 14762@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions. 14763 14764@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs 14765@cindex C@t{++} compilers 14766@cindex debug formats and C@t{++} 14767@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++} 14768@quotation 14769@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use 14770the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, 14771@value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled 14772with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF 14773debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most 14774popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to 14775work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++} 14776code. @xref{Compilation}. 14777@end quotation 14778 14779@enumerate 14780 14781@cindex member functions 14782@item 14783Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like 14784 14785@smallexample 14786count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y) 14787@end smallexample 14788 14789@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions} 14790@cindex namespace in C@t{++} 14791@item 14792While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your 14793expressions have the same namespace available as the member function; 14794that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance 14795pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using} 14796declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}. 14797 14798@cindex call overloaded functions 14799@cindex overloaded functions, calling 14800@cindex type conversions in C@t{++} 14801@item 14802You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function 14803call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not 14804perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions, 14805calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist 14806in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or 14807default arguments. 14808 14809It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point 14810promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of 14811class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of 14812functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the 14813number of function arguments. 14814 14815Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified 14816@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus, 14817,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}. 14818 14819You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an 14820explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in 14821@smallexample 14822p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13) 14823@end smallexample 14824 14825The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this; 14826see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}. 14827 14828@cindex reference declarations 14829@item 14830@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue 14831references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} 14832source---they are automatically dereferenced. 14833 14834In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of 14835reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this 14836avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures. 14837The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless 14838you have specified @samp{set print address off}. 14839 14840@item 14841@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your 14842expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since 14843one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if 14844necessary, for example in an expression like 14845@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows 14846resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++} 14847debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}). 14848 14849@item 14850@value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++} 14851specification. 14852@end enumerate 14853 14854@node C Defaults 14855@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults 14856 14857@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults 14858 14859If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it 14860defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to 14861C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN} 14862selects the working language. 14863 14864If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it 14865recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or 14866@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of 14867these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}. 14868@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language}, 14869for further details. 14870 14871@node C Checks 14872@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks 14873 14874@cindex C and C@t{++} checks 14875 14876By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type 14877checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN} 14878will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer 14879constants to pointers. 14880 14881Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array 14882indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer 14883that is not itself an array. 14884 14885@node Debugging C 14886@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C 14887 14888The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to 14889the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is 14890inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it 14891appears as @samp{@{...@}}. 14892 14893The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed 14894with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions, 14895,Expressions}. 14896 14897@node Debugging C Plus Plus 14898@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++} 14899 14900@cindex commands for C@t{++} 14901 14902Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are 14903designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary: 14904 14905@table @code 14906@cindex break in overloaded functions 14907@item @r{breakpoint menus} 14908When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded, 14909@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint 14910locations to help you specify which function definition you want. 14911@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}. 14912 14913@cindex overloading in C@t{++} 14914@item rbreak @var{regex} 14915Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting 14916breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special 14917classes. 14918@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. 14919 14920@cindex C@t{++} exception handling 14921@item catch throw 14922@itemx catch rethrow 14923@itemx catch catch 14924Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set 14925Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}. 14926 14927@cindex inheritance 14928@item ptype @var{typename} 14929Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type 14930@var{typename}. 14931@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}. 14932 14933@item info vtbl @var{expression}. 14934The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual 14935method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows 14936one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when 14937multiple inheritance is in use. 14938 14939@cindex C@t{++} demangling 14940@item demangle @var{name} 14941Demangle @var{name}. 14942@xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command. 14943 14944@cindex C@t{++} symbol display 14945@item set print demangle 14946@itemx show print demangle 14947@itemx set print asm-demangle 14948@itemx show print asm-demangle 14949Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when 14950displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies. 14951@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 14952 14953@item set print object 14954@itemx show print object 14955Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects. 14956@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 14957 14958@item set print vtbl 14959@itemx show print vtbl 14960Control the format for printing virtual function tables. 14961@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 14962(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP 14963ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).) 14964 14965@kindex set overload-resolution 14966@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution 14967@item set overload-resolution on 14968Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default 14969is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments 14970and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types, 14971using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus 14972Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details). 14973If it cannot find a match, it emits a message. 14974 14975@item set overload-resolution off 14976Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For 14977overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN} 14978chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the 14979symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For 14980overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN} 14981searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the 14982argument types. 14983 14984@kindex show overload-resolution 14985@item show overload-resolution 14986Show the current setting of overload resolution. 14987 14988@item @r{Overloaded symbol names} 14989You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using 14990the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type 14991@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can 14992also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the 14993available choices, or to finish the type list for you. 14994@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this. 14995@end table 14996 14997@node Decimal Floating Point 14998@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format 14999@cindex decimal floating point format 15000 15001@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in 15002decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the 15003@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as 15004specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic. 15005 15006There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary 15007Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for 15008PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the 15009configured target. 15010 15011Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN} 15012to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert 15013(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float. 15014 15015In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating 15016point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores 15017underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions. 15018 15019In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers 15020to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. 15021See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details. 15022 15023@node D 15024@subsection D 15025 15026@cindex D 15027@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with 15028GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D 15029specific feature --- dynamic arrays. 15030 15031@node Go 15032@subsection Go 15033 15034@cindex Go (programming language) 15035@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with 15036@file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers. 15037 15038Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions: 15039 15040@table @code 15041@cindex current Go package 15042@item The current Go package 15043The name of the current package does not need to be specified when 15044specifying global variables and functions. 15045 15046For example, given the program: 15047 15048@example 15049package main 15050var myglob = "Shall we?" 15051func main () @{ 15052 // ... 15053@} 15054@end example 15055 15056When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work: 15057 15058@example 15059(gdb) p myglob 15060(gdb) p main.myglob 15061@end example 15062 15063@cindex builtin Go types 15064@item Builtin Go types 15065The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed 15066as a string. 15067 15068@cindex builtin Go functions 15069@item Builtin Go functions 15070The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof} 15071function and handles it internally. 15072 15073@cindex restrictions on Go expressions 15074@item Restrictions on Go expressions 15075All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}. 15076The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported. 15077Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported. 15078@end table 15079 15080@node Objective-C 15081@subsection Objective-C 15082 15083@cindex Objective-C 15084This section provides information about some commands and command 15085options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also 15086@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a 15087few more commands specific to Objective-C support. 15088 15089@menu 15090* Method Names in Commands:: 15091* The Print Command with Objective-C:: 15092@end menu 15093 15094@node Method Names in Commands 15095@subsubsection Method Names in Commands 15096 15097The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method 15098names as line specifications: 15099 15100@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C} 15101@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C} 15102@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C} 15103@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C} 15104@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C} 15105@itemize 15106@item @code{clear} 15107@item @code{break} 15108@item @code{info line} 15109@item @code{jump} 15110@item @code{list} 15111@end itemize 15112 15113A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as 15114 15115@smallexample 15116-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}] 15117@end smallexample 15118 15119where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a 15120plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class 15121name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in 15122brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C 15123source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create} 15124instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being 15125debugged, enter: 15126 15127@smallexample 15128break -[Fruit create] 15129@end smallexample 15130 15131To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method, 15132enter: 15133 15134@smallexample 15135list +[NSText initialize] 15136@end smallexample 15137 15138In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is 15139required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus 15140sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It 15141is also possible to specify just a method name: 15142 15143@smallexample 15144break create 15145@end smallexample 15146 15147You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If 15148your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method, 15149you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that 15150method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if 15151none apply. 15152 15153As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the 15154@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter: 15155 15156@smallexample 15157clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:] 15158@end smallexample 15159 15160@node The Print Command with Objective-C 15161@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C 15162@cindex Objective-C, print objects 15163@kindex print-object 15164@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})} 15165 15166The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example: 15167 15168@smallexample 15169print -[@var{object} hash] 15170@end smallexample 15171 15172@cindex print an Objective-C object description 15173@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects 15174@noindent 15175will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object} 15176and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added, 15177@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print 15178the description of an object. However, this command may only work 15179with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook 15180function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined. 15181 15182@node OpenCL C 15183@subsection OpenCL C 15184 15185@cindex OpenCL C 15186This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support. 15187 15188@menu 15189* OpenCL C Datatypes:: 15190* OpenCL C Expressions:: 15191* OpenCL C Operators:: 15192@end menu 15193 15194@node OpenCL C Datatypes 15195@subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes 15196 15197@cindex OpenCL C Datatypes 15198@value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified 15199by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point 15200data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL 15201extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}. 15202 15203@node OpenCL C Expressions 15204@subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions 15205 15206@cindex OpenCL C Expressions 15207@value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as 15208lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions 15209supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well. 15210 15211@node OpenCL C Operators 15212@subsubsection OpenCL C Operators 15213 15214@cindex OpenCL C Operators 15215@value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and 15216vector data types. 15217 15218@node Fortran 15219@subsection Fortran 15220@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN} 15221 15222@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it 15223currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language. 15224 15225@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols 15226Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers 15227among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and 15228functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you 15229will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing 15230underscore. 15231 15232@menu 15233* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions 15234* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran 15235* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran 15236@end menu 15237 15238@node Fortran Operators 15239@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions 15240 15241@cindex Fortran operators and expressions 15242 15243Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 15244@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non- 15245arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types. 15246 15247@table @code 15248@item ** 15249The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power 15250of the second one. 15251 15252@item : 15253The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to 15254represent a section of array. 15255 15256@item % 15257The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived 15258types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran, 15259this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined 15260union type. 15261@end table 15262 15263@node Fortran Defaults 15264@subsubsection Fortran Defaults 15265 15266@cindex Fortran Defaults 15267 15268Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by 15269default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can 15270change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see 15271@ref{Symbols}, for the details. 15272 15273@node Special Fortran Commands 15274@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands 15275 15276@cindex Special Fortran commands 15277 15278@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features, 15279such as displaying common blocks. 15280 15281@table @code 15282@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran 15283@kindex info common 15284@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]} 15285This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON} 15286block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of 15287all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are 15288printed. 15289@end table 15290 15291@node Pascal 15292@subsection Pascal 15293 15294@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations 15295Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or 15296nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support 15297entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal 15298syntax. 15299 15300The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members} 15301controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed. 15302@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}. 15303 15304@node Rust 15305@subsection Rust 15306 15307@value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust 15308Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression 15309parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few 15310peculiarities and holes to be aware of. 15311 15312@itemize @bullet 15313@item 15314Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current 15315crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of 15316crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves. 15317 15318That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in 15319crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt 15320to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named 15321@samp{B}. 15322 15323As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to 15324items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}. 15325 15326@item 15327Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in 15328expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name. 15329For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate 15330@samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol 15331@samp{K::x::y}. 15332 15333However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when 15334debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to 15335circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before 15336a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global'' 15337scope. 15338 15339In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in 15340the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}. 15341 15342@item 15343The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like'' 15344expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions. 15345 15346@item 15347Tuple expressions are not implemented. 15348 15349@item 15350The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the 15351@code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will 15352never be destroyed. 15353 15354@item 15355@value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order 15356to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you 15357will have to specify the type parameters manually. 15358 15359@item 15360@value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most 15361cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression 15362context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically 15363invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::} 15364operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For 15365example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like 15366@code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require 15367@code{crate::f::<u32>}. 15368 15369@item 15370As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in 15371the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain 15372features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}: 15373@itemize @bullet 15374 15375@item 15376Method calls cannot be made via traits. 15377 15378@item 15379Trait objects cannot be created or inspected. 15380 15381@item 15382Operator overloading is not implemented. 15383 15384@item 15385When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic 15386type names. 15387 15388@item 15389The type @code{Self} is not available. 15390 15391@item 15392@code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be 15393available in the crate. 15394@end itemize 15395@end itemize 15396 15397@node Modula-2 15398@subsection Modula-2 15399 15400@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support 15401 15402The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support 15403output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being 15404developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and 15405attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely 15406to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol 15407table. 15408 15409@cindex expressions in Modula-2 15410@menu 15411* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators 15412* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures 15413* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants 15414* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types 15415* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2 15416* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2 15417* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks 15418* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.} 15419* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 15420@end menu 15421 15422@node M2 Operators 15423@subsubsection Operators 15424@cindex Modula-2 operators 15425 15426Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 15427@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are 15428often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the 15429following definitions hold: 15430 15431@itemize @bullet 15432 15433@item 15434@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and 15435their subranges. 15436 15437@item 15438@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges. 15439 15440@item 15441@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}. 15442 15443@item 15444@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO 15445@var{type}}. 15446 15447@item 15448@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above. 15449 15450@item 15451@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types. 15452 15453@item 15454@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}. 15455@end itemize 15456 15457@noindent 15458The following operators are supported, and appear in order of 15459increasing precedence: 15460 15461@table @code 15462@item , 15463Function argument or array index separator. 15464 15465@item := 15466Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is 15467@var{value}. 15468 15469@item <@r{, }> 15470Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated 15471types. 15472 15473@item <=@r{, }>= 15474Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to 15475on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on 15476set types. Same precedence as @code{<}. 15477 15478@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }# 15479Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types. 15480Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is 15481available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script 15482comment character. 15483 15484@item IN 15485Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members. 15486Same precedence as @code{<}. 15487 15488@item OR 15489Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types. 15490 15491@item AND@r{, }& 15492Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types. 15493 15494@item @@ 15495The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). 15496 15497@item +@r{, }- 15498Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union 15499and difference on set types. 15500 15501@item * 15502Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection 15503on set types. 15504 15505@item / 15506Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set 15507types. Same precedence as @code{*}. 15508 15509@item DIV@r{, }MOD 15510Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same 15511precedence as @code{*}. 15512 15513@item - 15514Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data. 15515 15516@item ^ 15517Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. 15518 15519@item NOT 15520Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as 15521@code{^}. 15522 15523@item . 15524@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same 15525precedence as @code{^}. 15526 15527@item [] 15528Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}. 15529 15530@item () 15531Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence 15532as @code{^}. 15533 15534@item ::@r{, }. 15535@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators. 15536@end table 15537 15538@quotation 15539@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN} 15540treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators 15541@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#}, 15542@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error. 15543@end quotation 15544 15545 15546@node Built-In Func/Proc 15547@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures 15548@cindex Modula-2 built-ins 15549 15550Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions. 15551In describing these, the following metavariables are used: 15552 15553@table @var 15554 15555@item a 15556represents an @code{ARRAY} variable. 15557 15558@item c 15559represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable. 15560 15561@item i 15562represents a variable or constant of integral type. 15563 15564@item m 15565represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the 15566same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should 15567be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}). 15568 15569@item n 15570represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type. 15571 15572@item r 15573represents a variable or constant of floating-point type. 15574 15575@item t 15576represents a type. 15577 15578@item v 15579represents a variable. 15580 15581@item x 15582represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the 15583explanation of the function for details. 15584@end table 15585 15586All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below. 15587 15588@table @code 15589@item ABS(@var{n}) 15590Returns the absolute value of @var{n}. 15591 15592@item CAP(@var{c}) 15593If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case 15594equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument. 15595 15596@item CHR(@var{i}) 15597Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}. 15598 15599@item DEC(@var{v}) 15600Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value. 15601 15602@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i}) 15603Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the 15604new value. 15605 15606@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s}) 15607Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new 15608set. 15609 15610@item FLOAT(@var{i}) 15611Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}. 15612 15613@item HIGH(@var{a}) 15614Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}. 15615 15616@item INC(@var{v}) 15617Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value. 15618 15619@item INC(@var{v},@var{i}) 15620Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the 15621new value. 15622 15623@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s}) 15624Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already 15625there. Returns the new set. 15626 15627@item MAX(@var{t}) 15628Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}. 15629 15630@item MIN(@var{t}) 15631Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}. 15632 15633@item ODD(@var{i}) 15634Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number. 15635 15636@item ORD(@var{x}) 15637Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal 15638value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting 15639the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an 15640ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types. 15641 15642@item SIZE(@var{x}) 15643Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a 15644variable or a type. 15645 15646@item TRUNC(@var{r}) 15647Returns the integral part of @var{r}. 15648 15649@item TSIZE(@var{x}) 15650Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a 15651variable or a type. 15652 15653@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i}) 15654Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}. 15655@end table 15656 15657@quotation 15658@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so 15659@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as 15660an error. 15661@end quotation 15662 15663@cindex Modula-2 constants 15664@node M2 Constants 15665@subsubsection Constants 15666 15667@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following 15668ways: 15669 15670@itemize @bullet 15671 15672@item 15673Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an 15674expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the 15675rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a 15676trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}. 15677 15678@item 15679Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a 15680decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can 15681then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where 15682@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the 15683digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10) 15684digits. 15685 15686@item 15687Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of 15688like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may 15689also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually) 15690followed by a @samp{C}. 15691 15692@item 15693String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a 15694pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). 15695Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C 15696Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape 15697sequences. 15698 15699@item 15700Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier. 15701 15702@item 15703Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and 15704@code{FALSE}. 15705 15706@item 15707Pointer constants consist of integral values only. 15708 15709@item 15710Set constants are not yet supported. 15711@end itemize 15712 15713@node M2 Types 15714@subsubsection Modula-2 Types 15715@cindex Modula-2 types 15716 15717Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2 15718syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure 15719types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also 15720print the contents of variables declared using these type. 15721This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with 15722sample @value{GDBN} sessions. 15723 15724The first example contains the following section of code: 15725 15726@smallexample 15727VAR 15728 s: SET OF CHAR ; 15729 r: [20..40] ; 15730@end smallexample 15731 15732@noindent 15733and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of 15734@code{r} and @code{s}. 15735 15736@smallexample 15737(@value{GDBP}) print s 15738@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@} 15739(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15740SET OF CHAR 15741(@value{GDBP}) print r 1574221 15743(@value{GDBP}) ptype r 15744[20..40] 15745@end smallexample 15746 15747@noindent 15748Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as: 15749 15750@smallexample 15751VAR 15752 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ; 15753@end smallexample 15754 15755@noindent 15756then you may query the type of @code{s} by: 15757 15758@smallexample 15759(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15760type = SET ['A'..'Z'] 15761@end smallexample 15762 15763@noindent 15764Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set 15765expressions using the debugger. 15766 15767The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2 15768and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents: 15769 15770@smallexample 15771VAR 15772 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ; 15773@end smallexample 15774 15775@smallexample 15776(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15777ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR 15778@end smallexample 15779 15780Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type 15781is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all 15782arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example 15783above. 15784 15785Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples: 15786 15787@smallexample 15788TYPE 15789 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ; 15790 t = [blue..yellow] ; 15791VAR 15792 s: t ; 15793BEGIN 15794 s := blue ; 15795@end smallexample 15796 15797@noindent 15798The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type 15799and value of a variable. 15800 15801@smallexample 15802(@value{GDBP}) print s 15803$1 = blue 15804(@value{GDBP}) ptype t 15805type = [blue..yellow] 15806@end smallexample 15807 15808@noindent 15809In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents 15810displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as 15811their @code{C} counterparts. 15812 15813@smallexample 15814VAR 15815 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ; 15816BEGIN 15817 s[1] := 1 ; 15818@end smallexample 15819 15820@smallexample 15821(@value{GDBP}) print s 15822$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@} 15823(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15824type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL 15825@end smallexample 15826 15827The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands 15828pointer types as shown in this example: 15829 15830@smallexample 15831VAR 15832 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ; 15833BEGIN 15834 NEW(s) ; 15835 s^[1] := 1 ; 15836@end smallexample 15837 15838@noindent 15839and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}. 15840 15841@smallexample 15842(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15843type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL 15844@end smallexample 15845 15846@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example. 15847Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange 15848types: 15849 15850@smallexample 15851TYPE 15852 foo = RECORD 15853 f1: CARDINAL ; 15854 f2: CHAR ; 15855 f3: myarray ; 15856 END ; 15857 15858 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ; 15859 myrange = [-2..2] ; 15860VAR 15861 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ; 15862@end smallexample 15863 15864@noindent 15865and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown 15866below. 15867 15868@smallexample 15869(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15870type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD 15871 f1 : CARDINAL; 15872 f2 : CHAR; 15873 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL; 15874END 15875@end smallexample 15876 15877@node M2 Defaults 15878@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults 15879@cindex Modula-2 defaults 15880 15881If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they 15882both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to 15883Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN} 15884selected the working language. 15885 15886If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering 15887code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the 15888working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} 15889Infer the Source Language}, for further details. 15890 15891@node Deviations 15892@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2 15893@cindex Modula-2, deviations from 15894 15895A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug. 15896This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness: 15897 15898@itemize @bullet 15899@item 15900Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by 15901integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during 15902debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a 15903pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified 15904through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that 15905returned a pointer.) 15906 15907@item 15908C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent 15909non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these 15910escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are 15911printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format. 15912 15913@item 15914The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand 15915argument. 15916 15917@item 15918All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument. 15919@end itemize 15920 15921@node M2 Checks 15922@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks 15923@cindex Modula-2 checks 15924 15925@quotation 15926@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or 15927range checking. 15928@end quotation 15929@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added 15930 15931@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if: 15932 15933@itemize @bullet 15934@item 15935They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE 15936@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement 15937 15938@item 15939They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the 15940@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.) 15941@end itemize 15942 15943As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables 15944whose types are not equivalent is an error. 15945 15946Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array 15947index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures. 15948 15949@node M2 Scope 15950@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.} 15951@cindex scope 15952@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator 15953@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator 15954@ifinfo 15955@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2} 15956@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can. 15957@end ifinfo 15958@ifnotinfo 15959@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2} 15960@end ifnotinfo 15961 15962There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator 15963(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have 15964similar syntax: 15965 15966@smallexample 15967 15968@var{module} . @var{id} 15969@var{scope} :: @var{id} 15970@end smallexample 15971 15972@noindent 15973where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure, 15974@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared 15975identifier within your program, except another module. 15976 15977Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope 15978specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not 15979found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes 15980enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}. 15981 15982Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for 15983the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the 15984definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is 15985an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition 15986module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in 15987@var{module}. 15988 15989@node GDB/M2 15990@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 15991 15992Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs. 15993Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply 15994specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle}, 15995@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four 15996apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct 15997analogue in Modula-2. 15998 15999The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available 16000with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its 16001intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be 16002created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an 16003address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct 16004@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful. 16005 16006@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2 16007In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is 16008interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead. 16009 16010@node Ada 16011@subsection Ada 16012@cindex Ada 16013 16014The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support 16015output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler. 16016Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and 16017attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely 16018to be difficult. 16019 16020 16021@cindex expressions in Ada 16022@menu 16023* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax 16024 and semantics supported by Ada mode 16025 in @value{GDBN}. 16026* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax. 16027* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax. 16028* Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded 16029 subprograms. 16030* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration. 16031* Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions 16032* Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks. 16033* Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files 16034* Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar 16035 Profile 16036* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode. 16037@end menu 16038 16039@node Ada Mode Intro 16040@subsubsection Introduction 16041@cindex Ada mode, general 16042 16043The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression 16044syntax, with some extensions. 16045The philosophy behind the design of this subset is 16046 16047@itemize @bullet 16048@item 16049That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for 16050arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls, 16051leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the 16052program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}). 16053 16054@item 16055That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions 16056are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user. 16057 16058@item 16059That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user. 16060@end itemize 16061 16062Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in 16063user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible 16064according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most 16065names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes 16066ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent. 16067 16068The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program. 16069As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that 16070was translated from an Ada source file. 16071 16072While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful 16073mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment 16074(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the 16075middle (to allow based literals). 16076 16077@node Omissions from Ada 16078@subsubsection Omissions from Ada 16079@cindex Ada, omissions from 16080 16081Here are the notable omissions from the subset: 16082 16083@itemize @bullet 16084@item 16085Only a subset of the attributes are supported: 16086 16087@itemize @minus 16088@item 16089@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length} 16090 on array objects (not on types and subtypes). 16091 16092@item 16093@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}. 16094 16095@item 16096@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}. 16097 16098@item 16099@t{'Tag}. 16100 16101@item 16102@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right 16103operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator. 16104 16105@item 16106@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and 16107@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension). 16108 16109@item 16110@t{'Address}. 16111@end itemize 16112 16113@item 16114The names in 16115@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and 16116concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are 16117not currently available. 16118 16119@item 16120Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise 16121equality of representations. They will generally work correctly 16122for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types. 16123They may not work correctly for arrays whose element 16124types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values 16125(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative 16126zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with 16127indeterminate values. 16128 16129@item 16130The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or}, 16131@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality) 16132are not implemented. 16133 16134@item 16135@cindex array aggregates (Ada) 16136@cindex record aggregates (Ada) 16137@cindex aggregates (Ada) 16138There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are 16139permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples: 16140 16141@smallexample 16142(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6) 16143(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0) 16144(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6) 16145(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9)) 16146(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True); 16147(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True) 16148@end smallexample 16149 16150Changing a 16151discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an 16152undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record. 16153However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to 16154them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an 16155aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec} 16156declared to have a type such as: 16157 16158@smallexample 16159type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record 16160 Id : Integer; 16161 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len); 16162end record; 16163@end smallexample 16164 16165you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two 16166assignments: 16167 16168@smallexample 16169(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4 16170(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4)) 16171@end smallexample 16172 16173As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual 16174rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the 16175components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len} 16176component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their 16177original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as 16178indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or 16179redundant component associations, although which component values are 16180assigned in such cases is not defined. 16181 16182@item 16183Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented. 16184 16185@item 16186The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective) 16187than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in 16188which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much 16189looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some 16190function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose 16191the proper resolution. 16192 16193@item 16194The @code{new} operator is not implemented. 16195 16196@item 16197Entry calls are not implemented. 16198 16199@item 16200Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point 16201formats are not supported. 16202 16203@item 16204It is not possible to slice a packed array. 16205 16206@item 16207The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name, 16208are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of 16209context. 16210Should your program 16211redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice), 16212you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions. 16213@end itemize 16214 16215@node Additions to Ada 16216@subsubsection Additions to Ada 16217@cindex Ada, deviations from 16218 16219As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic 16220extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}): 16221 16222@itemize @bullet 16223@item 16224If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically 16225a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer, 16226then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the 16227@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In 16228Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is 16229in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in 16230Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in 16231which certain debugging information has been optimized away. 16232 16233@item 16234@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that 16235appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, 16236you must typically surround it in single quotes. 16237 16238@item 16239The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type 16240@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.'' 16241 16242@item 16243A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable 16244(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}). 16245@end itemize 16246 16247In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright 16248additions specific to Ada: 16249 16250@itemize @bullet 16251@item 16252The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning 16253its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter 16254 16255@smallexample 16256(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3 16257(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1) 16258@end smallexample 16259 16260@item 16261The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value 16262the value of its right-hand operand. 16263This allows, for example, 16264complex conditional breaks: 16265 16266@smallexample 16267(@value{GDBP}) break f 16268(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100) 16269@end smallexample 16270 16271@item 16272Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special 16273characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation, 16274which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form 16275@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the 16276(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The 16277sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark 16278in strings. For example, 16279@smallexample 16280 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]" 16281@end smallexample 16282@noindent 16283contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) 16284after each period. 16285 16286@item 16287The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and 16288@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid 16289to write 16290 16291@smallexample 16292(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y) 16293@end smallexample 16294 16295@item 16296When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the 16297array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise. 16298For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound 16299of 3 might print as 16300 16301@smallexample 16302(3 => 10, 17, 1) 16303@end smallexample 16304 16305@noindent 16306That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>} 16307clause. 16308 16309@item 16310You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique, 16311multi-character subsequence of 16312their names (an exact match gets preference). 16313For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh} 16314in place of @t{a'length}. 16315 16316@item 16317@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers 16318Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type 16319to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for 16320some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users. 16321For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them, 16322enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping. 16323For example, 16324@smallexample 16325(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0] 16326@end smallexample 16327 16328@item 16329Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an 16330access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's 16331specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component 16332selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the 16333object. 16334 16335@end itemize 16336 16337@node Overloading support for Ada 16338@subsubsection Overloading support for Ada 16339@cindex overloading, Ada 16340 16341The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which 16342the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of 16343actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow 16344the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring 16345procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and 16346functions to procedures elsewhere. 16347 16348If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than 16349one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should 16350use, for instance: 16351 16352@smallexample 16353(@value{GDBP}) print f(1) 16354Multiple matches for f 16355[0] cancel 16356[1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23 16357[2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28 16358> 16359@end smallexample 16360 16361In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation 16362(type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific 16363instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}). 16364 16365Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this 16366case: 16367 16368@table @code 16369 16370@kindex set ada print-signatures 16371@item set ada print-signatures 16372Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads 16373selection menus. It is @code{on} by default. 16374@xref{Overloading support for Ada}. 16375 16376@kindex show ada print-signatures 16377@item show ada print-signatures 16378Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in 16379overloads selection menu. 16380@xref{Overloading support for Ada}. 16381 16382@end table 16383 16384@node Stopping Before Main Program 16385@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning 16386 16387@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code 16388It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and 16389before reaching the main procedure. 16390As defined in the Ada Reference 16391Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called 16392@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of 16393elaboration, simply use the following two commands: 16394@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}. 16395 16396@node Ada Exceptions 16397@subsubsection Ada Exceptions 16398 16399A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions: 16400 16401@table @code 16402@kindex info exceptions 16403@item info exceptions 16404@itemx info exceptions @var{regexp} 16405The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions 16406defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses. 16407With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions 16408whose names match @var{regexp} are listed. 16409@end table 16410 16411Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first 16412without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an 16413argument. 16414 16415@smallexample 16416(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions 16417All defined Ada exceptions: 16418constraint_error: 0x613da0 16419program_error: 0x613d20 16420storage_error: 0x613ce0 16421tasking_error: 0x613ca0 16422const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00 16423(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint 16424All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint": 16425constraint_error: 0x613da0 16426const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00 16427@end smallexample 16428 16429It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution 16430when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}. 16431 16432@node Ada Tasks 16433@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks 16434@cindex Ada, tasking 16435 16436Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}). 16437@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands: 16438 16439@table @code 16440@kindex info tasks 16441@item info tasks 16442This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example: 16443 16444 16445@smallexample 16446@iftex 16447@leftskip=0.5cm 16448@end iftex 16449(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16450 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16451 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16452 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b 16453 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a 16454* 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c 16455 16456@end smallexample 16457 16458@noindent 16459In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the 16460task currently being inspected. 16461 16462@table @asis 16463@item ID 16464Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number. 16465 16466@item TID 16467The Ada task ID. 16468 16469@item P-ID 16470The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number). 16471 16472@item Pri 16473The base priority of the task. 16474 16475@item State 16476Current state of the task. 16477 16478@table @code 16479@item Unactivated 16480The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be 16481executing. 16482 16483@item Runnable 16484The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting 16485for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode. 16486 16487@item Terminated 16488The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents 16489that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have 16490terminated themselves. 16491 16492@item Child Activation Wait 16493The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation. 16494 16495@item Accept Statement 16496The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement. 16497 16498@item Waiting on entry call 16499The task is waiting on an entry call. 16500 16501@item Async Select Wait 16502The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous 16503select statement. 16504 16505@item Delay Sleep 16506The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay 16507alternative open. 16508 16509@item Child Termination Wait 16510The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is 16511waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or 16512waiting on a terminate Phase. 16513 16514@item Wait Child in Term Alt 16515The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to 16516finish terminating. 16517 16518@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno} 16519The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}. 16520@end table 16521 16522@item Name 16523Name of the task in the program. 16524 16525@end table 16526 16527@kindex info task @var{taskno} 16528@item info task @var{taskno} 16529This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in 16530the following example: 16531@smallexample 16532@iftex 16533@leftskip=0.5cm 16534@end iftex 16535(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16536 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16537 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16538* 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1 16539(@value{GDBP}) info task 2 16540Ada Task: 0x807c468 16541Name: task_1 16542Thread: 0x807f378 16543Parent: 1 (main_task) 16544Base Priority: 15 16545State: Runnable 16546@end smallexample 16547 16548@item task 16549@kindex task@r{ (Ada)} 16550@cindex current Ada task ID 16551This command prints the ID of the current task. 16552 16553@smallexample 16554@iftex 16555@leftskip=0.5cm 16556@end iftex 16557(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16558 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16559 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16560* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t 16561(@value{GDBP}) task 16562[Current task is 2] 16563@end smallexample 16564 16565@item task @var{taskno} 16566@cindex Ada task switching 16567This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}} 16568command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging 16569from the current task to the given task. 16570 16571@smallexample 16572@iftex 16573@leftskip=0.5cm 16574@end iftex 16575(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16576 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16577 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16578* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t 16579(@value{GDBP}) task 1 16580[Switching to task 1] 16581#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait () 16582(@value{GDBP}) bt 16583#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait () 16584#1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait () 16585#2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep () 16586#3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks () 16587#4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5 16588@end smallexample 16589 16590@item break @var{location} task @var{taskno} 16591@itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{} 16592@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada 16593@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada 16594@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)} 16595These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}} 16596command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The 16597@var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described 16598in @ref{Specify Location}. 16599 16600Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command 16601to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a 16602particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the 16603numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first 16604column of the @samp{info tasks} display. 16605 16606If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a 16607breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your 16608program. 16609 16610You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as 16611well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the 16612breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}). 16613 16614For example, 16615 16616@smallexample 16617@iftex 16618@leftskip=0.5cm 16619@end iftex 16620(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16621 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16622 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16623 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2 16624 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1 16625* 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3 16626(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2 16627Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15. 16628(@value{GDBP}) cont 16629Continuing. 16630task # 1 running 16631task # 2 running 16632 16633Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15 1663415 flush; 16635(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16636 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16637 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16638* 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2 16639 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1 16640 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3 16641@end smallexample 16642@end table 16643 16644@node Ada Tasks and Core Files 16645@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files 16646@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging 16647 16648When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program, 16649tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on 16650the platform being used. 16651For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task 16652switching is not supported. 16653 16654On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some 16655memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting 16656a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write 16657privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}). 16658Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core 16659file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}. 16660 16661@node Ravenscar Profile 16662@subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile 16663@cindex Ravenscar Profile 16664 16665The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features, 16666specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time 16667requirements. 16668 16669@table @code 16670@kindex set ravenscar task-switching on 16671@cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile 16672@item set ravenscar task-switching on 16673Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar 16674Profile. This is the default. 16675 16676@kindex set ravenscar task-switching off 16677@item set ravenscar task-switching off 16678Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar 16679Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support 16680for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in 16681the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly. 16682To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started. 16683 16684@kindex show ravenscar task-switching 16685@item show ravenscar task-switching 16686Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program 16687using the Ravenscar Profile. 16688 16689@end table 16690 16691@node Ada Glitches 16692@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode 16693@cindex Ada, problems 16694 16695Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}), 16696we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in 16697@value{GDBN}, 16698some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger 16699and the GNU Ada compiler. 16700 16701@itemize @bullet 16702@item 16703Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in 16704storage are invisible to the debugger. 16705 16706@item 16707Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the 16708argument lists are treated as positional). 16709 16710@item 16711Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger. 16712 16713@item 16714Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using 16715floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on 16716the host machine. 16717 16718@item 16719The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of 16720the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about 16721this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never 16722look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against 16723symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have 16724defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and 16725local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard}, 16726GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens, 16727you can usually resolve the confusion 16728by qualifying the problematic names with package 16729@code{Standard} explicitly. 16730@end itemize 16731 16732Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging 16733information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value 16734of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work 16735around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able 16736to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically 16737enabled. 16738 16739@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS 16740@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS 16741@table @code 16742 16743@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on 16744Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the 16745value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS} 16746types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for 16747a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler). 16748This is the default. 16749 16750@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off 16751This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN} 16752sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada 16753trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix 16754the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to 16755@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is 16756recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary. 16757 16758@end table 16759 16760@cindex GNAT descriptive types 16761@cindex GNAT encoding 16762Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number 16763of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in 16764@file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes 16765how the debugging information should be generated for certain types. 16766In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types}, 16767which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger. 16768 16769These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information 16770format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex 16771types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all 16772Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive 16773types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition, 16774a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore 16775those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how 16776well @value{GDBN} works without them. 16777 16778@table @code 16779 16780@kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types 16781@item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off] 16782Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types. 16783The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}). 16784 16785@kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types 16786@item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types 16787Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}. 16788 16789@end table 16790 16791@node Unsupported Languages 16792@section Unsupported Languages 16793 16794@cindex unsupported languages 16795@cindex minimal language 16796In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages, 16797@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}. 16798It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set 16799of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide. 16800This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging 16801an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}. 16802 16803If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically 16804select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported 16805language. 16806 16807@node Symbols 16808@chapter Examining the Symbol Table 16809 16810The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the 16811symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your 16812program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and 16813does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your 16814program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN} 16815(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the 16816file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 16817 16818@cindex symbol names 16819@cindex names of symbols 16820@cindex quoting names 16821Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual 16822characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The 16823most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other 16824source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names 16825are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would 16826ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words 16827@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize 16828@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example, 16829 16830@smallexample 16831p 'foo.c'::x 16832@end smallexample 16833 16834@noindent 16835looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}. 16836 16837@table @code 16838@cindex case-insensitive symbol names 16839@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names 16840@kindex set case-sensitive 16841@item set case-sensitive on 16842@itemx set case-sensitive off 16843@itemx set case-sensitive auto 16844Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names 16845with case sensitivity determined by the current source language. 16846Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set 16847case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for 16848case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If 16849you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default 16850suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive 16851matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is 16852case-insensitive matches. 16853 16854@kindex show case-sensitive 16855@item show case-sensitive 16856This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols 16857lookups. 16858 16859@kindex set print type methods 16860@item set print type methods 16861@itemx set print type methods on 16862@itemx set print type methods off 16863Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods 16864declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by 16865passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set 16866print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to 16867display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will 16868cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods. 16869 16870@kindex show print type methods 16871@item show print type methods 16872This command shows the current setting of method display when printing 16873classes. 16874 16875@kindex set print type typedefs 16876@item set print type typedefs 16877@itemx set print type typedefs on 16878@itemx set print type typedefs off 16879 16880Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs 16881defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by 16882passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set 16883print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to 16884display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying 16885@code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions. 16886Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is 16887printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other 16888types. 16889 16890@kindex show print type typedefs 16891@item show print type typedefs 16892This command shows the current setting of typedef display when 16893printing classes. 16894 16895@kindex info address 16896@cindex address of a symbol 16897@item info address @var{symbol} 16898Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register 16899variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register 16900local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable 16901is always stored. 16902 16903Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work 16904at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints 16905the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable. 16906 16907@kindex info symbol 16908@cindex symbol from address 16909@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address 16910@item info symbol @var{addr} 16911Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}. 16912If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the 16913nearest symbol and an offset from it: 16914 16915@smallexample 16916(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320 16917_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text 16918@end smallexample 16919 16920@noindent 16921This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use 16922it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address. 16923 16924For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared 16925library containing the symbol is also printed: 16926 16927@smallexample 16928(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225 16929_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out 16930(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf 16931__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6 16932@end smallexample 16933 16934@kindex demangle 16935@cindex demangle 16936@item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name} 16937Demangle @var{name}. 16938If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle 16939@var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language. 16940 16941The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options, 16942and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash. 16943 16944The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind 16945of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}. 16946 16947@kindex whatis 16948@item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}] 16949Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression 16950or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of 16951@code{$}, the last value in the value history. 16952 16953If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it 16954is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as 16955assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. 16956 16957If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its 16958literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was 16959defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print 16960the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the 16961variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as 16962@code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their 16963fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class} 16964name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of 16965such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}. 16966 16967If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef}, 16968@code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}. 16969Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used 16970in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that 16971underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not 16972unroll it. 16973 16974For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class 16975@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union 16976@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}. 16977 16978@var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed. 16979Available flags are: 16980 16981@table @code 16982@item r 16983Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template 16984parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class' 16985members. The @code{/r} flag disables this. 16986 16987@item m 16988Do not print methods defined in the class. 16989 16990@item M 16991Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag 16992exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}. 16993 16994@item t 16995Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls 16996whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef 16997names are substituted when printing other types. 16998 16999@item T 17000Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag 17001exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}. 17002@end table 17003 17004@kindex ptype 17005@item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}] 17006@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a 17007detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type. 17008@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 17009 17010Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any 17011@code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is 17012a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype} 17013of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as 17014present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at 17015the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of 17016fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s, 17017@code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}. 17018 17019For example, for this variable declaration: 17020 17021@smallexample 17022typedef double real_t; 17023struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @}; 17024typedef struct complex complex_t; 17025complex_t var; 17026real_t *real_pointer_var; 17027@end smallexample 17028 17029@noindent 17030the two commands give this output: 17031 17032@smallexample 17033@group 17034(@value{GDBP}) whatis var 17035type = complex_t 17036(@value{GDBP}) ptype var 17037type = struct complex @{ 17038 real_t real; 17039 double imag; 17040@} 17041(@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t 17042type = struct complex 17043(@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex 17044type = struct complex 17045(@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex 17046type = struct complex @{ 17047 real_t real; 17048 double imag; 17049@} 17050(@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var 17051type = real_t * 17052(@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var 17053type = double * 17054@end group 17055@end smallexample 17056 17057@noindent 17058As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to 17059the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history. 17060 17061@cindex incomplete type 17062Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications 17063of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the 17064program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of 17065the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example, 17066given these declarations: 17067 17068@smallexample 17069 struct foo; 17070 struct foo *fooptr; 17071@end smallexample 17072 17073@noindent 17074but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say: 17075 17076@smallexample 17077 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo 17078 $1 = <incomplete type> 17079@end smallexample 17080 17081@noindent 17082``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not 17083completely specified. 17084 17085@kindex info types 17086@item info types @var{regexp} 17087@itemx info types 17088Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular 17089expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply 17090no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a 17091complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all 17092types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but 17093@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete 17094name is @code{value}. 17095 17096This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like 17097@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it 17098lists all source files where a type is defined. 17099 17100@kindex info type-printers 17101@item info type-printers 17102Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may 17103have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or 17104@command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type 17105is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing 17106type printers. 17107 17108@code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers. 17109 17110@kindex enable type-printer 17111@kindex disable type-printer 17112@item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{} 17113@item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{} 17114These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers. 17115 17116@kindex info scope 17117@cindex local variables 17118@item info scope @var{location} 17119List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command 17120accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or 17121an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local 17122to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for 17123details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example: 17124 17125@smallexample 17126(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler} 17127Scope for command_line_handler: 17128Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4. 17129Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4. 17130Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4. 17131Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4. 17132Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4. 17133Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4. 17134Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4. 17135@end smallexample 17136 17137@noindent 17138This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect 17139during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions, 17140collect}. 17141 17142@kindex info source 17143@item info source 17144Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for 17145the function containing the current point of execution: 17146@itemize @bullet 17147@item 17148the name of the source file, and the directory containing it, 17149@item 17150the directory it was compiled in, 17151@item 17152its length, in lines, 17153@item 17154which programming language it is written in, 17155@item 17156if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file 17157(which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments), 17158@item 17159whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and 17160if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and 17161@item 17162whether the debugging information includes information about 17163preprocessor macros. 17164@end itemize 17165 17166 17167@kindex info sources 17168@item info sources 17169Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is 17170debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols 17171have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed. 17172 17173@kindex info functions 17174@item info functions 17175Print the names and data types of all defined functions. 17176 17177@item info functions @var{regexp} 17178Print the names and data types of all defined functions 17179whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}. 17180Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names 17181include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names 17182start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters 17183that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@: 17184@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash. 17185 17186@kindex info variables 17187@item info variables 17188Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined 17189outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables). 17190 17191@item info variables @var{regexp} 17192Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local 17193variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression 17194@var{regexp}. 17195 17196@kindex info classes 17197@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors 17198@item info classes 17199@itemx info classes @var{regexp} 17200Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or 17201(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular 17202expression. 17203 17204@kindex info selectors 17205@item info selectors 17206@itemx info selectors @var{regexp} 17207Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or 17208(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular 17209expression. 17210 17211@ignore 17212This was never implemented. 17213@kindex info methods 17214@item info methods 17215@itemx info methods @var{regexp} 17216The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined 17217methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a 17218specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many 17219C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output 17220from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The 17221@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those 17222which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}. 17223@end ignore 17224 17225@cindex opaque data types 17226@kindex set opaque-type-resolution 17227@item set opaque-type-resolution on 17228Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type 17229declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or 17230@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one 17231source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in 17232another source file. The default is on. 17233 17234A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until 17235the next time symbols for a file are loaded. 17236 17237@item set opaque-type-resolution off 17238Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type 17239is printed as follows: 17240@smallexample 17241@{<no data fields>@} 17242@end smallexample 17243 17244@kindex show opaque-type-resolution 17245@item show opaque-type-resolution 17246Show whether opaque types are resolved or not. 17247 17248@kindex set print symbol-loading 17249@cindex print messages when symbols are loaded 17250@item set print symbol-loading 17251@itemx set print symbol-loading full 17252@itemx set print symbol-loading brief 17253@itemx set print symbol-loading off 17254The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the 17255printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information. 17256By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each 17257shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when 17258debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages 17259can be annoying. 17260When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable, 17261and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once 17262it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared 17263libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed. 17264 17265@kindex show print symbol-loading 17266@item show print symbol-loading 17267Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command 17268entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded. 17269 17270@kindex maint print symbols 17271@cindex symbol dump 17272@kindex maint print psymbols 17273@cindex partial symbol dump 17274@kindex maint print msymbols 17275@cindex minimal symbol dump 17276@item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 17277@itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 17278@itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 17279@itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 17280@itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 17281Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or 17282the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified. 17283If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for 17284that objfile. 17285If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file 17286with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like 17287@code{main}. 17288If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that 17289source file. 17290 17291These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. 17292These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore 17293@samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol 17294tables. 17295You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. 17296If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information 17297about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols 17298defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. 17299Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g., 17300``ELF symbols''. 17301 17302@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how 17303@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}). 17304 17305@kindex maint info symtabs 17306@kindex maint info psymtabs 17307@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables 17308@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17309@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17310@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17311@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 17312@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 17313 17314List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab} 17315structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not 17316given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can 17317copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular 17318structure in more detail. For example: 17319 17320@smallexample 17321(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read 17322@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb 17323 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0) 17324 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c 17325 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10) 17326 readin no 17327 fullname (null) 17328 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074 17329 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9) 17330 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882) 17331 dependencies (none) 17332 @} 17333@} 17334(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs 17335(@value{GDBP}) 17336@end smallexample 17337@noindent 17338We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains 17339the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable; 17340and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all. 17341If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to 17342read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function: 17343 17344@smallexample 17345(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab 17346Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c, 17347line 1574. 17348(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs 17349@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb 17350 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0) 17351 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c 17352 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38) 17353 dirname (null) 17354 fullname (null) 17355 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary) 17356 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0) 17357 debugformat DWARF 2 17358 @} 17359@} 17360(@value{GDBP}) 17361@end smallexample 17362 17363@kindex maint info line-table 17364@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables 17365@cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17366@item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 17367 17368List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab} 17369instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not 17370given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}. 17371 17372@kindex maint set symbol-cache-size 17373@cindex symbol cache size 17374@item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size} 17375Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}. 17376The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging 17377most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting 17378with different sizes. 17379 17380@kindex maint show symbol-cache-size 17381@item maint show symbol-cache-size 17382Show the size of the symbol cache. 17383 17384@kindex maint print symbol-cache 17385@cindex symbol cache, printing its contents 17386@item maint print symbol-cache 17387Print the contents of the symbol cache. 17388This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues. 17389 17390@kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics 17391@cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics 17392@item maint print symbol-cache-statistics 17393Print symbol cache usage statistics. 17394This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized. 17395 17396@kindex maint flush-symbol-cache 17397@cindex symbol cache, flushing 17398@item maint flush-symbol-cache 17399Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed. 17400This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache. 17401It is also useful when collecting performance data. 17402 17403@end table 17404 17405@node Altering 17406@chapter Altering Execution 17407 17408Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to 17409find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to 17410correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by 17411experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the 17412program. 17413 17414For example, you can store new values into variables or memory 17415locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different 17416address, or even return prematurely from a function. 17417 17418@menu 17419* Assignment:: Assignment to variables 17420* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address 17421* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal 17422* Returning:: Returning from a function 17423* Calling:: Calling your program's functions 17424* Patching:: Patching your program 17425* Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN} 17426@end menu 17427 17428@node Assignment 17429@section Assignment to Variables 17430 17431@cindex assignment 17432@cindex setting variables 17433To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression. 17434@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example, 17435 17436@smallexample 17437print x=4 17438@end smallexample 17439 17440@noindent 17441stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the 17442value of the assignment expression (which is 4). 17443@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more 17444information on operators in supported languages. 17445 17446@kindex set variable 17447@cindex variables, setting 17448If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the 17449@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is 17450really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is 17451not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History, 17452,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects. 17453 17454If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command 17455appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set 17456variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical 17457to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your 17458program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set 17459a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the 17460command @code{set width}: 17461 17462@smallexample 17463(@value{GDBP}) whatis width 17464type = double 17465(@value{GDBP}) p width 17466$4 = 13 17467(@value{GDBP}) set width=47 17468Invalid syntax in expression. 17469@end smallexample 17470 17471@noindent 17472The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In 17473order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use 17474 17475@smallexample 17476(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47 17477@end smallexample 17478 17479Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict 17480with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the 17481@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if 17482your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try 17483to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has 17484the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}: 17485 17486@smallexample 17487@group 17488(@value{GDBP}) whatis g 17489type = double 17490(@value{GDBP}) p g 17491$1 = 1 17492(@value{GDBP}) set g=4 17493(@value{GDBP}) p g 17494$2 = 1 17495(@value{GDBP}) r 17496The program being debugged has been started already. 17497Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y 17498Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out 17499"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: 17500 Invalid bfd target. 17501(@value{GDBP}) show g 17502The current BFD target is "=4". 17503@end group 17504@end smallexample 17505 17506@noindent 17507The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the 17508@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable 17509@code{g}, use 17510 17511@smallexample 17512(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4 17513@end smallexample 17514 17515@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can 17516freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa, 17517and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the 17518same length or shorter. 17519@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions? 17520@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990 17521 17522To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}} 17523construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address 17524(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers 17525to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size 17526and representation in memory), and 17527 17528@smallexample 17529set @{int@}0x83040 = 4 17530@end smallexample 17531 17532@noindent 17533stores the value 4 into that memory location. 17534 17535@node Jumping 17536@section Continuing at a Different Address 17537 17538Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where 17539it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at 17540an address of your own choosing, with the following commands: 17541 17542@table @code 17543@kindex jump 17544@kindex j @r{(@code{jump})} 17545@item jump @var{location} 17546@itemx j @var{location} 17547Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately 17548if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description 17549of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common 17550practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with 17551@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. 17552 17553The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or 17554the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any 17555register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in 17556a different function from the one currently executing, the results may 17557be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or 17558of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests 17559confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently 17560executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are 17561well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program. 17562@end table 17563 17564On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump} 17565command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The 17566difference is that this does not start your program running; it only 17567changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For 17568example, 17569 17570@smallexample 17571set $pc = 0x485 17572@end smallexample 17573 17574@noindent 17575makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at 17576address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped. 17577@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}. 17578 17579The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back 17580up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program 17581that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more 17582detail. 17583 17584@c @group 17585@node Signaling 17586@section Giving your Program a Signal 17587@cindex deliver a signal to a program 17588 17589@table @code 17590@kindex signal 17591@item signal @var{signal} 17592Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the 17593signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a 17594signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal 17595SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal. 17596 17597Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without 17598giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of 17599a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the 17600@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a 17601signal. 17602 17603@emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is 17604delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last 17605reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was 17606stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution 17607suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that 17608same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue 17609the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one, 17610@value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation. 17611 17612Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the 17613@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill} 17614causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on 17615the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command 17616passes the signal directly to your program. 17617 17618@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time 17619after executing the command. 17620 17621@kindex queue-signal 17622@item queue-signal @var{signal} 17623Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread 17624when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or 17625the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and 17626@code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal. 17627The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program, 17628otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. 17629You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the 17630@code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}). 17631 17632Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal 17633for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal 17634will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account 17635of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the 17636@code{continue} command. 17637 17638This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal 17639is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot 17640be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass} 17641(@pxref{Signals}). 17642@end table 17643@c @end group 17644 17645@xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping 17646commands behave when the thread has a signal queued. 17647 17648@node Returning 17649@section Returning from a Function 17650 17651@table @code 17652@cindex returning from a function 17653@kindex return 17654@item return 17655@itemx return @var{expression} 17656You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return} 17657command. If you give an 17658@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return 17659value. 17660@end table 17661 17662When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame 17663(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the 17664discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to 17665be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}. 17666 17667This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a 17668Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the 17669innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The 17670specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values 17671of functions. 17672 17673The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the 17674program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just 17675returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing 17676and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the 17677selected stack frame returns naturally. 17678 17679@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for 17680the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the 17681type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for 17682OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in 17683CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU 17684registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have 17685specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its 17686current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the 17687assignment into the right register(s). 17688 17689Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always 17690use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the 17691debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the 17692function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long 17693int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1 17694into a @code{long long int}: 17695 17696@smallexample 17697Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29 1769829 return 31; 17699(@value{GDBP}) return -1 17700Make func return now? (y or n) y 17701#0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43 1770243 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ()); 17703(@value{GDBP}) 17704@end smallexample 17705 17706However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the 17707function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type 17708to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value 17709in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example, 17710typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part 17711of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit 17712architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by 17713an appropriate cast explicitly: 17714 17715@smallexample 17716Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func () 17717(@value{GDBP}) return -1 17718Return value type not available for selected stack frame. 17719Please use an explicit cast of the value to return. 17720(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1 17721Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y 17722#0 0x00400526 in main () 17723(@value{GDBP}) 17724@end smallexample 17725 17726@node Calling 17727@section Calling Program Functions 17728 17729@table @code 17730@cindex calling functions 17731@cindex inferior functions, calling 17732@item print @var{expr} 17733Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value. 17734The expression may include calls to functions in the program being 17735debugged. 17736 17737@kindex call 17738@item call @var{expr} 17739Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void} 17740returned values. 17741 17742You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to 17743execute a function from your program that does not return anything 17744(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output 17745with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise 17746print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the 17747value history. 17748@end table 17749 17750It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or 17751@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in 17752the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens 17753in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command. 17754 17755Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you 17756call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an 17757exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy 17758frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has 17759an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a 17760dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot 17761seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens 17762in that case is controlled by the 17763@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command. 17764 17765@table @code 17766@item set unwindonsignal 17767@kindex set unwindonsignal 17768@cindex unwind stack in called functions 17769@cindex call dummy stack unwinding 17770Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function 17771that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on, 17772@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores 17773the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the 17774default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was 17775received. 17776 17777@item show unwindonsignal 17778@kindex show unwindonsignal 17779Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by 17780@value{GDBN}. 17781 17782@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception 17783@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception 17784@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions 17785@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception. 17786Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left 17787unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being 17788debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack 17789it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before 17790the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to 17791the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated. 17792 17793@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception 17794@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception 17795Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by 17796@value{GDBN}. 17797 17798@end table 17799 17800@cindex weak alias functions 17801Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias} 17802for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up 17803the type information, including the types of the function arguments, 17804which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly. 17805As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may 17806even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased 17807function instead. 17808 17809@node Patching 17810@section Patching Programs 17811 17812@cindex patching binaries 17813@cindex writing into executables 17814@cindex writing into corefiles 17815 17816By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's 17817executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental 17818alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally 17819patching your program's binary. 17820 17821If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that 17822explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might 17823want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency 17824repairs. 17825 17826@table @code 17827@kindex set write 17828@item set write on 17829@itemx set write off 17830If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and 17831core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write 17832off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only. 17833 17834If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the 17835@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set 17836write}, for your new setting to take effect. 17837 17838@item show write 17839@kindex show write 17840Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing 17841as well as reading. 17842@end table 17843 17844@node Compiling and Injecting Code 17845@section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN} 17846@cindex injecting code 17847@cindex writing into executables 17848@cindex compiling code 17849 17850@value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into 17851programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with 17852@file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled. 17853This functionality is implemented with the following commands. 17854 17855@table @code 17856@kindex compile code 17857@item compile code @var{source-code} 17858@itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code} 17859Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current 17860language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and 17861injection is not supported with the current language specified in 17862@value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error 17863message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links 17864successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted, 17865and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior. 17866It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately. 17867After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any 17868new types or variables you have defined will be deleted. 17869 17870The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways. 17871The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command. 17872E.g.: 17873 17874@smallexample 17875compile code printf ("hello world\n"); 17876@end smallexample 17877 17878If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they 17879may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options 17880from actual source code. E.g.: 17881 17882@smallexample 17883compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n"); 17884@end smallexample 17885 17886Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To 17887enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text 17888following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and 17889allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you 17890have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the 17891editor. 17892 17893@smallexample 17894compile code 17895>printf ("hello\n"); 17896>printf ("world\n"); 17897>end 17898@end smallexample 17899 17900Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the 17901provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must 17902specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named 17903@code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the 17904inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when 17905@var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with 17906inferior symbols otherwise. 17907 17908@kindex compile file 17909@item compile file @var{filename} 17910@itemx compile file -raw @var{filename} 17911Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}. 17912 17913@smallexample 17914compile file /home/user/example.c 17915@end smallexample 17916@end table 17917 17918@table @code 17919@item compile print @var{expr} 17920@itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr} 17921Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the 17922current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the 17923value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type; 17924you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where 17925@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output 17926Formats}. 17927 17928@item compile print 17929@itemx compile print /@var{f} 17930@cindex reprint the last value 17931Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as 17932multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print} 17933command without any text following the command. This will start the 17934multiple-line editor. 17935@end table 17936 17937@noindent 17938The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using: 17939 17940@table @code 17941@anchor{set debug compile} 17942@item set debug compile 17943@cindex compile command debugging info 17944Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and 17945injecting the code. The default is off. 17946 17947@item show debug compile 17948Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of 17949compiling and injecting the code. 17950@end table 17951 17952@subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command 17953 17954@value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code 17955to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior 17956and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s 17957injecting process. 17958 17959@noindent 17960The options used, in increasing precedence: 17961 17962@table @asis 17963@item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch}) 17964These options depend on target processor type and target operating 17965system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit 17966(@code{-m64}) compilation option. 17967 17968@item compilation options recorded in the target 17969@value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation 17970into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according 17971to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to 17972explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise 17973@value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for 17974platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may 17975try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}. 17976 17977@item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args} 17978@end table 17979 17980@noindent 17981You can override compilation options using the following command: 17982 17983@table @code 17984@item set compile-args 17985@cindex compile command options override 17986Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the 17987@code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones 17988from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior 17989compilation. 17990 17991@item show compile-args 17992Displays the current state of compilation options override. 17993This does not show all the options actually used during compilation, 17994use @ref{set debug compile} for that. 17995@end table 17996 17997@subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command 17998 17999There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile} 18000command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below 18001highlights specific issues on a per language basis. 18002 18003@table @asis 18004@item C code examples and caveats 18005When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will 18006attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source 18007code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same 18008access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of 18009the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}. 18010 18011Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that 18012follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN}, 18013much like any other normal debugging session. 18014 18015@smallexample 18016void function1 (void) 18017@{ 18018 int i = 42; 18019 printf ("function 1\n"); 18020@} 18021 18022void function2 (void) 18023@{ 18024 int j = 12; 18025 function1 (); 18026@} 18027 18028int main(void) 18029@{ 18030 int k = 6; 18031 int *p; 18032 function2 (); 18033 return 0; 18034@} 18035@end smallexample 18036 18037For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has 18038been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function 18039@code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user. 18040 18041To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the 18042program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The 18043@code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug 18044information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will 18045be very limited in what variables and types you can access. 18046 18047So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug 18048information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to 18049all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized 18050out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the 18051@code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to 18052the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command 18053and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also 18054read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in 18055@code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the 18056@code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example: 18057 18058@smallexample 18059compile code k = 3; 18060@end smallexample 18061 18062@noindent 18063the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until 18064something else in the example program changes it, or another 18065@code{compile} command changes it. 18066 18067Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and 18068injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables 18069@code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is 18070currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables 18071are not in scope. Therefore, the following command 18072 18073@smallexample 18074compile code j = 3; 18075@end smallexample 18076 18077@noindent 18078will result in a compilation error message. 18079 18080Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in 18081scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via 18082the @code{compile} command will be able to access them. 18083 18084You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as 18085part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part 18086of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for 18087the duration of its run. This example is valid: 18088 18089@smallexample 18090compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff); 18091@end smallexample 18092 18093However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that 18094command has completed: 18095 18096@smallexample 18097compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff); 18098@end smallexample 18099 18100@noindent 18101a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer 18102exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile} 18103command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised 18104when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the 18105code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid: 18106 18107@smallexample 18108compile code int ff = 5; k = ff; 18109@end smallexample 18110 18111The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable 18112@code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value 18113it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in 18114assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command 18115changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a 18116variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point 18117to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example 18118would likely cause issues with your debugged program: 18119 18120@smallexample 18121compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff; 18122@end smallexample 18123 18124In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the 18125@code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it. 18126However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their 18127assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid 18128location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed 18129in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers, 18130or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits. 18131 18132Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs 18133defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile} 18134command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command. 18135Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the 18136@code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future 18137need to resolve the type can be achieved. 18138 18139@smallexample 18140(gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v; 18141(gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a); 18142gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’ 18143Compilation failed. 18144(gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a); 1814542 18146@end smallexample 18147 18148Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not 18149accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command. 18150Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN} 18151will print to the console. 18152@end table 18153 18154@subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command 18155 18156@value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which 18157may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where 18158@value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from 18159shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN} 18160command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on 18161@value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the 18162target architecture and operating system. 18163 18164Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression 18165@code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being 18166debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for 18167example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern 18168@code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look 18169for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for 18170pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}. 18171 18172@node GDB Files 18173@chapter @value{GDBN} Files 18174 18175@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged, 18176both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your 18177program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell 18178@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file. 18179 18180@menu 18181* Files:: Commands to specify files 18182* File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching 18183* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files 18184* MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section 18185* Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB 18186* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files 18187* Data Files:: GDB data files 18188@end menu 18189 18190@node Files 18191@section Commands to Specify Files 18192 18193@cindex symbol table 18194@cindex core dump file 18195 18196You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual 18197way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to 18198@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and 18199Out of @value{GDBN}}). 18200 18201Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a 18202@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to 18203specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target 18204via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver} 18205Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify 18206new files are useful. 18207 18208@table @code 18209@cindex executable file 18210@kindex file 18211@item file @var{filename} 18212Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its 18213symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program 18214executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a 18215directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory, 18216@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of 18217directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program 18218to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN} 18219and your program, using the @code{path} command. 18220 18221@cindex unlinked object files 18222@cindex patching object files 18223You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using 18224the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object 18225file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also, 18226if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use 18227@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note 18228that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this 18229case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to 18230the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time. 18231 18232@item file 18233@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it 18234has on both executable file and the symbol table. 18235 18236@kindex exec-file 18237@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]} 18238Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found 18239in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH} 18240if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to 18241discard information on the executable file. 18242 18243@kindex symbol-file 18244@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]} 18245Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is 18246searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol 18247table and program to run from the same file. 18248 18249@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your 18250program's symbol table. 18251 18252The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of 18253some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may 18254contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types, 18255which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside 18256@value{GDBN}. 18257 18258@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after 18259executing it once. 18260 18261When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it 18262understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard 18263generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or 18264other compilers that adhere to the local conventions. 18265Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example, 18266using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for 18267optimized code. 18268 18269For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems 18270using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the 18271symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table 18272quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The 18273details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed. 18274 18275The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN} 18276start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for 18277occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source 18278file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these 18279pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional 18280Warnings and Messages}.) 18281 18282We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the 18283symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the 18284symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF'' 18285still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually 18286in stabs format. 18287 18288@kindex readnow 18289@cindex reading symbols immediately 18290@cindex symbols, reading immediately 18291@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename} 18292@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename} 18293You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol 18294tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that 18295load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the 18296entire symbol table available. 18297 18298@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in 18299@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in 18300@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing 18301@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now 18302@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy 18303@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol 18304@c files. 18305 18306@kindex core-file 18307@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 18308@itemx core 18309Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents 18310of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the 18311address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the 18312executable file itself for other parts. 18313 18314@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is 18315to be used. 18316 18317Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running 18318under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you 18319wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which 18320the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command 18321(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}). 18322 18323@kindex add-symbol-file 18324@cindex dynamic linking 18325@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} 18326@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} 18327@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} 18328The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table 18329information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command 18330when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) 18331into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory 18332address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure 18333this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number 18334of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit 18335section name and base address for that section. You can specify any 18336@var{address} as an expression. 18337 18338The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table 18339originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the 18340@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data 18341thus read is kept in addition to the old. 18342 18343Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}. 18344 18345@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from 18346@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from 18347@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files 18348@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files 18349@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from 18350Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an 18351executable file, or some other object file which has been fully 18352relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic 18353information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as: 18354 18355@itemize @bullet 18356@item 18357the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in 18358that file, not to symbols defined by other object files, 18359@item 18360every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually 18361been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and 18362@item 18363you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and 18364provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command. 18365@end itemize 18366 18367@noindent 18368Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load 18369relocatable files into an already running program; such systems 18370typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's 18371important to recognize that many native systems use complex link 18372procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table 18373assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In 18374general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a 18375relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect 18376as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal 18377way. 18378 18379@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 18380 18381@kindex remove-symbol-file 18382@item remove-symbol-file @var{filename} 18383@item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address} 18384Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The 18385file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address} 18386that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example: 18387 18388@smallexample 18389(gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480 18390add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at 18391 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480 18392(y or n) y 18393Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done. 18394(gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480 18395Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y 18396(gdb) 18397@end smallexample 18398 18399 18400@code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 18401 18402@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory 18403@cindex @code{syscall DSO} 18404@cindex load symbols from memory 18405@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address} 18406Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded 18407object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory. 18408For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each 18409process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for 18410some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose 18411evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header. 18412For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or 18413@code{exec-file} commands in advance. 18414 18415@kindex section 18416@item section @var{section} @var{addr} 18417The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named 18418@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the 18419exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the 18420@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file 18421itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The 18422@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and 18423their addresses. 18424 18425@kindex info files 18426@kindex info target 18427@item info files 18428@itemx info target 18429@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the 18430current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}), 18431including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in 18432use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The 18433command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than 18434current ones. 18435 18436@kindex maint info sections 18437@item maint info sections 18438Another command that can give you extra information about program sections 18439is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information 18440displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file 18441offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition, 18442@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which 18443may be arbitrarily combined): 18444 18445@table @code 18446@item ALLOBJ 18447Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries. 18448@item @var{sections} 18449Display info only for named @var{sections}. 18450@item @var{section-flags} 18451Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true. 18452The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are: 18453@table @code 18454@item ALLOC 18455Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded. 18456Set for all sections except those containing debug information. 18457@item LOAD 18458Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory. 18459Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections. 18460@item RELOC 18461Section needs to be relocated before loading. 18462@item READONLY 18463Section cannot be modified by the child process. 18464@item CODE 18465Section contains executable code only. 18466@item DATA 18467Section contains data only (no executable code). 18468@item ROM 18469Section will reside in ROM. 18470@item CONSTRUCTOR 18471Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists. 18472@item HAS_CONTENTS 18473Section is not empty. 18474@item NEVER_LOAD 18475An instruction to the linker to not output the section. 18476@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY 18477A notification to the linker that the section contains 18478COFF shared library information. 18479@item IS_COMMON 18480Section contains common symbols. 18481@end table 18482@end table 18483@kindex set trust-readonly-sections 18484@cindex read-only sections 18485@item set trust-readonly-sections on 18486Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file 18487really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change). 18488In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections 18489out of the object file, rather than from the target program. 18490For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant 18491enhancement to debugging performance. 18492 18493The default is off. 18494 18495@item set trust-readonly-sections off 18496Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that 18497the contents of the section might change while the program is running, 18498and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed. 18499 18500@item show trust-readonly-sections 18501Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections. 18502@end table 18503 18504All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names 18505as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file 18506name and remembers it that way. 18507 18508@cindex shared libraries 18509@anchor{Shared Libraries} 18510@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS, 18511Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and 18512DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries. 18513 18514On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support 18515shared libraries. @xref{Expat}. 18516 18517@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries 18518when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file. 18519(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand 18520references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are 18521debugging a core file). 18522 18523@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef 18524@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared 18525@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual 18526 18527There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load 18528symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are 18529particularly large or there are many of them. 18530 18531To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the 18532commands: 18533 18534@table @code 18535@kindex set auto-solib-add 18536@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode} 18537If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries 18538will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you 18539attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker 18540informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode} 18541is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the 18542@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}. 18543 18544@cindex memory used for symbol tables 18545If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that 18546takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN} 18547memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the 18548symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set 18549auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each 18550library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary 18551@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches 18552the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded. 18553 18554@kindex show auto-solib-add 18555@item show auto-solib-add 18556Display the current autoloading mode. 18557@end table 18558 18559@cindex load shared library 18560To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary} 18561command: 18562 18563@table @code 18564@kindex info sharedlibrary 18565@kindex info share 18566@item info share @var{regex} 18567@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex} 18568Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded 18569that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print 18570all shared libraries that are loaded. 18571 18572@kindex info dll 18573@item info dll @var{regex} 18574This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}. 18575 18576@kindex sharedlibrary 18577@kindex share 18578@item sharedlibrary @var{regex} 18579@itemx share @var{regex} 18580Load shared object library symbols for files matching a 18581Unix regular expression. 18582As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries 18583required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If 18584@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are 18585loaded. 18586 18587@item nosharedlibrary 18588@kindex nosharedlibrary 18589@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries 18590Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols 18591that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared 18592libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not 18593discarded. 18594@end table 18595 18596Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control 18597when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is 18598to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set 18599Catchpoints}). 18600 18601@value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events} 18602command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is 18603less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for 18604conditions or commands as a catchpoint does. 18605 18606@table @code 18607@item set stop-on-solib-events 18608@kindex set stop-on-solib-events 18609This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control 18610when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event. 18611The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new 18612shared library. 18613 18614@item show stop-on-solib-events 18615@kindex show stop-on-solib-events 18616Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared 18617library events happen. 18618@end table 18619 18620Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging 18621configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries; 18622this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries 18623on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the 18624libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are 18625provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the 18626copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are 18627not. 18628 18629@cindex where to look for shared libraries 18630For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target 18631libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it 18632may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables 18633to specify the search directories for target libraries. 18634 18635@table @code 18636@cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names 18637@cindex system root, alternate 18638@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix 18639@kindex set sysroot 18640@item set sysroot @var{path} 18641Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any 18642absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many 18643runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the 18644target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when 18645attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their 18646executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to 18647@value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use 18648@code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need 18649to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with 18650e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under 18651@var{path}. 18652 18653If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target 18654system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries 18655from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote 18656target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File 18657Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path} 18658following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system 18659root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the 18660sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence 18661@file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the 18662functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was 18663provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want 18664to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be 18665named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some 18666equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}. 18667 18668For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and 18669SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target 18670absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts, 18671@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward 18672slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix: 18673 18674@smallexample 18675 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll 18676@end smallexample 18677 18678Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with 18679@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file 18680system: 18681 18682@smallexample 18683 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll 18684@end smallexample 18685 18686If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing 18687the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and, 18688for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with 18689colons: 18690 18691@smallexample 18692 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll 18693@end smallexample 18694 18695This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target 18696with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local 18697copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs 18698@samp{z}): 18699 18700@smallexample 18701 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll} 18702 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll} 18703 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll} 18704@end smallexample 18705 18706@noindent 18707and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that 18708@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both 18709@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}. 18710 18711If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries 18712removing the whole drive spec from the target file name: 18713 18714@smallexample 18715 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll 18716@end smallexample 18717 18718This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name, 18719if you don't want or need to. 18720 18721The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set 18722sysroot}. 18723 18724@cindex default system root 18725@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot} 18726You can set the default system root by using the configure-time 18727@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside 18728@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or 18729@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated 18730automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 18731location. 18732 18733@kindex show sysroot 18734@item show sysroot 18735Display the current executable and shared library prefix. 18736 18737@kindex set solib-search-path 18738@item set solib-search-path @var{path} 18739If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 18740directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} 18741is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the 18742path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to 18743use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set 18744@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from 18745finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting 18746it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading 18747of shared library symbols. 18748 18749@kindex show solib-search-path 18750@item show solib-search-path 18751Display the current shared library search path. 18752 18753@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names. 18754@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto) 18755@kindex show target-file-system-kind 18756@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind} 18757Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names. 18758 18759Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not 18760make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For 18761example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file 18762system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to 18763@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as 18764@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of 18765drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as 18766indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash 18767normally considered a directory separator character. In that case, 18768the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name 18769as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make 18770it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's 18771shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical 18772with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting 18773@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN} 18774to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to 18775map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system 18776semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition 18777to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN} 18778tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the 18779current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the 18780Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are: 18781 18782@table @code 18783@item unix 18784Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix 18785kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character 18786are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also 18787the forward slash. 18788 18789@item dos-based 18790Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based. 18791File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter 18792followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and 18793both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are 18794considered directory separators. 18795 18796@item auto 18797Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the 18798target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}). 18799This is the default. 18800@end table 18801@end table 18802 18803@cindex file name canonicalization 18804@cindex base name differences 18805When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN} 18806frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the 18807program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the 18808@dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast 18809even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last 18810portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.) 18811This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files 18812cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but 18813references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem 18814facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files 18815using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN} 18816using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to 18817@code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each 18818pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name 18819comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown. 18820 18821@table @code 18822@item set basenames-may-differ 18823@kindex set basenames-may-differ 18824Set whether a source file may have multiple base names. 18825 18826@item show basenames-may-differ 18827@kindex show basenames-may-differ 18828Show whether a source file may have multiple base names. 18829@end table 18830 18831@node File Caching 18832@section File Caching 18833@cindex caching of opened files 18834@cindex caching of bfd objects 18835 18836To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will 18837reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, , 18838BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands 18839allow visibility and control of the caching behavior. 18840 18841@table @code 18842@kindex maint info bfds 18843@item maint info bfds 18844This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to 18845@value{GDBN}. 18846 18847@kindex maint set bfd-sharing 18848@kindex maint show bfd-sharing 18849@kindex bfd caching 18850@item maint set bfd-sharing 18851@item maint show bfd-sharing 18852Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is 18853enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather 18854than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause 18855already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files 18856that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly, 18857re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd} 18858objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object. 18859 18860@kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level} 18861@kindex bfd caching 18862@item set debug bfd-cache @var{level} 18863Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}. 18864 18865@kindex show debug bfd-cache 18866@kindex bfd caching 18867@item show debug bfd-cache 18868Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache. 18869@end table 18870 18871@node Separate Debug Files 18872@section Debugging Information in Separate Files 18873@cindex separate debugging information files 18874@cindex debugging information in separate files 18875@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories 18876@cindex debugging information directory, global 18877@cindex global debugging information directories 18878@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files 18879@cindex @file{.build-id} directory 18880 18881@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a 18882file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows 18883@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically. 18884Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger 18885than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging 18886information for their executables in separate files, which users can 18887install only when they need to debug a problem. 18888 18889@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info 18890file: 18891 18892@itemize @bullet 18893@item 18894The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of 18895the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is 18896usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the 18897name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories 18898(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the 18899debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC) 18900checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that 18901the executable and the debug file came from the same build. 18902 18903@item 18904The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is 18905also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported 18906only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats 18907for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about 18908this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id} 18909command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info, 18910The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified 18911explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see 18912below. 18913@end itemize 18914 18915Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN} 18916uses two different methods of looking for the debug file: 18917 18918@itemize @bullet 18919@item 18920For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in 18921the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that 18922directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug 18923directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading 18924directories of the executable's absolute file name. 18925 18926@item 18927For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the 18928@file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for 18929a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the 18930first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn} 18931are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more 18932hex characters, not 10.) 18933@end itemize 18934 18935So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug 18936@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the 18937file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is 18938@code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes 18939@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following 18940debug information files, in the indicated order: 18941 18942@itemize @minus 18943@item 18944@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug} 18945@item 18946@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug} 18947@item 18948@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug} 18949@item 18950@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}. 18951@end itemize 18952 18953@anchor{debug-file-directory} 18954Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN} 18955configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run 18956you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list 18957@value{GDBN} is currently using. 18958 18959@table @code 18960 18961@kindex set debug-file-directory 18962@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories} 18963Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging 18964information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set 18965concatenating them by a path separator. 18966 18967@kindex show debug-file-directory 18968@item show debug-file-directory 18969Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging 18970information files. 18971 18972@end table 18973 18974@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections 18975@cindex debug link sections 18976A debug link is a special section of the executable file named 18977@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain: 18978 18979@itemize 18980@item 18981A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by 18982a zero byte, 18983@item 18984zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte 18985boundary within the section, and 18986@item 18987a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the 18988executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging 18989information file's full contents by the function given below, passing 18990zero as the @var{crc} argument. 18991@end itemize 18992 18993Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can 18994contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents 18995described above. 18996 18997@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections 18998@cindex build ID sections 18999The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other 19000ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is 19001often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory. 19002It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains 19003the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default 19004algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the 19005content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical 19006value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its 19007stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file. 19008 19009The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary 19010executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and 19011debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file 19012should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file, 19013but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section 19014in an ordinary executable. 19015 19016The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the 19017@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce 19018the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the 19019following commands: 19020 19021@smallexample 19022@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug} 19023@kbd{strip -g foo} 19024@end smallexample 19025 19026@noindent 19027These commands remove the debugging 19028information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file 19029@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the 19030two files: 19031 19032@itemize @bullet 19033@item 19034The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave 19035behind a debug link in @file{foo}: 19036 19037@smallexample 19038@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo} 19039@end smallexample 19040 19041Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains 19042a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f 19043foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and 19044the @code{ln -s} command above, together. 19045 19046@item 19047Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or 19048the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus 19049compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary 19050utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18. 19051@end itemize 19052 19053@noindent 19054 19055@cindex CRC algorithm definition 19056The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in 19057IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial: 19058 19059@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex 19060@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using 19061@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2 19062@c different ways! 19063@ifhtml 19064@display 19065@html 19066 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup> 19067 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1 19068@end html 19069@end display 19070@end ifhtml 19071@ifnothtml 19072@display 19073 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}} 19074 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1} 19075@end display 19076@end ifnothtml 19077 19078The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least 19079significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern 19080@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and 19081the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the 19082CRC. 19083 19084@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the 19085@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}). 19086However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed 19087@emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so 19088trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value. 19089 19090To complete the description, we show below the code of the function 19091which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the 19092initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to 19093this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using 19094@code{0xffffffff}. 19095 19096@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32 19097@smallexample 19098unsigned long 19099gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc, 19100 unsigned char *buf, size_t len) 19101@{ 19102 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] = 19103 @{ 19104 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419, 19105 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4, 19106 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07, 19107 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de, 19108 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856, 19109 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9, 19110 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4, 19111 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b, 19112 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3, 19113 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a, 19114 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599, 19115 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924, 19116 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190, 19117 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f, 19118 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e, 19119 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01, 19120 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed, 19121 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950, 19122 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3, 19123 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2, 19124 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a, 19125 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5, 19126 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010, 19127 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f, 19128 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17, 19129 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6, 19130 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615, 19131 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8, 19132 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344, 19133 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb, 19134 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a, 19135 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5, 19136 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1, 19137 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c, 19138 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef, 19139 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236, 19140 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe, 19141 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31, 19142 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c, 19143 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713, 19144 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b, 19145 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242, 19146 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1, 19147 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c, 19148 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278, 19149 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7, 19150 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66, 19151 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9, 19152 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605, 19153 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8, 19154 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b, 19155 0x2d02ef8d 19156 @}; 19157 unsigned char *end; 19158 19159 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff; 19160 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf) 19161 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8); 19162 return ~crc & 0xffffffff; 19163@} 19164@end smallexample 19165 19166@noindent 19167This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method. 19168 19169@node MiniDebugInfo 19170@section Debugging information in a special section 19171@cindex separate debug sections 19172@cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section 19173 19174Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a 19175special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called 19176@dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and 19177is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces. 19178 19179The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging 19180information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a 19181replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate 19182Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however, 19183@value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of 19184debugging information might be included in the section. 19185 19186@value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists, 19187then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information 19188can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support. 19189 19190This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other 19191standard utilities: 19192 19193@smallexample 19194# Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need 19195# to also have these in the normal symbol table. 19196nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \ 19197 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms 19198 19199# Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo. 19200# (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit 19201# of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.) 19202nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \ 19203 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \ 19204 | sort > funcsyms 19205 19206# Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol 19207# table. 19208comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols 19209 19210# Separate full debug info into debug binary. 19211objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug 19212 19213# Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and 19214# removing some unnecessary sections. 19215objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \ 19216 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo 19217 19218# Drop the full debug info from the original binary. 19219strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary} 19220 19221# Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the 19222# original binary. 19223xz mini_debuginfo 19224objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary} 19225@end smallexample 19226 19227@node Index Files 19228@section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN} 19229@cindex index files 19230@cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section 19231 19232When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the 19233file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most 19234@value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early 19235on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so 19236@value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up 19237startup. 19238 19239The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can 19240write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file 19241using @command{objcopy}. 19242 19243To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command: 19244 19245@table @code 19246@item save gdb-index @var{directory} 19247@kindex save gdb-index 19248Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by 19249@value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file, 19250with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given 19251@var{directory}. 19252@end table 19253 19254Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol 19255file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}: 19256 19257@smallexample 19258$ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \ 19259 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile 19260@end smallexample 19261 19262@value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index} 19263sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because 19264they are missing a new feature or have performance issues. 19265To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway 19266specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}. 19267The default is @code{off}. 19268This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost. 19269@xref{Index Section Format}. 19270 19271@emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on} 19272must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work: 19273 19274@smallexample 19275$ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program> 19276@end smallexample 19277 19278Instead you must do, for example, 19279 19280@smallexample 19281$ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program> 19282@end smallexample 19283 19284There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when 19285for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not 19286currently work for programs using Ada. 19287 19288@node Symbol Errors 19289@section Errors Reading Symbol Files 19290 19291While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems, 19292such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler 19293output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since 19294they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people 19295debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information 19296about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print 19297only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many 19298times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages, 19299to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set 19300complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 19301Messages}). 19302 19303The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include: 19304 19305@table @code 19306@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol} 19307 19308The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end 19309(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This 19310error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained 19311in its outer scope blocks. 19312 19313@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had 19314the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol} 19315may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a 19316function. 19317 19318@item block at @var{address} out of order 19319 19320The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in 19321order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not 19322do so. 19323 19324@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble 19325locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You 19326can often determine what source file is affected by specifying 19327@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 19328Messages}.) 19329 19330@item bad block start address patched 19331 19332The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address 19333smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known 19334to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler. 19335 19336@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as 19337starting on the previous source line. 19338 19339@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n} 19340 19341@cindex foo 19342Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is 19343larger than the size of the string table. 19344 19345@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the 19346name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up 19347with this name. 19348 19349@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}} 19350 19351The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does 19352not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the 19353uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal. 19354 19355@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information. 19356This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols 19357are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like 19358debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint 19359on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab} 19360and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol. 19361 19362@item stub type has NULL name 19363 19364@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class. 19365 19366@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{} 19367The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some 19368information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for 19369it. 19370 19371@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger 19372 19373@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler. 19374 19375@end table 19376 19377@node Data Files 19378@section GDB Data Files 19379 19380@cindex prefix for data files 19381@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files 19382are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}. 19383 19384You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN} 19385is currently using. 19386 19387@table @code 19388@kindex set data-directory 19389@item set data-directory @var{directory} 19390Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files 19391to @var{directory}. 19392 19393@kindex show data-directory 19394@item show data-directory 19395Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files. 19396@end table 19397 19398@cindex default data directory 19399@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} 19400You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time 19401@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside 19402@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or 19403@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated 19404automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 19405location. 19406 19407The data directory may also be specified with the 19408@code{--data-directory} command line option. 19409@xref{Mode Options}. 19410 19411@node Targets 19412@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target 19413 19414@cindex debugging target 19415A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program. 19416 19417Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program; 19418in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when 19419you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more 19420flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate 19421host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a 19422realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target} 19423command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN} 19424(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}). 19425 19426@cindex target architecture 19427It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target 19428architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose 19429one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture} 19430command. 19431 19432@table @code 19433@kindex set architecture 19434@kindex show architecture 19435@item set architecture @var{arch} 19436This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The 19437value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the 19438supported architectures. 19439 19440@item show architecture 19441Show the current target architecture. 19442 19443@item set processor 19444@itemx processor 19445@kindex set processor 19446@kindex show processor 19447These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture} 19448and @code{show architecture}. 19449@end table 19450 19451@menu 19452* Active Targets:: Active targets 19453* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets 19454* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order 19455@end menu 19456 19457@node Active Targets 19458@section Active Targets 19459 19460@cindex stacking targets 19461@cindex active targets 19462@cindex multiple targets 19463 19464There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or 19465recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file 19466and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently 19467on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for 19468example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to 19469the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process 19470recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are 19471presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target 19472remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution. 19473 19474Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core 19475file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To 19476specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach} 19477command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}). 19478 19479@node Target Commands 19480@section Commands for Managing Targets 19481 19482@table @code 19483@item target @var{type} @var{parameters} 19484Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or 19485process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging 19486facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or 19487protocol of the target machine. 19488 19489Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but 19490typically include things like device names or host names to connect 19491with, process numbers, and baud rates. 19492 19493The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again 19494after executing the command. 19495 19496@kindex help target 19497@item help target 19498Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets 19499currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files} 19500(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 19501 19502@item help target @var{name} 19503Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to 19504select it. 19505 19506@kindex set gnutarget 19507@item set gnutarget @var{args} 19508@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN} 19509knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable}, 19510a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format 19511with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands, 19512with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine. 19513 19514@quotation 19515@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget}, 19516you must know the actual BFD name. 19517@end quotation 19518 19519@noindent 19520@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}. 19521 19522@kindex show gnutarget 19523@item show gnutarget 19524Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format 19525@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget}, 19526@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically, 19527and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}. 19528@end table 19529 19530@cindex common targets 19531Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB 19532configuration): 19533 19534@table @code 19535@kindex target 19536@item target exec @var{program} 19537@cindex executable file target 19538An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as 19539@samp{exec-file @var{program}}. 19540 19541@item target core @var{filename} 19542@cindex core dump file target 19543A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as 19544@samp{core-file @var{filename}}. 19545 19546@item target remote @var{medium} 19547@cindex remote target 19548A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network 19549connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote 19550protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}. 19551 19552For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the 19553machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say: 19554 19555@smallexample 19556target remote /dev/ttya 19557@end smallexample 19558 19559@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only 19560useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target 19561system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get 19562clobbered by the download. 19563 19564@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{} 19565@cindex built-in simulator target 19566Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures. 19567In general, 19568@smallexample 19569 target sim 19570 load 19571 run 19572@end smallexample 19573@noindent 19574works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device 19575drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do 19576provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details, 19577see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded 19578Processors}. 19579 19580@item target native 19581@cindex native target 19582Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the 19583@code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach}, 19584etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off} 19585(@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}). 19586 19587@end table 19588 19589Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN}; 19590your configuration may have more or fewer targets. 19591 19592Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once 19593you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control 19594various aspects of this process. 19595 19596@table @code 19597 19598@item set hash 19599@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors} 19600@cindex hash mark while downloading 19601This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while 19602downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is 19603displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the 19604monitor. 19605 19606@item show hash 19607@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors} 19608Show the current status of displaying the hash mark. 19609 19610@item set debug monitor 19611@kindex set debug monitor 19612@cindex display remote monitor communications 19613Enable or disable display of communications messages between 19614@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor. 19615 19616@item show debug monitor 19617@kindex show debug monitor 19618Show the current status of displaying communications between 19619@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor. 19620@end table 19621 19622@table @code 19623 19624@kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset} 19625@item load @var{filename} @var{offset} 19626@anchor{load} 19627Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into 19628@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it 19629is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging 19630on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example. 19631@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like 19632the @code{add-symbol-file} command. 19633 19634If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to 19635execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your 19636target is @dots{}}'' 19637 19638The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable. 19639For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you 19640link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format 19641specifies a fixed address. 19642@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc. 19643 19644It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a 19645specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When 19646@var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided. 19647 19648Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to 19649load programs into flash memory. 19650 19651@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. 19652@end table 19653 19654@table @code 19655 19656@kindex flash-erase 19657@item flash-erase 19658@anchor{flash-erase} 19659 19660Erases all known flash memory regions on the target. 19661 19662@end table 19663 19664@node Byte Order 19665@section Choosing Target Byte Order 19666 19667@cindex choosing target byte order 19668@cindex target byte order 19669 19670Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH, 19671offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte 19672orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to 19673designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about 19674which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust 19675@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually. 19676 19677@table @code 19678@kindex set endian 19679@item set endian big 19680Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian. 19681 19682@item set endian little 19683Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian. 19684 19685@item set endian auto 19686Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the 19687executable. 19688 19689@item show endian 19690Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order. 19691 19692@end table 19693 19694Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic 19695data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the 19696target system. 19697 19698 19699@node Remote Debugging 19700@chapter Debugging Remote Programs 19701@cindex remote debugging 19702 19703If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run 19704@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging. 19705For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel, 19706or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system 19707powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger. 19708 19709Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces 19710to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition, 19711@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN}, 19712but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you 19713write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to 19714communicate with @value{GDBN}. 19715 19716Other remote targets may be available in your 19717configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them. 19718 19719@menu 19720* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target 19721* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system 19722* Server:: Using the gdbserver program 19723* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration 19724* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub 19725@end menu 19726 19727@node Connecting 19728@section Connecting to a Remote Target 19729@cindex remote debugging, connecting 19730@cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting 19731@cindex remote debugging, types of connections 19732@cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections 19733@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode 19734@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode 19735 19736This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the 19737types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and 19738symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for 19739connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target. 19740 19741@subsection Types of Remote Connections 19742 19743@value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote} 19744mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets 19745support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major 19746differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here: 19747 19748@table @asis 19749 19750@cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit 19751@item Result of detach or program exit 19752@strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you 19753detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using 19754@code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit. 19755 19756@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or 19757you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even 19758though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a 19759running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target. 19760 19761When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was 19762invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option 19763was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the 19764@code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). 19765 19766@item Specifying the program to debug 19767For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the 19768program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are 19769some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the 19770target. 19771 19772@strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug 19773on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option 19774(@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}). 19775 19776@cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option 19777@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug 19778on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach 19779to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}. 19780 19781@anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections} 19782You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 19783or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line 19784option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start 19785the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the 19786@code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which 19787@code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it 19788(@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The 19789@option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that. 19790 19791@item The @code{run} command 19792@strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not 19793supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all 19794the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The 19795remote program is already running, so you can use commands like 19796@kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}. 19797 19798@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is 19799supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by 19800@code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select 19801the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for 19802wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}). 19803 19804If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the 19805@code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can 19806resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with 19807@code{target remote} mode. 19808 19809@anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections} 19810@item Attaching 19811@strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is 19812not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you 19813must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}). 19814 19815@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program, 19816you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been 19817established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke 19818@code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option 19819(@pxref{Running gdbserver}). 19820 19821@end table 19822 19823@anchor{Host and target files} 19824@subsection Host and Target Files 19825@cindex remote debugging, symbol files 19826@cindex symbol files, remote debugging 19827 19828@value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging 19829information for your program running on the target. This requires 19830access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated 19831symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target 19832remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. 19833 19834Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and 19835@pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over 19836the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a 19837target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is 19838@code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}). 19839 19840If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote 19841program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local 19842unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the 19843@code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on 19844the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with 19845the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you 19846may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates 19847target libraries. 19848 19849The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable 19850and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host 19851system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system 19852are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results 19853during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing 19854files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded 19855programs. 19856 19857@subsection Remote Connection Commands 19858@cindex remote connection commands 19859@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or 19860over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In 19861each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your 19862program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The 19863@code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands 19864establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same 19865arguments, which indicate the medium to use: 19866 19867@table @code 19868 19869@item target remote @var{serial-device} 19870@itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device} 19871@cindex serial line, @code{target remote} 19872Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example, 19873to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}: 19874 19875@smallexample 19876target remote /dev/ttyb 19877@end smallexample 19878 19879If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the 19880@samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command 19881(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the 19882@code{target} command. 19883 19884@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} 19885@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19886@itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} 19887@itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19888@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote} 19889Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}. 19890The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP} 19891address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be 19892the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or 19893it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the 19894target. 19895 19896For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named 19897@code{manyfarms}: 19898 19899@smallexample 19900target remote manyfarms:2828 19901@end smallexample 19902 19903If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your 19904debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the 19905same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to 19906port 1234 on your local machine: 19907 19908@smallexample 19909target remote :1234 19910@end smallexample 19911@noindent 19912 19913Note that the colon is still required here. 19914 19915@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19916@itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19917@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote} 19918Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to 19919connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}: 19920 19921@smallexample 19922target remote udp:manyfarms:2828 19923@end smallexample 19924 19925When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should 19926keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP} 19927can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will 19928cause havoc with your debugging session. 19929 19930@item target remote | @var{command} 19931@itemx target extended-remote | @var{command} 19932@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to 19933Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a 19934pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded 19935by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote 19936protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its 19937standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator 19938that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections 19939using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks. 19940 19941If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting), 19942@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the 19943program has already exited, this will have no effect.) 19944 19945@end table 19946 19947@cindex interrupting remote programs 19948@cindex remote programs, interrupting 19949Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the 19950interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the 19951program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware 19952and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the 19953interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt: 19954 19955@smallexample 19956Interrupted while waiting for the program. 19957Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n) 19958@end smallexample 19959 19960In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons 19961the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later, 19962you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type 19963@kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting. 19964 19965In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave 19966@value{GDBN} connected to the target. 19967 19968@table @code 19969@kindex detach (remote) 19970@item detach 19971When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the 19972@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. 19973Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results 19974will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach} 19975command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to 19976another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is 19977still connected to the target. 19978 19979@kindex disconnect 19980@item disconnect 19981The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and 19982the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN} 19983(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After 19984the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to 19985another target. 19986 19987@cindex send command to remote monitor 19988@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets 19989@cindex add new commands for external monitor 19990@kindex monitor 19991@item monitor @var{cmd} 19992This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the 19993remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it 19994sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you 19995can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand 19996and implement. 19997@end table 19998 19999@node File Transfer 20000@section Sending files to a remote system 20001@cindex remote target, file transfer 20002@cindex file transfer 20003@cindex sending files to remote systems 20004 20005Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same 20006connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient 20007for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems 20008running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets, 20009e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be 20010the only way to upload or download files. 20011 20012Not all remote targets support these commands. 20013 20014@table @code 20015@kindex remote put 20016@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile} 20017Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running 20018@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system. 20019 20020@kindex remote get 20021@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile} 20022Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile} 20023on the host system. 20024 20025@kindex remote delete 20026@item remote delete @var{targetfile} 20027Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system. 20028 20029@end table 20030 20031@node Server 20032@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program 20033 20034@kindex gdbserver 20035@cindex remote connection without stubs 20036@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which 20037allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via 20038@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without 20039linking in the usual debugging stub. 20040 20041@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs, 20042because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities 20043that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run 20044@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run 20045@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless, 20046because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is 20047also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get 20048started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}. 20049Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that 20050the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to 20051do as much development work as possible on another system, for example 20052by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar 20053choice for debugging. 20054 20055@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line 20056or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial 20057protocol. 20058 20059@quotation 20060@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security. 20061Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a 20062@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the 20063target system with the same privileges as the user running 20064@code{gdbserver}. 20065@end quotation 20066 20067@anchor{Running gdbserver} 20068@subsection Running @code{gdbserver} 20069@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver} 20070@cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments 20071 20072Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the 20073program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires. 20074@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can 20075strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host 20076system does all the symbol handling. 20077 20078To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN}; 20079the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual 20080syntax is: 20081 20082@smallexample 20083target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ] 20084@end smallexample 20085 20086@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP 20087hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use 20088stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. 20089For example, to debug Emacs with the argument 20090@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port 20091@file{/dev/com1}: 20092 20093@smallexample 20094target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt 20095@end smallexample 20096 20097@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate 20098with it. 20099 20100To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line: 20101 20102@smallexample 20103target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt 20104@end smallexample 20105 20106The only difference from the previous example is the first argument, 20107specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via 20108TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to 20109expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345. 20110(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number 20111you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any 20112TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is 20113reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that 20114conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message 20115and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN} 20116@code{target remote} command. 20117 20118The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver} 20119with ssh: 20120 20121@smallexample 20122(gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello 20123@end smallexample 20124 20125The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty, 20126and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when 20127a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit. 20128You could elide it if you want to. 20129 20130Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for 20131@code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for 20132display through a pipe connected to gdbserver. 20133Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe. 20134 20135@anchor{Attaching to a program} 20136@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program 20137@cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver} 20138@cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option 20139 20140On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs. 20141This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is: 20142 20143@smallexample 20144target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 20145@end smallexample 20146 20147@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't 20148necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 20149 20150In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the 20151@value{GDBN} attach command 20152(@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}). 20153 20154@pindex pidof 20155You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the 20156@code{pidof} utility: 20157 20158@smallexample 20159target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}` 20160@end smallexample 20161 20162In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program} 20163has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the 20164@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID. 20165 20166@subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver} 20167 20168This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP 20169port. 20170 20171@code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have 20172terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target 20173extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left. 20174@value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit, 20175which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote} 20176mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN} 20177cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver} 20178stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode. 20179 20180When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later. 20181Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For 20182completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time. 20183 20184@cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option 20185By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that 20186subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver} 20187with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further 20188connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This 20189means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the 20190first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first 20191connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed 20192connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The 20193@option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to 20194multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each 20195instance closes its port after the first connection. 20196 20197@anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver} 20198@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver} 20199 20200You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without 20201specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can 20202attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a 20203program. For more information, 20204@pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}. 20205 20206@cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option 20207The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra 20208status information about the debugging process. 20209@cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option 20210The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display 20211remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for 20212@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers. 20213 20214@cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option 20215The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells 20216@code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output. 20217Possible options are: 20218 20219@table @code 20220@item none 20221Turn off all extra information in debugging output. 20222@item all 20223Turn on all extra information in debugging output. 20224@item timestamps 20225Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output. 20226@end table 20227 20228Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none} 20229appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output. 20230 20231@cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option 20232The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs 20233for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the 20234wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then 20235@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments. 20236 20237@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined 20238command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the 20239program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper 20240runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control. 20241 20242You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with 20243its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do 20244this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending 20245with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work. 20246 20247For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to 20248the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s 20249environment: 20250 20251@smallexample 20252$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog 20253@end smallexample 20254 20255@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver} 20256 20257The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is: 20258@itemize 20259 20260@item 20261Run @value{GDBN} on the host system. 20262 20263@item 20264Make sure you have the necessary symbol files 20265(@pxref{Host and target files}). 20266Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you 20267connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your 20268@value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using 20269@code{--with-sysroot}). 20270 20271@item 20272Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}). 20273For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using 20274the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose 20275text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like 20276@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load} 20277command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the 20278program is already on the target. 20279 20280@end itemize 20281 20282@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver} 20283@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver} 20284@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver} 20285 20286During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the 20287@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}. 20288Here are the available commands. 20289 20290@table @code 20291@item monitor help 20292List the available monitor commands. 20293 20294@item monitor set debug 0 20295@itemx monitor set debug 1 20296Disable or enable general debugging messages. 20297 20298@item monitor set remote-debug 0 20299@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1 20300Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote 20301protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}). 20302 20303@item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]} 20304Specify additional text to add to debugging messages. 20305Possible options are: 20306 20307@table @code 20308@item none 20309Turn off all extra information in debugging output. 20310@item all 20311Turn on all extra information in debugging output. 20312@item timestamps 20313Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output. 20314@end table 20315 20316Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none} 20317appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output. 20318 20319@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH] 20320@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db} 20321When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 20322directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set 20323libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path}, 20324@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value. 20325 20326The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is 20327not supported in @code{gdbserver}. 20328 20329@item monitor exit 20330Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by 20331@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will 20332detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created. 20333Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end 20334of a multi-process mode debug session. 20335 20336@end table 20337 20338@subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver} 20339@cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver} 20340 20341On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast 20342tracepoints and static tracepoints. 20343 20344For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the 20345@dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process. 20346This library is built and distributed as an integral part of 20347@code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints 20348requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints 20349support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer, 20350@url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support 20351is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the 20352standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if 20353@code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust} 20354to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support 20355using @option{--with-ust=no}. 20356 20357There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program: 20358 20359@table @code 20360@item Specifying it as dependency at link time 20361 20362You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent 20363library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding 20364@code{-linproctrace} to the link command. 20365 20366@item Using the system's preloading mechanisms 20367 20368You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using 20369your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes 20370support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most 20371cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so} 20372in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s 20373@option{--wrapper} command line option. 20374 20375@item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time 20376 20377On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library, 20378by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care 20379of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix 20380systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call} 20381command for that. For example: 20382 20383@smallexample 20384(@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...) 20385@end smallexample 20386 20387Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be 20388available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}. 20389@end table 20390 20391On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix 20392systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target 20393remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic 20394loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the 20395program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that 20396case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints 20397features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared 20398libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the 20399main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start 20400@code{gdbserver} like so: 20401 20402@smallexample 20403$ gdbserver :9999 myprogram 20404@end smallexample 20405 20406Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main: 20407 20408@smallexample 20409$ gdb myprogram 20410(@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999 204110x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2 20412(@value{GDBP}) b main 20413(@value{GDBP}) continue 20414@end smallexample 20415 20416The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the 20417process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary} 20418command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the 20419process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static 20420tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start 20421tracing. 20422 20423@node Remote Configuration 20424@section Remote Configuration 20425 20426@kindex set remote 20427@kindex show remote 20428This section documents the configuration options available when 20429debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O 20430extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system, 20431system-call-allowed}. 20432 20433@table @code 20434@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits} 20435@cindex address size for remote targets 20436@cindex bits in remote address 20437Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified 20438number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above 20439that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The 20440default value is the number of bits in the target's address. 20441 20442@item show remoteaddresssize 20443Show the current value of remote address size in bits. 20444 20445@item set serial baud @var{n} 20446@cindex baud rate for remote targets 20447Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The 20448value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging 20449remote targets. 20450 20451@item show serial baud 20452Show the current speed of the remote connection. 20453 20454@item set serial parity @var{parity} 20455Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are: 20456@code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}. 20457 20458@item show serial parity 20459Show the current parity of the serial port. 20460 20461@item set remotebreak 20462@cindex interrupt remote programs 20463@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C 20464@anchor{set remotebreak} 20465If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote 20466when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running 20467on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C} 20468character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems 20469expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal. 20470 20471@item show remotebreak 20472Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to 20473interrupt the remote program. 20474 20475@item set remoteflow on 20476@itemx set remoteflow off 20477@kindex set remoteflow 20478Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS}) 20479on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target. 20480 20481@item show remoteflow 20482@kindex show remoteflow 20483Show the current setting of hardware flow control. 20484 20485@item set remotelogbase @var{base} 20486Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol 20487communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are: 20488@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is 20489@code{ascii}. 20490 20491@item show remotelogbase 20492Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial 20493protocol. 20494 20495@item set remotelogfile @var{file} 20496@cindex record serial communications on file 20497Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The 20498default is not to record at all. 20499 20500@item show remotelogfile. 20501Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the 20502serial communications. 20503 20504@item set remotetimeout @var{num} 20505@cindex timeout for serial communications 20506@cindex remote timeout 20507Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to 20508@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds. 20509 20510@item show remotetimeout 20511Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target 20512responses. 20513 20514@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints 20515@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints 20516@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit} 20517@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit} 20518@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit} 20519@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit} 20520Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or 20521watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited. 20522 20523@cindex limit hardware watchpoints length 20524@cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length 20525@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit} 20526@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit} 20527Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of 20528a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated 20529as unlimited. 20530 20531@item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit 20532Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of 20533a remote hardware watchpoint. 20534 20535@item set remote exec-file @var{filename} 20536@itemx show remote exec-file 20537@anchor{set remote exec-file} 20538@cindex executable file, for remote target 20539Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target 20540extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the 20541target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default 20542filename (e.g.@: the last program run). 20543 20544@item set remote interrupt-sequence 20545@cindex interrupt remote programs 20546@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g 20547Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or 20548@samp{BREAK-g} as the 20549sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution. 20550@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which 20551is high level of serial line for some certain time. 20552Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g. 20553It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}. 20554 20555@item show interrupt-sequence 20556Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g} 20557is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program. 20558@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and 20559also known as Magic SysRq g. 20560 20561@item set remote interrupt-on-connect 20562@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start 20563Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when 20564@value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug 20565Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} 20566which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}. 20567 20568@item show interrupt-on-connect 20569Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent 20570to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it. 20571 20572@kindex set tcp 20573@kindex show tcp 20574@item set tcp auto-retry on 20575@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target 20576Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote 20577debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race 20578condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection 20579before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is 20580enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts 20581to establish the connection using the timeout specified by 20582@code{set tcp connect-timeout}. 20583 20584@item set tcp auto-retry off 20585Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections. 20586 20587@item show tcp auto-retry 20588Show the current auto-retry setting. 20589 20590@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds} 20591@itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited 20592@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target 20593@cindex timeout, for remote target connection 20594Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to 20595@var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections 20596(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections 20597that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative 20598value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and 20599@value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever, 20600unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds. 20601 20602@item show tcp connect-timeout 20603Show the current connection timeout setting. 20604@end table 20605 20606@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling 20607The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by 20608your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you 20609can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each 20610packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this 20611packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet), 20612or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They 20613all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet, 20614see @ref{Remote Protocol}. 20615 20616During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands. 20617If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug 20618in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the 20619@value{GDBN} developers. 20620 20621For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the 20622packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings 20623are: 20624 20625@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25 20626@item Command Name 20627@tab Remote Packet 20628@tab Related Features 20629 20630@item @code{fetch-register} 20631@tab @code{p} 20632@tab @code{info registers} 20633 20634@item @code{set-register} 20635@tab @code{P} 20636@tab @code{set} 20637 20638@item @code{binary-download} 20639@tab @code{X} 20640@tab @code{load}, @code{set} 20641 20642@item @code{read-aux-vector} 20643@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read} 20644@tab @code{info auxv} 20645 20646@item @code{symbol-lookup} 20647@tab @code{qSymbol} 20648@tab Detecting multiple threads 20649 20650@item @code{attach} 20651@tab @code{vAttach} 20652@tab @code{attach} 20653 20654@item @code{verbose-resume} 20655@tab @code{vCont} 20656@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads 20657 20658@item @code{run} 20659@tab @code{vRun} 20660@tab @code{run} 20661 20662@item @code{software-breakpoint} 20663@tab @code{Z0} 20664@tab @code{break} 20665 20666@item @code{hardware-breakpoint} 20667@tab @code{Z1} 20668@tab @code{hbreak} 20669 20670@item @code{write-watchpoint} 20671@tab @code{Z2} 20672@tab @code{watch} 20673 20674@item @code{read-watchpoint} 20675@tab @code{Z3} 20676@tab @code{rwatch} 20677 20678@item @code{access-watchpoint} 20679@tab @code{Z4} 20680@tab @code{awatch} 20681 20682@item @code{pid-to-exec-file} 20683@tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read} 20684@tab @code{attach}, @code{run} 20685 20686@item @code{target-features} 20687@tab @code{qXfer:features:read} 20688@tab @code{set architecture} 20689 20690@item @code{library-info} 20691@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read} 20692@tab @code{info sharedlibrary} 20693 20694@item @code{memory-map} 20695@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read} 20696@tab @code{info mem} 20697 20698@item @code{read-sdata-object} 20699@tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read} 20700@tab @code{print $_sdata} 20701 20702@item @code{read-spu-object} 20703@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read} 20704@tab @code{info spu} 20705 20706@item @code{write-spu-object} 20707@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write} 20708@tab @code{info spu} 20709 20710@item @code{read-siginfo-object} 20711@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read} 20712@tab @code{print $_siginfo} 20713 20714@item @code{write-siginfo-object} 20715@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write} 20716@tab @code{set $_siginfo} 20717 20718@item @code{threads} 20719@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read} 20720@tab @code{info threads} 20721 20722@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address} 20723@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr} 20724@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables 20725 20726@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address} 20727@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr} 20728@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block. 20729 20730@item @code{search-memory} 20731@tab @code{qSearch:memory} 20732@tab @code{find} 20733 20734@item @code{supported-packets} 20735@tab @code{qSupported} 20736@tab Remote communications parameters 20737 20738@item @code{catch-syscalls} 20739@tab @code{QCatchSyscalls} 20740@tab @code{catch syscall} 20741 20742@item @code{pass-signals} 20743@tab @code{QPassSignals} 20744@tab @code{handle @var{signal}} 20745 20746@item @code{program-signals} 20747@tab @code{QProgramSignals} 20748@tab @code{handle @var{signal}} 20749 20750@item @code{hostio-close-packet} 20751@tab @code{vFile:close} 20752@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20753 20754@item @code{hostio-open-packet} 20755@tab @code{vFile:open} 20756@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20757 20758@item @code{hostio-pread-packet} 20759@tab @code{vFile:pread} 20760@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20761 20762@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet} 20763@tab @code{vFile:pwrite} 20764@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20765 20766@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet} 20767@tab @code{vFile:unlink} 20768@tab @code{remote delete} 20769 20770@item @code{hostio-readlink-packet} 20771@tab @code{vFile:readlink} 20772@tab Host I/O 20773 20774@item @code{hostio-fstat-packet} 20775@tab @code{vFile:fstat} 20776@tab Host I/O 20777 20778@item @code{hostio-setfs-packet} 20779@tab @code{vFile:setfs} 20780@tab Host I/O 20781 20782@item @code{noack-packet} 20783@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode} 20784@tab Packet acknowledgment 20785 20786@item @code{osdata} 20787@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read} 20788@tab @code{info os} 20789 20790@item @code{query-attached} 20791@tab @code{qAttached} 20792@tab Querying remote process attach state. 20793 20794@item @code{trace-buffer-size} 20795@tab @code{QTBuffer:size} 20796@tab @code{set trace-buffer-size} 20797 20798@item @code{trace-status} 20799@tab @code{qTStatus} 20800@tab @code{tstatus} 20801 20802@item @code{traceframe-info} 20803@tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 20804@tab Traceframe info 20805 20806@item @code{install-in-trace} 20807@tab @code{InstallInTrace} 20808@tab Install tracepoint in tracing 20809 20810@item @code{disable-randomization} 20811@tab @code{QDisableRandomization} 20812@tab @code{set disable-randomization} 20813 20814@item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet} 20815@tab @code{Z0 and Z1} 20816@tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation} 20817 20818@item @code{multiprocess-extensions} 20819@tab @code{multiprocess extensions} 20820@tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness 20821 20822@item @code{swbreak-feature} 20823@tab @code{swbreak stop reason} 20824@tab @code{break} 20825 20826@item @code{hwbreak-feature} 20827@tab @code{hwbreak stop reason} 20828@tab @code{hbreak} 20829 20830@item @code{fork-event-feature} 20831@tab @code{fork stop reason} 20832@tab @code{fork} 20833 20834@item @code{vfork-event-feature} 20835@tab @code{vfork stop reason} 20836@tab @code{vfork} 20837 20838@item @code{exec-event-feature} 20839@tab @code{exec stop reason} 20840@tab @code{exec} 20841 20842@item @code{thread-events} 20843@tab @code{QThreadEvents} 20844@tab Tracking thread lifetime. 20845 20846@item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply} 20847@tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply} 20848@tab Tracking thread lifetime. 20849 20850@end multitable 20851 20852@node Remote Stub 20853@section Implementing a Remote Stub 20854 20855@cindex debugging stub, example 20856@cindex remote stub, example 20857@cindex stub example, remote debugging 20858The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the 20859communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the 20860@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow 20861these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're 20862implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start 20863with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best 20864organized, and therefore the easiest to read.) 20865 20866@cindex remote serial debugging, overview 20867To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging 20868@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual 20869prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C 20870program, you need: 20871 20872@enumerate 20873@item 20874A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually 20875have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by 20876your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own. 20877 20878@item 20879A C subroutine library to support your program's 20880subroutine calls, notably managing input and output. 20881 20882@item 20883A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a 20884download program. These are often supplied by the hardware 20885manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware 20886documentation. 20887@end enumerate 20888 20889The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to 20890communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host} 20891machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this: 20892 20893@table @emph 20894@item On the host, 20895@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything 20896else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command 20897(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 20898 20899@item On the target, 20900you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that 20901implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these 20902subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}. 20903 20904On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program 20905@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program. 20906@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details. 20907@end table 20908 20909The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote 20910machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on 20911@sc{sparc} boards. 20912 20913@cindex remote serial stub list 20914These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}: 20915 20916@table @code 20917 20918@item i386-stub.c 20919@cindex @file{i386-stub.c} 20920@cindex Intel 20921@cindex i386 20922For Intel 386 and compatible architectures. 20923 20924@item m68k-stub.c 20925@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c} 20926@cindex Motorola 680x0 20927@cindex m680x0 20928For Motorola 680x0 architectures. 20929 20930@item sh-stub.c 20931@cindex @file{sh-stub.c} 20932@cindex Renesas 20933@cindex SH 20934For Renesas SH architectures. 20935 20936@item sparc-stub.c 20937@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c} 20938@cindex Sparc 20939For @sc{sparc} architectures. 20940 20941@item sparcl-stub.c 20942@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c} 20943@cindex Fujitsu 20944@cindex SparcLite 20945For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures. 20946 20947@end table 20948 20949The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other 20950recently added stubs. 20951 20952@menu 20953* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you 20954* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub 20955* Debug Session:: Putting it all together 20956@end menu 20957 20958@node Stub Contents 20959@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You 20960 20961@cindex remote serial stub 20962The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three 20963subroutines: 20964 20965@table @code 20966@item set_debug_traps 20967@findex set_debug_traps 20968@cindex remote serial stub, initialization 20969This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your 20970program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your 20971program's startup code. 20972 20973@item handle_exception 20974@findex handle_exception 20975@cindex remote serial stub, main routine 20976This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it 20977explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to 20978run when a trap is triggered. 20979 20980@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during 20981execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications 20982with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications 20983protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN} 20984representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary 20985information on the state of your program, then continues to execute, 20986retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you 20987execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point, 20988@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target 20989machine. 20990 20991@item breakpoint 20992@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote 20993Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a 20994breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only 20995way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target 20996machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this; 20997pressing the interrupt button transfers control to 20998@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines, 20999simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap; 21000again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from 21001your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host 21002@value{GDBN} session gets control. 21003 21004Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want 21005to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the 21006start of your debugging session. 21007@end table 21008 21009@node Bootstrapping 21010@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub 21011 21012@cindex remote stub, support routines 21013The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular 21014chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your 21015debugging target machine. 21016 21017First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the 21018serial port. 21019 21020@table @code 21021@item int getDebugChar() 21022@findex getDebugChar 21023Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port. 21024It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a 21025different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish. 21026 21027@item void putDebugChar(int) 21028@findex putDebugChar 21029Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port. 21030It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a 21031different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish. 21032@end table 21033 21034@cindex control C, and remote debugging 21035@cindex interrupting remote targets 21036If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is 21037running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange 21038for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C 21039character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the 21040remote system to stop. 21041 21042Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN} 21043probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way 21044is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that 21045@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}). 21046 21047Other routines you need to supply are: 21048 21049@table @code 21050@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address}) 21051@findex exceptionHandler 21052Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception 21053handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any 21054way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system 21055are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom}, 21056containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}). 21057The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed; 21058its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers 21059might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this 21060exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to 21061@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers, 21062and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if 21063you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it 21064should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine. 21065 21066For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt 21067gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate 21068should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The 21069@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without 21070help from @code{exceptionHandler}. 21071 21072@item void flush_i_cache() 21073@findex flush_i_cache 21074On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the 21075instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no 21076instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op. 21077 21078On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this 21079function to make certain that the state of your program is stable. 21080@end table 21081 21082@noindent 21083You must also make sure this library routine is available: 21084 21085@table @code 21086@item void *memset(void *, int, int) 21087@findex memset 21088This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of 21089memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of 21090@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must 21091either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own. 21092@end table 21093 21094If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard 21095library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another, 21096but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library 21097subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code. 21098 21099 21100@node Debug Session 21101@subsection Putting it All Together 21102 21103@cindex remote serial debugging summary 21104In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these 21105steps. 21106 21107@enumerate 21108@item 21109Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines 21110(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}): 21111@display 21112@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar}, 21113@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}. 21114@end display 21115 21116@item 21117Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main 21118procedure is called: 21119 21120@smallexample 21121set_debug_traps(); 21122breakpoint(); 21123@end smallexample 21124 21125On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware 21126automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the 21127breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust 21128@code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction 21129after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program 21130doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making 21131progress. 21132 21133@item 21134For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called 21135@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use: 21136 21137@smallexample 21138void (*exceptionHook)() = 0; 21139@end smallexample 21140 21141@noindent 21142but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a 21143function in your program, that function is called when 21144@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus 21145error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with 21146one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number. 21147 21148@item 21149Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for 21150your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines. 21151 21152@item 21153Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and 21154the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host. 21155 21156@item 21157@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should 21158@c document that. FIXME. 21159Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by 21160whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it. 21161 21162@item 21163Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target 21164(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}). 21165 21166@end enumerate 21167 21168@node Configurations 21169@chapter Configuration-Specific Information 21170 21171While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and 21172cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter 21173describes things that are only available in certain configurations. 21174 21175There are three major categories of configurations: native 21176configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded 21177operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several 21178different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which 21179are quite different from each other. 21180 21181@menu 21182* Native:: 21183* Embedded OS:: 21184* Embedded Processors:: 21185* Architectures:: 21186@end menu 21187 21188@node Native 21189@section Native 21190 21191This section describes details specific to particular native 21192configurations. 21193 21194@menu 21195* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images 21196* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information 21197* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port 21198* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port 21199* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd 21200* Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin 21201@end menu 21202 21203@node BSD libkvm Interface 21204@subsection BSD libkvm Interface 21205 21206@cindex libkvm 21207@cindex kernel memory image 21208@cindex kernel crash dump 21209 21210BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory 21211interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual 21212memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN} 21213uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash 21214dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a 21215special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load 21216the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the 21217@code{kvm} target: 21218 21219@smallexample 21220(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm} 21221@end smallexample 21222 21223For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an 21224argument: 21225 21226@smallexample 21227(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0} 21228@end smallexample 21229 21230Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are 21231available: 21232 21233@table @code 21234@kindex kvm 21235@item kvm pcb 21236Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address. 21237 21238@item kvm proc 21239Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on 21240modern FreeBSD systems. 21241@end table 21242 21243@node SVR4 Process Information 21244@subsection SVR4 Process Information 21245@cindex /proc 21246@cindex examine process image 21247@cindex process info via @file{/proc} 21248 21249Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called 21250@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running 21251process using file-system subroutines. 21252 21253If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this 21254facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report 21255information about the process running your program, or about any 21256process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing, 21257@sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example. 21258 21259This command may also work on core files that were created on a system 21260that has the @samp{/proc} facility. 21261 21262@table @code 21263@kindex info proc 21264@cindex process ID 21265@item info proc 21266@itemx info proc @var{process-id} 21267Summarize available information about any running process. If a 21268process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about 21269that process; otherwise display information about the program being 21270debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command 21271line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its 21272executable file's absolute file name. 21273 21274On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form 21275@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID 21276within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means 21277a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still 21278needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as 21279a process ID rather than a thread ID). 21280 21281@item info proc cmdline 21282@cindex info proc cmdline 21283Show the original command line of the process. This command is 21284specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux. 21285 21286@item info proc cwd 21287@cindex info proc cwd 21288Show the current working directory of the process. This command is 21289specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux. 21290 21291@item info proc exe 21292@cindex info proc exe 21293Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific 21294to @sc{gnu}/Linux. 21295 21296@item info proc mappings 21297@cindex memory address space mappings 21298Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with 21299information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access 21300rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range 21301includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the 21302memory access rights to that range. 21303 21304@item info proc stat 21305@itemx info proc status 21306@cindex process detailed status information 21307These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show 21308the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID; 21309how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage; 21310the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its 21311consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice} 21312value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page 21313(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt). 21314 21315@item info proc all 21316Show all the information about the process described under all of the 21317above @code{info proc} subcommands. 21318 21319@ignore 21320@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when 21321@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around 21322@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in. 21323@kindex info proc times 21324@item info proc times 21325Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and 21326its children. 21327 21328@kindex info proc id 21329@item info proc id 21330Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID, 21331the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID. 21332@end ignore 21333 21334@item set procfs-trace 21335@kindex set procfs-trace 21336@cindex @code{procfs} API calls 21337This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls. 21338 21339@item show procfs-trace 21340@kindex show procfs-trace 21341Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing. 21342 21343@item set procfs-file @var{file} 21344@kindex set procfs-file 21345Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named 21346@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous 21347contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the 21348standard output. 21349 21350@item show procfs-file 21351@kindex show procfs-file 21352Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written. 21353 21354@item proc-trace-entry 21355@itemx proc-trace-exit 21356@itemx proc-untrace-entry 21357@itemx proc-untrace-exit 21358@kindex proc-trace-entry 21359@kindex proc-trace-exit 21360@kindex proc-untrace-entry 21361@kindex proc-untrace-exit 21362These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits 21363from the @code{syscall} interface. 21364 21365@item info pidlist 21366@kindex info pidlist 21367@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino 21368For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the 21369processes and all the threads within each process. 21370 21371@item info meminfo 21372@kindex info meminfo 21373@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino 21374For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos. 21375@end table 21376 21377@node DJGPP Native 21378@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs 21379@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging 21380@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging 21381@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands 21382 21383@cindex DPMI 21384@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and 21385MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs 21386that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on 21387top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations. 21388 21389@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and 21390defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This 21391subsection describes those commands. 21392 21393@table @code 21394@kindex info dos 21395@item info dos 21396This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print 21397information about the target system and important OS structures. 21398 21399@kindex sysinfo 21400@cindex MS-DOS system info 21401@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS) 21402@item info dos sysinfo 21403This command displays assorted information about the underlying 21404platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the 21405DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory. 21406 21407@cindex GDT 21408@cindex LDT 21409@cindex IDT 21410@cindex segment descriptor tables 21411@cindex descriptor tables display 21412@item info dos gdt 21413@itemx info dos ldt 21414@itemx info dos idt 21415These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local, 21416and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor 21417tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment 21418that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a 21419descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the 21420descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access 21421rights. 21422 21423A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data 21424segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which 21425allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in 21426conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define 21427additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment. 21428 21429@cindex garbled pointers 21430These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables. 21431Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are 21432displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means 21433display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For 21434example, here's a convenient way to display information about the 21435debugged program's data segment: 21436 21437@smallexample 21438@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds} 21439@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)} 21440@end smallexample 21441 21442@noindent 21443This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside 21444the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}). 21445 21446@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS) 21447@item info dos pde 21448@itemx info dos pte 21449These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page 21450Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are 21451data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped 21452into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every 21453page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there 21454may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A 21455Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table 21456that is currently in use. 21457 21458Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page 21459Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of 21460the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the 21461@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page 21462Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command 21463means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by 21464the specified entry in the Page Directory. 21465 21466@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS 21467These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct 21468Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA 21469controller. 21470 21471These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers. 21472 21473@cindex physical address from linear address 21474@item info dos address-pte @var{addr} 21475This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear 21476address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should 21477already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it, 21478because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} 21479segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for 21480the page where a variable @code{i} is stored: 21481 21482@smallexample 21483@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i} 21484@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:} 21485@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30} 21486@end smallexample 21487 21488@noindent 21489This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page 21490whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the 21491attributes of that page. 21492 21493Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *}, 21494since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base 21495address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will 21496be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is 21497declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of 21498@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}. 21499 21500Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the 21501transfer buffer: 21502 21503@smallexample 21504@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)} 21505@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:} 21506@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110} 21507@end smallexample 21508 21509@noindent 21510(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the 215113rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output 21512clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional 21513memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and 21514linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical. 21515 21516This command is supported only with some DPMI servers. 21517@end table 21518 21519@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging 21520In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote 21521debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific 21522to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}. 21523 21524@table @code 21525@kindex set com1base 21526@kindex set com1irq 21527@kindex set com2base 21528@kindex set com2irq 21529@kindex set com3base 21530@kindex set com3irq 21531@kindex set com4base 21532@kindex set com4irq 21533@item set com1base @var{addr} 21534This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial 21535port. 21536 21537@item set com1irq @var{irq} 21538This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use 21539for the @file{COM1} serial port. 21540 21541There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq}, 21542etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the 21543other 3 COM ports. 21544 21545@kindex show com1base 21546@kindex show com1irq 21547@kindex show com2base 21548@kindex show com2irq 21549@kindex show com3base 21550@kindex show com3irq 21551@kindex show com4base 21552@kindex show com4irq 21553The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@: 21554display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ} 21555lines used by the COM ports. 21556 21557@item info serial 21558@kindex info serial 21559@cindex DOS serial port status 21560This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each 21561port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and 21562IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the 21563counts of various errors encountered so far. 21564@end table 21565 21566 21567@node Cygwin Native 21568@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables 21569@cindex MS Windows debugging 21570@cindex native Cygwin debugging 21571@cindex Cygwin-specific commands 21572 21573@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including 21574DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. 21575 21576@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows 21577@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows 21578MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the 21579special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted 21580by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows 21581supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key 21582sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it 21583ignores @kbd{C-c}. 21584 21585There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in 21586this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is 21587described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}. 21588 21589@table @code 21590@kindex info w32 21591@item info w32 21592This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print 21593information about the target system and important OS structures. 21594 21595@item info w32 selector 21596This command displays information returned by 21597the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function. 21598It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to 21599a long value to give the information about this given selector. 21600Without argument, this command displays information 21601about the six segment registers. 21602 21603@item info w32 thread-information-block 21604This command displays thread specific information stored in the 21605Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs} 21606selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs). 21607 21608@kindex signal-event 21609@item signal-event @var{id} 21610This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume 21611crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug). 21612 21613To use it, create or edit the following keys in 21614@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or 21615@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} 21616(for x86_64 versions): 21617 21618@itemize @minus 21619@item 21620@code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger. 21621Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex 21622"attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}. 21623 21624The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the 21625crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of 21626the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN} 21627to attach. 21628 21629@item 21630@code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will 21631make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key 21632automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and 21633``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either 21634terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel). 21635@end itemize 21636 21637@kindex set cygwin-exceptions 21638@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL 21639@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging 21640@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode} 21641If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that 21642happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off}, 21643@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some 21644exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL 21645``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the 21646Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying 21647@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals. 21648 21649@kindex show cygwin-exceptions 21650@item show cygwin-exceptions 21651Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen 21652inside the Cygwin DLL itself. 21653 21654@kindex set new-console 21655@item set new-console @var{mode} 21656If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will 21657be started in a new console on next start. 21658If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will 21659be started in the same console as the debugger. 21660 21661@kindex show new-console 21662@item show new-console 21663Displays whether a new console is used 21664when the debuggee is started. 21665 21666@kindex set new-group 21667@item set new-group @var{mode} 21668This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should 21669start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger. 21670This affects the way the Windows OS handles 21671@samp{Ctrl-C}. 21672 21673@kindex show new-group 21674@item show new-group 21675Displays current value of new-group boolean. 21676 21677@kindex set debugevents 21678@item set debugevents 21679This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related 21680to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that 21681signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and 21682unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the 21683Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call. 21684 21685@kindex set debugexec 21686@item set debugexec 21687This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events 21688(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger. 21689 21690@kindex set debugexceptions 21691@item set debugexceptions 21692This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the 21693debuggee seen by the debugger. 21694 21695@kindex set debugmemory 21696@item set debugmemory 21697This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads 21698and writes by the debugger. 21699 21700@kindex set shell 21701@item set shell 21702This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called 21703via a shell or directly (default value is on). 21704 21705@kindex show shell 21706@item show shell 21707Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell. 21708 21709@end table 21710 21711@menu 21712* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols 21713@end menu 21714 21715@node Non-debug DLL Symbols 21716@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols 21717@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols 21718@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs 21719 21720Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do 21721not include symbolic debugging information (for example, 21722@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging 21723symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic 21724information contained in the DLL's export table. This section 21725describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as 21726``minimal symbols''. 21727 21728Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs 21729will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to 21730start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the 21731program run once to completion. 21732 21733@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes 21734 21735In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging 21736tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the 21737DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is 21738also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often 21739sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program 21740(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols) 21741necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the 21742contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the 21743exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator. 21744 21745Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even 21746though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since 21747symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause 21748some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and 21749@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} 21750(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example: 21751 21752@smallexample 21753(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA 21754All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA": 21755 21756Non-debugging symbols: 217570x77e885f4 CreateFileA 217580x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA 21759@end smallexample 21760 21761@smallexample 21762(@value{GDBP}) info function ! 21763All functions matching regular expression "!": 21764 21765Non-debugging symbols: 217660x6100114c cygwin1!__assert 217670x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0 217680x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *) 21769[etc...] 21770@end smallexample 21771 21772@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols 21773 21774Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much 21775type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol 21776refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that 21777contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory 21778contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This 21779means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble 21780a function within a DLL without a running program. 21781 21782Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced 21783automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a 21784variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit 21785type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of 21786problem: 21787 21788@smallexample 21789(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv' 21790$1 = 268572168 21791@end smallexample 21792 21793@smallexample 21794(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv' 217950x10021610: "\230y\"" 21796@end smallexample 21797 21798And two possible solutions: 21799 21800@smallexample 21801(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0] 21802$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram" 21803@end smallexample 21804 21805@smallexample 21806(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv' 218070x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000 21808(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608 218090x10021608: 0x0022fd98 21810(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98 218110x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram" 21812@end smallexample 21813 21814Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program 21815starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't 21816examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the 21817function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&'' 21818to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address: 21819 21820@smallexample 21821(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline' 21822Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0 21823@end smallexample 21824 21825The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a 21826break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely 21827safe. 21828 21829@node Hurd Native 21830@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems 21831@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging 21832 21833This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the 21834@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging. 21835 21836@table @code 21837@item set signals 21838@itemx set sigs 21839@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command} 21840@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command} 21841This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by 21842@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not 21843affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for 21844@code{signals}. 21845 21846@item show signals 21847@itemx show sigs 21848@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command} 21849@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command} 21850Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals. 21851 21852@item set signal-thread 21853@itemx set sigthread 21854@kindex set signal-thread 21855@kindex set sigthread 21856This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal 21857thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running 21858process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set 21859signal-thread}. 21860 21861@item show signal-thread 21862@itemx show sigthread 21863@kindex show signal-thread 21864@kindex show sigthread 21865These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is 21866delivered a signal. 21867 21868@item set stopped 21869@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command} 21870This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped, 21871as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be 21872continued by delivering a signal to it. 21873 21874@item show stopped 21875@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command} 21876This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is 21877stopped. 21878 21879@item set exceptions 21880@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command} 21881Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior. 21882When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor 21883single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception 21884trapping on. 21885 21886@item show exceptions 21887@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command} 21888Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior. 21889 21890@item set task pause 21891@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands} 21892@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 21893@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 21894This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control. 21895Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended 21896whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take 21897effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set 21898to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set 21899thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads. 21900 21901@item show task pause 21902@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands} 21903Show the current state of task suspension. 21904 21905@item set task detach-suspend-count 21906@cindex task suspend count 21907@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21908This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when 21909@value{GDBN} detaches from it. 21910 21911@item show task detach-suspend-count 21912Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching. 21913 21914@item set task exception-port 21915@itemx set task excp 21916@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21917This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will 21918forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send 21919rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias. 21920 21921@item set noninvasive 21922@cindex noninvasive task options 21923This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least 21924invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This 21925is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and 21926@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults. 21927 21928@item info send-rights 21929@itemx info receive-rights 21930@itemx info port-rights 21931@itemx info port-sets 21932@itemx info dead-names 21933@itemx info ports 21934@itemx info psets 21935@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21936@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21937@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21938@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21939@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21940These commands display information about, respectively, send rights, 21941receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task. 21942There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info 21943port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}. 21944 21945@item set thread pause 21946@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command} 21947@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21948@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 21949This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has 21950control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current 21951thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to 21952off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued. 21953Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has 21954control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set 21955task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend 21956only the current thread. 21957 21958@item show thread pause 21959@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command} 21960This command shows the state of current thread suspension. 21961 21962@item set thread run 21963This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run. 21964 21965@item show thread run 21966Show whether the current thread is allowed to run. 21967 21968@item set thread detach-suspend-count 21969@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21970@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21971This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a 21972thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count 21973found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread 21974takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value. 21975 21976@item show thread detach-suspend-count 21977Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when 21978detaching. 21979 21980@item set thread exception-port 21981@itemx set thread excp 21982Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This 21983overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above). 21984@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias. 21985 21986@item set thread takeover-suspend-count 21987Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the 21988value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command 21989changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead. 21990 21991@item set thread default 21992@itemx show thread default 21993@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21994Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread 21995default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set 21996thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default} 21997variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all 21998threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with 21999the non-default commands. 22000@end table 22001 22002@node Darwin 22003@subsection Darwin 22004@cindex Darwin 22005 22006@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target: 22007 22008@table @code 22009@item set debug darwin @var{num} 22010@kindex set debug darwin 22011When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to 22012the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output. 22013 22014@item show debug darwin 22015@kindex show debug darwin 22016Show the current state of Darwin messages. 22017 22018@item set debug mach-o @var{num} 22019@kindex set debug mach-o 22020When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while 22021@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the 22022file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher 22023values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose 22024problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal 22025usage. 22026 22027@item show debug mach-o 22028@kindex show debug mach-o 22029Show the current state of Mach-O file messages. 22030 22031@item set mach-exceptions on 22032@itemx set mach-exceptions off 22033@kindex set mach-exceptions 22034On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then 22035mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of 22036Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to 22037better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off. 22038 22039@item show mach-exceptions 22040@kindex show mach-exceptions 22041Show the current state of exceptions trapping. 22042@end table 22043 22044 22045@node Embedded OS 22046@section Embedded Operating Systems 22047 22048This section describes configurations involving the debugging of 22049embedded operating systems that are available for several different 22050architectures. 22051 22052@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on 22053various real-time operating systems. 22054 22055@node Embedded Processors 22056@section Embedded Processors 22057 22058This section goes into details specific to particular embedded 22059configurations. 22060 22061@cindex send command to simulator 22062Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN} 22063allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator. 22064 22065@table @code 22066@item sim @var{command} 22067@kindex sim@r{, a command} 22068Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the 22069documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about 22070acceptable commands. 22071@end table 22072 22073 22074@menu 22075* ARC:: Synopsys ARC 22076* ARM:: ARM 22077* M68K:: Motorola M68K 22078* MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze 22079* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded 22080* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded 22081* AVR:: Atmel AVR 22082* CRIS:: CRIS 22083* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H 22084@end menu 22085 22086@node ARC 22087@subsection Synopsys ARC 22088@cindex Synopsys ARC 22089@cindex ARC specific commands 22090@cindex ARC600 22091@cindex ARC700 22092@cindex ARC EM 22093@cindex ARC HS 22094 22095@value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands: 22096 22097@table @code 22098@item set debug arc 22099@kindex set debug arc 22100Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the 22101default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages. 22102 22103@item show debug arc 22104@kindex show debug arc 22105Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation. 22106 22107@item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address} 22108@kindex maint print arc arc-instruction 22109Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address. 22110 22111@end table 22112 22113@node ARM 22114@subsection ARM 22115 22116@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands: 22117 22118@table @code 22119@item set arm disassembler 22120@kindex set arm 22121This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The 22122@code{"std"} style is the standard style. 22123 22124@item show arm disassembler 22125@kindex show arm 22126Show the current disassembly style. 22127 22128@item set arm apcs32 22129@cindex ARM 32-bit mode 22130This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit. 22131 22132@item show arm apcs32 22133Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode. 22134 22135@item set arm fpu @var{fputype} 22136This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The 22137argument @var{fputype} can be one of these: 22138 22139@table @code 22140@item auto 22141Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI. 22142@item softfpa 22143Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM 22144processors. 22145@item fpa 22146GCC-compiled FPA co-processor. 22147@item softvfp 22148Software FPU with pure-endian doubles. 22149@item vfp 22150VFP co-processor. 22151@end table 22152 22153@item show arm fpu 22154Show the current type of the FPU. 22155 22156@item set arm abi 22157This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI. 22158 22159@item show arm abi 22160Show the currently used ABI. 22161 22162@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto) 22163@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine 22164whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls 22165@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not 22166available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to 22167use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR} 22168register). 22169 22170@item show arm fallback-mode 22171Show the current fallback instruction mode. 22172 22173@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto) 22174This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether 22175instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which 22176causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting 22177of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}. 22178 22179@item show arm force-mode 22180Show the current forced instruction mode. 22181 22182@item set debug arm 22183Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM 22184target support subsystem. 22185 22186@item show debug arm 22187Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled. 22188@end table 22189 22190@table @code 22191@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{} 22192The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments. 22193 22194@table @code 22195@item --swi-support=@var{type} 22196Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument 22197@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values. 22198The default value is @code{all}. 22199 22200@table @code 22201@item none 22202@item demon 22203@item angel 22204@item redboot 22205@item all 22206@end table 22207@end table 22208@end table 22209 22210@node M68K 22211@subsection M68k 22212 22213The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support. 22214 22215@node MicroBlaze 22216@subsection MicroBlaze 22217@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze 22218@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger 22219 22220The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx 22221FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors 22222usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx 22223Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK). 22224This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to 22225the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program 22226communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and 22227presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default 22228@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change 22229this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd} 22230commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.) 22231 22232Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor. 22233 22234@table @code 22235@item target remote :1234 22236Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN} 22237on the same system as @code{xmd}. 22238 22239@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234 22240Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd} 22241running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}. 22242 22243@item load 22244Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target. 22245 22246@item set debug microblaze @var{n} 22247Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero. 22248 22249@item show debug microblaze @var{n} 22250Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level. 22251@end table 22252 22253@node MIPS Embedded 22254@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded 22255 22256@noindent 22257@value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets: 22258 22259@table @code 22260@item set mipsfpu double 22261@itemx set mipsfpu single 22262@itemx set mipsfpu none 22263@itemx set mipsfpu auto 22264@itemx show mipsfpu 22265@kindex set mipsfpu 22266@kindex show mipsfpu 22267@cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point 22268@cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote 22269If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point 22270coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you 22271need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init 22272file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of 22273functions which return floating point values. It also allows 22274@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling 22275functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor 22276with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650} 22277processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default 22278double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using 22279@samp{set mipsfpu double}. 22280 22281In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no 22282floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision 22283and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point. 22284 22285As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with 22286@samp{show mipsfpu}. 22287@end table 22288 22289@node PowerPC Embedded 22290@subsection PowerPC Embedded 22291 22292@cindex DVC register 22293@value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to 22294implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form: 22295 22296@smallexample 22297(@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \ 22298 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION} 22299@end smallexample 22300 22301The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects 22302such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one 22303debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the 22304variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature 22305is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34 22306or newer. 22307 22308When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses 22309ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on, 22310in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when 22311watching variables of scalar types. 22312 22313You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory 22314region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}): 22315 22316@smallexample 22317(@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length} 22318(@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address} 22319@end smallexample 22320 22321PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion 22322about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}. 22323 22324@cindex ranged breakpoint 22325PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated 22326@dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of 22327the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within 22328the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN}, 22329use the @code{break-range} command. 22330 22331@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands: 22332 22333@table @code 22334@kindex break-range 22335@item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location} 22336Set a breakpoint for an address range given by 22337@var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name, 22338a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start 22339location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location}, 22340for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.) 22341The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it 22342executes an instruction at any address within the specified range, 22343(including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.) 22344 22345@kindex set powerpc 22346@item set powerpc soft-float 22347@itemx show powerpc soft-float 22348Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling 22349convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based 22350on the selected architecture and the provided executable file. 22351 22352@item set powerpc vector-abi 22353@itemx show powerpc vector-abi 22354Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector 22355arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto}; 22356@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present; 22357@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE 22358registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention 22359based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file. 22360 22361@item set powerpc exact-watchpoints 22362@itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints 22363Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable 22364of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the 22365address of its first byte. 22366 22367@end table 22368 22369@node AVR 22370@subsection Atmel AVR 22371@cindex AVR 22372 22373When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the 22374following AVR-specific commands: 22375 22376@table @code 22377@item info io_registers 22378@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR} 22379@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR) 22380This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For 22381each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value. 22382@end table 22383 22384@node CRIS 22385@subsection CRIS 22386@cindex CRIS 22387 22388When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the 22389following CRIS-specific commands: 22390 22391@table @code 22392@item set cris-version @var{ver} 22393@cindex CRIS version 22394Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}. 22395The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in 22396case autodetection of the CRIS version fails. 22397 22398@item show cris-version 22399Show the current CRIS version. 22400 22401@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi 22402@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS 22403Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}. 22404Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below 22405@code{R59}. 22406 22407@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi 22408Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI. 22409 22410@item set cris-mode @var{mode} 22411@cindex CRIS mode 22412Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when 22413debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to 22414@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}). 22415 22416@item show cris-mode 22417Show the current CRIS mode. 22418@end table 22419 22420@node Super-H 22421@subsection Renesas Super-H 22422@cindex Super-H 22423 22424For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these 22425commands: 22426 22427@table @code 22428@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention} 22429@kindex set sh calling-convention 22430Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}. 22431Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}. 22432With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling 22433convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies 22434that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function 22435is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention 22436is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used, 22437regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the 22438default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler 22439does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function. 22440 22441@item show sh calling-convention 22442@kindex show sh calling-convention 22443Show the current calling convention setting. 22444 22445@end table 22446 22447 22448@node Architectures 22449@section Architectures 22450 22451This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect 22452all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross. 22453 22454@menu 22455* AArch64:: 22456* i386:: 22457* Alpha:: 22458* MIPS:: 22459* HPPA:: HP PA architecture 22460* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture 22461* PowerPC:: 22462* Nios II:: 22463@end menu 22464 22465@node AArch64 22466@subsection AArch64 22467@cindex AArch64 support 22468 22469When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the 22470following special commands: 22471 22472@table @code 22473@item set debug aarch64 22474@kindex set debug aarch64 22475This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging 22476messages are to be displayed. 22477 22478@item show debug aarch64 22479Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed. 22480 22481@end table 22482 22483@node i386 22484@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues 22485 22486@table @code 22487@item set struct-convention @var{mode} 22488@kindex set struct-convention 22489@cindex struct return convention 22490@cindex struct/union returned in registers 22491Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and 22492@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of 22493@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the 22494default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s 22495are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a 22496@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will 22497be returned in a register. 22498 22499@item show struct-convention 22500@kindex show struct-convention 22501Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s 22502from functions. 22503@end table 22504 22505 22506@subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX). 22507@cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX). 22508 22509Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0} 22510@footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture 22511registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values 22512which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or 22513memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's 22514complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0 22515(1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space. 22516 22517@samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw} 22518through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3} 22519display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the 22520upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the 22521@value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it 22522can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive. 22523 22524As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having 22525access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on 22526bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows: 22527 22528@smallexample 22529 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@} 22530 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64 22531@end smallexample 22532 22533This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any 22534change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its 22535counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via 22536Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to 22537the pointer. 22538 22539Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in 22540application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying 22541the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing 22542bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating 22543bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose: 22544 22545@table @code 22546@item show mpx bound @var{pointer} 22547@kindex show mpx bound 22548Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}. 22549 22550@item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound} 22551@kindex set mpx bound 22552Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table. 22553This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers 22554whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values 22555for lower and upper bounds respectively. 22556@end table 22557 22558When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program, 22559GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state 22560before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the 22561pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass. 22562 22563This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the 22564program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function. 22565Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not 22566clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called 22567function. 22568 22569You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the 22570execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the 22571called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and 22572continuing the execution. For example: 22573 22574@smallexample 22575 $ break *upper 22576 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47. 22577 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1) 22578 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48).... 22579 $ print $bnd0 22580 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1 22581@end smallexample 22582 22583At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound 22584violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to 22585set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI. 22586 22587@node Alpha 22588@subsection Alpha 22589 22590See the following section. 22591 22592@node MIPS 22593@subsection @acronym{MIPS} 22594 22595@cindex stack on Alpha 22596@cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS} 22597@cindex Alpha stack 22598@cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack 22599Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which 22600sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to 22601find the beginning of a function. 22602 22603@cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging 22604To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where 22605@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search) 22606you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these 22607commands: 22608 22609@table @code 22610@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS}) 22611@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit} 22612Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its 22613search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the 22614default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the 22615larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search 22616and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use 22617this command when debugging a stripped executable. 22618 22619@item show heuristic-fence-post 22620Display the current limit. 22621@end table 22622 22623@noindent 22624These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured 22625for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors. 22626 22627Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS} 22628programs: 22629 22630@table @code 22631@item set mips abi @var{arg} 22632@kindex set mips abi 22633@cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS} 22634Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible 22635values of @var{arg} are: 22636 22637@table @samp 22638@item auto 22639The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the 22640default). 22641@item o32 22642@item o64 22643@item n32 22644@item n64 22645@item eabi32 22646@item eabi64 22647@end table 22648 22649@item show mips abi 22650@kindex show mips abi 22651Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior. 22652 22653@item set mips compression @var{arg} 22654@kindex set mips compression 22655@cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS} 22656Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed 22657@acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the 22658inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other 22659internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to 22660when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or 22661the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses. 22662Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information 22663provided by the executable. 22664 22665Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}. 22666The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as 22667executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not 22668identified as such. 22669 22670This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across 22671debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or 22672implicitly from an executable. 22673 22674The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to 22675identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or 22676@acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations 22677are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global 22678compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting. 22679 22680@item show mips compression 22681@kindex show mips compression 22682Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by 22683@value{GDBN} to debug the inferior. 22684 22685@item set mipsfpu 22686@itemx show mipsfpu 22687@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}. 22688 22689@item set mips mask-address @var{arg} 22690@kindex set mips mask-address 22691@cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking 22692This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit 22693@acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be 22694@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default 22695setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value. 22696 22697@item show mips mask-address 22698@kindex show mips mask-address 22699Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or 22700not. 22701 22702@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22703@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22704This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that 22705transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target 22706that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr}, 22707and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}. 22708 22709@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22710@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22711Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets. 22712 22713@item set debug mips 22714@kindex set debug mips 22715This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific 22716target code in @value{GDBN}. 22717 22718@item show debug mips 22719@kindex show debug mips 22720Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages. 22721@end table 22722 22723 22724@node HPPA 22725@subsection HPPA 22726@cindex HPPA support 22727 22728When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the 22729following special commands: 22730 22731@table @code 22732@item set debug hppa 22733@kindex set debug hppa 22734This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging 22735messages are to be displayed. 22736 22737@item show debug hppa 22738Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed. 22739 22740@item maint print unwind @var{address} 22741@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA} 22742This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the 22743given @var{address}. 22744 22745@end table 22746 22747 22748@node SPU 22749@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture 22750@cindex Cell Broadband Engine 22751@cindex SPU 22752 22753When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture, 22754it provides the following special commands: 22755 22756@table @code 22757@item info spu event 22758@kindex info spu 22759Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask 22760and pending event status. 22761 22762@item info spu signal 22763Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending 22764signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal 22765notification channels. 22766 22767@item info spu mailbox 22768Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries, 22769in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound, 22770SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes. 22771 22772@item info spu dma 22773Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC 22774DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective 22775and local store addresses and transfer size are shown. 22776 22777@item info spu proxydma 22778Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC 22779Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective 22780and local store addresses and transfer size are shown. 22781 22782@end table 22783 22784When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application 22785on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following 22786special commands: 22787 22788@table @code 22789@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg} 22790@kindex set spu 22791Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN} 22792will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main} 22793function. The default is @code{off}. 22794 22795@item show spu stop-on-load 22796@kindex show spu 22797Show whether to stop for new SPE threads. 22798 22799@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg} 22800Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to 22801@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed 22802cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent 22803view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application 22804does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect. 22805 22806@item show spu auto-flush-cache 22807Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. 22808 22809@end table 22810 22811@node PowerPC 22812@subsection PowerPC 22813@cindex PowerPC architecture 22814 22815When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of 22816pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point 22817numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored 22818in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like 22819@code{f0} or @code{f2}. 22820 22821The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed 22822by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0}, 22823@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on. 22824 22825For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit 22826wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}). 22827 22828@node Nios II 22829@subsection Nios II 22830@cindex Nios II architecture 22831 22832When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture, 22833it provides the following special commands: 22834 22835@table @code 22836 22837@item set debug nios2 22838@kindex set debug nios2 22839This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II 22840target code in @value{GDBN}. 22841 22842@item show debug nios2 22843@kindex show debug nios2 22844Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages. 22845@end table 22846 22847@node Controlling GDB 22848@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN} 22849 22850You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the 22851@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays 22852data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are 22853described here. 22854 22855@menu 22856* Prompt:: Prompt 22857* Editing:: Command editing 22858* Command History:: Command history 22859* Screen Size:: Screen size 22860* Numbers:: Numbers 22861* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI 22862* Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files 22863* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages 22864* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings 22865* Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings 22866@end menu 22867 22868@node Prompt 22869@section Prompt 22870 22871@cindex prompt 22872 22873@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string 22874called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You 22875can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For 22876instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change 22877the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell 22878which one you are talking to. 22879 22880@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the 22881prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space 22882or a prompt that does not. 22883 22884@table @code 22885@kindex set prompt 22886@item set prompt @var{newprompt} 22887Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth. 22888 22889@kindex show prompt 22890@item show prompt 22891Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}} 22892@end table 22893 22894Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have 22895prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions 22896are: 22897 22898@table @code 22899@kindex set extended-prompt 22900@item set extended-prompt @var{prompt} 22901Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions. 22902@xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for 22903substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt 22904string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt 22905is displayed. 22906 22907For example: 22908 22909@smallexample 22910set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb) 22911@end smallexample 22912 22913Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the 22914@var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information. 22915 22916@kindex show extended-prompt 22917@item show extended-prompt 22918Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of 22919the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the 22920corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed. 22921@end table 22922 22923@node Editing 22924@section Command Editing 22925@cindex readline 22926@cindex command line editing 22927 22928@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This 22929@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a 22930command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style 22931or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history 22932substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across 22933debugging sessions. 22934 22935You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the 22936command @code{set}. 22937 22938@table @code 22939@kindex set editing 22940@cindex editing 22941@item set editing 22942@itemx set editing on 22943Enable command line editing (enabled by default). 22944 22945@item set editing off 22946Disable command line editing. 22947 22948@kindex show editing 22949@item show editing 22950Show whether command line editing is enabled. 22951@end table 22952 22953@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 22954@xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}, 22955@end ifset 22956@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 22957@xref{Command Line Editing}, 22958@end ifclear 22959for more details about the Readline 22960interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are 22961encouraged to read that chapter. 22962 22963@node Command History 22964@section Command History 22965@cindex command history 22966 22967@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your 22968debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what 22969happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command 22970history facility. 22971 22972@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline 22973package, to provide the history facility. 22974@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 22975@xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library}, 22976@end ifset 22977@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 22978@xref{Using History Interactively}, 22979@end ifclear 22980for the detailed description of the History library. 22981 22982To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of 22983the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server } 22984(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This 22985means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it 22986affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is 22987pressed on a line by itself. 22988 22989@cindex @code{server}, command prefix 22990The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value 22991history; to print a value without recording it into the value history, 22992use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command. 22993 22994Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command 22995history. 22996 22997@table @code 22998@cindex history substitution 22999@cindex history file 23000@kindex set history filename 23001@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable 23002@item set history filename @var{fname} 23003Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}. 23004This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history 23005list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it 23006exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through 23007the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults 23008to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to 23009@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable 23010is not set. 23011 23012@cindex save command history 23013@kindex set history save 23014@item set history save 23015@itemx set history save on 23016Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the 23017@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled. 23018 23019@item set history save off 23020Stop recording command history in a file. 23021 23022@cindex history size 23023@kindex set history size 23024@cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable 23025@item set history size @var{size} 23026@itemx set history size unlimited 23027Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list. 23028This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or 23029to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE} 23030are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is 23031either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands 23032@value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited. 23033 23034@cindex remove duplicate history 23035@kindex set history remove-duplicates 23036@item set history remove-duplicates @var{count} 23037@itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited 23038Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list. 23039If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count} 23040history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current 23041entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is 23042@code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then 23043removal of duplicate history entries is disabled. 23044 23045Only history entries added during the current session are considered for 23046removal. This option is set to 0 by default. 23047 23048@end table 23049 23050History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}. 23051@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 23052@xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library}, 23053@end ifset 23054@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 23055@xref{Event Designators}, 23056@end ifclear 23057for more details. 23058 23059@cindex history expansion, turn on/off 23060Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion 23061is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the 23062@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to 23063follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with 23064a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline 23065history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings 23066@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled. 23067 23068The commands to control history expansion are: 23069 23070@table @code 23071@item set history expansion on 23072@itemx set history expansion 23073@kindex set history expansion 23074Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default. 23075 23076@item set history expansion off 23077Disable history expansion. 23078 23079@c @group 23080@kindex show history 23081@item show history 23082@itemx show history filename 23083@itemx show history save 23084@itemx show history size 23085@itemx show history expansion 23086These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters. 23087@code{show history} by itself displays all four states. 23088@c @end group 23089@end table 23090 23091@table @code 23092@kindex show commands 23093@cindex show last commands 23094@cindex display command history 23095@item show commands 23096Display the last ten commands in the command history. 23097 23098@item show commands @var{n} 23099Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}. 23100 23101@item show commands + 23102Print ten commands just after the commands last printed. 23103@end table 23104 23105@node Screen Size 23106@section Screen Size 23107@cindex size of screen 23108@cindex screen size 23109@cindex pagination 23110@cindex page size 23111@cindex pauses in output 23112 23113Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of 23114information output to the screen. To help you read all of it, 23115@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of 23116output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q} 23117to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting 23118determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being 23119printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place, 23120rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line. 23121 23122Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal 23123driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base 23124together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the 23125@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct, 23126you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set 23127width} commands: 23128 23129@table @code 23130@kindex set height 23131@kindex set width 23132@kindex show width 23133@kindex show height 23134@item set height @var{lpp} 23135@itemx set height unlimited 23136@itemx show height 23137@itemx set width @var{cpl} 23138@itemx set width unlimited 23139@itemx show width 23140These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and 23141a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show} 23142commands display the current settings. 23143 23144If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines, 23145@value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the 23146output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor 23147buffer. 23148 23149Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set 23150width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output. 23151 23152@item set pagination on 23153@itemx set pagination off 23154@kindex set pagination 23155Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning 23156pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that 23157running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode 23158Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination. 23159 23160@item show pagination 23161@kindex show pagination 23162Show the current pagination mode. 23163@end table 23164 23165@node Numbers 23166@section Numbers 23167@cindex number representation 23168@cindex entering numbers 23169 23170You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in 23171@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with 23172@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers 23173begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or 23174@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base 2317510; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular 23176format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for 23177both input and output with the commands described below. 23178 23179@table @code 23180@kindex set input-radix 23181@item set input-radix @var{base} 23182Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices 23183for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be 23184specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for 23185example, any of 23186 23187@smallexample 23188set input-radix 012 23189set input-radix 10. 23190set input-radix 0xa 23191@end smallexample 23192 23193@noindent 23194sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10} 23195leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since 23196@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is 23197interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16, 23198@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't 23199change the radix. 23200 23201@kindex set output-radix 23202@item set output-radix @var{base} 23203Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices 23204for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be 23205specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix. 23206 23207@kindex show input-radix 23208@item show input-radix 23209Display the current default base for numeric input. 23210 23211@kindex show output-radix 23212@item show output-radix 23213Display the current default base for numeric display. 23214 23215@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]} 23216@itemx show radix 23217@kindex set radix 23218@kindex show radix 23219These commands set and show the default base for both input and output 23220of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to 23221the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its 23222default value of 10. 23223 23224@end table 23225 23226@node ABI 23227@section Configuring the Current ABI 23228 23229@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your 23230application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its 23231conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the 23232current ABI. 23233 23234@cindex OS ABI 23235@kindex set osabi 23236@kindex show osabi 23237@cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling 23238 23239One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating 23240system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation. 23241@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use, 23242but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command. 23243One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use 23244an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does 23245not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your 23246platform provides. 23247 23248When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a 23249``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and 23250@code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library. 23251The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}. 23252 23253@table @code 23254@item show osabi 23255Show the OS ABI currently in use. 23256 23257@item set osabi 23258With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's. 23259 23260@item set osabi @var{abi} 23261Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}. 23262@end table 23263 23264@cindex float promotion 23265 23266Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a 23267function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped 23268(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged, 23269according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped 23270(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type 23271@code{double} and then passed. 23272 23273Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether 23274a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked 23275as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}. 23276 23277@table @code 23278@kindex set coerce-float-to-double 23279@item set coerce-float-to-double 23280@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on 23281Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed 23282to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting. 23283 23284@item set coerce-float-to-double off 23285Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped 23286functions. 23287 23288@kindex show coerce-float-to-double 23289@item show coerce-float-to-double 23290Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}. 23291@end table 23292 23293@kindex set cp-abi 23294@kindex show cp-abi 23295@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++} 23296objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was 23297used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports 23298programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using 23299multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your 23300program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use. 23301Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions 23302before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and 23303``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may 23304use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is 23305``auto''. 23306 23307@table @code 23308@item show cp-abi 23309Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use. 23310 23311@item set cp-abi 23312With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's. 23313 23314@item set cp-abi @var{abi} 23315@itemx set cp-abi auto 23316Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection. 23317@end table 23318 23319@node Auto-loading 23320@section Automatically loading associated files 23321@cindex auto-loading 23322 23323@value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically, 23324without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature 23325@dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting 23326@value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected 23327results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted 23328sources). 23329 23330@menu 23331* Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit} 23332* libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db} 23333 23334* Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path} 23335* Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load} 23336@end menu 23337 23338There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load. 23339In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written 23340in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}. 23341 23342Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit} 23343file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path} 23344(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 23345 23346For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you 23347control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded. 23348 23349@table @code 23350@anchor{set auto-load off} 23351@kindex set auto-load off 23352@item set auto-load off 23353Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files. 23354You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option 23355(@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as: 23356@smallexample 23357$ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile} 23358@end smallexample 23359 23360Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration}) 23361and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}) 23362still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories). 23363To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the 23364@option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to 23365@code{set auto-load no}. 23366 23367@anchor{show auto-load} 23368@kindex show auto-load 23369@item show auto-load 23370Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled 23371or disabled. 23372 23373@smallexample 23374(gdb) show auto-load 23375gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on. 23376libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on. 23377local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory 23378 is on. 23379python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on. 23380safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files 23381 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load. 23382scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts 23383 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load. 23384@end smallexample 23385 23386@anchor{info auto-load} 23387@kindex info auto-load 23388@item info auto-load 23389Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or 23390not. 23391 23392@smallexample 23393(gdb) info auto-load 23394gdb-scripts: 23395Loaded Script 23396Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb 23397libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db. 23398local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been 23399 loaded. 23400python-scripts: 23401Loaded Script 23402Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py 23403@end smallexample 23404@end table 23405 23406These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading: 23407 23408@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5 23409@item @xref{set auto-load off}. 23410@tab Disable auto-loading globally. 23411@item @xref{show auto-load}. 23412@tab Show setting of all kinds of files. 23413@item @xref{info auto-load}. 23414@tab Show state of all kinds of files. 23415@item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}. 23416@tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts. 23417@item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}. 23418@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts. 23419@item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}. 23420@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts. 23421@item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}. 23422@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts. 23423@item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}. 23424@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts. 23425@item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}. 23426@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts. 23427@item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}. 23428@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts. 23429@item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}. 23430@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts. 23431@item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}. 23432@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts. 23433@item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}. 23434@tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. 23435@item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}. 23436@tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. 23437@item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}. 23438@tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list. 23439@item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}. 23440@tab Control for init file in the current directory. 23441@item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}. 23442@tab Show setting of init file in the current directory. 23443@item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}. 23444@tab Show state of init file in the current directory. 23445@item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}. 23446@tab Control for thread debugging library. 23447@item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}. 23448@tab Show setting of thread debugging library. 23449@item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}. 23450@tab Show state of thread debugging library. 23451@item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}. 23452@tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading. 23453@item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}. 23454@tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading. 23455@item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}. 23456@tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading. 23457@end multitable 23458 23459@node Init File in the Current Directory 23460@subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory 23461@cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory 23462 23463By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands 23464from init file (if any) in the current working directory, 23465see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}. 23466 23467Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly 23468configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 23469 23470@table @code 23471@anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit} 23472@kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit 23473@item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off] 23474Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands 23475(@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory. 23476 23477@anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit} 23478@kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit 23479@item show auto-load local-gdbinit 23480Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the 23481current directory is enabled or disabled. 23482 23483@anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit} 23484@kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit 23485@item info auto-load local-gdbinit 23486Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the 23487current directory have been auto-loaded. 23488@end table 23489 23490@node libthread_db.so.1 file 23491@subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library 23492@cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1 23493 23494This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts. 23495 23496@value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific 23497to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}). 23498 23499The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed 23500without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system 23501libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of 23502@samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set 23503auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging 23504library. 23505 23506Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured 23507@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 23508 23509@table @code 23510@anchor{set auto-load libthread-db} 23511@kindex set auto-load libthread-db 23512@item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off] 23513Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library. 23514 23515@anchor{show auto-load libthread-db} 23516@kindex show auto-load libthread-db 23517@item show auto-load libthread-db 23518Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is 23519enabled or disabled. 23520 23521@anchor{info auto-load libthread-db} 23522@kindex info auto-load libthread-db 23523@item info auto-load libthread-db 23524Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and 23525for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it. 23526@end table 23527 23528@node Auto-loading safe path 23529@subsection Security restriction for auto-loading 23530@cindex auto-loading safe-path 23531 23532As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by 23533an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically. 23534@value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list 23535directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user. 23536Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern. 23537 23538If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not 23539get loaded: 23540 23541@smallexample 23542$ ./gdb -q ./gdb 23543Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done. 23544warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been 23545 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set 23546 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load". 23547warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been 23548 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set 23549 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load". 23550@end smallexample 23551 23552@noindent 23553To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway, 23554invoke @value{GDBN} like this: 23555 23556@smallexample 23557$ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb 23558@end smallexample 23559 23560The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands: 23561 23562@table @code 23563@anchor{set auto-load safe-path} 23564@kindex set auto-load safe-path 23565@item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]} 23566Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic 23567loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file. 23568Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match 23569directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch} 23570(@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}). 23571If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to 23572its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation. 23573 23574The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix 23575systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly 23576to the @env{PATH} environment variable. 23577 23578@anchor{show auto-load safe-path} 23579@kindex show auto-load safe-path 23580@item show auto-load safe-path 23581Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of 23582scripts. 23583 23584@anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path} 23585@kindex add-auto-load-safe-path 23586@item add-auto-load-safe-path 23587Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for 23588automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited 23589by the host platform path separator in use. 23590@end table 23591 23592This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured 23593to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir} 23594substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}. 23595The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by 23596@value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}. 23597 23598Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection, 23599corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is 23600@option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}. 23601This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the 23602system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in 23603their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated 23604init file in the current directory 23605(@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}). 23606 23607To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous 23608example, you could use one of the following ways: 23609 23610@table @asis 23611@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb} 23612Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list. 23613You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by 23614by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example). 23615 23616@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}} 23617Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single 23618@value{GDBN} session. 23619 23620@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}} 23621Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session. 23622This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come 23623from trusted sources. 23624 23625@item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path} 23626During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety. 23627This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from 23628trusted sources. 23629@end table 23630 23631On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which 23632also suppresses any such warning messages: 23633 23634@table @asis 23635@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}} 23636You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session. 23637 23638@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no} 23639Disable auto-loading globally for the user 23640(@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also 23641use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). 23642@end table 23643 23644This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches 23645@value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into 23646their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the 23647entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its 23648own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is 23649recommended to be entered. 23650 23651@node Auto-loading verbose mode 23652@subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load 23653@cindex auto-loading verbose mode 23654 23655For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to 23656be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental 23657execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing 23658all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may 23659be printed. 23660 23661For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files 23662(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which 23663may not be too obvious while setting it up. 23664 23665@smallexample 23666(gdb) set debug auto-load on 23667(gdb) file ~/src/t/true 23668auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" 23669 for objfile "/tmp/true". 23670auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt". 23671auto-load: Using directory "/usr". 23672auto-load: Using directory "/opt". 23673warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined 23674 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt". 23675@end smallexample 23676 23677@table @code 23678@anchor{set debug auto-load} 23679@kindex set debug auto-load 23680@item set debug auto-load [on|off] 23681Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded. 23682 23683@anchor{show debug auto-load} 23684@kindex show debug auto-load 23685@item show debug auto-load 23686Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned 23687on or off. 23688@end table 23689 23690@node Messages/Warnings 23691@section Optional Warnings and Messages 23692 23693@cindex verbose operation 23694@cindex optional warnings 23695By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are 23696running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose} 23697command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy 23698internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed. 23699 23700Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those 23701which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read; 23702see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}. 23703 23704@table @code 23705@kindex set verbose 23706@item set verbose on 23707Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages. 23708 23709@item set verbose off 23710Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages. 23711 23712@kindex show verbose 23713@item show verbose 23714Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off. 23715@end table 23716 23717By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an 23718object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may 23719find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading 23720Symbol Files}). 23721 23722@table @code 23723 23724@kindex set complaints 23725@item set complaints @var{limit} 23726Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of 23727unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set 23728@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number 23729to prevent complaints from being suppressed. 23730 23731@kindex show complaints 23732@item show complaints 23733Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce. 23734 23735@end table 23736 23737@anchor{confirmation requests} 23738By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a 23739lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if 23740you try to run a program which is already running: 23741 23742@smallexample 23743(@value{GDBP}) run 23744The program being debugged has been started already. 23745Start it from the beginning? (y or n) 23746@end smallexample 23747 23748If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own 23749commands, you can disable this ``feature'': 23750 23751@table @code 23752 23753@kindex set confirm 23754@cindex flinching 23755@cindex confirmation 23756@cindex stupid questions 23757@item set confirm off 23758Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with 23759the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also 23760automatically disables confirmation requests. 23761 23762@item set confirm on 23763Enables confirmation requests (the default). 23764 23765@kindex show confirm 23766@item show confirm 23767Displays state of confirmation requests. 23768 23769@end table 23770 23771@cindex command tracing 23772If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it 23773useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be 23774printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the 23775quantity denoting the call depth of each command. 23776 23777@table @code 23778@kindex set trace-commands 23779@cindex command scripts, debugging 23780@item set trace-commands on 23781Enable command tracing. 23782@item set trace-commands off 23783Disable command tracing. 23784@item show trace-commands 23785Display the current state of command tracing. 23786@end table 23787 23788@node Debugging Output 23789@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings 23790@cindex optional debugging messages 23791 23792@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from 23793various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of 23794interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This 23795section documents those commands. 23796 23797@table @code 23798@kindex set exec-done-display 23799@item set exec-done-display 23800Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands' 23801completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an 23802asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off. 23803@kindex show exec-done-display 23804@item show exec-done-display 23805Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion 23806notification. 23807@kindex set debug 23808@cindex ARM AArch64 23809@item set debug aarch64 23810Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64. 23811The default is off. 23812@kindex show debug 23813@item show debug aarch64 23814Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to 23815ARM AArch64. 23816@cindex gdbarch debugging info 23817@cindex architecture debugging info 23818@item set debug arch 23819Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off 23820@item show debug arch 23821Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info. 23822@item set debug aix-solib 23823@cindex AIX shared library debugging 23824Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library 23825support module. The default is off. 23826@item show debug aix-thread 23827Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages. 23828@item set debug aix-thread 23829@cindex AIX threads 23830Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread 23831module. 23832@item show debug aix-thread 23833Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display. 23834@item set debug check-physname 23835@cindex physname 23836Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF 23837debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute 23838each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two 23839different ways, depending on exactly what information is present. 23840When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names 23841both ways and display any discrepancies. 23842@item show debug check-physname 23843Show the current state of ``physname'' checking. 23844@item set debug coff-pe-read 23845@cindex COFF/PE exported symbols 23846Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE 23847exported symbols. The default is off. 23848@item show debug coff-pe-read 23849Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to 23850reading of COFF/PE exported symbols. 23851@item set debug dwarf-die 23852@cindex DWARF DIEs 23853Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in. 23854The value is the number of nesting levels to print. 23855A value of zero turns off the display. 23856@item show debug dwarf-die 23857Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging. 23858@item set debug dwarf-line 23859@cindex DWARF Line Tables 23860Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading 23861DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off). 23862A value of 1 provides basic information. 23863A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 23864@item show debug dwarf-line 23865Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging. 23866@item set debug dwarf-read 23867@cindex DWARF Reading 23868Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading 23869DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off). 23870A value of 1 provides basic information. 23871A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 23872@item show debug dwarf-read 23873Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging. 23874@item set debug displaced 23875@cindex displaced stepping debugging info 23876Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the 23877displaced stepping support. The default is off. 23878@item show debug displaced 23879Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info 23880related to displaced stepping. 23881@item set debug event 23882@cindex event debugging info 23883Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The 23884default is off. 23885@item show debug event 23886Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging 23887info. 23888@item set debug expression 23889@cindex expression debugging info 23890Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN} 23891expression parsing. The default is off. 23892@item show debug expression 23893Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about 23894@value{GDBN} expression parsing. 23895@item set debug fbsd-lwp 23896@cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages 23897Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support. 23898@item show debug fbsd-lwp 23899Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages. 23900@item set debug frame 23901@cindex frame debugging info 23902Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The 23903default is off. 23904@item show debug frame 23905Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging 23906info. 23907@item set debug gnu-nat 23908@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages 23909Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support. 23910@item show debug gnu-nat 23911Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages. 23912@item set debug infrun 23913@cindex inferior debugging info 23914Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior. 23915The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used 23916for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior. 23917@item show debug infrun 23918Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging. 23919@item set debug jit 23920@cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages 23921Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support. 23922@item show debug jit 23923Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging. 23924@item set debug lin-lwp 23925@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages 23926@cindex Linux lightweight processes 23927Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support. 23928@item show debug lin-lwp 23929Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages. 23930@item set debug linux-namespaces 23931@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages 23932Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support. 23933@item show debug linux-namespaces 23934Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages. 23935@item set debug mach-o 23936@cindex Mach-O symbols processing 23937Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols 23938processing. The default is off. 23939@item show debug mach-o 23940Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to 23941reading of COFF/PE exported symbols. 23942@item set debug notification 23943@cindex remote async notification debugging info 23944Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification. 23945The default is off. 23946@item show debug notification 23947Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages. 23948@item set debug observer 23949@cindex observer debugging info 23950Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This 23951includes info such as the notification of observable events. 23952@item show debug observer 23953Displays the current state of observer debugging. 23954@item set debug overload 23955@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info 23956Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging 23957info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default 23958is off. 23959@item show debug overload 23960Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload 23961debugging info. 23962@cindex expression parser, debugging info 23963@cindex debug expression parser 23964@item set debug parser 23965Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output. 23966Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression 23967parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for 23968details. The default is off. 23969@item show debug parser 23970Show the current state of expression parser debugging. 23971@cindex packets, reporting on stdout 23972@cindex serial connections, debugging 23973@cindex debug remote protocol 23974@cindex remote protocol debugging 23975@cindex display remote packets 23976@item set debug remote 23977Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across 23978the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the 23979@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off. 23980@item show debug remote 23981Displays the state of display of remote packets. 23982@item set debug serial 23983Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The 23984default is off. 23985@item show debug serial 23986Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging 23987info. 23988@item set debug solib-frv 23989@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging 23990Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code. 23991@item show debug solib-frv 23992Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging 23993messages. 23994@item set debug symbol-lookup 23995@cindex symbol lookup 23996Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup. 23997The default is 0 (off). 23998A value of 1 provides basic information. 23999A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 24000@item show debug symbol-lookup 24001Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages. 24002@item set debug symfile 24003@cindex symbol file functions 24004Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions. 24005The default is off. @xref{Files}. 24006@item show debug symfile 24007Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages. 24008@item set debug symtab-create 24009@cindex symbol table creation 24010Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation. 24011The default is 0 (off). 24012A value of 1 provides basic information. 24013A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 24014@item show debug symtab-create 24015Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging. 24016@item set debug target 24017@cindex target debugging info 24018Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info 24019includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The 24020default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the 24021value of large memory transfers. 24022@item show debug target 24023Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging 24024info. 24025@item set debug timestamp 24026@cindex timestampping debugging info 24027Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info. 24028When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging 24029message. 24030@item show debug timestamp 24031Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN} 24032debugging info. 24033@item set debug varobj 24034@cindex variable object debugging info 24035Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging 24036info. The default is off. 24037@item show debug varobj 24038Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object 24039debugging info. 24040@item set debug xml 24041@cindex XML parser debugging 24042Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers. 24043@item show debug xml 24044Displays the current state of XML debugging messages. 24045@end table 24046 24047@node Other Misc Settings 24048@section Other Miscellaneous Settings 24049@cindex miscellaneous settings 24050 24051@table @code 24052@kindex set interactive-mode 24053@item set interactive-mode 24054If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started 24055in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait 24056for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at 24057the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate 24058in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries. 24059If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether 24060its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it 24061is, non-interactively otherwise. 24062 24063In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess 24064correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful 24065in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN} 24066inside a cygwin window. 24067 24068@kindex show interactive-mode 24069@item show interactive-mode 24070Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not. 24071@end table 24072 24073@node Extending GDB 24074@chapter Extending @value{GDBN} 24075@cindex extending GDB 24076 24077@value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension. 24078@value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load 24079extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the 24080user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program 24081being debugged. 24082 24083@menu 24084* Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands 24085* Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python 24086* Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile 24087* Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions 24088* Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages 24089* Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands 24090@end menu 24091 24092To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable 24093of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN} 24094can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at 24095the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension 24096are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files. 24097@xref{Command Files,, Command files}. 24098 24099You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following 24100setting: 24101 24102@table @code 24103@kindex set script-extension 24104@kindex show script-extension 24105@item set script-extension off 24106All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files. 24107 24108@item set script-extension soft 24109The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename 24110extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN} 24111evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates 24112the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File. 24113 24114@item set script-extension strict 24115The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename 24116extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the 24117language is not supported, then the evaluation fails. 24118 24119@item show script-extension 24120Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option. 24121 24122@end table 24123 24124@node Sequences 24125@section Canned Sequences of Commands 24126 24127Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint 24128Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of 24129commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command 24130files. 24131 24132@menu 24133* Define:: How to define your own commands 24134* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands 24135* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file 24136* Output:: Commands for controlled output 24137* Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files 24138@end menu 24139 24140@node Define 24141@subsection User-defined Commands 24142 24143@cindex user-defined command 24144@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands 24145A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to 24146which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the 24147@code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments 24148separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command 24149via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example: 24150 24151@smallexample 24152define adder 24153 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2 24154end 24155@end smallexample 24156 24157@noindent 24158To execute the command use: 24159 24160@smallexample 24161adder 1 2 3 24162@end smallexample 24163 24164@noindent 24165This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of 24166its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may 24167reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior 24168functions calls. 24169 24170@cindex argument count in user-defined commands 24171@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands) 24172In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have 24173been passed. 24174 24175@smallexample 24176define adder 24177 if $argc == 2 24178 print $arg0 + $arg1 24179 end 24180 if $argc == 3 24181 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2 24182 end 24183end 24184@end smallexample 24185 24186Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier 24187to process a variable number of arguments: 24188 24189@smallexample 24190define adder 24191 set $i = 0 24192 set $sum = 0 24193 while $i < $argc 24194 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i 24195 set $i = $i + 1 24196 end 24197 print $sum 24198end 24199@end smallexample 24200 24201@table @code 24202 24203@kindex define 24204@item define @var{commandname} 24205Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command 24206by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it. 24207The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters, 24208numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined 24209prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates 24210a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command. 24211 24212The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines, 24213which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these 24214commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}. 24215 24216@kindex document 24217@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)} 24218@item document @var{commandname} 24219Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be 24220accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be 24221defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define} 24222reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}. 24223After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command 24224@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written. 24225 24226You may use the @code{document} command again to change the 24227documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define} 24228does not change the documentation. 24229 24230@kindex dont-repeat 24231@cindex don't repeat command 24232@item dont-repeat 24233Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this 24234command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET} 24235(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}). 24236 24237@kindex help user-defined 24238@item help user-defined 24239List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class 24240COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is 24241included (if any). 24242 24243@kindex show user 24244@item show user 24245@itemx show user @var{commandname} 24246Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but 24247not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the 24248definitions for all user-defined commands. 24249This does not work for user-defined python commands. 24250 24251@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands 24252@kindex show max-user-call-depth 24253@kindex set max-user-call-depth 24254@item show max-user-call-depth 24255@itemx set max-user-call-depth 24256The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion 24257levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an 24258infinite recursion and aborts the command. 24259This does not apply to user-defined python commands. 24260@end table 24261 24262In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently 24263use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}. 24264 24265When user-defined commands are executed, the 24266commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command 24267stops execution of the user-defined command. 24268 24269If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed 24270without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN} 24271commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the 24272messages when used in a user-defined command. 24273 24274@node Hooks 24275@subsection User-defined Command Hooks 24276@cindex command hooks 24277@cindex hooks, for commands 24278@cindex hooks, pre-command 24279 24280@kindex hook 24281You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined 24282command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined 24283command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) 24284before that command. 24285 24286@cindex hooks, post-command 24287@kindex hookpost 24288A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed. 24289Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command 24290@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after 24291that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with 24292pre-execution hooks, for the same command. 24293 24294It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this 24295occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion. 24296 24297@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating 24298@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME! 24299 24300@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command} 24301In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining 24302(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time 24303execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run, 24304displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed. 24305 24306For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while 24307single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution, 24308you could define: 24309 24310@smallexample 24311define hook-stop 24312handle SIGALRM nopass 24313end 24314 24315define hook-run 24316handle SIGALRM pass 24317end 24318 24319define hook-continue 24320handle SIGALRM pass 24321end 24322@end smallexample 24323 24324As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo} 24325command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message, 24326you could define: 24327 24328@smallexample 24329define hook-echo 24330echo <<<--- 24331end 24332 24333define hookpost-echo 24334echo --->>>\n 24335end 24336 24337(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World 24338<<<---Hello World--->>> 24339(@value{GDBP}) 24340 24341@end smallexample 24342 24343You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but 24344not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command 24345name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}. 24346@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias 24347@c or not? 24348You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or 24349@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@: 24350@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}. 24351 24352If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of 24353@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt 24354(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run). 24355 24356If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you 24357get a warning from the @code{define} command. 24358 24359@node Command Files 24360@subsection Command Files 24361 24362@cindex command files 24363@cindex scripting commands 24364A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are 24365@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may 24366also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it 24367does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the 24368terminal. 24369 24370You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source} 24371command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate 24372scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured 24373using the @code{script-extension} setting. 24374@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}. 24375 24376@table @code 24377@kindex source 24378@cindex execute commands from a file 24379@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename} 24380Execute the command file @var{filename}. 24381@end table 24382 24383The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially, 24384unless the order of execution is changed by one of the 24385@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not 24386printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates 24387execution of the command file and control is returned to the console. 24388 24389@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory. 24390If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a 24391directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path 24392(specified with the @samp{directory} command); 24393except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory 24394is not relevant to scripts. 24395 24396If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} 24397on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory. 24398The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the 24399search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript} 24400and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will 24401look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}. 24402The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path. 24403For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and 24404the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will 24405look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}. 24406For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification, 24407it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is 24408@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN} 24409will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}. 24410 24411If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays 24412each command as it is executed. The option must be given before 24413@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else. 24414 24415Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed 24416without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that 24417normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages 24418when called from command files. 24419 24420@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this 24421mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to 24422standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do 24423not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with 24424the next command. 24425 24426@smallexample 24427gdb < cmds > log 2>&1 24428@end smallexample 24429 24430(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example 24431will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors 24432would be directed to @file{log}. 24433 24434Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than 24435commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with 24436complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of 24437variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is 24438built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to 24439deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write 24440complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands 24441conditionally, etc. 24442 24443@table @code 24444@kindex if 24445@kindex else 24446@item if 24447@itemx else 24448This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed 24449commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an 24450expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that 24451are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero). 24452There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series 24453of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The 24454end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}. 24455 24456@kindex while 24457@item while 24458This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to 24459@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression 24460to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per 24461line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the 24462@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are 24463executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true. 24464 24465@kindex loop_break 24466@item loop_break 24467This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. 24468Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end} 24469line. 24470 24471@kindex loop_continue 24472@item loop_continue 24473This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands 24474in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution 24475branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates 24476the controlling expression. 24477 24478@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)} 24479@item end 24480Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if}, 24481@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands. 24482@end table 24483 24484 24485@node Output 24486@subsection Commands for Controlled Output 24487 24488During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal 24489@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is 24490explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section 24491describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you 24492want. 24493 24494@table @code 24495@kindex echo 24496@item echo @var{text} 24497@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence 24498@c because it is not in ANSI. 24499Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in 24500@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a 24501newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.} 24502In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed 24503by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a 24504string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and 24505trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments. 24506To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command 24507@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}. 24508 24509A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue 24510the command onto subsequent lines. For example, 24511 24512@smallexample 24513echo This is some text\n\ 24514which is continued\n\ 24515onto several lines.\n 24516@end smallexample 24517 24518produces the same output as 24519 24520@smallexample 24521echo This is some text\n 24522echo which is continued\n 24523echo onto several lines.\n 24524@end smallexample 24525 24526@kindex output 24527@item output @var{expression} 24528Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no 24529newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the 24530value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information 24531on expressions. 24532 24533@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression} 24534Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use 24535the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output 24536Formats}, for more information. 24537 24538@kindex printf 24539@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{} 24540Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of 24541the string @var{template}. To print several values, make 24542@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions, 24543which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as 24544specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by 24545executing the code below: 24546 24547@smallexample 24548printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}); 24549@end smallexample 24550 24551As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template} 24552are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced 24553by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be 24554evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and 24555style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then 24556printed. 24557 24558For example, you can print two values in hex like this: 24559 24560@smallexample 24561printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo 24562@end smallexample 24563 24564@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion 24565specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%} 24566character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions: 24567 24568@itemize @bullet 24569@item 24570The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported. 24571 24572@item 24573The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or 24574width. 24575 24576@item 24577The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to 24578@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported. 24579 24580@item 24581The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not 24582supported. 24583 24584@item 24585The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported. 24586 24587@item 24588The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported. 24589@end itemize 24590 24591@noindent 24592Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the 24593underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports 24594the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is 24595supported only if @code{long double} type is available. 24596 24597As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape 24598sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"}, 24599@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a 24600single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not 24601supported. 24602 24603Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP 24604(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers 24605together with a floating point specifier. 24606letters: 24607 24608@itemize @bullet 24609@item 24610@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types. 24611 24612@item 24613@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types. 24614 24615@item 24616@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types. 24617@end itemize 24618 24619If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has 24620support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers 24621such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use. 24622 24623In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be 24624available and the value will be printed in the standard way. 24625 24626Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters: 24627@smallexample 24628printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl 24629@end smallexample 24630 24631@anchor{eval} 24632@kindex eval 24633@item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{} 24634Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of 24635the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it. 24636 24637@end table 24638 24639@node Auto-loading sequences 24640@subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts 24641@cindex native script auto-loading 24642 24643When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file} 24644command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library), 24645@value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}. 24646@xref{Auto-loading extensions}. 24647 24648Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled, 24649and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed. 24650 24651@table @code 24652@anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts} 24653@kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts 24654@item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off] 24655Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts. 24656 24657@anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts} 24658@kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts 24659@item show auto-load gdb-scripts 24660Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or 24661disabled. 24662 24663@anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts} 24664@kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts 24665@cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts 24666@item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}] 24667Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN} 24668auto-loaded. 24669@end table 24670 24671If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with 24672matching names are printed. 24673 24674@c Python docs live in a separate file. 24675@include python.texi 24676 24677@c Guile docs live in a separate file. 24678@include guile.texi 24679 24680@node Auto-loading extensions 24681@section Auto-loading extensions 24682@cindex auto-loading extensions 24683 24684@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions 24685when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file} 24686command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library): 24687@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} 24688section of modern file formats like ELF. 24689 24690@menu 24691* objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file 24692* .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 24693* Which flavor to choose?:: 24694@end menu 24695 24696The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific 24697debugging commands and features. 24698 24699Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled, 24700and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed. 24701See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language 24702for more information. 24703For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}. 24704For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}. 24705 24706Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured 24707@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24708 24709@node objfile-gdbdotext file 24710@subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file 24711@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} 24712@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} 24713@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm} 24714 24715When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named 24716@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below), 24717where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and 24718where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language: 24719 24720@table @code 24721@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} 24722GDB's own command language 24723@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} 24724Python 24725@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm} 24726Guile 24727@end table 24728 24729@var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile} 24730is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..} 24731components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix. 24732If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a 24733script in the specified extension language. 24734 24735If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for 24736@var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below. 24737 24738Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured 24739@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24740 24741For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the 24742scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are 24743found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without 24744its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it 24745is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible 24746between Unix and MS-Windows hosts. 24747 24748@table @code 24749@anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory} 24750@kindex set auto-load scripts-directory 24751@item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]} 24752Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries 24753may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use 24754(@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS). 24755 24756Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting 24757@code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}). 24758 24759@anchor{with-auto-load-dir} 24760This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default 24761@code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN} 24762configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}. 24763 24764Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by 24765@var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any 24766reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is 24767determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and 24768@file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or 24769delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host 24770platform. 24771 24772The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix 24773systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly 24774to the @env{PATH} environment variable. 24775 24776@anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory} 24777@kindex show auto-load scripts-directory 24778@item show auto-load scripts-directory 24779Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. 24780 24781@anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory} 24782@kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory 24783@item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]} 24784Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations. 24785Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use. 24786@end table 24787 24788@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way. 24789@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding 24790@var{objfile} is opened. 24791So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it 24792is evaluated more than once. 24793 24794@node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section 24795@subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 24796@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 24797 24798For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF, 24799when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file 24800it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}. 24801If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries 24802specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that 24803specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the 24804script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}. 24805 24806The following entries are supported: 24807 24808@table @code 24809@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1 24810@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3 24811@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4 24812@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6 24813@end table 24814 24815@subsubsection Script File Entries 24816 24817If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first 24818in the current directory and then along the source search path 24819(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}), 24820except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation 24821directory is not relevant to scripts. 24822 24823File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with, 24824for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts. 24825 24826@example 24827/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */ 24828#define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \ 24829 asm("\ 24830.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\ 24831.byte 1 /* Python */\n\ 24832.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\ 24833.popsection \n\ 24834"); 24835@end example 24836 24837@noindent 24838For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}. 24839Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this: 24840 24841@example 24842DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py") 24843@end example 24844 24845The script name may include directories if desired. 24846 24847Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured 24848@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24849 24850If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library 24851using this header will get a reference to the specified script, 24852and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker 24853will remove duplicates. 24854 24855@subsubsection Script Text Entries 24856 24857Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry 24858itself instead of loading it from a file. 24859The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to 24860the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not 24861contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs. 24862The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to 24863execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among 24864all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based 24865on its name. 24866 24867Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN} 24868testsuite. 24869 24870@example 24871#include "symcat.h" 24872#include "gdb/section-scripts.h" 24873asm( 24874".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n" 24875".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n" 24876".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n" 24877".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n" 24878".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n" 24879".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ (" 24880 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n" 24881".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n" 24882".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n" 24883".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n" 24884".byte 0\n" 24885".popsection\n" 24886); 24887@end example 24888 24889Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured 24890@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24891The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file 24892containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section. 24893 24894@node Which flavor to choose? 24895@subsection Which flavor to choose? 24896 24897Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always 24898be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance. 24899 24900@noindent 24901Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way: 24902 24903@itemize @bullet 24904@item 24905Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections. 24906 24907@item 24908Ease of finding scripts for public libraries. 24909 24910Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for 24911in the source search path. 24912For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically 24913isn't a source directory in which to find the script. 24914 24915@item 24916Doesn't require source code additions. 24917@end itemize 24918 24919@noindent 24920Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way: 24921 24922@itemize @bullet 24923@item 24924Works with static linking. 24925 24926Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to 24927trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only 24928objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the 24929scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's 24930@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script. 24931 24932@item 24933Works with classes that are entirely inlined. 24934 24935Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated 24936shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to. 24937 24938@item 24939Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree. 24940 24941In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal 24942libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the 24943@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is 24944cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the 24945@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the 24946top of the source tree to the source search path. 24947@end itemize 24948 24949@node Multiple Extension Languages 24950@section Multiple Extension Languages 24951 24952The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state, 24953and generally do not interfere with each other. 24954There are some things to be aware of, however. 24955 24956@subsection Python comes first 24957 24958Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking 24959existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the 24960``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled 24961extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language, 24962(say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension 24963language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the 24964pretty-printed form of a value). 24965This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens 24966while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is 24967reported and any following extension languages are not tried. 24968 24969@node Aliases 24970@section Creating new spellings of existing commands 24971@cindex aliases for commands 24972 24973It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands. 24974For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has 24975a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it 24976that involves less typing. 24977 24978@value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias 24979of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous 24980abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}. 24981 24982Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions 24983of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the 24984@samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command. 24985 24986You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command. 24987 24988@table @code 24989 24990@kindex alias 24991@item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND} 24992 24993@end table 24994 24995@var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias. 24996Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and 24997underscores. 24998 24999@var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command 25000that is being aliased. 25001 25002The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation 25003of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command 25004lists displayed by the @samp{help} command. 25005 25006The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options, 25007and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash. 25008 25009Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation 25010of a command so that there is less to type. 25011Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current 25012shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command 25013and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}. 25014The following will accomplish this. 25015 25016@smallexample 25017(gdb) alias -a di = disas 25018@end smallexample 25019 25020Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands. 25021With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation 25022for it with the @samp{document} command. 25023An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command. 25024 25025Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of 25026@samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command. 25027This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part 25028of a command. 25029 25030@smallexample 25031(gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements 25032(gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements 25033(gdb) set p elms 20 25034(gdb) show p elms 25035Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200. 25036@end smallexample 25037 25038Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command, 25039and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show} 25040command, then you need to define the latter separately. 25041 25042Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and 25043@var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally. 25044 25045@smallexample 25046(gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele 25047@end smallexample 25048 25049Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word 25050alias for a more complex command. 25051This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}. 25052 25053@smallexample 25054(gdb) alias spe = set print elements 25055(gdb) spe 20 25056@end smallexample 25057 25058@node Interpreters 25059@chapter Command Interpreters 25060@cindex command interpreters 25061 25062@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command 25063infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch 25064between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters. 25065 25066@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console 25067interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli}) 25068and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual 25069describes both of these interfaces in great detail. 25070 25071By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter. 25072However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another 25073interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter} 25074startup options. Defined interpreters include: 25075 25076@table @code 25077@item console 25078@cindex console interpreter 25079The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often 25080used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime, 25081@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter. 25082 25083@item mi 25084@cindex mi interpreter 25085The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily 25086by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI 25087or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} 25088Interface}. 25089 25090@item mi2 25091@cindex mi2 interpreter 25092The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface. 25093 25094@item mi1 25095@cindex mi1 interpreter 25096The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3. 25097 25098@end table 25099 25100@cindex invoke another interpreter 25101 25102@kindex interpreter-exec 25103You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current 25104interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the 25105console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command: 25106 25107@smallexample 25108interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names" 25109@end smallexample 25110 25111@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of 25112@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater). 25113 25114Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the 25115duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter 25116permanently. 25117 25118@cindex start a new independent interpreter 25119 25120Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is 25121possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output 25122device (usually a tty). 25123 25124For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a 25125@value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal 25126emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional 25127command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that 25128terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified 25129input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN} 25130at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget, 25131while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using 25132the separate MI interpreter. 25133 25134To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the 25135@code{new-ui} command: 25136 25137@kindex new-ui 25138@cindex new user interface 25139@smallexample 25140new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty} 25141@end smallexample 25142 25143The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run. 25144This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command. 25145For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The 25146@var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the 25147interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a 25148pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example: 25149 25150@smallexample 25151(@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9 25152@end smallexample 25153 25154@noindent 25155runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}. 25156 25157@node TUI 25158@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface 25159@cindex TUI 25160@cindex Text User Interface 25161 25162@menu 25163* TUI Overview:: TUI overview 25164* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings 25165* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode 25166* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands 25167* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables 25168@end menu 25169 25170The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal 25171interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source 25172file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN} 25173commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only 25174on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library 25175is available. 25176 25177The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as 25178@samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}. 25179You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by 25180using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui 25181enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and 25182@ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}. 25183 25184@node TUI Overview 25185@section TUI Overview 25186 25187In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows: 25188 25189@table @emph 25190@item command 25191This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN} 25192prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still 25193managed using readline. 25194 25195@item source 25196The source window shows the source file of the program. The current 25197line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window. 25198 25199@item assembly 25200The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program. 25201 25202@item register 25203This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted 25204when their values change. 25205@end table 25206 25207The source and assembly windows show the current program position 25208by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker. 25209Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker 25210indicates the breakpoint type: 25211 25212@table @code 25213@item B 25214Breakpoint which was hit at least once. 25215 25216@item b 25217Breakpoint which was never hit. 25218 25219@item H 25220Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once. 25221 25222@item h 25223Hardware breakpoint which was never hit. 25224@end table 25225 25226The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not: 25227 25228@table @code 25229@item + 25230Breakpoint is enabled. 25231 25232@item - 25233Breakpoint is disabled. 25234@end table 25235 25236The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current 25237thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter 25238changes. 25239 25240These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command 25241window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several 25242layouts: 25243 25244@itemize @bullet 25245@item 25246source only, 25247 25248@item 25249assembly only, 25250 25251@item 25252source and assembly, 25253 25254@item 25255source and registers, or 25256 25257@item 25258assembly and registers. 25259@end itemize 25260 25261A status line above the command window shows the following information: 25262 25263@table @emph 25264@item target 25265Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target. 25266(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 25267 25268@item process 25269Gives the current process or thread number. 25270When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}. 25271 25272@item function 25273Gives the current function name for the selected frame. 25274The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}). 25275When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter, 25276the string @code{??} is displayed. 25277 25278@item line 25279Indicates the current line number for the selected frame. 25280When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed. 25281 25282@item pc 25283Indicates the current program counter address. 25284@end table 25285 25286@node TUI Keys 25287@section TUI Key Bindings 25288@cindex TUI key bindings 25289 25290The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps 25291@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 25292(@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}). 25293@end ifset 25294@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 25295(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). 25296@end ifclear 25297The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the 25298@value{GDBN} standard mode. 25299 25300@table @kbd 25301@kindex C-x C-a 25302@item C-x C-a 25303@kindex C-x a 25304@itemx C-x a 25305@kindex C-x A 25306@itemx C-x A 25307Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode, 25308the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using 25309its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering 25310the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows. 25311The screen is then refreshed. 25312 25313@kindex C-x 1 25314@item C-x 1 25315Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will 25316either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode 25317is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode. 25318 25319Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding. 25320 25321@kindex C-x 2 25322@item C-x 2 25323Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current 25324layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used. 25325When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the 25326previous layout and the new one. 25327 25328Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding. 25329 25330@kindex C-x o 25331@item C-x o 25332Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings 25333(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command 25334gives the focus to the next TUI window. 25335 25336Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding. 25337 25338@kindex C-x s 25339@item C-x s 25340Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single 25341keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}). 25342@end table 25343 25344The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode: 25345 25346@table @asis 25347@kindex PgUp 25348@item @key{PgUp} 25349Scroll the active window one page up. 25350 25351@kindex PgDn 25352@item @key{PgDn} 25353Scroll the active window one page down. 25354 25355@kindex Up 25356@item @key{Up} 25357Scroll the active window one line up. 25358 25359@kindex Down 25360@item @key{Down} 25361Scroll the active window one line down. 25362 25363@kindex Left 25364@item @key{Left} 25365Scroll the active window one column left. 25366 25367@kindex Right 25368@item @key{Right} 25369Scroll the active window one column right. 25370 25371@kindex C-L 25372@item @kbd{C-L} 25373Refresh the screen. 25374@end table 25375 25376Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they 25377are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command 25378window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use 25379other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} 25380and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window. 25381 25382@node TUI Single Key Mode 25383@section TUI Single Key Mode 25384@cindex TUI single key mode 25385 25386The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several 25387frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to 25388switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used: 25389 25390@table @kbd 25391@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25392@item c 25393continue 25394 25395@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25396@item d 25397down 25398 25399@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25400@item f 25401finish 25402 25403@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25404@item n 25405next 25406 25407@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25408@item q 25409exit the SingleKey mode. 25410 25411@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25412@item r 25413run 25414 25415@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25416@item s 25417step 25418 25419@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25420@item u 25421up 25422 25423@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25424@item v 25425info locals 25426 25427@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25428@item w 25429where 25430@end table 25431 25432Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt. 25433The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that 25434it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction 25435with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI 25436SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave 25437this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}. 25438 25439 25440@node TUI Commands 25441@section TUI-specific Commands 25442@cindex TUI commands 25443 25444The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows. 25445These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in 25446the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most 25447of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode. 25448 25449Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a 25450terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface 25451interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of 25452these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be 25453possible or desirable to enable curses window management. 25454 25455@table @code 25456@item tui enable 25457@kindex tui enable 25458Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if 25459TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session, 25460otherwise a default layout is used. 25461 25462@item tui disable 25463@kindex tui disable 25464Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter. 25465 25466@item info win 25467@kindex info win 25468List and give the size of all displayed windows. 25469 25470@item layout @var{name} 25471@kindex layout 25472Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command 25473window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which 25474additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following: 25475 25476@table @code 25477@item next 25478Display the next layout. 25479 25480@item prev 25481Display the previous layout. 25482 25483@item src 25484Display the source and command windows. 25485 25486@item asm 25487Display the assembly and command windows. 25488 25489@item split 25490Display the source, assembly, and command windows. 25491 25492@item regs 25493When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command 25494windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the 25495register, assembler, and command windows. 25496@end table 25497 25498@item focus @var{name} 25499@kindex focus 25500Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The 25501@var{name} parameter can be any of the following: 25502 25503@table @code 25504@item next 25505Make the next window active for scrolling. 25506 25507@item prev 25508Make the previous window active for scrolling. 25509 25510@item src 25511Make the source window active for scrolling. 25512 25513@item asm 25514Make the assembly window active for scrolling. 25515 25516@item regs 25517Make the register window active for scrolling. 25518 25519@item cmd 25520Make the command window active for scrolling. 25521@end table 25522 25523@item refresh 25524@kindex refresh 25525Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}. 25526 25527@item tui reg @var{group} 25528@kindex tui reg 25529Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to 25530@var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this 25531command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of 25532register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The 25533following groups are available on most targets: 25534@table @code 25535@item next 25536Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle 25537through all of the available register groups. 25538 25539@item prev 25540Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle 25541through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to 25542@var{next}. 25543 25544@item general 25545Display the general registers. 25546@item float 25547Display the floating point registers. 25548@item system 25549Display the system registers. 25550@item vector 25551Display the vector registers. 25552@item all 25553Display all registers. 25554@end table 25555 25556@item update 25557@kindex update 25558Update the source window and the current execution point. 25559 25560@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count} 25561@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count} 25562@kindex winheight 25563Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count} 25564lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts 25565decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the 25566source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the 25567disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window). 25568 25569@item tabset @var{nchars} 25570@kindex tabset 25571Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This 25572setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and 25573assembly windows. 25574@end table 25575 25576@node TUI Configuration 25577@section TUI Configuration Variables 25578@cindex TUI configuration variables 25579 25580Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows. 25581 25582@table @code 25583@item set tui border-kind @var{kind} 25584@kindex set tui border-kind 25585Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows. 25586The possible values are the following: 25587@table @code 25588@item space 25589Use a space character to draw the border. 25590 25591@item ascii 25592Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border. 25593 25594@item acs 25595Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is 25596drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them. 25597@end table 25598 25599@item set tui border-mode @var{mode} 25600@kindex set tui border-mode 25601@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode} 25602@kindex set tui active-border-mode 25603Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows 25604or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following: 25605@table @code 25606@item normal 25607Use normal attributes to display the border. 25608 25609@item standout 25610Use standout mode. 25611 25612@item reverse 25613Use reverse video mode. 25614 25615@item half 25616Use half bright mode. 25617 25618@item half-standout 25619Use half bright and standout mode. 25620 25621@item bold 25622Use extra bright or bold mode. 25623 25624@item bold-standout 25625Use extra bright or bold and standout mode. 25626@end table 25627@end table 25628 25629@node Emacs 25630@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs 25631 25632@cindex Emacs 25633@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs 25634A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and 25635edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with 25636@value{GDBN}. 25637 25638To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the 25639executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts 25640@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly 25641created Emacs buffer. 25642@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.) 25643 25644Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two 25645things: 25646 25647@itemize @bullet 25648@item 25649All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called 25650the GUD buffer. 25651 25652This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input 25653and output done by the program you are debugging. 25654 25655This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous 25656commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output 25657in this way. 25658 25659All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting 25660with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual 25661way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a 25662stop. 25663 25664@item 25665@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs. 25666 25667Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the 25668source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the 25669left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for 25670source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session 25671and the source. 25672 25673Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as 25674usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs. 25675@end itemize 25676 25677We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses 25678a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers 25679that can control the execution and describe the state of your program. 25680@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}. 25681 25682If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x 25683gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where 25684your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs 25685sets your current working directory to the directory associated 25686with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your 25687program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on 25688some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the 25689@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary 25690buffer does not display the current source and line of execution. 25691 25692The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top 25693line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands 25694that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, 25695,Commands to Specify Files}. 25696 25697By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you 25698need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you 25699keep several configurations around, with different names) you can 25700customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the 25701one you want. 25702 25703In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in 25704addition to the standard Shell mode commands: 25705 25706@table @kbd 25707@item C-h m 25708Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode. 25709 25710@item C-c C-s 25711Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also 25712update the display window to show the current file and location. 25713 25714@item C-c C-n 25715Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function 25716calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window 25717to show the current file and location. 25718 25719@item C-c C-i 25720Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update 25721display window accordingly. 25722 25723@item C-c C-f 25724Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN} 25725@code{finish} command. 25726 25727@item C-c C-r 25728Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue} 25729command. 25730 25731@item C-c < 25732Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument 25733(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}), 25734like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command. 25735 25736@item C-c > 25737Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the 25738@value{GDBN} @code{down} command. 25739@end table 25740 25741In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break}) 25742tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on. 25743 25744In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a 25745separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current. 25746Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it 25747become the current frame and display the associated source in the 25748source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the 25749selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the 25750speedbar displays watch expressions. 25751 25752If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get 25753it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to 25754request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates 25755the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current 25756frame. 25757 25758The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers 25759which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit 25760the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN} 25761communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or 25762delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease 25763to correspond properly with the code. 25764 25765A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is 25766given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} 25767Emacs Manual}). 25768 25769@node GDB/MI 25770@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface 25771 25772@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose 25773 25774@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose 25775@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to 25776@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the 25777@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It 25778is specifically intended to support the development of systems which 25779use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system. 25780 25781This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written 25782in the form of a reference manual. 25783 25784Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the 25785features described below are incomplete and subject to change 25786(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}). 25787 25788@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology 25789 25790@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi} 25791This chapter uses the following notation: 25792 25793@itemize @bullet 25794@item 25795@code{|} separates two alternatives. 25796 25797@item 25798@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional: 25799it may or may not be given. 25800 25801@item 25802@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses 25803may repeat zero or more times. 25804 25805@item 25806@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses 25807may repeat one or more times. 25808 25809@item 25810@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}. 25811@end itemize 25812 25813@ignore 25814@heading Dependencies 25815@end ignore 25816 25817@menu 25818* GDB/MI General Design:: 25819* GDB/MI Command Syntax:: 25820* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI:: 25821* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends:: 25822* GDB/MI Output Records:: 25823* GDB/MI Simple Examples:: 25824* GDB/MI Command Description Format:: 25825* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands:: 25826* GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands:: 25827* GDB/MI Program Context:: 25828* GDB/MI Thread Commands:: 25829* GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands:: 25830* GDB/MI Program Execution:: 25831* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation:: 25832* GDB/MI Variable Objects:: 25833* GDB/MI Data Manipulation:: 25834* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands:: 25835* GDB/MI Symbol Query:: 25836* GDB/MI File Commands:: 25837@ignore 25838* GDB/MI Kod Commands:: 25839* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands:: 25840* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands:: 25841@end ignore 25842* GDB/MI Target Manipulation:: 25843* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands:: 25844* GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands:: 25845* GDB/MI Support Commands:: 25846* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands:: 25847@end menu 25848 25849@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25850@node GDB/MI General Design 25851@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design 25852@cindex GDB/MI General Design 25853 25854Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three 25855parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands 25856and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response, 25857indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error. 25858For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the 25859requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the 25860response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed. 25861Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the 25862target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with 25863a command and reported as part of that command response. 25864 25865The important examples of notifications are: 25866@itemize @bullet 25867 25868@item 25869Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in 25870target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not 25871be feasible to include this information in response of resuming 25872commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in 25873different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event 25874happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming 25875command itself was successfully executed. 25876 25877@item 25878Console output, and status notifications. Console output 25879notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as 25880diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to 25881report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including 25882this information in command response would mean no output is produced 25883until the command is finished, which is undesirable. 25884 25885@item 25886General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on 25887the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example, 25888a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can 25889be included in command response, using notification allows for more 25890orthogonal frontend design. 25891 25892@end itemize 25893 25894There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error, 25895@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially, 25896the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was 25897processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error, 25898we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in 25899the user interface. 25900 25901 25902@menu 25903* Context management:: 25904* Asynchronous and non-stop modes:: 25905* Thread groups:: 25906@end menu 25907 25908@node Context management 25909@subsection Context management 25910 25911@subsubsection Threads and Frames 25912 25913In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is 25914done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}). 25915Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread 25916be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame, 25917and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient, 25918because a command line user would not want to specify that information 25919explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with 25920@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as 25921to what thread and frame are the current ones. 25922 25923In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less 25924useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information 25925itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window, 25926each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might 25927want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This 25928increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the 25929frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command 25930should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To 25931make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and 25932@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global 25933identifier for thread and frame to operate on. 25934 25935Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select 25936a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further 25937operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the 25938current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a 25939breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is 25940hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or 25941@samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the 25942frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN} 25943communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the 25944@samp{=thread-selected} notification. 25945 25946Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so 25947frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the 25948right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The 25949simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command 25950before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need 25951to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select} 25952if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the 25953thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this 25954optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend 25955sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the 25956selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will 25957change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such 25958problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for 25959all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly 25960right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and 25961@samp{--frame} options. 25962 25963@subsubsection Language 25964 25965The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected. 25966By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used. 25967But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended 25968to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument, 25969which is the name of the language to use while executing the command. 25970For instance: 25971 25972@smallexample 25973-data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)" 25974^done,value="4" 25975(gdb) 25976@end smallexample 25977 25978The valid language names are the same names accepted by the 25979@samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto}, 25980@samp{local} or @samp{unknown}. 25981 25982@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes 25983@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode 25984 25985On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands 25986even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous 25987command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may 25988specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the 25989@code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before 25990either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the 25991frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can 25992find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the 25993@code{-list-target-features} command. 25994 25995@table @code 25996@item -gdb-set mi-async on 25997@item -gdb-set mi-async off 25998Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode. 25999 26000When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g., 26001@code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits 26002for the program to stop before processing further commands. 26003 26004When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution 26005commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the 26006@code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing 26007MI commands even while the target is running. 26008 26009@item -gdb-show mi-async 26010Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled. 26011@end table 26012 26013Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called 26014@code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect 26015of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background 26016commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible 26017``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is 26018kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility. 26019 26020Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running, 26021many commands that access the target do not work when the target is 26022running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful 26023when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then, 26024it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads 26025are running. 26026 26027When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the 26028target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on 26029some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's 26030stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or 26031modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note 26032that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print}, 26033@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the 26034context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a 26035stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the 26036@samp{--thread} option). 26037 26038Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is 26039highly target dependent. However, the two commands 26040@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info}, 26041to find the state of a thread, will always work. 26042 26043@node Thread groups 26044@subsection Thread groups 26045@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time. 26046On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several 26047hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different 26048processes running on each core. This section describes the MI 26049mechanism to support such debugging scenarios. 26050 26051The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the 26052target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that 26053accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that 26054thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce 26055neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the 26056current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature 26057that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped 26058into processes. 26059 26060To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary 26061hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a 26062@dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other 26063thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type, 26064and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new 26065command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level 26066thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is 26067debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group 26068to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain 26069the members of specific thread group. 26070 26071To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he 26072wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is 26073introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that 26074@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the 26075@code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread 26076groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}. 26077In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only 26078after attaching to that thread group. 26079 26080Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and 26081Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special 26082type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on 26083such thread groups. 26084 26085@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26086@node GDB/MI Command Syntax 26087@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax 26088 26089@menu 26090* GDB/MI Input Syntax:: 26091* GDB/MI Output Syntax:: 26092@end menu 26093 26094@node GDB/MI Input Syntax 26095@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax 26096 26097@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi} 26098@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax 26099@table @code 26100@item @var{command} @expansion{} 26101@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}} 26102 26103@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{} 26104@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where 26105@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command. 26106 26107@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{} 26108@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )* 26109@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}} 26110 26111@item @var{token} @expansion{} 26112"any sequence of digits" 26113 26114@item @var{option} @expansion{} 26115@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]} 26116 26117@item @var{parameter} @expansion{} 26118@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}} 26119 26120@item @var{operation} @expansion{} 26121@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter} 26122 26123@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{} 26124@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as 26125"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "} 26126 26127@item @var{c-string} @expansion{} 26128@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """} 26129 26130@item @var{nl} @expansion{} 26131@code{CR | CR-LF} 26132@end table 26133 26134@noindent 26135Notes: 26136 26137@itemize @bullet 26138@item 26139The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their 26140output is described below. 26141 26142@item 26143The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command 26144finishes. 26145 26146@item 26147Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter 26148list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be 26149followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the 26150parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using 26151@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash). 26152@end itemize 26153 26154Pragmatics: 26155 26156@itemize @bullet 26157@item 26158We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging). 26159 26160@item 26161We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation. 26162@end itemize 26163 26164@node GDB/MI Output Syntax 26165@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax 26166 26167@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi} 26168@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax 26169The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records 26170followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record 26171is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is 26172terminated by @samp{(gdb)}. 26173 26174If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the 26175corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same 26176@var{token}. 26177 26178@table @code 26179@item @var{output} @expansion{} 26180@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}} 26181 26182@item @var{result-record} @expansion{} 26183@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}} 26184 26185@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{} 26186@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}} 26187 26188@item @var{async-record} @expansion{} 26189@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}} 26190 26191@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{} 26192@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}} 26193 26194@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{} 26195@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}} 26196 26197@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{} 26198@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}} 26199 26200@item @var{async-output} @expansion{} 26201@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*} 26202 26203@item @var{result-class} @expansion{} 26204@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"} 26205 26206@item @var{async-class} @expansion{} 26207@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added 26208depending on the needs---this is still in development). 26209 26210@item @var{result} @expansion{} 26211@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}} 26212 26213@item @var{variable} @expansion{} 26214@code{ @var{string} } 26215 26216@item @var{value} @expansion{} 26217@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} } 26218 26219@item @var{const} @expansion{} 26220@code{@var{c-string}} 26221 26222@item @var{tuple} @expansion{} 26223@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" } 26224 26225@item @var{list} @expansion{} 26226@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "[" 26227@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" } 26228 26229@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{} 26230@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}} 26231 26232@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{} 26233@code{"~" @var{c-string nl}} 26234 26235@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{} 26236@code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}} 26237 26238@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{} 26239@code{"&" @var{c-string nl}} 26240 26241@item @var{nl} @expansion{} 26242@code{CR | CR-LF} 26243 26244@item @var{token} @expansion{} 26245@emph{any sequence of digits}. 26246@end table 26247 26248@noindent 26249Notes: 26250 26251@itemize @bullet 26252@item 26253All output sequences end in a single line containing a period. 26254 26255@item 26256The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that 26257for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and 26258may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async 26259output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat 26260all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the 26261target and there should be no need to associate async output to any 26262prior command. 26263 26264@item 26265@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26266@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the 26267progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is 26268prefixed by @samp{+}. 26269 26270@item 26271@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26272@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target 26273(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by 26274@samp{*}. 26275 26276@item 26277@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26278@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the 26279client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify 26280output is prefixed by @samp{=}. 26281 26282@item 26283@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26284@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the 26285console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console 26286output is prefixed by @samp{~}. 26287 26288@item 26289@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26290@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program. 26291All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}. 26292 26293@item 26294@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26295@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for 26296instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All 26297the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}. 26298 26299@item 26300@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26301New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing 26302@var{values}. 26303 26304 26305@end itemize 26306 26307@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more 26308details about the various output records. 26309 26310@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26311@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI 26312@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI 26313 26314@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI 26315@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI 26316 26317For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly, 26318but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands 26319that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint 26320command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as 26321@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with 26322@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output. 26323 26324This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is 26325recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command 26326(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}). 26327 26328@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26329@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends 26330@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends 26331@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development 26332 26333The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the 26334program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}. 26335 26336Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used 26337by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult 26338to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This 26339section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol 26340might change. 26341 26342Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and 26343for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a 26344list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should 26345parse MI output in a way that can handle them: 26346 26347@itemize @bullet 26348@item 26349New MI commands may be added. 26350 26351@item 26352New fields may be added to the output of any MI command. 26353 26354@item 26355The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g., 26356@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended. 26357 26358@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it 26359@c at your own risk. Yes, in general? 26360 26361@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might 26362@c resolve inconsistencies. 26363@end itemize 26364 26365If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level 26366will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the 26367output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of 26368@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the 26369responsibility of the front end to work with the new one. 26370 26371@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI 26372@c version? 26373 26374The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front 26375end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and 26376follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and 26377@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. 26378@cindex mailing lists 26379 26380@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26381@node GDB/MI Output Records 26382@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records 26383 26384@menu 26385* GDB/MI Result Records:: 26386* GDB/MI Stream Records:: 26387* GDB/MI Async Records:: 26388* GDB/MI Breakpoint Information:: 26389* GDB/MI Frame Information:: 26390* GDB/MI Thread Information:: 26391* GDB/MI Ada Exception Information:: 26392@end menu 26393 26394@node GDB/MI Result Records 26395@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records 26396 26397@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi} 26398@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records 26399In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a 26400@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications: 26401 26402@table @code 26403@findex ^done 26404@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ] 26405The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return 26406values. 26407 26408@item "^running" 26409@findex ^running 26410This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it 26411was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the 26412target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but 26413all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running} 26414identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine 26415which threads are resumed. 26416 26417@item "^connected" 26418@findex ^connected 26419@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target. 26420 26421@item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ] 26422@findex ^error 26423The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains 26424the corresponding error message. 26425 26426If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error 26427code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding 26428error condition. At present, only one error code is defined: 26429 26430@table @samp 26431@item "undefined-command" 26432Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist. 26433@end table 26434 26435@item "^exit" 26436@findex ^exit 26437@value{GDBN} has terminated. 26438 26439@end table 26440 26441@node GDB/MI Stream Records 26442@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records 26443 26444@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records 26445@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi} 26446@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the 26447target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is 26448funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}. 26449 26450Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which 26451identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output 26452Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a 26453@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new 26454line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline). 26455 26456@table @code 26457@item "~" @var{string-output} 26458The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the 26459CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands. 26460 26461@item "@@" @var{string-output} 26462The target output stream contains any textual output from the running 26463target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly 26464asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets. 26465 26466@item "&" @var{string-output} 26467The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s 26468internals. 26469@end table 26470 26471@node GDB/MI Async Records 26472@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records 26473 26474@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi} 26475@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records 26476@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of 26477additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a 26478consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of 26479target activity (e.g., target stopped). 26480 26481The following is the list of possible async records: 26482 26483@table @code 26484 26485@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}" 26486The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global 26487thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be 26488@samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume 26489that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this 26490notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this 26491notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may 26492emit this notification several times, either for different threads, 26493because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single 26494thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting 26495it run freely. 26496 26497@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}" 26498The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the 26499following values: 26500 26501@table @code 26502@item breakpoint-hit 26503A breakpoint was reached. 26504@item watchpoint-trigger 26505A watchpoint was triggered. 26506@item read-watchpoint-trigger 26507A read watchpoint was triggered. 26508@item access-watchpoint-trigger 26509An access watchpoint was triggered. 26510@item function-finished 26511An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished. 26512@item location-reached 26513An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished. 26514@item watchpoint-scope 26515A watchpoint has gone out of scope. 26516@item end-stepping-range 26517An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or 26518similar CLI command was accomplished. 26519@item exited-signalled 26520The inferior exited because of a signal. 26521@item exited 26522The inferior exited. 26523@item exited-normally 26524The inferior exited normally. 26525@item signal-received 26526A signal was received by the inferior. 26527@item solib-event 26528The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded. 26529This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is 26530set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is 26531in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}). 26532@item fork 26533The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork} 26534(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26535@item vfork 26536The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork} 26537(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26538@item syscall-entry 26539The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch 26540syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26541@item syscall-return 26542The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when 26543@code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26544@item exec 26545The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec} 26546(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26547@end table 26548 26549The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread 26550that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. 26551Depending on whether all-stop 26552mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either 26553stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop. 26554If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the 26555value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped} 26556field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will 26557always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see 26558several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the 26559processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent 26560if such information is not available. 26561 26562@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}" 26563@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}" 26564A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field 26565contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread 26566group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running 26567process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and 26568cannot be used in any way. 26569 26570@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}" 26571A thread group became associated with a running program, 26572either because the program was just started or the thread group 26573was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the 26574@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field 26575contains process identifier, specific to the operating system. 26576 26577@item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"] 26578A thread group is no longer associated with a running program, 26579either because the program has exited, or because it was detached 26580from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the 26581thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists 26582only when the inferior exited with some code. 26583 26584@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}" 26585@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}" 26586A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field 26587contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid} 26588field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to. 26589 26590@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"] 26591Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification 26592is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or 26593@code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command 26594that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually 26595changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly 26596(via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands, 26597will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another 26598user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification. 26599 26600The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is 26601stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value. 26602 26603We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends 26604highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to 26605that thread. 26606 26607@item =library-loaded,... 26608Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This 26609notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name}, 26610@var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an 26611opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case, 26612@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the 26613library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native 26614debugging, both those fields have the same value. The 26615@var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility 26616and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The 26617@var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread 26618group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is 26619absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present 26620thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging 26621to this library. 26622 26623@item =library-unloaded,... 26624Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification 26625has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with 26626the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification. 26627The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the 26628thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is 26629absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present 26630thread groups. 26631 26632@item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum} 26633@itemx =traceframe-changed,end 26634Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is 26635@var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace 26636frame is @var{tpnum}. 26637 26638@item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial} 26639Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with 26640initial value @var{initial}. 26641 26642@item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name} 26643@itemx =tsv-deleted 26644Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all 26645trace state variables are deleted. 26646 26647@item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}] 26648Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with 26649the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of 26650trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current 26651value of trace state variable is known. 26652 26653@item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@} 26654@itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@} 26655@itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number} 26656Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted, 26657respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI 26658user. 26659 26660The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various 26661breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The 26662@var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint. 26663 26664Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a 26665command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record. 26666 26667@item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"] 26668@itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}" 26669Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an 26670inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread 26671group corresponding to the affected inferior. 26672 26673The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the 26674method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present 26675and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay}, 26676for existing method and format values. 26677 26678@item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value} 26679Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is 26680changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command, 26681the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command. 26682For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param} 26683is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}. 26684 26685@item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"] 26686Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were 26687written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the 26688thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional 26689@code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds 26690executable code. 26691@end table 26692 26693@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information 26694@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information 26695 26696When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a 26697tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the 26698following fields: 26699 26700@table @code 26701@item number 26702The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location 26703of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like 26704@samp{1.2}. 26705 26706@item type 26707The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be 26708@samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible. 26709 26710@item catch-type 26711If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this 26712indicates the exact type of catchpoint. 26713 26714@item disp 26715This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that 26716the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep}, 26717meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted. 26718 26719@item enabled 26720This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the 26721value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}. 26722Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}. 26723 26724@item addr 26725The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number, 26726giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending 26727breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with 26728multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can 26729be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address. 26730 26731@item func 26732If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears. 26733If not known, this field is not present. 26734 26735@item filename 26736The name of the source file which contains this function, if known. 26737If not known, this field is not present. 26738 26739@item fullname 26740The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if 26741known. If not known, this field is not present. 26742 26743@item line 26744The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known. 26745If not known, this field is not present. 26746 26747@item at 26748If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If 26749provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed 26750by a symbol name. 26751 26752@item pending 26753If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the 26754text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user. 26755 26756@item evaluated-by 26757Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or 26758@samp{target}. 26759 26760@item thread 26761If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the 26762thread in which the breakpoint can trigger. 26763 26764@item task 26765If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this 26766field will hold the task identifier. 26767 26768@item cond 26769If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression. 26770 26771@item ignore 26772The ignore count of the breakpoint. 26773 26774@item enable 26775The enable count of the breakpoint. 26776 26777@item traceframe-usage 26778FIXME. 26779 26780@item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id 26781For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker. 26782 26783@item mask 26784For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask. 26785 26786@item pass 26787A tracepoint's pass count. 26788 26789@item original-location 26790The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user. 26791This field is optional. 26792 26793@item times 26794The number of times the breakpoint has been hit. 26795 26796@item installed 26797This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y}, 26798meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it 26799is not. 26800 26801@item what 26802Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent. 26803 26804@end table 26805 26806For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert} 26807(@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be: 26808 26809@smallexample 26810-> -break-insert main 26811<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 26812 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c", 26813 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"], 26814 times="0"@} 26815<- (gdb) 26816@end smallexample 26817 26818@node GDB/MI Frame Information 26819@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information 26820 26821Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack 26822frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following 26823fields: 26824 26825@table @code 26826@item level 26827The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of 26828zero. This field is always present. 26829 26830@item func 26831The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may 26832be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name. 26833 26834@item addr 26835The code address for the frame. This field is always present. 26836 26837@item file 26838The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code 26839address. This field may be absent. 26840 26841@item line 26842The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field 26843may be absent. 26844 26845@item from 26846The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the 26847corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent. 26848 26849@end table 26850 26851@node GDB/MI Thread Information 26852@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information 26853 26854Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it 26855uses a tuple with the following fields: 26856 26857@table @code 26858@item id 26859The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is 26860always present. 26861 26862@item target-id 26863Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present. 26864 26865@item details 26866Additional information about the thread provided by the target. 26867It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the 26868frontend. This field is optional. 26869 26870@item state 26871Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the 26872thread is presently running. This field is always present. 26873 26874@item core 26875The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the 26876thread was last seen on. This field is optional. 26877@end table 26878 26879@node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information 26880@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information 26881 26882Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program 26883stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}), 26884@value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via 26885the @code{exception-name} field. 26886 26887@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26888@node GDB/MI Simple Examples 26889@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction 26890@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples 26891 26892This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using 26893the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the 26894following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means 26895the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}. 26896 26897Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for 26898readability, they don't appear in the real output. 26899 26900@subheading Setting a Breakpoint 26901 26902Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed 26903information of the breakpoint. 26904 26905@smallexample 26906-> -break-insert main 26907<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 26908 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c", 26909 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"], 26910 times="0"@} 26911<- (gdb) 26912@end smallexample 26913 26914@subheading Program Execution 26915 26916Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the 26917reason that execution stopped. 26918 26919@smallexample 26920-> -exec-run 26921<- ^running 26922<- (gdb) 26923<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0", 26924 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main", 26925 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}], 26926 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@} 26927<- (gdb) 26928-> -exec-continue 26929<- ^running 26930<- (gdb) 26931<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally" 26932<- (gdb) 26933@end smallexample 26934 26935@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN} 26936 26937Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}. 26938 26939@smallexample 26940-> (gdb) 26941<- -gdb-exit 26942<- ^exit 26943@end smallexample 26944 26945Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might 26946take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN} 26947performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged 26948or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till 26949@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it 26950fails to exit in reasonable time. 26951 26952@subheading A Bad Command 26953 26954Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command: 26955 26956@smallexample 26957-> -rubbish 26958<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish" 26959<- (gdb) 26960@end smallexample 26961 26962 26963@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26964@node GDB/MI Command Description Format 26965@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format 26966 26967The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of 26968commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section. 26969 26970@subheading Motivation 26971 26972The motivation for this collection of commands. 26973 26974@subheading Introduction 26975 26976A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole. 26977 26978@subheading Commands 26979 26980For each command in the block, the following is described: 26981 26982@subsubheading Synopsis 26983 26984@smallexample 26985 -command @var{args}@dots{} 26986@end smallexample 26987 26988@subsubheading Result 26989 26990@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26991 26992The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any. 26993 26994@subsubheading Example 26995 26996Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have 26997not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available). 26998 26999 27000@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27001@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands 27002@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands 27003 27004@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi} 27005@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands 27006This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating 27007breakpoints. 27008 27009@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command 27010@findex -break-after 27011 27012@subsubheading Synopsis 27013 27014@smallexample 27015 -break-after @var{number} @var{count} 27016@end smallexample 27017 27018The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been 27019hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of 27020the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the 27021@samp{-break-list} command below. 27022 27023@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27024 27025The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}. 27026 27027@subsubheading Example 27028 27029@smallexample 27030(gdb) 27031-break-insert main 27032^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 27033enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c", 27034fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"], 27035times="0"@} 27036(gdb) 27037-break-after 1 3 27038~ 27039^done 27040(gdb) 27041-break-list 27042^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27043hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27044@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27045@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27046@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27047@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27048@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27049body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27050addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27051line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@} 27052(gdb) 27053@end smallexample 27054 27055@ignore 27056@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command 27057@findex -break-catch 27058@end ignore 27059 27060@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command 27061@findex -break-commands 27062 27063@subsubheading Synopsis 27064 27065@smallexample 27066 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ] 27067@end smallexample 27068 27069Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint 27070@var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN} 27071are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set 27072commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this 27073functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of 27074some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing. 27075 27076@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27077 27078The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}. 27079 27080@subsubheading Example 27081 27082@smallexample 27083(gdb) 27084-break-insert main 27085^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 27086enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c", 27087fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"], 27088times="0"@} 27089(gdb) 27090-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue" 27091^done 27092(gdb) 27093@end smallexample 27094 27095@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command 27096@findex -break-condition 27097 27098@subsubheading Synopsis 27099 27100@smallexample 27101 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr} 27102@end smallexample 27103 27104Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in 27105@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the 27106@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list} 27107command below). 27108 27109@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27110 27111The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}. 27112 27113@subsubheading Example 27114 27115@smallexample 27116(gdb) 27117-break-condition 1 1 27118^done 27119(gdb) 27120-break-list 27121^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27122hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27123@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27124@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27125@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27126@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27127@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27128body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27129addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27130line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@} 27131(gdb) 27132@end smallexample 27133 27134@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command 27135@findex -break-delete 27136 27137@subsubheading Synopsis 27138 27139@smallexample 27140 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 27141@end smallexample 27142 27143Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument 27144list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list. 27145 27146@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27147 27148The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}. 27149 27150@subsubheading Example 27151 27152@smallexample 27153(gdb) 27154-break-delete 1 27155^done 27156(gdb) 27157-break-list 27158^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6", 27159hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27160@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27161@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27162@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27163@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27164@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27165body=[]@} 27166(gdb) 27167@end smallexample 27168 27169@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command 27170@findex -break-disable 27171 27172@subsubheading Synopsis 27173 27174@smallexample 27175 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 27176@end smallexample 27177 27178Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the 27179break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s). 27180 27181@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27182 27183The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}. 27184 27185@subsubheading Example 27186 27187@smallexample 27188(gdb) 27189-break-disable 2 27190^done 27191(gdb) 27192-break-list 27193^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27194hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27195@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27196@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27197@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27198@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27199@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27200body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n", 27201addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27202line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27203(gdb) 27204@end smallexample 27205 27206@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command 27207@findex -break-enable 27208 27209@subsubheading Synopsis 27210 27211@smallexample 27212 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 27213@end smallexample 27214 27215Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s). 27216 27217@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27218 27219The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}. 27220 27221@subsubheading Example 27222 27223@smallexample 27224(gdb) 27225-break-enable 2 27226^done 27227(gdb) 27228-break-list 27229^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27230hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27231@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27232@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27233@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27234@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27235@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27236body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27237addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27238line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27239(gdb) 27240@end smallexample 27241 27242@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command 27243@findex -break-info 27244 27245@subsubheading Synopsis 27246 27247@smallexample 27248 -break-info @var{breakpoint} 27249@end smallexample 27250 27251@c REDUNDANT??? 27252Get information about a single breakpoint. 27253 27254The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint 27255Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the 27256table. 27257 27258@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27259 27260The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}. 27261 27262@subsubheading Example 27263N.A. 27264 27265@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command 27266@findex -break-insert 27267@anchor{-break-insert} 27268 27269@subsubheading Synopsis 27270 27271@smallexample 27272 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ] 27273 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ] 27274 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] 27275@end smallexample 27276 27277@noindent 27278If specified, @var{location}, can be one of: 27279 27280@table @var 27281@item linespec location 27282A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}. 27283 27284@item explicit location 27285An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are 27286analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names 27287listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}. 27288 27289@table @samp 27290@item --source @var{filename} 27291The source file name of the location. This option requires the use 27292of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}. 27293 27294@item --function @var{function} 27295The name of a function or method. 27296 27297@item --label @var{label} 27298The name of a label. 27299 27300@item --line @var{lineoffset} 27301An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location. 27302@end table 27303 27304@item address location 27305An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}. 27306@end table 27307 27308@noindent 27309The possible optional parameters of this command are: 27310 27311@table @samp 27312@item -t 27313Insert a temporary breakpoint. 27314@item -h 27315Insert a hardware breakpoint. 27316@item -f 27317If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it 27318refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending 27319breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report 27320an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location} 27321cannot be parsed. 27322@item -d 27323Create a disabled breakpoint. 27324@item -a 27325Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter 27326is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created. 27327@item -c @var{condition} 27328Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27329@item -i @var{ignore-count} 27330Initialize the @var{ignore-count}. 27331@item -p @var{thread-id} 27332Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global 27333@var{thread-id}. 27334@end table 27335 27336@subsubheading Result 27337 27338@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the 27339resulting breakpoint. 27340 27341Note: this format is open to change. 27342@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result? 27343 27344@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27345 27346The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak}, 27347@samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}. 27348 27349@subsubheading Example 27350 27351@smallexample 27352(gdb) 27353-break-insert main 27354^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c", 27355fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"], 27356times="0"@} 27357(gdb) 27358-break-insert -t foo 27359^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c", 27360fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"], 27361times="0"@} 27362(gdb) 27363-break-list 27364^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27365hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27366@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27367@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27368@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27369@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27370@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27371body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27372addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c", 27373fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"], 27374times="0"@}, 27375bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y", 27376addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c", 27377fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"], 27378times="0"@}]@} 27379(gdb) 27380@c -break-insert -r foo.* 27381@c ~int foo(int, int); 27382@c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c, 27383@c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"], 27384@c times="0"@} 27385@c (gdb) 27386@end smallexample 27387 27388@subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command 27389@findex -dprintf-insert 27390 27391@subsubheading Synopsis 27392 27393@smallexample 27394 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ] 27395 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ] 27396 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ] 27397 [ @var{argument} ] 27398@end smallexample 27399 27400@noindent 27401If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for 27402the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}. 27403 27404The possible optional parameters of this command are: 27405 27406@table @samp 27407@item -t 27408Insert a temporary breakpoint. 27409@item -f 27410If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it 27411refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending 27412breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report 27413an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location} 27414cannot be parsed. 27415@item -d 27416Create a disabled breakpoint. 27417@item -c @var{condition} 27418Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27419@item -i @var{ignore-count} 27420Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count}) 27421to @var{ignore-count}. 27422@item -p @var{thread-id} 27423Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global 27424@var{thread-id}. 27425@end table 27426 27427@subsubheading Result 27428 27429@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the 27430resulting breakpoint. 27431 27432@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result? 27433 27434@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27435 27436The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}. 27437 27438@subsubheading Example 27439 27440@smallexample 27441(gdb) 274424-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n" 274434^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27444addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c", 27445fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"], 27446times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@}, 27447original-location="foo"@} 27448(gdb) 274495-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g 274505^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27451addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c", 27452fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"], 27453times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@}, 27454original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@} 27455(gdb) 27456@end smallexample 27457 27458@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command 27459@findex -break-list 27460 27461@subsubheading Synopsis 27462 27463@smallexample 27464 -break-list 27465@end smallexample 27466 27467Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields: 27468 27469@table @samp 27470@item Number 27471number of the breakpoint 27472@item Type 27473type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint} 27474@item Disposition 27475should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep} 27476or @samp{nokeep} 27477@item Enabled 27478is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n} 27479@item Address 27480memory location at which the breakpoint is set 27481@item What 27482logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file 27483name, line number 27484@item Thread-groups 27485list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies 27486@item Times 27487number of times the breakpoint has been hit 27488@end table 27489 27490If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable} 27491@code{body} field is an empty list. 27492 27493@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27494 27495The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}. 27496 27497@subsubheading Example 27498 27499@smallexample 27500(gdb) 27501-break-list 27502^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27503hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27504@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27505@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27506@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27507@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27508@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27509body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27510addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"], 27511times="0"@}, 27512bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27513addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27514line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27515(gdb) 27516@end smallexample 27517 27518Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints: 27519 27520@smallexample 27521(gdb) 27522-break-list 27523^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6", 27524hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27525@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27526@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27527@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27528@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27529@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27530body=[]@} 27531(gdb) 27532@end smallexample 27533 27534@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command 27535@findex -break-passcount 27536 27537@subsubheading Synopsis 27538 27539@smallexample 27540 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount} 27541@end smallexample 27542 27543Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to 27544@var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number} 27545is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI 27546command @samp{passcount}. 27547 27548@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command 27549@findex -break-watch 27550 27551@subsubheading Synopsis 27552 27553@smallexample 27554 -break-watch [ -a | -r ] 27555@end smallexample 27556 27557Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an 27558@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a 27559read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r} 27560option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will 27561trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without 27562either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint, 27563i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing. 27564@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}. 27565 27566Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and 27567breakpoints inserted. 27568 27569@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27570 27571The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and 27572@samp{rwatch}. 27573 27574@subsubheading Example 27575 27576Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function: 27577 27578@smallexample 27579(gdb) 27580-break-watch x 27581^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@} 27582(gdb) 27583-exec-continue 27584^running 27585(gdb) 27586*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}, 27587value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@}, 27588frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c", 27589fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@} 27590(gdb) 27591@end smallexample 27592 27593Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop 27594the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then 27595for the watchpoint going out of scope. 27596 27597@smallexample 27598(gdb) 27599-break-watch C 27600^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@} 27601(gdb) 27602-exec-continue 27603^running 27604(gdb) 27605*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger", 27606wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@}, 27607frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 27608file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27609fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@} 27610(gdb) 27611-exec-continue 27612^running 27613(gdb) 27614*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5", 27615frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg", 27616value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 27617file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27618fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 27619(gdb) 27620@end smallexample 27621 27622Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program 27623execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is 27624deleted. 27625 27626@smallexample 27627(gdb) 27628-break-watch C 27629^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@} 27630(gdb) 27631-break-list 27632^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27633hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27634@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27635@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27636@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27637@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27638@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27639body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27640addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 27641file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27642fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"], 27643times="1"@}, 27644bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep", 27645enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27646(gdb) 27647-exec-continue 27648^running 27649(gdb) 27650*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}, 27651value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@}, 27652frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 27653file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27654fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@} 27655(gdb) 27656-break-list 27657^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27658hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27659@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27660@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27661@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27662@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27663@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27664body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27665addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 27666file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27667fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"], 27668times="1"@}, 27669bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep", 27670enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@} 27671(gdb) 27672-exec-continue 27673^running 27674^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2", 27675frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg", 27676value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 27677file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27678fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 27679(gdb) 27680-break-list 27681^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27682hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27683@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27684@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27685@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27686@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27687@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27688body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27689addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 27690file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27691fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8", 27692thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@} 27693(gdb) 27694@end smallexample 27695 27696 27697@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27698@node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands 27699@section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands 27700 27701This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating 27702catchpoints. 27703 27704@menu 27705* Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands:: 27706* Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands:: 27707@end menu 27708 27709@node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands 27710@subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints 27711 27712@subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command 27713@findex -catch-load 27714 27715@subsubheading Synopsis 27716 27717@smallexample 27718 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp} 27719@end smallexample 27720 27721Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used, 27722the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting 27723Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created 27724in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular 27725expression used to match the name of the loaded library. 27726 27727 27728@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27729 27730The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}. 27731 27732@subsubheading Example 27733 27734@smallexample 27735-catch-load -t foo.so 27736^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y", 27737what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@} 27738(gdb) 27739@end smallexample 27740 27741 27742@subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command 27743@findex -catch-unload 27744 27745@subsubheading Synopsis 27746 27747@smallexample 27748 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp} 27749@end smallexample 27750 27751Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is 27752used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting 27753Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is 27754created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular 27755expression used to match the name of the unloaded library. 27756 27757@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27758 27759The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}. 27760 27761@subsubheading Example 27762 27763@smallexample 27764-catch-unload -d bar.so 27765^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n", 27766what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@} 27767(gdb) 27768@end smallexample 27769 27770@node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands 27771@subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints 27772 27773The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints 27774that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised. 27775 27776@subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command 27777@findex -catch-assert 27778 27779@subsubheading Synopsis 27780 27781@smallexample 27782 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ] 27783@end smallexample 27784 27785Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions. 27786 27787The possible optional parameters for this command are: 27788 27789@table @samp 27790@item -c @var{condition} 27791Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27792@item -d 27793Create a disabled catchpoint. 27794@item -t 27795Create a temporary catchpoint. 27796@end table 27797 27798@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27799 27800The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}. 27801 27802@subsubheading Example 27803 27804@smallexample 27805-catch-assert 27806^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 27807enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions", 27808thread-groups=["i1"],times="0", 27809original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@} 27810(gdb) 27811@end smallexample 27812 27813@subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command 27814@findex -catch-exception 27815 27816@subsubheading Synopsis 27817 27818@smallexample 27819 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ] 27820 [ -t ] [ -u ] 27821@end smallexample 27822 27823Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised. 27824By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception 27825gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the 27826optional parameters described below, to create more selective 27827catchpoints. 27828 27829The possible optional parameters for this command are: 27830 27831@table @samp 27832@item -c @var{condition} 27833Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27834@item -d 27835Create a disabled catchpoint. 27836@item -e @var{exception-name} 27837Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot 27838be used combined with @samp{-u}. 27839@item -t 27840Create a temporary catchpoint. 27841@item -u 27842Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option 27843cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}. 27844@end table 27845 27846@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27847 27848The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception} 27849and @samp{catch exception unhandled}. 27850 27851@subsubheading Example 27852 27853@smallexample 27854-catch-exception -e Program_Error 27855^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 27856enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874", 27857what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"], 27858times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@} 27859(gdb) 27860@end smallexample 27861 27862@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27863@node GDB/MI Program Context 27864@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context 27865 27866@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command 27867@findex -exec-arguments 27868 27869 27870@subsubheading Synopsis 27871 27872@smallexample 27873 -exec-arguments @var{args} 27874@end smallexample 27875 27876Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next 27877@samp{-exec-run}. 27878 27879@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27880 27881The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}. 27882 27883@subsubheading Example 27884 27885@smallexample 27886(gdb) 27887-exec-arguments -v word 27888^done 27889(gdb) 27890@end smallexample 27891 27892 27893@ignore 27894@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command 27895@findex -exec-show-arguments 27896 27897@subsubheading Synopsis 27898 27899@smallexample 27900 -exec-show-arguments 27901@end smallexample 27902 27903Print the arguments of the program. 27904 27905@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27906 27907The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}. 27908 27909@subsubheading Example 27910N.A. 27911@end ignore 27912 27913 27914@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command 27915@findex -environment-cd 27916 27917@subsubheading Synopsis 27918 27919@smallexample 27920 -environment-cd @var{pathdir} 27921@end smallexample 27922 27923Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory. 27924 27925@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27926 27927The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}. 27928 27929@subsubheading Example 27930 27931@smallexample 27932(gdb) 27933-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb 27934^done 27935(gdb) 27936@end smallexample 27937 27938 27939@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command 27940@findex -environment-directory 27941 27942@subsubheading Synopsis 27943 27944@smallexample 27945 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+ 27946@end smallexample 27947 27948Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files. 27949If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default 27950search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the 27951@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition 27952occurs as normal. 27953Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying 27954multiple directories in a single command 27955results in the directories added to the beginning of the 27956search path in the same order they were presented in the command. 27957If blanks are needed as 27958part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around 27959the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated 27960by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator 27961character must not be used 27962in any directory name. 27963If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed. 27964 27965@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27966 27967The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}. 27968 27969@subsubheading Example 27970 27971@smallexample 27972(gdb) 27973-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb 27974^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd" 27975(gdb) 27976-environment-directory "" 27977^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd" 27978(gdb) 27979-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src 27980^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd" 27981(gdb) 27982-environment-directory -r 27983^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd" 27984(gdb) 27985@end smallexample 27986 27987 27988@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command 27989@findex -environment-path 27990 27991@subsubheading Synopsis 27992 27993@smallexample 27994 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+ 27995@end smallexample 27996 27997Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files. 27998If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original 27999search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are 28000supplied in addition to the 28001@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition 28002occurs as normal. 28003Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying 28004multiple directories in a single command 28005results in the directories added to the beginning of the 28006search path in the same order they were presented in the command. 28007If blanks are needed as 28008part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around 28009the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated 28010by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator 28011character must not be used 28012in any directory name. 28013If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed. 28014 28015 28016@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28017 28018The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}. 28019 28020@subsubheading Example 28021 28022@smallexample 28023(gdb) 28024-environment-path 28025^done,path="/usr/bin" 28026(gdb) 28027-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin 28028^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin" 28029(gdb) 28030-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin 28031^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin" 28032(gdb) 28033@end smallexample 28034 28035 28036@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command 28037@findex -environment-pwd 28038 28039@subsubheading Synopsis 28040 28041@smallexample 28042 -environment-pwd 28043@end smallexample 28044 28045Show the current working directory. 28046 28047@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28048 28049The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}. 28050 28051@subsubheading Example 28052 28053@smallexample 28054(gdb) 28055-environment-pwd 28056^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb" 28057(gdb) 28058@end smallexample 28059 28060@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28061@node GDB/MI Thread Commands 28062@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands 28063 28064 28065@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command 28066@findex -thread-info 28067 28068@subsubheading Synopsis 28069 28070@smallexample 28071 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ] 28072@end smallexample 28073 28074Reports information about either a specific thread, if the 28075@var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads. 28076@var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing 28077information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the 28078current thread. 28079 28080@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28081 28082The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information 28083about all threads. 28084 28085@subsubheading Result 28086 28087The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are 28088defined for a given thread: 28089 28090@table @samp 28091@item current 28092This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}. 28093 28094@item id 28095The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread. 28096 28097@item target-id 28098The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread. 28099 28100@item details 28101Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This 28102field is optional. 28103 28104@item name 28105The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the 28106@code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if 28107@value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that 28108name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this 28109field is omitted. 28110 28111@item frame 28112The stack frame currently executing in the thread. 28113 28114@item state 28115The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following 28116values: 28117 28118@table @code 28119@item stopped 28120The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped 28121threads. 28122 28123@item running 28124The thread is running. There's no frame information for running 28125threads. 28126 28127@end table 28128 28129@item core 28130If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running, 28131then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional. 28132 28133@end table 28134 28135@subsubheading Example 28136 28137@smallexample 28138-thread-info 28139^done,threads=[ 28140@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)", 28141 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall", 28142 args=[]@},state="running"@}, 28143@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)", 28144 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo", 28145 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}], 28146 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}, 28147 state="running"@}], 28148current-thread-id="1" 28149(gdb) 28150@end smallexample 28151 28152@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command 28153@findex -thread-list-ids 28154 28155@subsubheading Synopsis 28156 28157@smallexample 28158 -thread-list-ids 28159@end smallexample 28160 28161Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids. 28162At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such 28163threads. 28164 28165This command is retained for historical reasons, the 28166@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead. 28167 28168@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28169 28170Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information. 28171 28172@subsubheading Example 28173 28174@smallexample 28175(gdb) 28176-thread-list-ids 28177^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@}, 28178current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3" 28179(gdb) 28180@end smallexample 28181 28182 28183@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command 28184@findex -thread-select 28185 28186@subsubheading Synopsis 28187 28188@smallexample 28189 -thread-select @var{thread-id} 28190@end smallexample 28191 28192Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current 28193thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the 28194topmost frame for that thread. 28195 28196This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the 28197@samp{--thread} option to each command. 28198 28199@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28200 28201The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}. 28202 28203@subsubheading Example 28204 28205@smallexample 28206(gdb) 28207-exec-next 28208^running 28209(gdb) 28210*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187", 28211file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c" 28212(gdb) 28213-thread-list-ids 28214^done, 28215thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@}, 28216number-of-threads="3" 28217(gdb) 28218-thread-select 3 28219^done,new-thread-id="3", 28220frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf", 28221args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@}, 28222@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@} 28223(gdb) 28224@end smallexample 28225 28226@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28227@node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands 28228@section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands 28229 28230@subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command 28231@findex -ada-task-info 28232 28233@subsubheading Synopsis 28234 28235@smallexample 28236 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ] 28237@end smallexample 28238 28239Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the 28240@var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks. 28241 28242@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28243 28244The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information 28245about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}). 28246 28247@subsubheading Result 28248 28249The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are 28250defined for each Ada task: 28251 28252@table @samp 28253@item current 28254This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}. 28255 28256@item id 28257The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task. 28258 28259@item task-id 28260The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task. 28261 28262@item thread-id 28263The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada 28264task. 28265 28266This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented 28267on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding 28268thread for any reason, the field is omitted. 28269 28270@item parent-id 28271This field exists only when the task was created by another task. 28272In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task. 28273 28274@item priority 28275The base priority of the task. 28276 28277@item state 28278The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the 28279possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}. 28280 28281@item name 28282The name of the task. 28283 28284@end table 28285 28286@subsubheading Example 28287 28288@smallexample 28289-ada-task-info 28290^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8", 28291hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@}, 28292@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@}, 28293@{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@}, 28294@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@}, 28295@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@}, 28296@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@}, 28297@{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@}, 28298@{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}], 28299body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48", 28300state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@} 28301(gdb) 28302@end smallexample 28303 28304@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28305@node GDB/MI Program Execution 28306@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution 28307 28308These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band 28309record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes 28310asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in 28311other cases. 28312 28313@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command 28314@findex -exec-continue 28315 28316@subsubheading Synopsis 28317 28318@smallexample 28319 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N] 28320@end smallexample 28321 28322Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue 28323to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the 28324@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until 28325it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include 28326@itemize @bullet 28327@item 28328breakpoints or watchpoints 28329@item 28330signals or exceptions 28331@item 28332the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse}) 28333@item 28334the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used. 28335@end itemize 28336In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop 28337Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the 28338value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is 28339specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is 28340ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is 28341specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed. 28342 28343@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28344 28345The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}. 28346 28347@subsubheading Example 28348 28349@smallexample 28350-exec-continue 28351^running 28352(gdb) 28353@@Hello world 28354*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{ 28355func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c", 28356line="13"@} 28357(gdb) 28358@end smallexample 28359 28360 28361@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command 28362@findex -exec-finish 28363 28364@subsubheading Synopsis 28365 28366@smallexample 28367 -exec-finish [--reverse] 28368@end smallexample 28369 28370Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current 28371function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function. 28372If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse 28373execution of the inferior program until the point where current 28374function was called. 28375 28376@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28377 28378The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}. 28379 28380@subsubheading Example 28381 28382Function returning @code{void}. 28383 28384@smallexample 28385-exec-finish 28386^running 28387(gdb) 28388@@hello from foo 28389*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[], 28390file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@} 28391(gdb) 28392@end smallexample 28393 28394Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal 28395@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the 28396value itself. 28397 28398@smallexample 28399-exec-finish 28400^running 28401(gdb) 28402*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo", 28403args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@}, 28404file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28405gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0" 28406(gdb) 28407@end smallexample 28408 28409 28410@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command 28411@findex -exec-interrupt 28412 28413@subsubheading Synopsis 28414 28415@smallexample 28416 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N] 28417@end smallexample 28418 28419Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token 28420associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command 28421that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only 28422appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to 28423interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed. 28424 28425Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is 28426asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the 28427@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be 28428reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification. 28429 28430In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default. 28431All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the 28432@samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} 28433option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted. 28434 28435@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28436 28437The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}. 28438 28439@subsubheading Example 28440 28441@smallexample 28442(gdb) 28443111-exec-continue 28444111^running 28445 28446(gdb) 28447222-exec-interrupt 28448222^done 28449(gdb) 28450111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt", 28451frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 28452fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@} 28453(gdb) 28454 28455(gdb) 28456-exec-interrupt 28457^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing." 28458(gdb) 28459@end smallexample 28460 28461@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command 28462@findex -exec-jump 28463 28464@subsubheading Synopsis 28465 28466@smallexample 28467 -exec-jump @var{location} 28468@end smallexample 28469 28470Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by 28471parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the 28472different forms of @var{location}. 28473 28474@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28475 28476The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}. 28477 28478@subsubheading Example 28479 28480@smallexample 28481-exec-jump foo.c:10 28482*running,thread-id="all" 28483^running 28484@end smallexample 28485 28486 28487@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command 28488@findex -exec-next 28489 28490@subsubheading Synopsis 28491 28492@smallexample 28493 -exec-next [--reverse] 28494@end smallexample 28495 28496Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning 28497of the next source line is reached. 28498 28499If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution 28500of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous 28501source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a 28502function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the 28503source line where the function was called. 28504 28505 28506@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28507 28508The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}. 28509 28510@subsubheading Example 28511 28512@smallexample 28513-exec-next 28514^running 28515(gdb) 28516*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c" 28517(gdb) 28518@end smallexample 28519 28520 28521@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command 28522@findex -exec-next-instruction 28523 28524@subsubheading Synopsis 28525 28526@smallexample 28527 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse] 28528@end smallexample 28529 28530Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function 28531call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an 28532instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be 28533printed as well. 28534 28535If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution 28536of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the 28537previously executed instruction was a return from another function, 28538it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function 28539(from the current stack frame) is reached. 28540 28541@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28542 28543The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}. 28544 28545@subsubheading Example 28546 28547@smallexample 28548(gdb) 28549-exec-next-instruction 28550^running 28551 28552(gdb) 28553*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28554addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c" 28555(gdb) 28556@end smallexample 28557 28558 28559@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command 28560@findex -exec-return 28561 28562@subsubheading Synopsis 28563 28564@smallexample 28565 -exec-return 28566@end smallexample 28567 28568Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior. 28569Displays the new current frame. 28570 28571@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28572 28573The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}. 28574 28575@subsubheading Example 28576 28577@smallexample 28578(gdb) 28579200-break-insert callee4 28580200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734", 28581file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@} 28582(gdb) 28583000-exec-run 28584000^running 28585(gdb) 28586000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1", 28587frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 28588file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28589fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@} 28590(gdb) 28591205-break-delete 28592205^done 28593(gdb) 28594111-exec-return 28595111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3", 28596args=[@{name="strarg", 28597value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 28598file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28599fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 28600(gdb) 28601@end smallexample 28602 28603 28604@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command 28605@findex -exec-run 28606 28607@subsubheading Synopsis 28608 28609@smallexample 28610 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ] 28611@end smallexample 28612 28613Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior 28614executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program 28615exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if 28616the program has exited exceptionally. 28617 28618When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option 28619is specified, the current inferior is started. If the 28620@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread 28621group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started. 28622If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started. 28623 28624Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop 28625the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram, 28626following the same behavior as the @code{start} command 28627(@pxref{Starting}). 28628 28629@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28630 28631The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}. 28632 28633@subsubheading Examples 28634 28635@smallexample 28636(gdb) 28637-break-insert main 28638^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@} 28639(gdb) 28640-exec-run 28641^running 28642(gdb) 28643*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1", 28644frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c", 28645fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@} 28646(gdb) 28647@end smallexample 28648 28649@noindent 28650Program exited normally: 28651 28652@smallexample 28653(gdb) 28654-exec-run 28655^running 28656(gdb) 28657x = 55 28658*stopped,reason="exited-normally" 28659(gdb) 28660@end smallexample 28661 28662@noindent 28663Program exited exceptionally: 28664 28665@smallexample 28666(gdb) 28667-exec-run 28668^running 28669(gdb) 28670x = 55 28671*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01" 28672(gdb) 28673@end smallexample 28674 28675Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as 28676@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this: 28677 28678@smallexample 28679(gdb) 28680*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT", 28681signal-meaning="Interrupt" 28682@end smallexample 28683 28684 28685@c @subheading -exec-signal 28686 28687 28688@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command 28689@findex -exec-step 28690 28691@subsubheading Synopsis 28692 28693@smallexample 28694 -exec-step [--reverse] 28695@end smallexample 28696 28697Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning 28698of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a 28699function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called 28700function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse 28701execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the 28702previously executed source line. 28703 28704@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28705 28706The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}. 28707 28708@subsubheading Example 28709 28710Stepping into a function: 28711 28712@smallexample 28713-exec-step 28714^running 28715(gdb) 28716*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28717frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@}, 28718@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c", 28719fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@} 28720(gdb) 28721@end smallexample 28722 28723Regular stepping: 28724 28725@smallexample 28726-exec-step 28727^running 28728(gdb) 28729*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c" 28730(gdb) 28731@end smallexample 28732 28733 28734@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command 28735@findex -exec-step-instruction 28736 28737@subsubheading Synopsis 28738 28739@smallexample 28740 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse] 28741@end smallexample 28742 28743Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the 28744@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the 28745inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction. 28746The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on 28747whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the 28748former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed 28749as well. 28750 28751@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28752 28753The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}. 28754 28755@subsubheading Example 28756 28757@smallexample 28758(gdb) 28759-exec-step-instruction 28760^running 28761 28762(gdb) 28763*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28764frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 28765fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@} 28766(gdb) 28767-exec-step-instruction 28768^running 28769 28770(gdb) 28771*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28772frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 28773fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@} 28774(gdb) 28775@end smallexample 28776 28777 28778@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command 28779@findex -exec-until 28780 28781@subsubheading Synopsis 28782 28783@smallexample 28784 -exec-until [ @var{location} ] 28785@end smallexample 28786 28787Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the 28788argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes 28789until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The 28790reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}. 28791 28792@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28793 28794The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}. 28795 28796@subsubheading Example 28797 28798@smallexample 28799(gdb) 28800-exec-until recursive2.c:6 28801^running 28802(gdb) 28803x = 55 28804*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[], 28805file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@} 28806(gdb) 28807@end smallexample 28808 28809@ignore 28810@subheading -file-clear 28811Is this going away???? 28812@end ignore 28813 28814@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28815@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation 28816@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands 28817 28818@subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command 28819@findex -enable-frame-filters 28820 28821@smallexample 28822-enable-frame-filters 28823@end smallexample 28824 28825@value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of 28826the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to 28827implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must 28828request that this functionality be enabled. 28829 28830Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled. 28831 28832Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN}, 28833this command will still succeed (and do nothing). 28834 28835@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command 28836@findex -stack-info-frame 28837 28838@subsubheading Synopsis 28839 28840@smallexample 28841 -stack-info-frame 28842@end smallexample 28843 28844Get info on the selected frame. 28845 28846@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28847 28848The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame} 28849(without arguments). 28850 28851@subsubheading Example 28852 28853@smallexample 28854(gdb) 28855-stack-info-frame 28856^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3", 28857file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28858fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@} 28859(gdb) 28860@end smallexample 28861 28862@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command 28863@findex -stack-info-depth 28864 28865@subsubheading Synopsis 28866 28867@smallexample 28868 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ] 28869@end smallexample 28870 28871Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth} 28872is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames. 28873 28874@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28875 28876There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. 28877 28878@subsubheading Example 28879 28880For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11: 28881 28882@smallexample 28883(gdb) 28884-stack-info-depth 28885^done,depth="12" 28886(gdb) 28887-stack-info-depth 4 28888^done,depth="4" 28889(gdb) 28890-stack-info-depth 12 28891^done,depth="12" 28892(gdb) 28893-stack-info-depth 11 28894^done,depth="11" 28895(gdb) 28896-stack-info-depth 13 28897^done,depth="12" 28898(gdb) 28899@end smallexample 28900 28901@anchor{-stack-list-arguments} 28902@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command 28903@findex -stack-list-arguments 28904 28905@subsubheading Synopsis 28906 28907@smallexample 28908 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values} 28909 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ] 28910@end smallexample 28911 28912Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame} 28913and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and 28914@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole 28915call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame 28916at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is 28917larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand, 28918@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in 28919which case only existing frames will be returned. 28920 28921If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 28922the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 28923values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 28924type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 28925structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is 28926supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed. 28927 28928If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that 28929are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments 28930are still displayed, however. 28931 28932Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is 28933deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command. 28934 28935@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28936 28937@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a 28938@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the 28939functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}. 28940 28941@subsubheading Example 28942 28943@smallexample 28944(gdb) 28945-stack-list-frames 28946^done, 28947stack=[ 28948frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 28949file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28950fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}, 28951frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3", 28952file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28953fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}, 28954frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2", 28955file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28956fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@}, 28957frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1", 28958file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28959fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@}, 28960frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main", 28961file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28962fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}] 28963(gdb) 28964-stack-list-arguments 0 28965^done, 28966stack-args=[ 28967frame=@{level="0",args=[]@}, 28968frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@}, 28969frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}, 28970frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@}, 28971frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}] 28972(gdb) 28973-stack-list-arguments 1 28974^done, 28975stack-args=[ 28976frame=@{level="0",args=[]@}, 28977frame=@{level="1", 28978 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}, 28979frame=@{level="2",args=[ 28980@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 28981@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}, 28982@{frame=@{level="3",args=[ 28983@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 28984@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}, 28985@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@}, 28986frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}] 28987(gdb) 28988-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2 28989^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}] 28990(gdb) 28991-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2 28992^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2", 28993args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 28994@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}] 28995(gdb) 28996@end smallexample 28997 28998@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers 28999 29000 29001@anchor{-stack-list-frames} 29002@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command 29003@findex -stack-list-frames 29004 29005@subsubheading Synopsis 29006 29007@smallexample 29008 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ] 29009@end smallexample 29010 29011List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the 29012following info: 29013 29014@table @samp 29015@item @var{level} 29016The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function. 29017@item @var{addr} 29018The @code{$pc} value for that frame. 29019@item @var{func} 29020Function name. 29021@item @var{file} 29022File name of the source file where the function lives. 29023@item @var{fullname} 29024The full file name of the source file where the function lives. 29025@item @var{line} 29026Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}. 29027@item @var{from} 29028The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given 29029if the frame's function is not known. 29030@end table 29031 29032If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the 29033whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose 29034levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments 29035are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is 29036an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of 29037frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the 29038actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be 29039returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then 29040Python frame filters will not be executed. 29041 29042@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29043 29044The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}. 29045 29046@subsubheading Example 29047 29048Full stack backtrace: 29049 29050@smallexample 29051(gdb) 29052-stack-list-frames 29053^done,stack= 29054[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo", 29055 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}, 29056frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29057 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29058frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29059 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29060frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29061 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29062frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29063 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29064frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29065 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29066frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29067 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29068frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29069 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29070frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29071 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29072frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29073 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29074frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29075 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29076frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main", 29077 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}] 29078(gdb) 29079@end smallexample 29080 29081Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}: 29082 29083@smallexample 29084(gdb) 29085-stack-list-frames 3 5 29086^done,stack= 29087[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29088 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29089frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29090 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 29091frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29092 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}] 29093(gdb) 29094@end smallexample 29095 29096Show a single frame: 29097 29098@smallexample 29099(gdb) 29100-stack-list-frames 3 3 29101^done,stack= 29102[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 29103 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}] 29104(gdb) 29105@end smallexample 29106 29107 29108@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command 29109@findex -stack-list-locals 29110@anchor{-stack-list-locals} 29111 29112@subsubheading Synopsis 29113 29114@smallexample 29115 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values} 29116@end smallexample 29117 29118Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If 29119@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 29120the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 29121values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 29122type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 29123structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately 29124display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for 29125other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in 29126more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then 29127Python frame filters will not be executed. 29128 29129If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables 29130that are not available are not listed. Partially available local 29131variables are still displayed, however. 29132 29133This command is deprecated in favor of the 29134@samp{-stack-list-variables} command. 29135 29136@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29137 29138@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}. 29139 29140@subsubheading Example 29141 29142@smallexample 29143(gdb) 29144-stack-list-locals 0 29145^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"] 29146(gdb) 29147-stack-list-locals --all-values 29148^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@}, 29149 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}] 29150-stack-list-locals --simple-values 29151^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@}, 29152 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}] 29153(gdb) 29154@end smallexample 29155 29156@anchor{-stack-list-variables} 29157@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command 29158@findex -stack-list-variables 29159 29160@subsubheading Synopsis 29161 29162@smallexample 29163 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values} 29164@end smallexample 29165 29166Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If 29167@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 29168the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 29169values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 29170type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 29171structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is 29172supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed. 29173 29174If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables 29175and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially 29176available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however. 29177 29178@subsubheading Example 29179 29180@smallexample 29181(gdb) 29182-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values 29183^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}] 29184(gdb) 29185@end smallexample 29186 29187 29188@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command 29189@findex -stack-select-frame 29190 29191@subsubheading Synopsis 29192 29193@smallexample 29194 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum} 29195@end smallexample 29196 29197Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on 29198the stack. 29199 29200This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame} 29201option to every command. 29202 29203@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29204 29205The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up}, 29206@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}. 29207 29208@subsubheading Example 29209 29210@smallexample 29211(gdb) 29212-stack-select-frame 2 29213^done 29214(gdb) 29215@end smallexample 29216 29217@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29218@node GDB/MI Variable Objects 29219@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects 29220 29221@ignore 29222 29223@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi} 29224 29225For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched 29226expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code 29227used by @code{Insight}. 29228 29229The two main reasons for that are: 29230 29231@enumerate 1 29232@item 29233It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation). 29234 29235@item 29236It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is 29237now). 29238@end enumerate 29239 29240The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was 29241slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section 29242describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some 29243hints about their use. 29244 29245@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we 29246expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at 29247least, the following operations: 29248 29249@itemize @bullet 29250@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix} 29251@item @code{-stack-list-arguments} 29252@item @code{-stack-list-locals} 29253@item @code{-stack-select-frame} 29254@end itemize 29255 29256@end ignore 29257 29258@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects 29259 29260@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi} 29261 29262Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and 29263changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that 29264work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for 29265simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object 29266is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the 29267frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The 29268expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex 29269expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a 29270variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object 29271operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable 29272object, or to change display format. 29273 29274Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object 29275that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has 29276a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each 29277element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have 29278children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach 29279leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable 29280objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend 29281is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no 29282child will be created. 29283 29284For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a 29285string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also 29286obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string 29287that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its 29288contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed. 29289 29290A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time 29291the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all 29292variable objects whose values has changed since the last update 29293operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must 29294be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable 29295objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a 29296real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf 29297variables that frontend has created. 29298 29299The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend 29300might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference, 29301and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is 29302relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want 29303to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not 29304visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so 29305called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never 29306implicitly updated. 29307 29308Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the 29309fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable 29310object is created, including associating identifiers to specific 29311variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating 29312variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the 29313expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current 29314frame. Consider this example: 29315 29316@smallexample 29317void do_work(...) 29318@{ 29319 struct work_state state; 29320 29321 if (...) 29322 do_work(...); 29323@} 29324@end smallexample 29325 29326If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in 29327this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable 29328object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level 29329@code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable 29330object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame. 29331 29332If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object 29333refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the 29334thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such 29335variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the 29336thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists, 29337and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame. 29338 29339The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to 29340access this functionality: 29341 29342@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6 29343@item @strong{Operation} 29344@tab @strong{Description} 29345 29346@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing} 29347@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing 29348@item @code{-var-create} 29349@tab create a variable object 29350@item @code{-var-delete} 29351@tab delete the variable object and/or its children 29352@item @code{-var-set-format} 29353@tab set the display format of this variable 29354@item @code{-var-show-format} 29355@tab show the display format of this variable 29356@item @code{-var-info-num-children} 29357@tab tells how many children this object has 29358@item @code{-var-list-children} 29359@tab return a list of the object's children 29360@item @code{-var-info-type} 29361@tab show the type of this variable object 29362@item @code{-var-info-expression} 29363@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents 29364@item @code{-var-info-path-expression} 29365@tab print full expression that this variable object represents 29366@item @code{-var-show-attributes} 29367@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here? 29368@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression} 29369@tab get the value of this variable 29370@item @code{-var-assign} 29371@tab set the value of this variable 29372@item @code{-var-update} 29373@tab update the variable and its children 29374@item @code{-var-set-frozen} 29375@tab set frozeness attribute 29376@item @code{-var-set-update-range} 29377@tab set range of children to display on update 29378@end multitable 29379 29380In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest 29381how it can be used. 29382 29383@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects 29384 29385@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command 29386@findex -enable-pretty-printing 29387 29388@smallexample 29389-enable-pretty-printing 29390@end smallexample 29391 29392@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the 29393MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to 29394implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must 29395request that this functionality be enabled. 29396 29397Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled. 29398 29399Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN}, 29400this command will still succeed (and do nothing). 29401 29402This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and 29403may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}. 29404 29405@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command 29406@findex -var-create 29407 29408@subsubheading Synopsis 29409 29410@smallexample 29411 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@} 29412 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression} 29413@end smallexample 29414 29415This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of 29416a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU 29417register. 29418 29419The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be 29420referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj 29421system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be 29422unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format. 29423The command fails if a duplicate name is found. 29424 29425The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be 29426specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current 29427frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable 29428object must be created. 29429 29430@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not 29431begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following: 29432 29433@itemize @bullet 29434@item 29435@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell 29436 29437@item 29438@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD) 29439 29440@item 29441@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name 29442@end itemize 29443 29444@cindex dynamic varobj 29445A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this 29446case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs 29447have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the 29448@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN} 29449will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward 29450compatibility for existing clients. 29451 29452@subsubheading Result 29453 29454This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These 29455are: 29456 29457@table @samp 29458@item name 29459The name of the varobj. 29460 29461@item numchild 29462The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily 29463reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the 29464@samp{has_more} attribute. 29465 29466@item value 29467The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of 29468aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value 29469will not be interesting. 29470 29471@item type 29472The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as 29473would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object} 29474(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the 29475@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the 29476@emph{declared} one. 29477 29478@item thread-id 29479If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the 29480thread's global identifier. 29481 29482@item has_more 29483For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any 29484children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0. 29485 29486@item dynamic 29487This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 29488varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 29489then this attribute will not be present. 29490 29491@item displayhint 29492A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 29493value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 29494@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 29495@end table 29496 29497Typical output will look like this: 29498 29499@smallexample 29500 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}", 29501 has_more="@var{has_more}" 29502@end smallexample 29503 29504 29505@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command 29506@findex -var-delete 29507 29508@subsubheading Synopsis 29509 29510@smallexample 29511 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name} 29512@end smallexample 29513 29514Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children. 29515With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children. 29516 29517Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found. 29518 29519 29520@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command 29521@findex -var-set-format 29522 29523@subsubheading Synopsis 29524 29525@smallexample 29526 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec} 29527@end smallexample 29528 29529Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be 29530@var{format-spec}. 29531 29532@anchor{-var-set-format} 29533The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows: 29534 29535@smallexample 29536 @var{format-spec} @expansion{} 29537 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@} 29538@end smallexample 29539 29540The natural format is the default format choosen automatically 29541based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex 29542for pointers, etc.). 29543 29544The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal 29545but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit 29546hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the 29547zero-hexadecimal format. 29548 29549For a variable with children, the format is set only on the 29550variable itself, and the children are not affected. 29551 29552@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command 29553@findex -var-show-format 29554 29555@subsubheading Synopsis 29556 29557@smallexample 29558 -var-show-format @var{name} 29559@end smallexample 29560 29561Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}. 29562 29563@smallexample 29564 @var{format} @expansion{} 29565 @var{format-spec} 29566@end smallexample 29567 29568 29569@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command 29570@findex -var-info-num-children 29571 29572@subsubheading Synopsis 29573 29574@smallexample 29575 -var-info-num-children @var{name} 29576@end smallexample 29577 29578Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}: 29579 29580@smallexample 29581 numchild=@var{n} 29582@end smallexample 29583 29584Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj. 29585It will return the current number of children, but more children may 29586be available. 29587 29588 29589@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command 29590@findex -var-list-children 29591 29592@subsubheading Synopsis 29593 29594@smallexample 29595 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}] 29596@end smallexample 29597@anchor{-var-list-children} 29598 29599Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and 29600create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With 29601a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or 29602@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if 29603@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their 29604values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and 29605value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures 29606and unions. 29607 29608@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children 29609to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is 29610reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting 29611at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be 29612reported. 29613 29614If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to 29615@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}. 29616For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The 29617intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any 29618update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the 29619front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and 29620then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a 29621different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just 29622the visible items. 29623 29624For each child the following results are returned: 29625 29626@table @var 29627 29628@item name 29629Name of the variable object created for this child. 29630 29631@item exp 29632The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child. 29633For example this may be the name of a structure member. 29634 29635For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an 29636expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj. 29637 29638For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to 29639designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is 29640@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the 29641type and value are not present. 29642 29643A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying 29644pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not 29645available at all with a dynamic varobj. 29646 29647@item numchild 29648Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be 296490. 29650 29651@item type 29652The type of the child. If @samp{print object} 29653(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the 29654@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the 29655@emph{declared} one. 29656 29657@item value 29658If values were requested, this is the value. 29659 29660@item thread-id 29661If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the 29662thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present. 29663 29664@item frozen 29665If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1. 29666 29667@item displayhint 29668A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 29669value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 29670@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 29671 29672@item dynamic 29673This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 29674varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 29675then this attribute will not be present. 29676 29677@end table 29678 29679The result may have its own attributes: 29680 29681@table @samp 29682@item displayhint 29683A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 29684value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 29685@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 29686 29687@item has_more 29688This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children 29689remaining after the end of the selected range. 29690@end table 29691 29692@subsubheading Example 29693 29694@smallexample 29695(gdb) 29696 -var-list-children n 29697 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp}, 29698 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}] 29699(gdb) 29700 -var-list-children --all-values n 29701 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp}, 29702 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}] 29703@end smallexample 29704 29705 29706@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command 29707@findex -var-info-type 29708 29709@subsubheading Synopsis 29710 29711@smallexample 29712 -var-info-type @var{name} 29713@end smallexample 29714 29715Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is 29716returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the 29717@value{GDBN} CLI: 29718 29719@smallexample 29720 type=@var{typename} 29721@end smallexample 29722 29723 29724@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command 29725@findex -var-info-expression 29726 29727@subsubheading Synopsis 29728 29729@smallexample 29730 -var-info-expression @var{name} 29731@end smallexample 29732 29733Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this 29734variable object in user interface. The string is generally 29735not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated. 29736 29737For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object 29738@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output: 29739 29740@smallexample 29741(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1 29742^done,lang="C",exp="1" 29743@end smallexample 29744 29745@noindent 29746Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be 29747found in @ref{Supported Languages}. 29748 29749Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also 29750includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command 29751is of limited use. 29752 29753@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command 29754@findex -var-info-path-expression 29755 29756@subsubheading Synopsis 29757 29758@smallexample 29759 -var-info-path-expression @var{name} 29760@end smallexample 29761 29762Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current 29763context and will yield the same value that a variable object has. 29764Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which 29765result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of 29766the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a 29767watchpoint from a variable object. 29768 29769This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj, 29770and will give an error when invoked on one. 29771 29772For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class 29773@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called 29774@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of 29775@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable 29776@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output: 29777@smallexample 29778(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size 29779^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size) 29780@end smallexample 29781 29782@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command 29783@findex -var-show-attributes 29784 29785@subsubheading Synopsis 29786 29787@smallexample 29788 -var-show-attributes @var{name} 29789@end smallexample 29790 29791List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}: 29792 29793@smallexample 29794 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ] 29795@end smallexample 29796 29797@noindent 29798where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}. 29799 29800@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command 29801@findex -var-evaluate-expression 29802 29803@subsubheading Synopsis 29804 29805@smallexample 29806 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name} 29807@end smallexample 29808 29809Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable 29810object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string 29811can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of 29812this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format} 29813(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified, 29814the current display format will be used. The current display format 29815can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command. 29816 29817@smallexample 29818 value=@var{value} 29819@end smallexample 29820 29821Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable 29822before the value of a child variable can be evaluated. 29823 29824@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command 29825@findex -var-assign 29826 29827@subsubheading Synopsis 29828 29829@smallexample 29830 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression} 29831@end smallexample 29832 29833Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified 29834by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's 29835value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any 29836subsequent @code{-var-update} list. 29837 29838@subsubheading Example 29839 29840@smallexample 29841(gdb) 29842-var-assign var1 3 29843^done,value="3" 29844(gdb) 29845-var-update * 29846^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}] 29847(gdb) 29848@end smallexample 29849 29850@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command 29851@findex -var-update 29852 29853@subsubheading Synopsis 29854 29855@smallexample 29856 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@} 29857@end smallexample 29858 29859Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object 29860@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the 29861list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must 29862be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of 29863@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the 29864@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable 29865object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except 29866for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option 29867@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just 29868names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same 29869as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is 29870recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the 29871number of MI commands needed on each program stop. 29872 29873With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a 29874currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any 29875diagnostic. 29876 29877If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then 29878only the selected range of children will be reported. 29879 29880@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named 29881@samp{changelist}. 29882 29883Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding: 29884 29885@table @samp 29886@item name 29887The name of the varobj. 29888 29889@item value 29890If values were requested for this update, then this field will be 29891present and will hold the value of the varobj. 29892 29893@item in_scope 29894@anchor{-var-update} 29895This field is a string which may take one of three values: 29896 29897@table @code 29898@item "true" 29899The variable object's current value is valid. 29900 29901@item "false" 29902The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may 29903hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into 29904scope. 29905 29906@item "invalid" 29907The variable object no longer holds a valid value. 29908This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed, 29909either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file} 29910command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable 29911objects. 29912@end table 29913 29914In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should 29915be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}. 29916 29917@item type_changed 29918This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type 29919changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will 29920be @samp{false}. 29921 29922When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have 29923become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically 29924deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update 29925range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is 29926unset. 29927 29928@item new_type 29929If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will 29930hold the new type. 29931 29932@item new_num_children 29933For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the 29934type changed, this will be the new number of children. 29935 29936The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not 29937valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that 29938@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily 29939instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of 29940children which may be available. 29941 29942The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the 29943number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to 29944detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can 29945only happen at the end of the update range). 29946 29947@item displayhint 29948The display hint, if any. 29949 29950@item has_more 29951This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children 29952available outside the varobj's update range. 29953 29954@item dynamic 29955This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 29956varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 29957then this attribute will not be present. 29958 29959@item new_children 29960If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected 29961update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will 29962be listed in this attribute. 29963@end table 29964 29965@subsubheading Example 29966 29967@smallexample 29968(gdb) 29969-var-assign var1 3 29970^done,value="3" 29971(gdb) 29972-var-update --all-values var1 29973^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true", 29974type_changed="false"@}] 29975(gdb) 29976@end smallexample 29977 29978@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command 29979@findex -var-set-frozen 29980@anchor{-var-set-frozen} 29981 29982@subsubheading Synopsis 29983 29984@smallexample 29985 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag} 29986@end smallexample 29987 29988Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The 29989@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable 29990frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is 29991frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are 29992implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of 29993a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only 29994@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and 29995values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is 29996implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations. 29997Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent 29998@code{-var-update} does. 29999 30000@subsubheading Example 30001 30002@smallexample 30003(gdb) 30004-var-set-frozen V 1 30005^done 30006(gdb) 30007@end smallexample 30008 30009@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command 30010@findex -var-set-update-range 30011@anchor{-var-set-update-range} 30012 30013@subsubheading Synopsis 30014 30015@smallexample 30016 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to} 30017@end smallexample 30018 30019Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of 30020@code{-var-update}. 30021 30022@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If 30023@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all 30024children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from} 30025(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported. 30026 30027@subsubheading Example 30028 30029@smallexample 30030(gdb) 30031-var-set-update-range V 1 2 30032^done 30033@end smallexample 30034 30035@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command 30036@findex -var-set-visualizer 30037@anchor{-var-set-visualizer} 30038 30039@subsubheading Synopsis 30040 30041@smallexample 30042 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer} 30043@end smallexample 30044 30045Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}. 30046 30047@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value 30048@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use. 30049 30050If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression. 30051This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a 30052single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of 30053the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same 30054Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI). 30055When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the 30056pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). 30057 30058The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to 30059select a visualizer by following the built-in process 30060(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when 30061a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed. 30062 30063This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI 30064command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands}) 30065can be used to check this. 30066 30067@subsubheading Example 30068 30069Resetting the visualizer: 30070 30071@smallexample 30072(gdb) 30073-var-set-visualizer V None 30074^done 30075@end smallexample 30076 30077Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer: 30078 30079@smallexample 30080(gdb) 30081-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer 30082^done 30083@end smallexample 30084 30085Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression 30086can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj: 30087 30088@smallexample 30089(gdb) 30090-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()" 30091^done 30092@end smallexample 30093 30094@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 30095@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation 30096@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation 30097 30098@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi} 30099@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation 30100This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data: 30101examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc. 30102 30103For details about what an addressable memory unit is, 30104@pxref{addressable memory unit}. 30105 30106@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE. 30107@c @subheading -data-assign 30108@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects. 30109@c @subsubheading GDB Command 30110@c set variable 30111@c @subsubheading Example 30112@c N.A. 30113 30114@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command 30115@findex -data-disassemble 30116 30117@subsubheading Synopsis 30118 30119@smallexample 30120 -data-disassemble 30121 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ] 30122 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ] 30123 -- @var{mode} 30124@end smallexample 30125 30126@noindent 30127Where: 30128 30129@table @samp 30130@item @var{start-addr} 30131is the beginning address (or @code{$pc}) 30132@item @var{end-addr} 30133is the end address 30134@item @var{filename} 30135is the name of the file to disassemble 30136@item @var{linenum} 30137is the line number to disassemble around 30138@item @var{lines} 30139is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1, 30140the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is 30141specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and 30142@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between 30143@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are 30144displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between 30145@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr} 30146are displayed. 30147@item @var{mode} 30148is one of: 30149@itemize @bullet 30150@item 0 disassembly only 30151@item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated) 30152@item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes 30153@item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated) 30154@item 4 mixed source and disassembly 30155@item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes 30156@end itemize 30157 30158Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric'' 30159which hasn't proved useful in practice. 30160@xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between 30161@code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command. 30162@end table 30163 30164@subsubheading Result 30165 30166The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named 30167@samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode} 30168used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command. 30169 30170For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the 30171following fields: 30172 30173@table @code 30174@item address 30175The address at which this instruction was disassembled. 30176 30177@item func-name 30178The name of the function this instruction is within. 30179 30180@item offset 30181The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}. 30182 30183@item inst 30184The text disassembly for this @samp{address}. 30185 30186@item opcodes 30187This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode 30188bytes for the @samp{inst} field. 30189 30190@end table 30191 30192For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named 30193@samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields: 30194 30195@table @code 30196@item line 30197The line number within @samp{file}. 30198 30199@item file 30200The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute 30201file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command 30202used. 30203 30204@item fullname 30205Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form 30206using the source file search path 30207(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}) 30208and after resolving all the symbolic links. 30209 30210If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as 30211present in the debug information. 30212 30213@item line_asm_insn 30214This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in 30215@samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for 30216@code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address}, 30217@samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally 30218@samp{opcodes}. 30219 30220@end table 30221 30222Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not 30223manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to 30224adjust its format. 30225 30226@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30227 30228The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}. 30229 30230@subsubheading Example 30231 30232Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}: 30233 30234@smallexample 30235(gdb) 30236-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0 30237^done, 30238asm_insns=[ 30239@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 30240inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30241@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30242inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 30243@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12", 30244inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@}, 30245@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16", 30246inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 30247@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20", 30248inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}] 30249(gdb) 30250@end smallexample 30251 30252Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of 30253@code{main}. 30254 30255@smallexample 30256-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0 30257^done,asm_insns=[ 30258@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 30259inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}, 30260@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 30261inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30262@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30263inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 30264[@dots{}] 30265@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@}, 30266@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}] 30267(gdb) 30268@end smallexample 30269 30270Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}: 30271 30272@smallexample 30273(gdb) 30274-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0 30275^done,asm_insns=[ 30276@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 30277inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}, 30278@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 30279inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30280@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30281inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}] 30282(gdb) 30283@end smallexample 30284 30285Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode: 30286 30287@smallexample 30288(gdb) 30289-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1 30290^done,asm_insns=[ 30291src_and_asm_line=@{line="31", 30292file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30293fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30294line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc", 30295func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@}, 30296src_and_asm_line=@{line="32", 30297file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30298fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30299line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0", 30300func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30301@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30302inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}] 30303(gdb) 30304@end smallexample 30305 30306 30307@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command 30308@findex -data-evaluate-expression 30309 30310@subsubheading Synopsis 30311 30312@smallexample 30313 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr} 30314@end smallexample 30315 30316Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an 30317inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously. 30318If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes. 30319 30320@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30321 30322The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and 30323@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding 30324@samp{gdb_eval} command. 30325 30326@subsubheading Example 30327 30328In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the 30329@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi} 30330Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its 30331output. 30332 30333@smallexample 30334211-data-evaluate-expression A 30335211^done,value="1" 30336(gdb) 30337311-data-evaluate-expression &A 30338311^done,value="0xefffeb7c" 30339(gdb) 30340411-data-evaluate-expression A+3 30341411^done,value="4" 30342(gdb) 30343511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3" 30344511^done,value="4" 30345(gdb) 30346@end smallexample 30347 30348 30349@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command 30350@findex -data-list-changed-registers 30351 30352@subsubheading Synopsis 30353 30354@smallexample 30355 -data-list-changed-registers 30356@end smallexample 30357 30358Display a list of the registers that have changed. 30359 30360@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30361 30362@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk} 30363has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}. 30364 30365@subsubheading Example 30366 30367On a PPC MBX board: 30368 30369@smallexample 30370(gdb) 30371-exec-continue 30372^running 30373 30374(gdb) 30375*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{ 30376func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c", 30377line="5"@} 30378(gdb) 30379-data-list-changed-registers 30380^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9", 30381"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23", 30382"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"] 30383(gdb) 30384@end smallexample 30385 30386 30387@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command 30388@findex -data-list-register-names 30389 30390@subsubheading Synopsis 30391 30392@smallexample 30393 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ] 30394@end smallexample 30395 30396Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments 30397are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If 30398integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the 30399names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure 30400consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may 30401include empty register names. 30402 30403@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30404 30405@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to 30406@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a 30407corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}. 30408 30409@subsubheading Example 30410 30411For the PPC MBX board: 30412@smallexample 30413(gdb) 30414-data-list-register-names 30415^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7", 30416"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18", 30417"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29", 30418"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9", 30419"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20", 30420"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31", 30421"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"] 30422(gdb) 30423-data-list-register-names 1 2 3 30424^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"] 30425(gdb) 30426@end smallexample 30427 30428@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command 30429@findex -data-list-register-values 30430 30431@subsubheading Synopsis 30432 30433@smallexample 30434 -data-list-register-values 30435 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*] 30436@end smallexample 30437 30438Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the 30439registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed 30440by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A 30441missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the 30442registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option 30443indicates that only the available registers are to be returned. 30444 30445Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are: 30446 30447@table @code 30448@item x 30449Hexadecimal 30450@item o 30451Octal 30452@item t 30453Binary 30454@item d 30455Decimal 30456@item r 30457Raw 30458@item N 30459Natural 30460@end table 30461 30462@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30463 30464The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info 30465all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}. 30466 30467@subsubheading Example 30468 30469For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they 30470don't appear in the actual output): 30471 30472@smallexample 30473(gdb) 30474-data-list-register-values r 64 65 30475^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@}, 30476@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}] 30477(gdb) 30478-data-list-register-values x 30479^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@}, 30480@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@}, 30481@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@}, 30482@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@}, 30483@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@}, 30484@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@}, 30485@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@}, 30486@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@}, 30487@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@}, 30488@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@}, 30489@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@}, 30490@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@}, 30491@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@}, 30492@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@}, 30493@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@}, 30494@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@}, 30495@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@}, 30496@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@}, 30497@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@}, 30498@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@}, 30499@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@}, 30500@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@}, 30501@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@}, 30502@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@}, 30503@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@}, 30504@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@}, 30505@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@}, 30506@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@}, 30507@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@}, 30508@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@}, 30509@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@}, 30510@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@}, 30511@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@}, 30512@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@}, 30513@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@}, 30514@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}] 30515(gdb) 30516@end smallexample 30517 30518 30519@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command 30520@findex -data-read-memory 30521 30522This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead. 30523 30524@subsubheading Synopsis 30525 30526@smallexample 30527 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ] 30528 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size} 30529 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ] 30530@end smallexample 30531 30532@noindent 30533where: 30534 30535@table @samp 30536@item @var{address} 30537An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be 30538read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 30539quoted using the C convention. 30540 30541@item @var{word-format} 30542The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the 30543same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats, 30544,Output Formats}). 30545 30546@item @var{word-size} 30547The size of each memory word in bytes. 30548 30549@item @var{nr-rows} 30550The number of rows in the output table. 30551 30552@item @var{nr-cols} 30553The number of columns in the output table. 30554 30555@item @var{aschar} 30556If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The 30557value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a 30558member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii} 30559characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively). 30560 30561@item @var{byte-offset} 30562An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory. 30563@end table 30564 30565This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by 30566@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total, 30567@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read 30568(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number 30569of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified 30570using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned 30571in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in 30572@samp{addr}. 30573 30574The address of the next/previous row or page is available in 30575@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and 30576@samp{prev-page}. 30577 30578@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30579 30580The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has 30581@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command. 30582 30583@subsubheading Example 30584 30585Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by 30586@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per 30587word. Display each word in hex. 30588 30589@smallexample 30590(gdb) 305919-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2 305929^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6", 30593next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396", 30594prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[ 30595@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@}, 30596@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@}, 30597@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}] 30598(gdb) 30599@end smallexample 30600 30601Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and 30602display as a single word formatted in decimal. 30603 30604@smallexample 30605(gdb) 306065-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1 306075^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2", 30608next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e", 30609next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[ 30610@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}] 30611(gdb) 30612@end smallexample 30613 30614Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format 30615as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x} 30616used as the non-printable character. 30617 30618@smallexample 30619(gdb) 306204-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x 306214^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32", 30622next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c", 30623next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[ 30624@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30625@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30626@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30627@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30628@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@}, 30629@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@}, 30630@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@}, 30631@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}] 30632(gdb) 30633@end smallexample 30634 30635@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command 30636@findex -data-read-memory-bytes 30637 30638@subsubheading Synopsis 30639 30640@smallexample 30641 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ] 30642 @var{address} @var{count} 30643@end smallexample 30644 30645@noindent 30646where: 30647 30648@table @samp 30649@item @var{address} 30650An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit 30651to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 30652quoted using the C convention. 30653 30654@item @var{count} 30655The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer 30656literal. 30657 30658@item @var{offset} 30659The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This 30660should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend 30661is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address 30662arithmetics itself. 30663 30664@end table 30665 30666This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the 30667specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory 30668map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region 30669Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining 30670regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors, 30671@value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region. 30672 30673In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not, 30674and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at 30675every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will 30676attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end 30677of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works 30678well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region 30679has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end, 30680@value{GDBN} will not read it. 30681 30682The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of 30683the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a 30684list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block 30685and has the following fields: 30686 30687@table @code 30688@item begin 30689The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal. 30690 30691@item end 30692The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal. 30693 30694@item offset 30695The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to 30696the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}. 30697 30698@item contents 30699The contents of the memory block, in hex. 30700 30701@end table 30702 30703 30704 30705@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30706 30707The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. 30708 30709@subsubheading Example 30710 30711@smallexample 30712(gdb) 30713-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10 30714^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000", 30715 end="0xbffff15e", 30716 contents="01000000020000000300"@}] 30717(gdb) 30718@end smallexample 30719 30720 30721@subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command 30722@findex -data-write-memory-bytes 30723 30724@subsubheading Synopsis 30725 30726@smallexample 30727 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} 30728 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 30729@end smallexample 30730 30731@noindent 30732where: 30733 30734@table @samp 30735@item @var{address} 30736An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit 30737to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should 30738be quoted using the C convention. 30739 30740@item @var{contents} 30741The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does 30742not represent an integral number of addressable memory units. 30743 30744@item @var{count} 30745Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be 30746written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length, 30747@value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills 30748@var{count} memory units. 30749 30750@end table 30751 30752@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30753 30754There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 30755 30756@subsubheading Example 30757 30758@smallexample 30759(gdb) 30760-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 30761^done 30762(gdb) 30763@end smallexample 30764 30765@smallexample 30766(gdb) 30767-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e 30768^done 30769(gdb) 30770@end smallexample 30771 30772@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 30773@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands 30774@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands 30775 30776The commands defined in this section implement MI support for 30777tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}. 30778 30779@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command 30780@findex -trace-find 30781 30782@subsubheading Synopsis 30783 30784@smallexample 30785 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}] 30786@end smallexample 30787 30788Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and 30789@var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible 30790modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}. 30791 30792@table @samp 30793 30794@item none 30795No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames. 30796 30797@item frame-number 30798An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with 30799that index. 30800 30801@item tracepoint-number 30802An integer is required as parameter. Finds next 30803trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number. 30804 30805@item pc 30806An address is required as parameter. Finds 30807next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified 30808address. 30809 30810@item pc-inside-range 30811Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace 30812frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the 30813specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range. 30814 30815@item pc-outside-range 30816Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds 30817next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside 30818the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range. 30819 30820@item line 30821Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}. 30822Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at 30823the specified location. 30824 30825@end table 30826 30827If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not 30828have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields: 30829 30830@table @samp 30831@item found 30832This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending 30833on whether a matching tracepoint was found. 30834 30835@item traceframe 30836The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff 30837the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}. 30838 30839@item tracepoint 30840The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff 30841the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}. 30842 30843@item frame 30844The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace 30845frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found. 30846@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field. 30847 30848@end table 30849 30850@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30851 30852The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}. 30853 30854@subheading -trace-define-variable 30855@findex -trace-define-variable 30856 30857@subsubheading Synopsis 30858 30859@smallexample 30860 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ] 30861@end smallexample 30862 30863Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If 30864@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified 30865trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start 30866with the @samp{$} character. 30867 30868@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30869 30870The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}. 30871 30872@subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command 30873@findex -trace-frame-collected 30874 30875@subsubheading Synopsis 30876 30877@smallexample 30878 -trace-frame-collected 30879 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}] 30880 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}] 30881 [--registers-format @var{regformat}] 30882 [--memory-contents] 30883@end smallexample 30884 30885This command returns the set of collected objects, register names, 30886trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions 30887that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional 30888parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways. 30889See the output description table below for more details. 30890 30891The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create 30892varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by 30893this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable, 30894which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a 30895memory range and which is a computed expression. 30896 30897For instance, if the actions were 30898@smallexample 30899collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2 30900collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40 30901@end smallexample 30902 30903@noindent 30904the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The 30905object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the 30906element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining 30907objects would be computed expressions. 30908 30909An example output would be: 30910 30911@smallexample 30912(gdb) 30913-trace-frame-collected 30914^done, 30915 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}], 30916 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@}, 30917 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@}, 30918 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@}, 30919 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@}, 30920 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}], 30921 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@}, 30922 @{number="1",value="0x0"@}, 30923 @{number="2",value="0x4"@}, 30924 ... 30925 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}], 30926 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}], 30927 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@}, 30928 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}] 30929(gdb) 30930@end smallexample 30931 30932Where: 30933 30934@table @code 30935@item explicit-variables 30936The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as 30937opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct 30938members). For each object, its name and value are printed. 30939The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value 30940field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names; 30941if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name, 30942type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for 30943arrays, structures and unions. 30944 30945@item computed-expressions 30946The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the 30947current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects 30948this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the 30949@code{explicit-variables} set. See above. 30950 30951@item registers 30952The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame. 30953For each register collected, the name and current value are returned. 30954The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format} 30955option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a 30956list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}. 30957 30958@item tvars 30959The trace state variables that have been collected at the current 30960trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and 30961current value are returned. 30962 30963@item memory 30964The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace 30965frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a 30966collected memory range and has the following fields: 30967 30968@table @code 30969@item address 30970The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal. 30971 30972@item length 30973The length of the memory range, as decimal literal. 30974 30975@item contents 30976The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present 30977if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified. 30978 30979@end table 30980 30981@end table 30982 30983@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30984 30985There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 30986 30987@subsubheading Example 30988 30989@subheading -trace-list-variables 30990@findex -trace-list-variables 30991 30992@subsubheading Synopsis 30993 30994@smallexample 30995 -trace-list-variables 30996@end smallexample 30997 30998Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the 30999table has the following fields: 31000 31001@table @samp 31002@item name 31003The name of the trace variable. This field is always present. 31004 31005@item initial 31006The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This 31007field is always present. 31008 31009@item current 31010The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit 31011signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is 31012not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is 31013presently running. 31014 31015@end table 31016 31017@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31018 31019The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}. 31020 31021@subsubheading Example 31022 31023@smallexample 31024(gdb) 31025-trace-list-variables 31026^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3", 31027hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}, 31028 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@}, 31029 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}], 31030body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@} 31031 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@} 31032(gdb) 31033@end smallexample 31034 31035@subheading -trace-save 31036@findex -trace-save 31037 31038@subsubheading Synopsis 31039 31040@smallexample 31041 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename} 31042@end smallexample 31043 31044Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the 31045@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved 31046in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked 31047to perform the save. 31048 31049By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can 31050supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See 31051@ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF. 31052 31053@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31054 31055The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}. 31056 31057 31058@subheading -trace-start 31059@findex -trace-start 31060 31061@subsubheading Synopsis 31062 31063@smallexample 31064 -trace-start 31065@end smallexample 31066 31067Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not 31068have any fields. 31069 31070@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31071 31072The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}. 31073 31074@subheading -trace-status 31075@findex -trace-status 31076 31077@subsubheading Synopsis 31078 31079@smallexample 31080 -trace-status 31081@end smallexample 31082 31083Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include 31084the following fields: 31085 31086@table @samp 31087 31088@item supported 31089May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are 31090supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or 31091@samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining 31092of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be 31093started. This field is always present. 31094 31095@item running 31096May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether 31097tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present 31098if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}. 31099 31100@item stop-reason 31101Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field 31102may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The 31103value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of 31104the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means 31105the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means 31106tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected. 31107The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a 31108tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint. 31109This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}. 31110 31111@item stopping-tracepoint 31112The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is 31113present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of 31114@samp{passcount}. 31115 31116@item frames 31117@itemx frames-created 31118The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames 31119in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created 31120during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a 31121circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional. 31122 31123@item buffer-size 31124@itemx buffer-free 31125These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the 31126remaining space. These fields are optional. 31127 31128@item circular 31129The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the 31130trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if 31131necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear 31132and may fill up. 31133 31134@item disconnected 31135The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that 31136tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means 31137that the trace run will stop. 31138 31139@item trace-file 31140The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is 31141optional, and only present when examining a trace file. 31142 31143@end table 31144 31145@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31146 31147The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}. 31148 31149@subheading -trace-stop 31150@findex -trace-stop 31151 31152@subsubheading Synopsis 31153 31154@smallexample 31155 -trace-stop 31156@end smallexample 31157 31158Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same 31159fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and 31160@samp{running} fields are not output. 31161 31162@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31163 31164The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}. 31165 31166 31167@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31168@node GDB/MI Symbol Query 31169@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands 31170 31171 31172@ignore 31173@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command 31174@findex -symbol-info-address 31175 31176@subsubheading Synopsis 31177 31178@smallexample 31179 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol} 31180@end smallexample 31181 31182Describe where @var{symbol} is stored. 31183 31184@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31185 31186The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}. 31187 31188@subsubheading Example 31189N.A. 31190 31191 31192@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command 31193@findex -symbol-info-file 31194 31195@subsubheading Synopsis 31196 31197@smallexample 31198 -symbol-info-file 31199@end smallexample 31200 31201Show the file for the symbol. 31202 31203@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31204 31205There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has 31206@samp{gdb_find_file}. 31207 31208@subsubheading Example 31209N.A. 31210 31211 31212@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command 31213@findex -symbol-info-function 31214 31215@subsubheading Synopsis 31216 31217@smallexample 31218 -symbol-info-function 31219@end smallexample 31220 31221Show which function the symbol lives in. 31222 31223@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31224 31225@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}. 31226 31227@subsubheading Example 31228N.A. 31229 31230 31231@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command 31232@findex -symbol-info-line 31233 31234@subsubheading Synopsis 31235 31236@smallexample 31237 -symbol-info-line 31238@end smallexample 31239 31240Show the core addresses of the code for a source line. 31241 31242@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31243 31244The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}. 31245@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands. 31246 31247@subsubheading Example 31248N.A. 31249 31250 31251@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command 31252@findex -symbol-info-symbol 31253 31254@subsubheading Synopsis 31255 31256@smallexample 31257 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr} 31258@end smallexample 31259 31260Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}. 31261 31262@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31263 31264The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}. 31265 31266@subsubheading Example 31267N.A. 31268 31269 31270@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command 31271@findex -symbol-list-functions 31272 31273@subsubheading Synopsis 31274 31275@smallexample 31276 -symbol-list-functions 31277@end smallexample 31278 31279List the functions in the executable. 31280 31281@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31282 31283@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and 31284@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 31285 31286@subsubheading Example 31287N.A. 31288@end ignore 31289 31290 31291@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command 31292@findex -symbol-list-lines 31293 31294@subsubheading Synopsis 31295 31296@smallexample 31297 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename} 31298@end smallexample 31299 31300Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program 31301addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in 31302ascending PC order. 31303 31304@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31305 31306There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 31307 31308@subsubheading Example 31309@smallexample 31310(gdb) 31311-symbol-list-lines basics.c 31312^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}] 31313(gdb) 31314@end smallexample 31315 31316 31317@ignore 31318@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command 31319@findex -symbol-list-types 31320 31321@subsubheading Synopsis 31322 31323@smallexample 31324 -symbol-list-types 31325@end smallexample 31326 31327List all the type names. 31328 31329@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31330 31331The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN}, 31332@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 31333 31334@subsubheading Example 31335N.A. 31336 31337 31338@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command 31339@findex -symbol-list-variables 31340 31341@subsubheading Synopsis 31342 31343@smallexample 31344 -symbol-list-variables 31345@end smallexample 31346 31347List all the global and static variable names. 31348 31349@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31350 31351@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 31352 31353@subsubheading Example 31354N.A. 31355 31356 31357@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command 31358@findex -symbol-locate 31359 31360@subsubheading Synopsis 31361 31362@smallexample 31363 -symbol-locate 31364@end smallexample 31365 31366@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31367 31368@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}. 31369 31370@subsubheading Example 31371N.A. 31372 31373 31374@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command 31375@findex -symbol-type 31376 31377@subsubheading Synopsis 31378 31379@smallexample 31380 -symbol-type @var{variable} 31381@end smallexample 31382 31383Show type of @var{variable}. 31384 31385@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31386 31387The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has 31388@samp{gdb_obj_variable}. 31389 31390@subsubheading Example 31391N.A. 31392@end ignore 31393 31394 31395@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31396@node GDB/MI File Commands 31397@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands 31398 31399This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names 31400and to read in and obtain symbol table information. 31401 31402@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command 31403@findex -file-exec-and-symbols 31404 31405@subsubheading Synopsis 31406 31407@smallexample 31408 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file} 31409@end smallexample 31410 31411Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from 31412which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the 31413command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints 31414are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce 31415error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion 31416notification. 31417 31418@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31419 31420The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}. 31421 31422@subsubheading Example 31423 31424@smallexample 31425(gdb) 31426-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 31427^done 31428(gdb) 31429@end smallexample 31430 31431 31432@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command 31433@findex -file-exec-file 31434 31435@subsubheading Synopsis 31436 31437@smallexample 31438 -file-exec-file @var{file} 31439@end smallexample 31440 31441Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike 31442@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read 31443from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information 31444about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion 31445notification. 31446 31447@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31448 31449The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}. 31450 31451@subsubheading Example 31452 31453@smallexample 31454(gdb) 31455-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 31456^done 31457(gdb) 31458@end smallexample 31459 31460 31461@ignore 31462@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command 31463@findex -file-list-exec-sections 31464 31465@subsubheading Synopsis 31466 31467@smallexample 31468 -file-list-exec-sections 31469@end smallexample 31470 31471List the sections of the current executable file. 31472 31473@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31474 31475The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same 31476information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command 31477@samp{gdb_load_info}. 31478 31479@subsubheading Example 31480N.A. 31481@end ignore 31482 31483 31484@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command 31485@findex -file-list-exec-source-file 31486 31487@subsubheading Synopsis 31488 31489@smallexample 31490 -file-list-exec-source-file 31491@end smallexample 31492 31493List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path 31494to the current source file for the current executable. The macro 31495information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on 31496whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information. 31497 31498@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31499 31500The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source} 31501 31502@subsubheading Example 31503 31504@smallexample 31505(gdb) 31506123-file-list-exec-source-file 31507123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1" 31508(gdb) 31509@end smallexample 31510 31511 31512@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command 31513@findex -file-list-exec-source-files 31514 31515@subsubheading Synopsis 31516 31517@smallexample 31518 -file-list-exec-source-files 31519@end smallexample 31520 31521List the source files for the current executable. 31522 31523It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file 31524name) of a source file. 31525 31526@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31527 31528The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}. 31529@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}. 31530 31531@subsubheading Example 31532@smallexample 31533(gdb) 31534-file-list-exec-source-files 31535^done,files=[ 31536@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@}, 31537@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@}, 31538@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}] 31539(gdb) 31540@end smallexample 31541 31542@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command 31543@findex -file-list-shared-libraries 31544 31545@subsubheading Synopsis 31546 31547@smallexample 31548 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ] 31549@end smallexample 31550 31551List the shared libraries in the program. 31552With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose 31553names match @var{regexp} are listed. 31554 31555@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31556 31557The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields 31558have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification. 31559The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this 31560library. Each range has the following fields: 31561 31562@table @samp 31563@item from 31564The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment. 31565@item to 31566The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment. 31567@end table 31568 31569@subsubheading Example 31570@smallexample 31571(gdb) 31572-file-list-exec-source-files 31573^done,shared-libraries=[ 31574@{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@}, 31575@{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}] 31576(gdb) 31577@end smallexample 31578 31579 31580@ignore 31581@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command 31582@findex -file-list-symbol-files 31583 31584@subsubheading Synopsis 31585 31586@smallexample 31587 -file-list-symbol-files 31588@end smallexample 31589 31590List symbol files. 31591 31592@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31593 31594The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it). 31595 31596@subsubheading Example 31597N.A. 31598@end ignore 31599 31600 31601@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command 31602@findex -file-symbol-file 31603 31604@subsubheading Synopsis 31605 31606@smallexample 31607 -file-symbol-file @var{file} 31608@end smallexample 31609 31610Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When 31611used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is 31612produced, except for a completion notification. 31613 31614@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31615 31616The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}. 31617 31618@subsubheading Example 31619 31620@smallexample 31621(gdb) 31622-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 31623^done 31624(gdb) 31625@end smallexample 31626 31627@ignore 31628@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31629@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands 31630@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands 31631 31632The memory overlay commands are not implemented. 31633 31634@c @subheading -overlay-auto 31635 31636@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state 31637 31638@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays 31639 31640@c @subheading -overlay-map 31641 31642@c @subheading -overlay-off 31643 31644@c @subheading -overlay-on 31645 31646@c @subheading -overlay-unmap 31647 31648@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31649@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands 31650@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands 31651 31652Signal handling commands are not implemented. 31653 31654@c @subheading -signal-handle 31655 31656@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions 31657 31658@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types 31659@end ignore 31660 31661 31662@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31663@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation 31664@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands 31665 31666 31667@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command 31668@findex -target-attach 31669 31670@subsubheading Synopsis 31671 31672@smallexample 31673 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file} 31674@end smallexample 31675 31676Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of 31677@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread 31678group, the id previously returned by 31679@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used. 31680 31681@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31682 31683The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}. 31684 31685@subsubheading Example 31686@smallexample 31687(gdb) 31688-target-attach 34 31689=thread-created,id="1" 31690*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@} 31691^done 31692(gdb) 31693@end smallexample 31694 31695@ignore 31696@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command 31697@findex -target-compare-sections 31698 31699@subsubheading Synopsis 31700 31701@smallexample 31702 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ] 31703@end smallexample 31704 31705Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file. 31706Without the argument, all sections are compared. 31707 31708@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31709 31710The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}. 31711 31712@subsubheading Example 31713N.A. 31714@end ignore 31715 31716 31717@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command 31718@findex -target-detach 31719 31720@subsubheading Synopsis 31721 31722@smallexample 31723 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ] 31724@end smallexample 31725 31726Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution. 31727If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either 31728the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output. 31729 31730@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31731 31732The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}. 31733 31734@subsubheading Example 31735 31736@smallexample 31737(gdb) 31738-target-detach 31739^done 31740(gdb) 31741@end smallexample 31742 31743 31744@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command 31745@findex -target-disconnect 31746 31747@subsubheading Synopsis 31748 31749@smallexample 31750 -target-disconnect 31751@end smallexample 31752 31753Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is 31754generally not resumed. 31755 31756@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31757 31758The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}. 31759 31760@subsubheading Example 31761 31762@smallexample 31763(gdb) 31764-target-disconnect 31765^done 31766(gdb) 31767@end smallexample 31768 31769 31770@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command 31771@findex -target-download 31772 31773@subsubheading Synopsis 31774 31775@smallexample 31776 -target-download 31777@end smallexample 31778 31779Loads the executable onto the remote target. 31780It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields: 31781 31782@table @samp 31783@item section 31784The name of the section. 31785@item section-sent 31786The size of what has been sent so far for that section. 31787@item section-size 31788The size of the section. 31789@item total-sent 31790The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections). 31791@item total-size 31792The size of the overall executable to download. 31793@end table 31794 31795@noindent 31796Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , 31797@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}). 31798 31799In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are 31800downloaded. These messages include the following fields: 31801 31802@table @samp 31803@item section 31804The name of the section. 31805@item section-size 31806The size of the section. 31807@item total-size 31808The size of the overall executable to download. 31809@end table 31810 31811@noindent 31812At the end, a summary is printed. 31813 31814@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31815 31816The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}. 31817 31818@subsubheading Example 31819 31820Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages 31821have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page. 31822 31823@smallexample 31824(gdb) 31825-target-download 31826+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@} 31827+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668", 31828total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@} 31829+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668", 31830total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@} 31831+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668", 31832total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@} 31833+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668", 31834total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@} 31835+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668", 31836total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@} 31837+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668", 31838total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@} 31839+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668", 31840total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@} 31841+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668", 31842total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@} 31843+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668", 31844total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@} 31845+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668", 31846total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@} 31847+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668", 31848total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@} 31849+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668", 31850total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@} 31851+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668", 31852total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@} 31853+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@} 31854+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@} 31855+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@} 31856+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156", 31857total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@} 31858+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156", 31859total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@} 31860+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156", 31861total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@} 31862+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156", 31863total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@} 31864+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156", 31865total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@} 31866+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156", 31867total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@} 31868^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586", 31869write-rate="429" 31870(gdb) 31871@end smallexample 31872 31873 31874@ignore 31875@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command 31876@findex -target-exec-status 31877 31878@subsubheading Synopsis 31879 31880@smallexample 31881 -target-exec-status 31882@end smallexample 31883 31884Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or 31885not, for instance). 31886 31887@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31888 31889There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. 31890 31891@subsubheading Example 31892N.A. 31893 31894 31895@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command 31896@findex -target-list-available-targets 31897 31898@subsubheading Synopsis 31899 31900@smallexample 31901 -target-list-available-targets 31902@end smallexample 31903 31904List the possible targets to connect to. 31905 31906@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31907 31908The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}. 31909 31910@subsubheading Example 31911N.A. 31912 31913 31914@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command 31915@findex -target-list-current-targets 31916 31917@subsubheading Synopsis 31918 31919@smallexample 31920 -target-list-current-targets 31921@end smallexample 31922 31923Describe the current target. 31924 31925@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31926 31927The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among 31928other things). 31929 31930@subsubheading Example 31931N.A. 31932 31933 31934@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command 31935@findex -target-list-parameters 31936 31937@subsubheading Synopsis 31938 31939@smallexample 31940 -target-list-parameters 31941@end smallexample 31942 31943@c ???? 31944@end ignore 31945 31946@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31947 31948No equivalent. 31949 31950@subsubheading Example 31951N.A. 31952 31953@subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command 31954@findex -target-flash-erase 31955 31956@subsubheading Synopsis 31957 31958@smallexample 31959 -target-flash-erase 31960@end smallexample 31961 31962Erases all known flash memory regions on the target. 31963 31964The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}. 31965 31966The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting 31967addresses and memory region sizes. 31968 31969@smallexample 31970(gdb) 31971-target-flash-erase 31972^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@} 31973(gdb) 31974@end smallexample 31975 31976@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command 31977@findex -target-select 31978 31979@subsubheading Synopsis 31980 31981@smallexample 31982 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}} 31983@end smallexample 31984 31985Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args: 31986 31987@table @samp 31988@item @var{type} 31989The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc. 31990@item @var{parameters} 31991Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, , 31992Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details. 31993@end table 31994 31995The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at 31996which the target program is, in the following form: 31997 31998@smallexample 31999^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}", 32000 args=[@var{arg list}] 32001@end smallexample 32002 32003@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32004 32005The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}. 32006 32007@subsubheading Example 32008 32009@smallexample 32010(gdb) 32011-target-select remote /dev/ttya 32012^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[] 32013(gdb) 32014@end smallexample 32015 32016@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 32017@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands 32018@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands 32019 32020 32021@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command 32022@findex -target-file-put 32023 32024@subsubheading Synopsis 32025 32026@smallexample 32027 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile} 32028@end smallexample 32029 32030Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running 32031@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system. 32032 32033@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32034 32035The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}. 32036 32037@subsubheading Example 32038 32039@smallexample 32040(gdb) 32041-target-file-put localfile remotefile 32042^done 32043(gdb) 32044@end smallexample 32045 32046 32047@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command 32048@findex -target-file-get 32049 32050@subsubheading Synopsis 32051 32052@smallexample 32053 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile} 32054@end smallexample 32055 32056Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile} 32057on the host system. 32058 32059@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32060 32061The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}. 32062 32063@subsubheading Example 32064 32065@smallexample 32066(gdb) 32067-target-file-get remotefile localfile 32068^done 32069(gdb) 32070@end smallexample 32071 32072 32073@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command 32074@findex -target-file-delete 32075 32076@subsubheading Synopsis 32077 32078@smallexample 32079 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile} 32080@end smallexample 32081 32082Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system. 32083 32084@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32085 32086The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}. 32087 32088@subsubheading Example 32089 32090@smallexample 32091(gdb) 32092-target-file-delete remotefile 32093^done 32094(gdb) 32095@end smallexample 32096 32097 32098@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 32099@node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands 32100@section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands 32101 32102@subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command 32103@findex -info-ada-exceptions 32104 32105@subsubheading Synopsis 32106 32107@smallexample 32108 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}] 32109@end smallexample 32110 32111List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged. 32112With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose 32113names match @var{regexp} are listed. 32114 32115@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32116 32117The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}. 32118 32119@subsubheading Result 32120 32121The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are 32122defined for each exception: 32123 32124@table @samp 32125@item name 32126The name of the exception. 32127 32128@item address 32129The address of the exception. 32130 32131@end table 32132 32133@subsubheading Example 32134 32135@smallexample 32136-info-ada-exceptions aint 32137^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2", 32138hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}, 32139@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}], 32140body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@}, 32141@{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@} 32142@end smallexample 32143 32144@subheading Catching Ada Exceptions 32145 32146The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program 32147raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI 32148Catchpoint Commands}. 32149 32150 32151@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 32152@node GDB/MI Support Commands 32153@section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands 32154 32155Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi}, 32156some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger 32157about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible 32158to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features. 32159 32160@subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command 32161@cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} 32162@findex -info-gdb-mi-command 32163 32164@subsubheading Synopsis 32165 32166@smallexample 32167 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name} 32168@end smallexample 32169 32170Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}. 32171 32172Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands 32173is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input 32174Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However, 32175for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading 32176dash. 32177 32178@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32179 32180There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 32181 32182@subsubheading Result 32183 32184The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field: 32185 32186@table @samp 32187@item exists 32188This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists, 32189@code{"false"} otherwise. 32190 32191@end table 32192 32193@subsubheading Example 32194 32195Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist: 32196 32197@smallexample 32198-info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command 32199^done,command=@{exists="false"@} 32200@end smallexample 32201 32202@noindent 32203And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known 32204to the debugger: 32205 32206@smallexample 32207-info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines 32208^done,command=@{exists="true"@} 32209@end smallexample 32210 32211@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command 32212@findex -list-features 32213@cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list 32214 32215Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that 32216this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command, 32217or a new field in an output of some command, or even an 32218important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence 32219of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger 32220startup. 32221 32222The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an 32223available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not 32224have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names 32225is given below. 32226 32227Example output: 32228 32229@smallexample 32230(gdb) -list-features 32231^done,result=["feature1","feature2"] 32232@end smallexample 32233 32234The current list of features is: 32235 32236@ftable @samp 32237@item frozen-varobjs 32238Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well 32239as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output 32240of @code{-varobj-create}. 32241@item pending-breakpoints 32242Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} 32243command. 32244@item python 32245Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based 32246pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the 32247@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children} 32248@item thread-info 32249Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command. 32250@item data-read-memory-bytes 32251Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the 32252@code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands. 32253@item breakpoint-notifications 32254Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the 32255CLI will be announced via async records. 32256@item ada-task-info 32257Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command. 32258@item language-option 32259Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language} 32260option (@pxref{Context management}). 32261@item info-gdb-mi-command 32262Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command. 32263@item undefined-command-error-code 32264Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result 32265records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command 32266(@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}). 32267@item exec-run-start-option 32268Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start} 32269option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}). 32270@end ftable 32271 32272@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command 32273@findex -list-target-features 32274 32275Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the 32276target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but 32277unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the 32278features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever 32279a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select}, 32280@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features 32281may change, and the frontend should obtain it again. 32282Example output: 32283 32284@smallexample 32285(gdb) -list-target-features 32286^done,result=["async"] 32287@end smallexample 32288 32289The current list of features is: 32290 32291@table @samp 32292@item async 32293Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command 32294execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands 32295while the target is running. 32296 32297@item reverse 32298Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution. 32299@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 32300 32301@end table 32302 32303@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 32304@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands 32305@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands 32306 32307@c @subheading -gdb-complete 32308 32309@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command 32310@findex -gdb-exit 32311 32312@subsubheading Synopsis 32313 32314@smallexample 32315 -gdb-exit 32316@end smallexample 32317 32318Exit @value{GDBN} immediately. 32319 32320@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32321 32322Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}. 32323 32324@subsubheading Example 32325 32326@smallexample 32327(gdb) 32328-gdb-exit 32329^exit 32330@end smallexample 32331 32332 32333@ignore 32334@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command 32335@findex -exec-abort 32336 32337@subsubheading Synopsis 32338 32339@smallexample 32340 -exec-abort 32341@end smallexample 32342 32343Kill the inferior running program. 32344 32345@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32346 32347The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}. 32348 32349@subsubheading Example 32350N.A. 32351@end ignore 32352 32353 32354@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command 32355@findex -gdb-set 32356 32357@subsubheading Synopsis 32358 32359@smallexample 32360 -gdb-set 32361@end smallexample 32362 32363Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable. 32364@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ????? 32365 32366@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32367 32368The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}. 32369 32370@subsubheading Example 32371 32372@smallexample 32373(gdb) 32374-gdb-set $foo=3 32375^done 32376(gdb) 32377@end smallexample 32378 32379 32380@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command 32381@findex -gdb-show 32382 32383@subsubheading Synopsis 32384 32385@smallexample 32386 -gdb-show 32387@end smallexample 32388 32389Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable. 32390 32391@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32392 32393The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}. 32394 32395@subsubheading Example 32396 32397@smallexample 32398(gdb) 32399-gdb-show annotate 32400^done,value="0" 32401(gdb) 32402@end smallexample 32403 32404@c @subheading -gdb-source 32405 32406 32407@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command 32408@findex -gdb-version 32409 32410@subsubheading Synopsis 32411 32412@smallexample 32413 -gdb-version 32414@end smallexample 32415 32416Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing. 32417 32418@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32419 32420The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by 32421default shows this information when you start an interactive session. 32422 32423@subsubheading Example 32424 32425@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull 32426@c box in TeX. 32427@smallexample 32428(gdb) 32429-gdb-version 32430~GNU gdb 5.2.1 32431~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 32432~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and 32433~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under 32434~ certain conditions. 32435~Type "show copying" to see the conditions. 32436~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for 32437~ details. 32438~This GDB was configured as 32439 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi". 32440^done 32441(gdb) 32442@end smallexample 32443 32444@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command 32445@findex -list-thread-groups 32446 32447@subheading Synopsis 32448 32449@smallexample 32450-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ] 32451@end smallexample 32452 32453Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread 32454group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group. 32455When several thread group are passed, lists information about those 32456thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all 32457top-level thread groups. 32458 32459Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported. 32460With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups 32461available on the target. 32462 32463The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or 32464a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples 32465as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread 32466Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value, 32467each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are 32468requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups 32469are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format 32470of the @samp{group} result is described below. 32471 32472To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups 32473together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option 32474and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is 32475permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group 32476will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or 32477@samp{threads} field. 32478 32479In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with 32480the following caveats: 32481 32482@itemize @bullet 32483@item 32484When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically 32485be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain 32486anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored. 32487 32488@item 32489When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may 32490be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might 32491be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might 32492not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups. 32493The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} 32494is always an expensive operation and cache the results. 32495 32496@end itemize 32497 32498The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may 32499have the following fields: 32500 32501@table @code 32502@item id 32503Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present. 32504The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to 32505convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one. 32506 32507@item type 32508The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a 32509valid type. 32510 32511@item pid 32512The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present 32513for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists. 32514 32515@item exit-code 32516The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal. 32517This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and 32518only if the process is not running. 32519 32520@item num_children 32521The number of children this thread group has. This field may be 32522absent for an available thread group. 32523 32524@item threads 32525This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a 32526thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is 32527specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads. 32528 32529@item cores 32530This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one 32531thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if 32532such information is not available. 32533 32534@item executable 32535The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group. 32536The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process}, 32537and only if there is a corresponding executable file. 32538 32539@end table 32540 32541@subheading Example 32542 32543@smallexample 32544@value{GDBP} 32545-list-thread-groups 32546^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}] 32547-list-thread-groups 17 32548^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)", 32549 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@}, 32550@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)", 32551 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}], 32552 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]] 32553-list-thread-groups --available 32554^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}] 32555-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 32556 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2], 32557 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@}, 32558 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..] 32559-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18 32560^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2], 32561 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@}, 32562 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...] 32563@end smallexample 32564 32565@subheading The @code{-info-os} Command 32566@findex -info-os 32567 32568@subsubheading Synopsis 32569 32570@smallexample 32571-info-os [ @var{type} ] 32572@end smallexample 32573 32574If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available 32575operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is 32576supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table 32577of data of that type. 32578 32579The types of information available depend on the target operating 32580system. 32581 32582@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32583 32584The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}. 32585 32586@subsubheading Example 32587 32588When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something 32589like this: 32590 32591@smallexample 32592@value{GDBP} 32593-info-os 32594^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3", 32595hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@}, 32596 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@}, 32597 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}], 32598body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system", 32599 col2="CPUs"@}, 32600 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors", 32601 col2="File descriptors"@}, 32602 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules", 32603 col2="Kernel modules"@}, 32604 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues", 32605 col2="Message queues"@}, 32606 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes", 32607 col2="Processes"@}, 32608 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups", 32609 col2="Process groups"@}, 32610 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores", 32611 col2="Semaphores"@}, 32612 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions", 32613 col2="Shared-memory regions"@}, 32614 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets", 32615 col2="Sockets"@}, 32616 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads", 32617 col2="Threads"@}] 32618@value{GDBP} 32619-info-os processes 32620^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4", 32621hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@}, 32622 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@}, 32623 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@}, 32624 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}], 32625body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@}, 32626 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@}, 32627 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@}, 32628 ... 32629 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@}, 32630 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@} 32631(gdb) 32632@end smallexample 32633 32634(Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that 32635does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful 32636for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a 32637popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and 32638@code{info os} omits it.) 32639 32640@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command 32641@findex -add-inferior 32642 32643@subheading Synopsis 32644 32645@smallexample 32646-add-inferior 32647@end smallexample 32648 32649Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created 32650inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may 32651be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command 32652(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single 32653field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the 32654thread group corresponding to the new inferior. 32655 32656@subheading Example 32657 32658@smallexample 32659@value{GDBP} 32660-add-inferior 32661^done,inferior="i3" 32662@end smallexample 32663 32664@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command 32665@findex -interpreter-exec 32666 32667@subheading Synopsis 32668 32669@smallexample 32670-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command} 32671@end smallexample 32672@anchor{-interpreter-exec} 32673 32674Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}. 32675 32676@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32677 32678The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}. 32679 32680@subheading Example 32681 32682@smallexample 32683(gdb) 32684-interpreter-exec console "break main" 32685&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n" 32686&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n" 32687~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n" 32688^done 32689(gdb) 32690@end smallexample 32691 32692@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command 32693@findex -inferior-tty-set 32694 32695@subheading Synopsis 32696 32697@smallexample 32698-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 32699@end smallexample 32700 32701Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged. 32702 32703@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32704 32705The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1. 32706 32707@subheading Example 32708 32709@smallexample 32710(gdb) 32711-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 32712^done 32713(gdb) 32714@end smallexample 32715 32716@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command 32717@findex -inferior-tty-show 32718 32719@subheading Synopsis 32720 32721@smallexample 32722-inferior-tty-show 32723@end smallexample 32724 32725Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged. 32726 32727@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32728 32729The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}. 32730 32731@subheading Example 32732 32733@smallexample 32734(gdb) 32735-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 32736^done 32737(gdb) 32738-inferior-tty-show 32739^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1" 32740(gdb) 32741@end smallexample 32742 32743@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command 32744@findex -enable-timings 32745 32746@subheading Synopsis 32747 32748@smallexample 32749-enable-timings [yes | no] 32750@end smallexample 32751 32752Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI 32753command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend 32754developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is 32755equivalent to @samp{yes}. 32756 32757@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32758 32759No equivalent. 32760 32761@subheading Example 32762 32763@smallexample 32764(gdb) 32765-enable-timings 32766^done 32767(gdb) 32768-break-insert main 32769^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 32770addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c", 32771fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"], 32772times="0"@}, 32773time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@} 32774(gdb) 32775-enable-timings no 32776^done 32777(gdb) 32778-exec-run 32779^running 32780(gdb) 32781*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0", 32782frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@}, 32783@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c", 32784fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@} 32785(gdb) 32786@end smallexample 32787 32788@node Annotations 32789@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations 32790 32791This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were 32792designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other 32793similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a 32794relatively high level. 32795 32796The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi} 32797(@pxref{GDB/MI}). 32798 32799@ignore 32800This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}. 32801@end ignore 32802 32803@menu 32804* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax. 32805* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state. 32806* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input. 32807* Errors:: Annotations for error messages. 32808* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid. 32809* Annotations for Running:: 32810 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc. 32811* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code. 32812@end menu 32813 32814@node Annotations Overview 32815@section What is an Annotation? 32816@cindex annotations 32817 32818Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z} 32819characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional 32820information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation 32821is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional 32822information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the 32823additional information, and a newline. The additional information 32824cannot contain newline characters. 32825 32826Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z} 32827characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is 32828no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two 32829@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the 32830annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which 32831means those three characters as output. 32832 32833The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the 32834@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls 32835how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, 32836values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 32837is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a 32838subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable 32839for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have 32840been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation 32841Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). 32842 32843@table @code 32844@kindex set annotate 32845@item set annotate @var{level} 32846The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of 32847annotations to the specified @var{level}. 32848 32849@item show annotate 32850@kindex show annotate 32851Show the current annotation level. 32852@end table 32853 32854This chapter describes level 3 annotations. 32855 32856A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is: 32857 32858@smallexample 32859$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3} 32860GNU gdb 6.0 32861Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 32862GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, 32863and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it 32864under certain conditions. 32865Type "show copying" to see the conditions. 32866There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" 32867for details. 32868This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu" 32869 32870^Z^Zpre-prompt 32871(@value{GDBP}) 32872^Z^Zprompt 32873@kbd{quit} 32874 32875^Z^Zpost-prompt 32876$ 32877@end smallexample 32878 32879Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from 32880@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z} 32881denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is 32882output from @value{GDBN}. 32883 32884@node Server Prefix 32885@section The Server Prefix 32886@cindex server prefix 32887 32888If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect 32889the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which 32890command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This 32891means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in 32892a transparent manner. 32893 32894The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into 32895the value history; to print a value without recording it into the 32896value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the 32897@code{print} command. 32898 32899Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests 32900(@pxref{confirmation requests}). 32901 32902@node Prompting 32903@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input 32904 32905@cindex annotations for prompts 32906When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible 32907to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is 32908over, etc. 32909 32910Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each 32911input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which 32912denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain 32913annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-} 32914annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be 32915associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type 32916features the following annotations: 32917 32918@smallexample 32919^Z^Zpre-prompt 32920^Z^Zprompt 32921^Z^Zpost-prompt 32922@end smallexample 32923 32924The input types are 32925 32926@table @code 32927@findex pre-prompt annotation 32928@findex prompt annotation 32929@findex post-prompt annotation 32930@item prompt 32931When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt). 32932 32933@findex pre-commands annotation 32934@findex commands annotation 32935@findex post-commands annotation 32936@item commands 32937When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands} 32938command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input. 32939 32940@findex pre-overload-choice annotation 32941@findex overload-choice annotation 32942@findex post-overload-choice annotation 32943@item overload-choice 32944When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions. 32945 32946@findex pre-query annotation 32947@findex query annotation 32948@findex post-query annotation 32949@item query 32950When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation. 32951 32952@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation 32953@findex prompt-for-continue annotation 32954@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation 32955@item prompt-for-continue 32956When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't 32957expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable 32958prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the 32959presence of annotations. 32960@end table 32961 32962@node Errors 32963@section Errors 32964@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts 32965 32966@findex quit annotation 32967@smallexample 32968^Z^Zquit 32969@end smallexample 32970 32971This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt. 32972 32973@findex error annotation 32974@smallexample 32975^Z^Zerror 32976@end smallexample 32977 32978This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error. 32979 32980Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was 32981in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a 32982@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one 32983cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One 32984cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation 32985does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way 32986to the top level. 32987 32988@findex error-begin annotation 32989A quit or error annotation may be preceded by 32990 32991@smallexample 32992^Z^Zerror-begin 32993@end smallexample 32994 32995Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error 32996message. 32997 32998Warning messages are not yet annotated. 32999@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(), 33000@c range_error(), and possibly other places. 33001 33002@node Invalidation 33003@section Invalidation Notices 33004 33005@cindex annotations for invalidation messages 33006The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have 33007changed. 33008 33009@table @code 33010@findex frames-invalid annotation 33011@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid 33012 33013The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may 33014have changed. 33015 33016@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation 33017@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid 33018 33019The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or 33020deleted a breakpoint. 33021@end table 33022 33023@node Annotations for Running 33024@section Running the Program 33025@cindex annotations for running programs 33026 33027@findex starting annotation 33028@findex stopping annotation 33029When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as 33030@code{step} or @code{continue}, 33031 33032@smallexample 33033^Z^Zstarting 33034@end smallexample 33035 33036is output. When the program stops, 33037 33038@smallexample 33039^Z^Zstopped 33040@end smallexample 33041 33042is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of 33043annotations describe how the program stopped. 33044 33045@table @code 33046@findex exited annotation 33047@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status} 33048The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for 33049successful exit, otherwise nonzero). 33050 33051@findex signalled annotation 33052@findex signal-name annotation 33053@findex signal-name-end annotation 33054@findex signal-string annotation 33055@findex signal-string-end annotation 33056@item ^Z^Zsignalled 33057The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the 33058annotation continues: 33059 33060@smallexample 33061@var{intro-text} 33062^Z^Zsignal-name 33063@var{name} 33064^Z^Zsignal-name-end 33065@var{middle-text} 33066^Z^Zsignal-string 33067@var{string} 33068^Z^Zsignal-string-end 33069@var{end-text} 33070@end smallexample 33071 33072@noindent 33073where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or 33074@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such 33075as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments 33076@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the 33077user's benefit and have no particular format. 33078 33079@findex signal annotation 33080@item ^Z^Zsignal 33081The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is 33082just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was 33083terminated with it. 33084 33085@findex breakpoint annotation 33086@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number} 33087The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}. 33088 33089@findex watchpoint annotation 33090@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number} 33091The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}. 33092@end table 33093 33094@node Source Annotations 33095@section Displaying Source 33096@cindex annotations for source display 33097 33098@findex source annotation 33099The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code: 33100 33101@smallexample 33102^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr} 33103@end smallexample 33104 33105where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source 33106file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the 33107first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position 33108within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most 33109debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line), 33110@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the 33111line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and 33112@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the 33113source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x} 33114followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not 33115depend on the language). 33116 33117@node JIT Interface 33118@chapter JIT Compilation Interface 33119@cindex just-in-time compilation 33120@cindex JIT compilation interface 33121 33122This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation 33123interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native 33124executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good 33125performance while maintaining platform independence. 33126 33127Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because 33128portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from 33129object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols 33130and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation, 33131@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory 33132symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime. 33133 33134If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then 33135it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If 33136you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest 33137of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the 33138LLVM JIT. 33139 33140Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The 33141JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global 33142variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN} 33143attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to 33144find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find 33145out about additional code. 33146 33147@menu 33148* Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations 33149* Registering Code:: Steps to register code 33150* Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code 33151* Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format 33152@end menu 33153 33154@node Declarations 33155@section JIT Declarations 33156 33157These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to 33158implement the interface: 33159 33160@smallexample 33161typedef enum 33162@{ 33163 JIT_NOACTION = 0, 33164 JIT_REGISTER_FN, 33165 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN 33166@} jit_actions_t; 33167 33168struct jit_code_entry 33169@{ 33170 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry; 33171 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry; 33172 const char *symfile_addr; 33173 uint64_t symfile_size; 33174@}; 33175 33176struct jit_descriptor 33177@{ 33178 uint32_t version; 33179 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t 33180 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */ 33181 uint32_t action_flag; 33182 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry; 33183 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry; 33184@}; 33185 33186/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */ 33187void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @}; 33188 33189/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the 33190 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */ 33191struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @}; 33192@end smallexample 33193 33194If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any 33195modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting 33196a global mutex around modifications to these structures. 33197 33198@node Registering Code 33199@section Registering Code 33200 33201To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol: 33202 33203@itemize @bullet 33204@item 33205Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug 33206information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections. 33207 33208@item 33209Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol 33210file. 33211 33212@item 33213Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor. 33214 33215@item 33216Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry. 33217 33218@item 33219Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call 33220@code{__jit_debug_register_code}. 33221@end itemize 33222 33223When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the 33224@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for 33225new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow 33226@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files. 33227 33228@node Unregistering Code 33229@section Unregistering Code 33230 33231If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol: 33232 33233@itemize @bullet 33234@item 33235Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list. 33236 33237@item 33238Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry. 33239 33240@item 33241Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call 33242@code{__jit_debug_register_code}. 33243@end itemize 33244 33245If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN} 33246and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files. 33247 33248@node Custom Debug Info 33249@section Custom Debug Info 33250@cindex custom JIT debug info 33251@cindex JIT debug info reader 33252 33253Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF 33254or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the 33255debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The 33256issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info 33257format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated 33258by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing 33259such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file 33260@file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at 33261@file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion. 33262 33263The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is 33264not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at 33265runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and 33266@code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload 33267the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared 33268object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT 33269compiler. 33270 33271@menu 33272* Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly 33273* Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader 33274@end menu 33275 33276@node Using JIT Debug Info Readers 33277@subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers 33278@kindex jit-reader-load 33279@kindex jit-reader-unload 33280 33281Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load} 33282and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands. 33283 33284@table @code 33285@item jit-reader-load @var{reader} 33286Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared 33287object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In 33288the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a 33289pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX 33290system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often 33291@file{/usr/local/lib}). 33292 33293Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second 33294reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN} 33295reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading 33296the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking 33297@code{jit-reader-load}. 33298 33299@item jit-reader-unload 33300Unload the currently loaded JIT reader. 33301 33302@end table 33303 33304@node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers 33305@subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers 33306@cindex writing JIT debug info readers 33307 33308As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a 33309certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}. 33310 33311@file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions 33312required to write a reader. It is installed (along with 33313@value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is 33314the system include directory. 33315 33316Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader 33317can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro 33318@code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file. 33319 33320The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader}, 33321which is expected to be a function with the prototype 33322 33323@findex gdb_init_reader 33324@smallexample 33325extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void); 33326@end smallexample 33327 33328@cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} 33329 33330@code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback 33331functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info 33332generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames 33333(@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs 33334(@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the 33335reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this 33336 33337@smallexample 33338struct gdb_reader_funcs 33339@{ 33340 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */ 33341 int reader_version; 33342 33343 /* For use by the reader. */ 33344 void *priv_data; 33345 33346 gdb_read_debug_info *read; 33347 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind; 33348 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id; 33349 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy; 33350@}; 33351@end smallexample 33352 33353@cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} 33354@cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks} 33355 33356The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by 33357@value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are 33358passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind} 33359and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}. 33360@code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object 33361files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct 33362gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current 33363frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous 33364frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the 33365target's address space. 33366 33367@node In-Process Agent 33368@chapter In-Process Agent 33369@cindex debugging agent 33370The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine, 33371because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However, 33372as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and 33373multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more 33374and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for 33375example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's 33376timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications, 33377it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution 33378long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior. 33379If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays 33380introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the 33381code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's 33382behavior without interrupting it. 33383 33384Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce 33385some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can 33386reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The 33387@dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same 33388process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations 33389itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and 33390performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that 33391interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely, 33392because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program. 33393 33394The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions 33395(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The 33396agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting 33397data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints. 33398 33399@anchor{Control Agent} 33400You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for 33401debugging with the following commands: 33402 33403@table @code 33404@kindex set agent on 33405@item set agent on 33406Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the 33407debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done 33408by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example, 33409if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent, 33410and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint 33411conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent. 33412 33413@kindex set agent off 33414@item set agent off 33415Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All 33416of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}. 33417 33418@kindex show agent 33419@item show agent 33420Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by 33421the in-process agent. 33422@end table 33423 33424@menu 33425* In-Process Agent Protocol:: 33426@end menu 33427 33428@node In-Process Agent Protocol 33429@section In-Process Agent Protocol 33430@cindex in-process agent protocol 33431 33432The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and 33433GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol 33434used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA. 33435In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands 33436(@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then 33437in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or 33438some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed 33439of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite 33440types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}). 33441 33442@menu 33443* IPA Protocol Objects:: 33444* IPA Protocol Commands:: 33445@end menu 33446 33447@node IPA Protocol Objects 33448@subsection IPA Protocol Objects 33449@cindex ipa protocol objects 33450 33451The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some 33452complex data types called @dfn{objects}. 33453 33454The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN} 33455or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between 33456two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle. 33457However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes: 33458 33459@enumerate 33460@item 33461word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be 33462compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one. 33463@item 33464ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or 33465GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with 33466the other one. 33467@end enumerate 33468 33469Here are the IPA Protocol Objects: 33470 33471@enumerate 33472@item 33473agent expression object. It represents an agent expression 33474(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). 33475@anchor{agent expression object} 33476@item 33477tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action 33478(@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers, 33479memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression. 33480@anchor{tracepoint action object} 33481@item 33482tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}). 33483@anchor{tracepoint object} 33484 33485@end enumerate 33486 33487The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol 33488object: 33489 33490@multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50 33491@headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description 33492@item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab 33493@item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code 33494@item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code 33495@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab 33496@item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33497@item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the 33498address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset 33499of @var{basereg} for memory collecting. 33500@item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting 33501@item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting 33502memory address for collecting. 33503@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab 33504@item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33505@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab 33506@item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33507@item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab 33508@item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33509@item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object} 33510@item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab 33511@item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint 33512@item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on 33513@item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint 33514@item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint 33515@item step_count @tab 8 @tab step 33516@item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass 33517@item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions 33518@item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count 33519@item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage 33520@item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition 33521@item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size 33522@item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of 33523@ref{agent expression object} 33524@tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is 33525@ref{agent expression object} 33526@item actions @tab variable 33527@tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object} 33528@end multitable 33529 33530@node IPA Protocol Commands 33531@subsection IPA Protocol Commands 33532@cindex ipa protocol commands 33533 33534The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands 33535specification. They don't exist in real commands. 33536 33537@table @samp 33538 33539@item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} 33540Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object} 33541(@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the 33542head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine 33543in IPA finally. 33544 33545Replies: 33546@table @samp 33547@item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump} 33548@var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior. 33549The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of 33550@var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long. 33551The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry. 33552The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}. 33553@item E @var{NN} 33554for an error 33555 33556@end table 33557 33558@item close 33559Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver 33560is about to kill inferiors. 33561 33562@item qTfSTM 33563@xref{qTfSTM}. 33564@item qTsSTM 33565@xref{qTsSTM}. 33566@item qTSTMat 33567@xref{qTSTMat}. 33568@item probe_marker_at:@var{address} 33569Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}. 33570 33571Replies: 33572@table @samp 33573@item E @var{NN} 33574for an error 33575@end table 33576@item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address} 33577Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}. 33578@end table 33579 33580@node GDB Bugs 33581@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN} 33582@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN} 33583@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN} 33584 33585Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable. 33586 33587Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it 33588may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help 33589the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug 33590reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}. 33591 33592In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the 33593information that enables us to fix the bug. 33594 33595@menu 33596* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug? 33597* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs 33598@end menu 33599 33600@node Bug Criteria 33601@section Have You Found a Bug? 33602@cindex bug criteria 33603 33604If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines: 33605 33606@itemize @bullet 33607@cindex fatal signal 33608@cindex debugger crash 33609@cindex crash of debugger 33610@item 33611If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a 33612@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash. 33613 33614@cindex error on valid input 33615@item 33616If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a 33617bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be 33618somewhere in the connection to the target.) 33619 33620@cindex invalid input 33621@item 33622If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input, 33623that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of 33624``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support 33625for traditional practice''. 33626 33627@item 33628If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions 33629for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case. 33630@end itemize 33631 33632@node Bug Reporting 33633@section How to Report Bugs 33634@cindex bug reports 33635@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting 33636 33637A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products. 33638If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you 33639contact that organization first. 33640 33641You can find contact information for many support companies and 33642individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs 33643distribution. 33644@c should add a web page ref... 33645 33646@ifset BUGURL 33647@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT 33648In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for 33649@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using 33650@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web 33651page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can 33652be used. 33653 33654@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to 33655@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do 33656not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive 33657@samp{bug-gdb}. 33658 33659The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which 33660serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly 33661the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the 33662newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one 33663problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail 33664path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information, 33665we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send 33666bug reports to the mailing list. 33667@end ifset 33668@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT 33669In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for 33670@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}. 33671@end ifclear 33672@end ifset 33673 33674The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this: 33675@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a 33676fact or leave it out, state it! 33677 33678Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the 33679problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might 33680assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter. 33681Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a 33682stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that 33683name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents 33684of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite 33685the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the 33686easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful. 33687 33688Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the 33689bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither 33690you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and 33691self-contained. 33692 33693Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a 33694bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to 33695@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report 33696bugs properly. 33697 33698To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things: 33699 33700@itemize @bullet 33701@item 33702The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start 33703with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show 33704version}. 33705 33706Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for 33707the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}. 33708 33709@item 33710The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and 33711version number. 33712 33713@item 33714The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration. 33715@value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the 33716@option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type 33717@code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt. 33718 33719@item 33720What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@: 33721``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''. 33722 33723@item 33724What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are 33725debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP 33726C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version} 33727to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for 33728those compilers. 33729 33730@item 33731The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and 33732observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee 33733you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the 33734Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient. 33735 33736If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong 33737and then we might not encounter the bug. 33738 33739@item 33740A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will 33741reproduce the bug. 33742 33743@item 33744A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is 33745incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.'' 33746 33747Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we 33748will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might 33749not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us 33750a chance to make a mistake. 33751 33752Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still 33753say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your 33754copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in 33755the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might 33756crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when 33757ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for 33758us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able 33759to draw any conclusion from our observations. 33760 33761@pindex script 33762@cindex recording a session script 33763To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program 33764such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems. 33765Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then 33766include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report. 33767 33768Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN} 33769inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file. 33770 33771@item 33772If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context 33773diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to 33774it by context, not by line number. 33775 33776The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your 33777sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us. 33778 33779@end itemize 33780 33781Here are some things that are not necessary: 33782 33783@itemize @bullet 33784@item 33785A description of the envelope of the bug. 33786 33787Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating 33788which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which 33789changes will not affect it. 33790 33791This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we 33792will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger 33793with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples. 33794We recommend that you save your time for something else. 33795 33796Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead} 33797of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the 33798output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take 33799less time, and so on. 33800 33801However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this, 33802report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used. 33803 33804@item 33805A patch for the bug. 33806 33807A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit 33808the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that 33809a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide 33810to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all. 33811 33812Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to 33813construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path 33814through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able 33815to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed. 33816 33817And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your 33818patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will 33819help us to understand. 33820 33821@item 33822A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on. 33823 33824Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such 33825things without first using the debugger to find the facts. 33826@end itemize 33827 33828@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code 33829@c and consists of the two following files: 33830@c rluser.texi 33831@c hsuser.texi 33832@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory, 33833@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX. 33834@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 33835@include rluser.texi 33836@include hsuser.texi 33837@end ifclear 33838 33839@node In Memoriam 33840@appendix In Memoriam 33841 33842The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time 33843contributors: 33844 33845@table @code 33846@item Fred Fish 33847Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and 33848to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in 33849the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project. 33850 33851@item Michael Snyder 33852Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project, 33853with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition 33854to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind 33855adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}. 33856@end table 33857 33858Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also 33859enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them. 33860 33861@node Formatting Documentation 33862@appendix Formatting Documentation 33863 33864@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card 33865@cindex reference card 33866The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready 33867for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb} 33868subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In 33869@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN} 33870release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer, 33871you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}. 33872 33873The release also includes the source for the reference card. You 33874can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing: 33875 33876@smallexample 33877make refcard.dvi 33878@end smallexample 33879 33880The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape} 33881mode on US ``letter'' size paper; 33882that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches 33883high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to 33884your @sc{dvi} output program. 33885 33886@cindex documentation 33887 33888All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable 33889distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is 33890a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both 33891on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info 33892formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation 33893and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version. 33894 33895@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info 33896version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info 33897file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to 33898subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If 33899necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor; 33900but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu} 33901Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the 33902@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution. 33903 33904If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the 33905Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or 33906@code{makeinfo}. 33907 33908If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level 33909@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of 33910version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing: 33911 33912@smallexample 33913cd gdb 33914make gdb.info 33915@end smallexample 33916 33917If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{}, 33918a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the 33919Texinfo definitions file. 33920 33921@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but 33922produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset 33923document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system 33924has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise 33925command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another 33926(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may 33927require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension. 33928 33929@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called 33930@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document 33931written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or 33932typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB 33933and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo} 33934directory. 33935 33936If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can 33937typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb} 33938subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to 33939@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type: 33940 33941@smallexample 33942make gdb.dvi 33943@end smallexample 33944 33945Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program. 33946 33947@node Installing GDB 33948@appendix Installing @value{GDBN} 33949@cindex installation 33950 33951@menu 33952* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN} 33953* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script 33954* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory 33955* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets 33956* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure 33957* System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file 33958@end menu 33959 33960@node Requirements 33961@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN} 33962@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for 33963 33964Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available. 33965Other packages will be used only if they are found. 33966 33967@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN} 33968@table @asis 33969@item ISO C90 compiler 33970@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any 33971working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC. 33972 33973@end table 33974 33975@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN} 33976@table @asis 33977@item Expat 33978@anchor{Expat} 33979@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be 33980included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you 33981can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}. 33982The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several 33983standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can 33984use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location. 33985 33986Expat is used for: 33987 33988@itemize @bullet 33989@item 33990Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format}) 33991@item 33992Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) 33993@item 33994Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format}, 33995or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}) 33996@item 33997MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries}) 33998@item 33999Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format}) 34000@item 34001Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format}, 34002@pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}) 34003@end itemize 34004 34005@item zlib 34006@cindex compressed debug sections 34007@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read 34008compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable 34009of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN} 34010is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug 34011information in such binaries. 34012 34013The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system 34014distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from 34015@url{http://zlib.net}. 34016 34017@item iconv 34018@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character 34019Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are 34020on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some 34021other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}. 34022 34023If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed 34024in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it. 34025This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the 34026directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. 34027 34028On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you 34029have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the 34030@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure. 34031 34032@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will 34033arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears 34034in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and 34035if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv} 34036implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used 34037by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU 34038Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the 34039Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}. 34040@end table 34041 34042@node Running Configure 34043@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script 34044@cindex configuring @value{GDBN} 34045@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process 34046of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to 34047build the @code{gdb} program. 34048@iftex 34049@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with. 34050@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN}, 34051look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the 34052installation procedures since publishing this manual.} 34053@end iftex 34054 34055The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for 34056@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by 34057appending the version number to @samp{gdb}. 34058 34059For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the 34060@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains: 34061 34062@table @code 34063@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)} 34064script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries 34065 34066@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb 34067the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself 34068 34069@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd 34070source for the Binary File Descriptor library 34071 34072@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include 34073@sc{gnu} include files 34074 34075@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty 34076source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library 34077 34078@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes 34079source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers 34080 34081@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline 34082source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface 34083 34084@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob 34085source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine 34086 34087@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc 34088source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package 34089@end table 34090 34091The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure} 34092from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in 34093this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. 34094 34095First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory 34096if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the 34097identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an 34098argument. 34099 34100For example: 34101 34102@smallexample 34103cd gdb-@value{GDBVN} 34104./configure @var{host} 34105make 34106@end smallexample 34107 34108@noindent 34109where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or 34110@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run. 34111(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the 34112correct value by examining your system.) 34113 34114Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the 34115@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty} 34116libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the 34117binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories. 34118 34119@need 750 34120@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your 34121system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different 34122shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly: 34123 34124@smallexample 34125sh configure @var{host} 34126@end smallexample 34127 34128If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source 34129directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the 34130@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, 34131@file{configure} 34132creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless 34133you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option). 34134 34135You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the 34136source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run 34137@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only 34138that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular, 34139if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory 34140of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the 34141configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling 34142directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors 34143about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}. 34144 34145You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths. 34146However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by 34147the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember 34148that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to 34149let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable. 34150 34151@node Separate Objdir 34152@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory 34153 34154If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines, 34155you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of 34156host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by 34157allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory, 34158rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program 34159handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running 34160@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb} 34161program specified there. 34162 34163To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure} 34164with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source. 34165(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure} 34166itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure} 34167would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out 34168the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.) 34169 34170For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a 34171separate directory for a Sun 4 like this: 34172 34173@smallexample 34174@group 34175cd gdb-@value{GDBVN} 34176mkdir ../gdb-sun4 34177cd ../gdb-sun4 34178../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4 34179make 34180@end group 34181@end smallexample 34182 34183When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source 34184directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure 34185(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In 34186the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the 34187directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in 34188@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}. 34189 34190Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one 34191instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks 34192like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only 34193one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to 34194build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}. 34195 34196One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate 34197directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where 34198@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging 34199programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}). 34200You specify a cross-debugging target by 34201giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}. 34202 34203When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run 34204it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you 34205called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories). 34206 34207The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source 34208directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source 34209directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured 34210directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you 34211will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB. 34212 34213When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate 34214directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example, 34215if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere 34216with each other. 34217 34218@node Config Names 34219@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets 34220 34221The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure} 34222script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined 34223aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces 34224of information in the following pattern: 34225 34226@smallexample 34227@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os} 34228@end smallexample 34229 34230For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument, 34231or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}} 34232option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}. 34233 34234The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide 34235any query facility to list all supported host and target names or 34236aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script 34237@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the 34238script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on 34239abbreviations---for example: 34240 34241@smallexample 34242% sh config.sub i386-linux 34243i386-pc-linux-gnu 34244% sh config.sub alpha-linux 34245alpha-unknown-linux-gnu 34246% sh config.sub hp9k700 34247hppa1.1-hp-hpux 34248% sh config.sub sun4 34249sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1 34250% sh config.sub sun3 34251m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1 34252% sh config.sub i986v 34253Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized 34254@end smallexample 34255 34256@noindent 34257@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source 34258directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}). 34259 34260@node Configure Options 34261@section @file{configure} Options 34262 34263Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that 34264are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has 34265several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure 34266Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}. 34267 34268@smallexample 34269configure @r{[}--help@r{]} 34270 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]} 34271 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]} 34272 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]} 34273 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]} 34274 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]} 34275 @var{host} 34276@end smallexample 34277 34278@noindent 34279You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than 34280@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use 34281@samp{--}. 34282 34283@table @code 34284@item --help 34285Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}. 34286 34287@item --prefix=@var{dir} 34288Configure the source to install programs and files under directory 34289@file{@var{dir}}. 34290 34291@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir} 34292Configure the source to install programs under directory 34293@file{@var{dir}}. 34294 34295@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation: 34296@need 2000 34297@item --srcdir=@var{dirname} 34298@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another 34299@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@* 34300Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the 34301@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to 34302build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate 34303directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in 34304the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the 34305directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under 34306the working directory in parallel to the source directories below 34307@var{dirname}. 34308 34309@item --norecursion 34310Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not 34311propagate configuration to subdirectories. 34312 34313@item --target=@var{target} 34314Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified 34315@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug 34316programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself. 34317 34318There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets. 34319 34320@item @var{host} @dots{} 34321Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}. 34322 34323There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts. 34324@end table 34325 34326There are many other options available as well, but they are generally 34327needed for special purposes only. 34328 34329@node System-wide configuration 34330@section System-wide configuration and settings 34331@cindex system-wide init file 34332 34333@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file; 34334this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What 34335@value{GDBN} does during startup}). 34336 34337Here is the corresponding configure option: 34338 34339@table @code 34340@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file} 34341Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is 34342@var{file}. 34343@end table 34344 34345If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix}, 34346it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases: 34347 34348@itemize @bullet 34349@item 34350If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix}, 34351it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options 34352are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit}; 34353if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system 34354init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of 34355@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}. 34356 34357@item 34358By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix, 34359it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with 34360@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit}, 34361then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit}, 34362wherever @value{GDBN} is installed. 34363@end itemize 34364 34365If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the 34366@option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the 34367data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure 34368time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the 34369system-wide init file in the directory specified by the 34370@option{--data-directory} command-line option. 34371Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN} 34372initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has 34373started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be 34374reread. 34375 34376@menu 34377* System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts 34378@end menu 34379 34380@node System-wide Configuration Scripts 34381@subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts 34382@cindex system-wide configuration scripts 34383 34384The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory 34385(as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains 34386a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To 34387automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be 34388configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user 34389should be able to source them by hand as needed. 34390 34391The following scripts are currently available: 34392@itemize @bullet 34393 34394@item @file{elinos.py} 34395@pindex elinos.py 34396@cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script 34397This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target. 34398It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard 34399ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system 34400shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} 34401and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately. 34402 34403@item @file{wrs-linux.py} 34404@pindex wrs-linux.py 34405@cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script 34406This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running 34407Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to 34408the host-side sysroot used by the target system. 34409 34410@end itemize 34411 34412@node Maintenance Commands 34413@appendix Maintenance Commands 34414@cindex maintenance commands 34415@cindex internal commands 34416 34417In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN} 34418includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers, 34419that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are 34420provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging 34421messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.) 34422 34423@table @code 34424@kindex maint agent 34425@kindex maint agent-eval 34426@item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression} 34427@itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression} 34428Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes. 34429This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism 34430(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an 34431expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while 34432@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly 34433to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa + 34434globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each 34435of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding 34436the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the 34437addition and return the sum. 34438If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}. 34439If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address. 34440 34441@kindex maint agent-printf 34442@item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},... 34443Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions 34444into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list. 34445This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic 34446printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}). 34447 34448@kindex maint info breakpoints 34449@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints 34450Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the 34451breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for 34452internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative 34453breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint 34454is shown: 34455 34456@table @code 34457@item breakpoint 34458Normal, explicitly set breakpoint. 34459 34460@item watchpoint 34461Normal, explicitly set watchpoint. 34462 34463@item longjmp 34464Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through 34465@code{longjmp} calls. 34466 34467@item longjmp resume 34468Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}. 34469 34470@item until 34471Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command. 34472 34473@item finish 34474Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command. 34475 34476@item shlib events 34477Shared library events. 34478 34479@end table 34480 34481@kindex maint info btrace 34482@item maint info btrace 34483Pint information about raw branch tracing data. 34484 34485@kindex maint btrace packet-history 34486@item maint btrace packet-history 34487Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the 34488execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the 34489information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace 34490recording format. 34491 34492@table @code 34493@item bts 34494For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential 34495code. For each block, the following information is printed: 34496 34497@table @asis 34498@item Block number 34499Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero. 34500@item Lowest @samp{PC} 34501@item Highest @samp{PC} 34502@end table 34503 34504@item pt 34505For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of 34506Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following 34507information is printed: 34508 34509@table @asis 34510@item Packet number 34511Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero. 34512@item Trace offset 34513The packet's offset in the trace stream. 34514@item Packet opcode and payload 34515@end table 34516@end table 34517 34518@kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history 34519@item maint btrace clear-packet-history 34520Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace 34521packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when 34522needed. 34523 34524@kindex maint btrace clear 34525@item maint btrace clear 34526Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the 34527branch trace will be recomputed when needed. 34528 34529This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace 34530buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace 34531available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace 34532buffer. 34533 34534@kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad 34535@item maint set btrace pt skip-pad 34536@kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad 34537@item maint show btrace pt skip-pad 34538Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the 34539packet history. 34540 34541@kindex set displaced-stepping 34542@kindex show displaced-stepping 34543@cindex displaced stepping support 34544@cindex out-of-line single-stepping 34545@item set displaced-stepping 34546@itemx show displaced-stepping 34547Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping} 34548if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step 34549over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing 34550an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the 34551breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping. 34552 34553@table @code 34554@item set displaced-stepping on 34555If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use 34556displaced stepping to step over breakpoints. 34557 34558@item set displaced-stepping off 34559@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints, 34560even if such is supported by the target architecture. 34561 34562@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping} 34563@item set displaced-stepping auto 34564This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping 34565only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target 34566architecture supports displaced stepping. 34567@end table 34568 34569@kindex maint check-psymtabs 34570@item maint check-psymtabs 34571Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs. 34572Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other. 34573 34574@kindex maint check-symtabs 34575@item maint check-symtabs 34576Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs. 34577 34578@kindex maint expand-symtabs 34579@item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}] 34580Expand symbol tables. 34581If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file 34582names matching @var{regexp}. 34583 34584@kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes 34585@kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes 34586@cindex demangler crashes 34587@item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off] 34588@itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes 34589Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the 34590symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes. 34591If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created, 34592the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the 34593option to terminate the current session. 34594 34595@kindex maint cplus first_component 34596@item maint cplus first_component @var{name} 34597Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}. 34598 34599@kindex maint cplus namespace 34600@item maint cplus namespace 34601Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces. 34602 34603@kindex maint deprecate 34604@kindex maint undeprecate 34605@cindex deprecated commands 34606@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]} 34607@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command} 34608Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands 34609cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional 34610argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in 34611favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention 34612the replacement as part of the warning. 34613 34614@kindex maint dump-me 34615@item maint dump-me 34616@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN} 34617Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core. 34618This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program 34619with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal. 34620 34621@kindex maint internal-error 34622@kindex maint internal-warning 34623@kindex maint demangler-warning 34624@cindex demangler crashes 34625@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 34626@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 34627@itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 34628 34629Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}, 34630@code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave 34631as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to 34632reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the 34633opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error} 34634and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current 34635@value{GDBN} session. 34636 34637These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is 34638used as the text of the error or warning message. 34639 34640Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}: 34641 34642@smallexample 34643(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2} 34644@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2 34645A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further 34646debugging may prove unreliable. 34647Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n} 34648Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n} 34649(@value{GDBP}) 34650@end smallexample 34651 34652@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error 34653@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior 34654@cindex demangler crashes 34655 34656@kindex maint set internal-error 34657@kindex maint show internal-error 34658@kindex maint set internal-warning 34659@kindex maint show internal-warning 34660@kindex maint set demangler-warning 34661@kindex maint show demangler-warning 34662@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 34663@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action} 34664@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 34665@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action} 34666@itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 34667@itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action} 34668When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it 34669gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a 34670core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you 34671override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action}, 34672described in the table below. 34673 34674@table @samp 34675@item quit 34676You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no) 34677quit. The default is to ask the user what to do. 34678 34679@item corefile 34680You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no) 34681create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note 34682that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}: 34683demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be 34684disabled. 34685@end table 34686 34687@kindex maint packet 34688@item maint packet @var{text} 34689If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol, 34690then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and 34691displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial 34692@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the 34693checksum. 34694 34695@kindex maint print architecture 34696@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34697Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument 34698@var{file} names the file where the output goes. 34699 34700@kindex maint print c-tdesc 34701@item maint print c-tdesc 34702Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as 34703a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN} 34704when an XML parser is not available to parse the description. 34705 34706@kindex maint print dummy-frames 34707@item maint print dummy-frames 34708Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack. 34709 34710@smallexample 34711(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add} 34712@dots{} 34713(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)} 34714Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{} 3471558 return (a + b); 34716The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB. 34717@dots{} 34718(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames} 347190xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353 34720(@value{GDBP}) 34721@end smallexample 34722 34723Takes an optional file parameter. 34724 34725@kindex maint print registers 34726@kindex maint print raw-registers 34727@kindex maint print cooked-registers 34728@kindex maint print register-groups 34729@kindex maint print remote-registers 34730@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34731@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34732@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34733@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34734@itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34735Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures. 34736 34737The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of 34738the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print 34739cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers, 34740including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible 34741to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the 34742groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint 34743print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers 34744and offsets in the `G' packets. 34745 34746These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to 34747write the information. 34748 34749@kindex maint print reggroups 34750@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34751Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The 34752optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the 34753information. 34754 34755The register groups info looks like this: 34756 34757@smallexample 34758(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups} 34759 Group Type 34760 general user 34761 float user 34762 all user 34763 vector user 34764 system user 34765 save internal 34766 restore internal 34767@end smallexample 34768 34769@kindex flushregs 34770@item flushregs 34771This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache. 34772 34773@kindex maint print objfiles 34774@cindex info for known object files 34775@item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 34776Print a dump of all known object files. 34777If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names 34778match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name, 34779address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs. 34780 34781@kindex maint print user-registers 34782@cindex user registers 34783@item maint print user-registers 34784List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers 34785typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They 34786include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc}, 34787@code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User 34788registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical 34789register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info 34790registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands. 34791 34792@kindex maint print section-scripts 34793@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts 34794@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}] 34795Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section. 34796If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files 34797matching @var{regexp}. 34798For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile, 34799and the full path if known. 34800@xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}. 34801 34802@kindex maint print statistics 34803@cindex bcache statistics 34804@item maint print statistics 34805This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data 34806about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache}) 34807statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number 34808of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types 34809defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables, 34810the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory 34811used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts, 34812sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max, 34813average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and 34814savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain 34815lengths. 34816 34817@kindex maint print target-stack 34818@cindex target stack description 34819@item maint print target-stack 34820A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular 34821kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata}, 34822so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request. 34823In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets 34824until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular 34825address. 34826 34827This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on 34828the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one. 34829 34830@kindex maint print type 34831@cindex type chain of a data type 34832@item maint print type @var{expr} 34833Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument 34834can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of 34835that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is 34836a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s 34837data structures, including its flags and contained types. 34838 34839@kindex maint selftest 34840@cindex self tests 34841Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will 34842print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed. 34843 34844@kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble 34845@kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble 34846@item maint set dwarf always-disassemble 34847@item maint show dwarf always-disassemble 34848Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging 34849information. 34850 34851The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to 34852describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When 34853@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location 34854expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are 34855too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will 34856always see the disassembly form. 34857 34858Here is an example of the resulting disassembly: 34859 34860@smallexample 34861(gdb) info addr argc 34862Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression: 34863 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0 34864@end smallexample 34865 34866For more information on these expressions, see 34867@uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}. 34868 34869@kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age 34870@kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age 34871@item maint set dwarf max-cache-age 34872@itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age 34873Control the DWARF compilation unit cache. 34874 34875@cindex DWARF compilation units cache 34876In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those 34877produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 34878reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units. 34879This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the 34880cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached 34881compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total 34882memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will 34883slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption. 34884 34885@kindex maint set profile 34886@kindex maint show profile 34887@cindex profiling GDB 34888@item maint set profile 34889@itemx maint show profile 34890Control profiling of @value{GDBN}. 34891 34892Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile} 34893command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin 34894collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or 34895exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that 34896if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file 34897(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling 34898data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location. 34899 34900Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be 34901compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option. 34902 34903@kindex maint set show-debug-regs 34904@kindex maint show show-debug-regs 34905@cindex hardware debug registers 34906@item maint set show-debug-regs 34907@itemx maint show show-debug-regs 34908Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug 34909registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If 34910enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or 34911removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior 34912triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint. 34913 34914@kindex maint set show-all-tib 34915@kindex maint show show-all-tib 34916@item maint set show-all-tib 34917@itemx maint show show-all-tib 34918Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting 34919at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block} 34920command. 34921 34922@kindex maint set target-async 34923@kindex maint show target-async 34924@item maint set target-async 34925@itemx maint show target-async 34926This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or 34927asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the 34928default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed 34929to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode. 34930 34931@kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto] 34932@kindex maint show target-non-stop 34933@item maint set target-non-stop 34934@itemx maint show target-non-stop 34935 34936This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop 34937mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop 34938Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled 34939if supported by the target. 34940 34941@table @code 34942@item maint set target-non-stop auto 34943This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in 34944non-stop mode if the target supports it. 34945 34946@item maint set target-non-stop on 34947@value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target 34948does not indicate support. 34949 34950@item maint set target-non-stop off 34951@value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the 34952target supports it. 34953@end table 34954 34955@kindex maint set per-command 34956@kindex maint show per-command 34957@item maint set per-command 34958@itemx maint show per-command 34959@cindex resources used by commands 34960 34961@value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command. 34962This is useful in debugging performance problems. 34963 34964@table @code 34965@item maint set per-command space [on|off] 34966@itemx maint show per-command space 34967Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command. 34968If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command 34969took, following the command's own output. 34970This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the 34971@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}). 34972 34973@item maint set per-command time [on|off] 34974@itemx maint show per-command time 34975Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN} 34976for each command. 34977If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it 34978took to execute each command, following the command's own output. 34979Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed. 34980Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is 34981CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency. 34982Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include 34983the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently 34984to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was 34985spent by the program been debugged. 34986This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the 34987@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}). 34988 34989@item maint set per-command symtab [on|off] 34990@itemx maint show per-command symtab 34991Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics 34992for each command. 34993If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information: 34994 34995@enumerate a 34996@item 34997number of symbol tables 34998@item 34999number of primary symbol tables 35000@item 35001number of blocks in the blockvector 35002@end enumerate 35003@end table 35004 35005@kindex maint space 35006@cindex memory used by commands 35007@item maint space @var{value} 35008An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}. 35009A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it. 35010 35011@kindex maint time 35012@cindex time of command execution 35013@item maint time @var{value} 35014An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}. 35015A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it. 35016 35017@kindex maint translate-address 35018@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr} 35019Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address 35020@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found, 35021@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from 35022the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to 35023the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this 35024command also allows to find symbols in other sections. 35025 35026If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found 35027is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of 35028executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well. 35029 35030@end table 35031 35032The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of 35033@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite. 35034 35035@table @code 35036@item set watchdog @var{nsec} 35037@kindex set watchdog 35038@cindex watchdog timer 35039@cindex timeout for commands 35040Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the 35041target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN} 35042reports and error and the command is aborted. 35043 35044@item show watchdog 35045Show the current setting of the target wait timeout. 35046@end table 35047 35048@node Remote Protocol 35049@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol 35050 35051@menu 35052* Overview:: 35053* Packets:: 35054* Stop Reply Packets:: 35055* General Query Packets:: 35056* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details:: 35057* Tracepoint Packets:: 35058* Host I/O Packets:: 35059* Interrupts:: 35060* Notification Packets:: 35061* Remote Non-Stop:: 35062* Packet Acknowledgment:: 35063* Examples:: 35064* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension:: 35065* Library List Format:: 35066* Library List Format for SVR4 Targets:: 35067* Memory Map Format:: 35068* Thread List Format:: 35069* Traceframe Info Format:: 35070* Branch Trace Format:: 35071* Branch Trace Configuration Format:: 35072@end menu 35073 35074@node Overview 35075@section Overview 35076 35077There may be occasions when you need to know something about the 35078protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target 35079machine, you might want your program to do something special if it 35080recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}. 35081 35082In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate 35083transmitted and received data, respectively. 35084 35085@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial 35086@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote 35087@cindex remote serial protocol 35088All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments 35089and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a 35090@var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character 35091@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character 35092@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}: 35093 35094@smallexample 35095@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 35096@end smallexample 35097@noindent 35098 35099@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote 35100@noindent 35101The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all 35102characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an 35103eight bit unsigned checksum). 35104 35105Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol 35106specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}: 35107 35108@smallexample 35109@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 35110@end smallexample 35111 35112@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote 35113@noindent 35114That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN} 35115has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added 35116since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}. 35117 35118When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first 35119response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate 35120the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request 35121retransmission): 35122 35123@smallexample 35124-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 35125<- @code{+} 35126@end smallexample 35127@noindent 35128 35129The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled 35130once a connection is established. 35131@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details. 35132 35133The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the 35134debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In 35135the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent 35136when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all 35137threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode 35138behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop 35139execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details. 35140 35141@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the 35142exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional 35143exceptions). 35144 35145@cindex remote protocol, field separator 35146Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or 35147@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in 35148@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed. 35149 35150Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character 35151@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it 35152would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}). 35153 35154@cindex remote protocol, binary data 35155@anchor{Binary Data} 35156Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal 35157digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote 35158protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean. 35159Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean 35160connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive 35161binary data. 35162 35163The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}) 35164as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape 35165character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}. 35166For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two 35167bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}), 35168@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii} 35169@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub 35170must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it 35171is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence 35172(described next). 35173 35174Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. 35175Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one 35176instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a 35177repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid 35178binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as 35179@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this 35180produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii} 35181code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length 35182encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example, 35183@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character 35184after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 = 351853}} more times. 35186 35187The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value 35188greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or 35189seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only 35190five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as 35191@samp{0*"00}. 35192 35193The error response returned for some packets includes a two character 35194error number. That number is not well defined. 35195 35196@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets 35197For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response 35198(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the 35199protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based 35200on that response. 35201 35202At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G} 35203commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands 35204for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets 35205can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s} 35206(step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should 35207support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional. 35208 35209@node Packets 35210@section Packets 35211 35212The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined 35213@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}. 35214@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File 35215I/O extension of the remote protocol. 35216 35217Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall 35218syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We 35219include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not 35220part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to 35221separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo 35222@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII 35223bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a 35224@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the 35225@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the 35226@var{baz}. 35227 35228@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol 35229@anchor{thread-id syntax} 35230Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify 35231a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific 35232interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id} 35233can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to 35234pick any thread. 35235 35236In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in 35237which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both 35238process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}. 35239The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the 35240format described above: a positive number with target-specific 35241interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1} 35242to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to 35243indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as 35244@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an 35245error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as 35246@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used 35247for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process 35248ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}. 35249 35250The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both 35251@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess} 35252feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for 35253more information. 35254 35255Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case 35256letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use. 35257 35258Here are the packet descriptions. 35259 35260@table @samp 35261 35262@item ! 35263@cindex @samp{!} packet 35264@anchor{extended mode} 35265Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made 35266persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being 35267debugged. 35268 35269Reply: 35270@table @samp 35271@item OK 35272The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode. 35273@end table 35274 35275@item ? 35276@cindex @samp{?} packet 35277@anchor{? packet} 35278Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for 35279step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the 35280target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}. 35281 35282Reply: 35283@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35284 35285@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{} 35286@cindex @samp{A} packet 35287Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen} 35288specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream 35289@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details. 35290 35291Reply: 35292@table @samp 35293@item OK 35294The arguments were set. 35295@item E @var{NN} 35296An error occurred. 35297@end table 35298 35299@item b @var{baud} 35300@cindex @samp{b} packet 35301(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.) 35302Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. 35303 35304JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's 35305received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are 35306problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.} 35307 35308Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get 35309it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send 35310some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the 35311switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point 35312of view, nothing actually happened.} 35313 35314@item B @var{addr},@var{mode} 35315@cindex @samp{B} packet 35316Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a 35317breakpoint at @var{addr}. 35318 35319Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead 35320(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}). 35321 35322@cindex @samp{bc} packet 35323@anchor{bc} 35324@item bc 35325Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter. 35326@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 35327 35328Reply: 35329@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35330 35331@cindex @samp{bs} packet 35332@anchor{bs} 35333@item bs 35334Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter. 35335@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 35336 35337Reply: 35338@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35339 35340@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]} 35341@cindex @samp{c} packet 35342Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr} 35343is omitted, resume at current address. 35344 35345This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35346packet}. 35347 35348Reply: 35349@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35350 35351@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]} 35352@cindex @samp{C} packet 35353Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If 35354@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address. 35355 35356This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35357packet}. 35358 35359Reply: 35360@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35361 35362@item d 35363@cindex @samp{d} packet 35364Toggle debug flag. 35365 35366Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet 35367(@pxref{General Query Packets}). 35368 35369@item D 35370@itemx D;@var{pid} 35371@cindex @samp{D} packet 35372The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the 35373remote system. It is sent to the remote target 35374before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command. 35375 35376The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess 35377protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to 35378detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a 35379big-endian hex string. 35380 35381Reply: 35382@table @samp 35383@item OK 35384for success 35385@item E @var{NN} 35386for an error 35387@end table 35388 35389@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX} 35390@cindex @samp{F} packet 35391A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target. 35392This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O 35393Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification. 35394 35395@item g 35396@anchor{read registers packet} 35397@cindex @samp{g} packet 35398Read general registers. 35399 35400Reply: 35401@table @samp 35402@item @var{XX@dots{}} 35403Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes 35404with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of 35405each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are 35406determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions 35407@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. 35408 35409When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected 35410Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of 35411literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate 35412that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value 35413is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of 354144 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that 35415registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3 35416have been collected, and both have zero value: 35417 35418@smallexample 35419-> @code{g} 35420<- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000} 35421@end smallexample 35422 35423@item E @var{NN} 35424for an error. 35425@end table 35426 35427@item G @var{XX@dots{}} 35428@cindex @samp{G} packet 35429Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a 35430description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data. 35431 35432Reply: 35433@table @samp 35434@item OK 35435for success 35436@item E @var{NN} 35437for an error 35438@end table 35439 35440@item H @var{op} @var{thread-id} 35441@cindex @samp{H} packet 35442Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g}, 35443@samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op} 35444should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this 35445is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better 35446option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator 35447@var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in 35448@ref{thread-id syntax}. 35449 35450Reply: 35451@table @samp 35452@item OK 35453for success 35454@item E @var{NN} 35455for an error 35456@end table 35457 35458@c FIXME: JTC: 35459@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a 35460@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed 35461@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the 35462@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be 35463@c described. For example: 35464@c 35465@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is 35466@c selected, returns the register block from that thread; 35467@c otherwise returns current registers. 35468@c 35469@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is 35470@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of 35471@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers. 35472 35473@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]} 35474@anchor{cycle step packet} 35475@cindex @samp{i} packet 35476Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is 35477present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle 35478step starting at that address. 35479 35480@item I 35481@cindex @samp{I} packet 35482Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle 35483step packet}. 35484 35485@item k 35486@cindex @samp{k} packet 35487Kill request. 35488 35489The exact effect of this packet is not specified. 35490 35491For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target 35492system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply. 35493 35494For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible. 35495 35496A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all 35497that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use 35498the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}). 35499 35500If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to 35501@samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet 35502acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful. 35503 35504If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does 35505not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN} 35506probes the target state as if a new connection was opened 35507(@pxref{? packet}). 35508 35509@item m @var{addr},@var{length} 35510@cindex @samp{m} packet 35511Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr} 35512(@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to 35513any particular boundary. 35514 35515The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering 35516data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned 35517and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to 35518use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be 35519suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices. 35520@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses 35521@cindex size of remote memory accesses 35522@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses 35523 35524Reply: 35525@table @samp 35526@item @var{XX@dots{}} 35527Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number. 35528The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the 35529server was able to read only part of the region of memory. 35530@item E @var{NN} 35531@var{NN} is errno 35532@end table 35533 35534@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}} 35535@cindex @samp{M} packet 35536Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr} 35537(@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each 35538byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number. 35539 35540Reply: 35541@table @samp 35542@item OK 35543for success 35544@item E @var{NN} 35545for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was 35546written). 35547@end table 35548 35549@item p @var{n} 35550@cindex @samp{p} packet 35551Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex. 35552@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned 35553register value is encoded. 35554 35555Reply: 35556@table @samp 35557@item @var{XX@dots{}} 35558the register's value 35559@item E @var{NN} 35560for an error 35561@item @w{} 35562Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}. 35563@end table 35564 35565@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}} 35566@anchor{write register packet} 35567@cindex @samp{P} packet 35568Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register 35569number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex 35570digits for each byte in the register (target byte order). 35571 35572Reply: 35573@table @samp 35574@item OK 35575for success 35576@item E @var{NN} 35577for an error 35578@end table 35579 35580@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{} 35581@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{} 35582@cindex @samp{q} packet 35583@cindex @samp{Q} packet 35584General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are 35585described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}. 35586 35587@item r 35588@cindex @samp{r} packet 35589Reset the entire system. 35590 35591Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead. 35592 35593@item R @var{XX} 35594@cindex @samp{R} packet 35595Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored. 35596This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 35597 35598The @samp{R} packet has no reply. 35599 35600@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]} 35601@cindex @samp{s} packet 35602Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If 35603@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address. 35604 35605This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35606packet}. 35607 35608Reply: 35609@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35610 35611@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]} 35612@anchor{step with signal packet} 35613@cindex @samp{S} packet 35614Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but 35615requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution. 35616 35617This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35618packet}. 35619 35620Reply: 35621@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35622 35623@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM} 35624@cindex @samp{t} packet 35625Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern 35626@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long. 35627There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}. 35628 35629@item T @var{thread-id} 35630@cindex @samp{T} packet 35631Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}. 35632 35633Reply: 35634@table @samp 35635@item OK 35636thread is still alive 35637@item E @var{NN} 35638thread is dead 35639@end table 35640 35641@item v 35642Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name, 35643up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet). 35644 35645@item vAttach;@var{pid} 35646@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet 35647Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}. 35648The process ID is a 35649hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all 35650threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be 35651attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target. 35652 35653@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the 35654@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After 35655@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC. 35656@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the 35657@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you 35658@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not 35659@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either 35660@c stopping or restarting threads. 35661 35662This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 35663 35664Reply: 35665@table @samp 35666@item E @var{nn} 35667for an error 35668@item @r{Any stop packet} 35669for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 35670@item OK 35671for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) 35672@end table 35673 35674@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{} 35675@cindex @samp{vCont} packet 35676@anchor{vCont packet} 35677Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread. 35678 35679For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching 35680@var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action 35681remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the 35682syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess 35683extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions 35684can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the 35685@samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no 35686@var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an 35687error. 35688 35689Currently supported actions are: 35690 35691@table @samp 35692@item c 35693Continue. 35694@item C @var{sig} 35695Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits. 35696@item s 35697Step. 35698@item S @var{sig} 35699Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits. 35700@item t 35701Stop. 35702@item r @var{start},@var{end} 35703Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at 35704addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive). 35705The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out 35706of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting 35707a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}. 35708 35709If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action 35710becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words, 35711single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction 35712jumps to @var{start}). 35713 35714(A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within 35715the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet 35716in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.) 35717 35718@end table 35719 35720The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the 35721@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is 35722not supported in @samp{vCont}. 35723 35724The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode 35725(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise. 35726A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped. 35727When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action, 35728the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with 35729signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal 35730as an implementation detail. 35731 35732The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and 35733@samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely, 35734the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already 35735stopped. 35736 35737@emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until 35738@value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with 35739the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}). 35740 35741The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for 35742multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). 35743 35744Reply: 35745@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35746 35747@item vCont? 35748@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet 35749Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet. 35750 35751Reply: 35752@table @samp 35753@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]} 35754The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported 35755command in the @samp{vCont} packet. 35756@item @w{} 35757The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported. 35758@end table 35759 35760@anchor{vCtrlC packet} 35761@item vCtrlC 35762@cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet 35763Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote 35764terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C} 35765(@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode 35766while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode. 35767@xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop 35768variant. 35769 35770Reply: 35771@table @samp 35772@item E @var{nn} 35773for an error 35774@item OK 35775for success 35776@end table 35777 35778@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{} 35779@cindex @samp{vFile} packet 35780Perform a file operation on the target system. For details, 35781see @ref{Host I/O Packets}. 35782 35783@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length} 35784@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet 35785Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at 35786@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but 35787its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the 35788flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map 35789Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations 35790together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the 35791stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone} 35792packet is received. 35793 35794Reply: 35795@table @samp 35796@item OK 35797for success 35798@item E @var{NN} 35799for an error 35800@end table 35801 35802@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}} 35803@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet 35804Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data 35805is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X} 35806packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by 35807@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must 35808not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses 35809(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already 35810have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between 35811@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was 35812neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other 35813target-specific method, the results are unpredictable. 35814 35815 35816Reply: 35817@table @samp 35818@item OK 35819for success 35820@item E.memtype 35821for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory 35822@item E @var{NN} 35823for an error 35824@end table 35825 35826@item vFlashDone 35827@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet 35828Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished. 35829The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of 35830@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a 35831@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected 35832regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone} 35833request is completed. 35834 35835@item vKill;@var{pid} 35836@cindex @samp{vKill} packet 35837@anchor{vKill packet} 35838Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a 35839hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in 35840preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are 35841supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}. 35842 35843Reply: 35844@table @samp 35845@item E @var{nn} 35846for an error 35847@item OK 35848for success 35849@end table 35850 35851@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{} 35852@cindex @samp{vRun} packet 35853Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its 35854command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If 35855@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program 35856(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped 35857state. 35858 35859@c FIXME: What about non-stop mode? 35860 35861This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 35862 35863Reply: 35864@table @samp 35865@item E @var{nn} 35866for an error 35867@item @r{Any stop packet} 35868for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 35869@end table 35870 35871@item vStopped 35872@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet 35873@xref{Notification Packets}. 35874 35875@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}} 35876@anchor{X packet} 35877@cindex @samp{X} packet 35878Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary. 35879Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory 35880units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit}); 35881@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}). 35882 35883Reply: 35884@table @samp 35885@item OK 35886for success 35887@item E @var{NN} 35888for an error 35889@end table 35890 35891@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind} 35892@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind} 35893@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet} 35894@cindex @samp{z} packet 35895@cindex @samp{Z} packets 35896Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or 35897watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}. 35898 35899Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented 35900separately. 35901 35902@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string 35903for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A 35904remote target shall support either both or neither of a given 35905@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To 35906avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should 35907be implemented in an idempotent way.} 35908 35909@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35910@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]} 35911@cindex @samp{z0} packet 35912@cindex @samp{Z0} packet 35913Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address 35914@var{addr} of type @var{kind}. 35915 35916A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at 35917@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The 35918@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the 35919breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and 35920@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some 35921architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind} 35922(@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no 35923architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}. 35924@var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of 35925conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on 35926the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into 35927consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be 35928reported back to @value{GDBN}. 35929 35930See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}) 35931for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}. 35932 35933The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions, 35934concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form: 35935 35936@table @samp 35937 35938@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 35939@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the 35940actual conditional expression in bytecode form. 35941 35942@end table 35943 35944The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be 35945run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}. 35946The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is 35947nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands 35948continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. 35949Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no 35950separators. Each expression has the following form: 35951 35952@table @samp 35953 35954@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 35955@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the 35956actual conditional expression in bytecode form. 35957 35958@end table 35959 35960@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move 35961code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing 35962overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a 35963target, is not defined.} 35964 35965Reply: 35966@table @samp 35967@item OK 35968success 35969@item @w{} 35970not supported 35971@item E @var{NN} 35972for an error 35973@end table 35974 35975@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35976@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]} 35977@cindex @samp{z1} packet 35978@cindex @samp{Z1} packet 35979Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at 35980address @var{addr}. 35981 35982A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not 35983dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The 35984@var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the 35985same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets. 35986 35987@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code 35988movement.} 35989 35990Reply: 35991@table @samp 35992@item OK 35993success 35994@item @w{} 35995not supported 35996@item E @var{NN} 35997for an error 35998@end table 35999 36000@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind} 36001@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind} 36002@cindex @samp{z2} packet 36003@cindex @samp{Z2} packet 36004Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}. 36005The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}. 36006 36007Reply: 36008@table @samp 36009@item OK 36010success 36011@item @w{} 36012not supported 36013@item E @var{NN} 36014for an error 36015@end table 36016 36017@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind} 36018@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind} 36019@cindex @samp{z3} packet 36020@cindex @samp{Z3} packet 36021Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}. 36022The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}. 36023 36024Reply: 36025@table @samp 36026@item OK 36027success 36028@item @w{} 36029not supported 36030@item E @var{NN} 36031for an error 36032@end table 36033 36034@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind} 36035@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind} 36036@cindex @samp{z4} packet 36037@cindex @samp{Z4} packet 36038Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}. 36039The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}. 36040 36041Reply: 36042@table @samp 36043@item OK 36044success 36045@item @w{} 36046not supported 36047@item E @var{NN} 36048for an error 36049@end table 36050 36051@end table 36052 36053@node Stop Reply Packets 36054@section Stop Reply Packets 36055@cindex stop reply packets 36056 36057The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont}, 36058@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can 36059receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?} 36060and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned 36061when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal 36062number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the 36063@value{GDBN} source code. 36064 36065In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands 36066such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future 36067notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}. 36068 36069As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the 36070reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's 36071syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its 36072components. 36073 36074@table @samp 36075 36076@item S @var{AA} 36077The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal 36078number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no 36079@var{n}:@var{r} pairs. 36080 36081@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{} 36082@cindex @samp{T} packet reply 36083The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal 36084number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the 36085@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers 36086and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing 36087round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported 36088this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows: 36089 36090@itemize @bullet 36091@item 36092If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the 36093corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a 36094series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a 36095two-digit hex number. 36096 36097@item 36098If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of 36099the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}. 36100 36101@item 36102If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of 36103the core on which the stop event was detected. 36104 36105@item 36106If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more 36107specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop 36108reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap 36109signal. At most one stop reason should be present. 36110 36111@item 36112Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair 36113and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the 36114future. 36115@end itemize 36116 36117The currently defined stop reasons are: 36118 36119@table @samp 36120@item watch 36121@itemx rwatch 36122@itemx awatch 36123The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in 36124hex. 36125 36126@item syscall_entry 36127@itemx syscall_return 36128The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the 36129syscall number, in hex. 36130 36131@cindex shared library events, remote reply 36132@item library 36133The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed. 36134@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new 36135list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored. 36136 36137@cindex replay log events, remote reply 36138@item replaylog 36139The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying 36140logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the 36141beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r} 36142will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution}, 36143for more information. 36144 36145@item swbreak 36146@anchor{swbreak stop reason} 36147The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed, 36148irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the 36149breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r} 36150part must be left empty. 36151 36152On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a 36153breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the 36154breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is 36155responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint 36156address. 36157 36158This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36159did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36160appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36161remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36162indicating support. 36163 36164This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation. 36165 36166@item hwbreak 36167The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint. 36168The @var{r} part must be left empty. 36169 36170The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above 36171apply. 36172 36173@cindex fork events, remote reply 36174@item fork 36175The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r} 36176is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to 36177@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id} 36178field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support 36179fork events. 36180 36181This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36182did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36183appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36184remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36185indicating support. 36186 36187@cindex vfork events, remote reply 36188@item vfork 36189The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r} 36190is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to 36191@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id} 36192field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support 36193vfork events. 36194 36195This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36196did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36197appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36198remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36199indicating support. 36200 36201@cindex vforkdone events, remote reply 36202@item vforkdone 36203The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork 36204has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the 36205address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer 36206shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only 36207applicable to targets that support vforkdone events. 36208 36209This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36210did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36211appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36212remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36213indicating support. 36214 36215@cindex exec events, remote reply 36216@item exec 36217The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r} 36218is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex. 36219This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events. 36220 36221This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36222did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36223appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36224remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36225indicating support. 36226 36227@cindex thread create event, remote reply 36228@anchor{thread create event} 36229@item create 36230The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread 36231is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet 36232(@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default; 36233@value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See 36234also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The 36235@var{r} part is ignored. 36236 36237@end table 36238 36239@item W @var{AA} 36240@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid} 36241The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only 36242applicable to certain targets. 36243 36244The second form of the response, including the process ID of the 36245exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported 36246support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess 36247extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian 36248hex strings. 36249 36250@item X @var{AA} 36251@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid} 36252The process terminated with signal @var{AA}. 36253 36254The second form of the response, including the process ID of the 36255terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported 36256support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess 36257extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian 36258hex strings. 36259 36260@anchor{thread exit event} 36261@cindex thread exit event, remote reply 36262@item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid} 36263 36264The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response 36265should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the 36266@ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above. 36267@var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string. 36268 36269@item N 36270There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even 36271though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For 36272example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread 362732. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which 36274subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still 36275alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually 36276executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client 36277that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be 36278sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it. 36279@value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate 36280@samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must 36281also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating 36282support. 36283 36284@item O @var{XX}@dots{} 36285@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be 36286written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time 36287while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait 36288for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode. 36289 36290@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{} 36291@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should 36292be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the 36293correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}. 36294@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented 36295system calls. 36296 36297@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for 36298this very system call. 36299 36300The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to 36301call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies 36302with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next 36303reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} 36304or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote 36305Protocol Extension}, for more details. 36306 36307@end table 36308 36309@node General Query Packets 36310@section General Query Packets 36311@cindex remote query requests 36312 36313Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets}; 36314packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General 36315query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and 36316sending information to and from the stub. 36317 36318The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name 36319indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example, 36320@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol 36321definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some 36322conventions: 36323 36324@itemize @bullet 36325@item 36326The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons. 36327@item 36328Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case 36329letter. 36330@item 36331The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in 36332lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at 36333the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying 36334foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars). 36335@end itemize 36336 36337The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any 36338parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be 36339separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the 36340full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet, 36341in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin 36342with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL} 36343packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator 36344for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that 36345are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some 36346existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the 36347packet.}. 36348 36349Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here 36350has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an 36351explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the 36352templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No 36353@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components. 36354 36355Here are the currently defined query and set packets: 36356 36357@table @samp 36358 36359@item QAgent:1 36360@itemx QAgent:0 36361Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations 36362delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}). 36363 36364@item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{} 36365@cindex @samp{QAllow} packet 36366Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the 36367target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value 36368pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg}, 36369@samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace}, 36370@samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0, 36371indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1, 36372indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its 36373own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to 36374insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.) 36375 36376@item qC 36377@cindex current thread, remote request 36378@cindex @samp{qC} packet 36379Return the current thread ID. 36380 36381Reply: 36382@table @samp 36383@item QC @var{thread-id} 36384Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in 36385@ref{thread-id syntax}. 36386@item @r{(anything else)} 36387Any other reply implies the old thread ID. 36388@end table 36389 36390@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length} 36391@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request 36392@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet 36393@anchor{qCRC packet} 36394Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in 36395IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most 36396significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code 36397@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC. 36398 36399@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug 36400files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate 36401Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating 36402separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least} 36403significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to 36404detect trailing zeros. 36405 36406Reply: 36407@table @samp 36408@item E @var{NN} 36409An error (such as memory fault) 36410@item C @var{crc32} 36411The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}. 36412@end table 36413 36414@item QDisableRandomization:@var{value} 36415@cindex disable address space randomization, remote request 36416@cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet 36417Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space 36418of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature 36419to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic 36420debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value} 36421of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for 36422processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet 36423with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space 36424randomization. 36425 36426This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 36427 36428Reply: 36429@table @samp 36430@item OK 36431The request succeeded. 36432 36433@item E @var{nn} 36434An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36435 36436@item @w{} 36437An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported 36438by the stub. 36439@end table 36440 36441This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36442by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36443This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling 36444address space randomization. 36445 36446@item qfThreadInfo 36447@itemx qsThreadInfo 36448@cindex list active threads, remote request 36449@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet 36450@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet 36451Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there 36452may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query 36453works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to 36454obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will 36455be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the 36456sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query. 36457 36458NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below). 36459 36460Reply: 36461@table @samp 36462@item m @var{thread-id} 36463A single thread ID 36464@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{} 36465a comma-separated list of thread IDs 36466@item l 36467(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list. 36468@end table 36469 36470In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or 36471more thread IDs, separated by commas. 36472@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread 36473ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds 36474with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}). 36475Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id} 36476fields. 36477 36478@emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the 36479initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID 36480mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent 36481message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in 36482the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.} 36483 36484@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm} 36485@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request 36486@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet 36487Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified 36488by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}. 36489 36490@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the 36491thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}. 36492 36493@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the 36494thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug 36495information associated with the variable.) 36496 36497@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the 36498load module associated with the thread local storage. For example, 36499a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared 36500object associated with the thread local storage under consideration. 36501Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module 36502differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary. 36503 36504Reply: 36505@table @samp 36506@item @var{XX}@dots{} 36507Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread 36508local storage requested. 36509 36510@item E @var{nn} 36511An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36512 36513@item @w{} 36514An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub. 36515@end table 36516 36517@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id} 36518@cindex get thread information block address 36519@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet 36520Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block. 36521 36522@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread. 36523 36524Reply: 36525@table @samp 36526@item @var{XX}@dots{} 36527Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the 36528thread information block. 36529 36530@item E @var{nn} 36531An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the 36532address could not be retrieved. 36533 36534@item @w{} 36535An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub. 36536@end table 36537 36538@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread} 36539Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex 36540digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a 36541subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum 36542number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread} 36543(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is 36544returned in the response as @var{argthread}. 36545 36546Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above). 36547 36548Reply: 36549@table @samp 36550@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{} 36551Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being 36552returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads 36553and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex 36554digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{} 36555is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex 36556digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}. 36557@end table 36558 36559@item qOffsets 36560@cindex section offsets, remote request 36561@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet 36562Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded 36563image. 36564 36565Reply: 36566@table @samp 36567@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]} 36568Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address. 36569Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address. 36570If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf} 36571@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire 36572segments by the supplied offsets. 36573 36574@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response, 36575@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset 36576to the @code{Bss} section.} 36577 36578@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]} 36579Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally 36580contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If 36581@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which 36582conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of 36583@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file 36584does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least 36585as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are 36586kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment. 36587@end table 36588 36589@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id} 36590@cindex thread information, remote request 36591@cindex @samp{qP} packet 36592Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex 36593encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID 36594(@pxref{thread-id syntax}). 36595 36596Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead 36597(see below). 36598 36599Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}. 36600 36601@item QNonStop:1 36602@itemx QNonStop:0 36603@cindex non-stop mode, remote request 36604@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet 36605@anchor{QNonStop} 36606Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode. 36607@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information. 36608 36609Reply: 36610@table @samp 36611@item OK 36612The request succeeded. 36613 36614@item E @var{nn} 36615An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36616 36617@item @w{} 36618An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by 36619the stub. 36620@end table 36621 36622This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36623by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36624Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command; 36625@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}. 36626 36627@item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{} 36628@itemx QCatchSyscalls:0 36629@cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request 36630@cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet 36631@anchor{QCatchSyscalls} 36632Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0}) 36633catching syscalls from the inferior process. 36634 36635For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded 36636in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno} 36637is listed, every system call should be reported. 36638 36639Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will 36640still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding 36641@code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only 36642report the requested syscalls. 36643 36644Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier 36645@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list. 36646 36647If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is 36648kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall 36649numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the 36650client should send a new packet with the new syscall list. 36651 36652Reply: 36653@table @samp 36654@item OK 36655The request succeeded. 36656 36657@item E @var{nn} 36658An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits. 36659 36660@item @w{} 36661An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by 36662the stub. 36663@end table 36664 36665Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls} 36666command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}). 36667This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36668by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36669 36670@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{} 36671@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request 36672@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet 36673@anchor{QPassSignals} 36674Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process. 36675Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies 36676(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be 36677strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop 36678the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be 36679reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not 36680combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the 36681new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle 36682@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}. 36683 36684Reply: 36685@table @samp 36686@item OK 36687The request succeeded. 36688 36689@item E @var{nn} 36690An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36691 36692@item @w{} 36693An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by 36694the stub. 36695@end table 36696 36697Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals} 36698command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}). 36699This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36700by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36701 36702@item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{} 36703@cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request 36704@cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet 36705@anchor{QProgramSignals} 36706Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process. 36707Others should be silently discarded. 36708 36709In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a 36710signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One 36711example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have 36712stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to 36713@value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified 36714by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending 36715signals. 36716 36717This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a 36718resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}). 36719 36720Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies 36721(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be 36722strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple 36723@samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier 36724@samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list. 36725 36726Reply: 36727@table @samp 36728@item OK 36729The request succeeded. 36730 36731@item E @var{nn} 36732An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36733 36734@item @w{} 36735An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported 36736by the stub. 36737@end table 36738 36739Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals} 36740command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}). 36741This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36742by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36743 36744@anchor{QThreadEvents} 36745@item QThreadEvents:1 36746@itemx QThreadEvents:0 36747@cindex thread create/exit events, remote request 36748@cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet 36749 36750Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0}) 36751reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create 36752event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in 36753non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and 36754synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without 36755exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang 36756forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that 36757same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the 36758stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in 36759its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36760 36761Reply: 36762@table @samp 36763@item OK 36764The request succeeded. 36765 36766@item E @var{nn} 36767An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36768 36769@item @w{} 36770An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by 36771the stub. 36772@end table 36773 36774Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events} 36775command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}). 36776 36777@item qRcmd,@var{command} 36778@cindex execute remote command, remote request 36779@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet 36780@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for 36781execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output 36782string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond 36783with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output 36784packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a 36785stubs's interpreter may have security implications}. 36786 36787Reply: 36788@table @samp 36789@item OK 36790A command response with no output. 36791@item @var{OUTPUT} 36792A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}. 36793@item E @var{NN} 36794Indicate a badly formed request. 36795@item @w{} 36796An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized. 36797@end table 36798 36799(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the 36800command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming 36801conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new 36802packets.) 36803 36804@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern} 36805@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging 36806@ifnotinfo 36807@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet 36808@end ifnotinfo 36809@cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet 36810@anchor{qSearch memory} 36811Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}. 36812Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex; 36813@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded. 36814 36815Reply: 36816@table @samp 36817@item 0 36818The pattern was not found. 36819@item 1,address 36820The pattern was found at @var{address}. 36821@item E @var{NN} 36822A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory. 36823@item @w{} 36824An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized. 36825@end table 36826 36827@item QStartNoAckMode 36828@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet 36829@anchor{QStartNoAckMode} 36830Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-} 36831protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}). 36832 36833Reply: 36834@table @samp 36835@item OK 36836The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode. 36837@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse, 36838but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further 36839@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection. 36840@item @w{} 36841An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode. 36842@end table 36843 36844@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]} 36845@cindex supported packets, remote query 36846@cindex features of the remote protocol 36847@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet 36848@anchor{qSupported} 36849Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and 36850query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows 36851@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others' 36852features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes 36853at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger 36854packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on 36855high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not 36856be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or 36857stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be 36858automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be 36859reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default 36860unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it 36861helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new 36862versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets. 36863 36864Reply: 36865@table @samp 36866@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{} 36867The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature}, 36868depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the 36869possible forms). 36870@item @w{} 36871An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized, 36872or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}. 36873@end table 36874 36875The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the 36876@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response) 36877are: 36878 36879@table @samp 36880@item @var{name}=@var{value} 36881The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated 36882with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends 36883on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon. 36884@item @var{name}+ 36885The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not 36886need an associated value. 36887@item @var{name}- 36888The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported. 36889@item @var{name}? 36890The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and 36891@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is 36892needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications, 36893but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses. 36894@end table 36895 36896Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the 36897supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous 36898request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known 36899state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with 36900a different version of @value{GDBN}. 36901 36902The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN}) 36903are defined: 36904 36905@table @samp 36906@item multiprocess 36907This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess 36908extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36909extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36910including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36911@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details. 36912 36913@item xmlRegisters 36914This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target 36915description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target 36916specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register 36917description. 36918 36919@item qRelocInsn 36920This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the 36921@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate 36922instruction reply packet}). 36923 36924@item swbreak 36925This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop 36926reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details. 36927 36928@item hwbreak 36929This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop 36930reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details. 36931 36932@item fork-events 36933This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event 36934extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36935extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36936including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36937 36938@item vfork-events 36939This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event 36940extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36941extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36942including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36943 36944@item exec-events 36945This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event 36946extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36947extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36948including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36949 36950@item vContSupported 36951This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the 36952supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet. 36953@end table 36954 36955Stubs should ignore any unknown values for 36956@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported} 36957packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier 36958versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values 36959for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take 36960advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible 36961improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is 36962an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent 36963of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN} 36964describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with 36965all the features it supports. 36966 36967Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature 36968responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms. 36969 36970Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature 36971should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features 36972require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=} 36973form response. 36974 36975Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if 36976@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned 36977in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a 36978stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults. 36979 36980Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing 36981mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal 36982architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information 36983about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in 36984stubs which may be configured for multiple targets. 36985 36986These are the currently defined stub features and their properties: 36987 36988@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2 36989@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require 36990@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem. 36991@item Feature Name 36992@tab Value Required 36993@tab Default 36994@tab Probe Allowed 36995 36996@item @samp{PacketSize} 36997@tab Yes 36998@tab @samp{-} 36999@tab No 37000 37001@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} 37002@tab No 37003@tab @samp{-} 37004@tab Yes 37005 37006@item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read} 37007@tab No 37008@tab @samp{-} 37009@tab Yes 37010 37011@item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read} 37012@tab No 37013@tab @samp{-} 37014@tab Yes 37015 37016@item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} 37017@tab No 37018@tab @samp{-} 37019@tab Yes 37020 37021@item @samp{qXfer:features:read} 37022@tab No 37023@tab @samp{-} 37024@tab Yes 37025 37026@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} 37027@tab No 37028@tab @samp{-} 37029@tab Yes 37030 37031@item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} 37032@tab No 37033@tab @samp{-} 37034@tab Yes 37035 37036@item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read} 37037@tab No 37038@tab @samp{-} 37039@tab No 37040 37041@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} 37042@tab No 37043@tab @samp{-} 37044@tab Yes 37045 37046@item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} 37047@tab No 37048@tab @samp{-} 37049@tab Yes 37050 37051@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read} 37052@tab No 37053@tab @samp{-} 37054@tab Yes 37055 37056@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write} 37057@tab No 37058@tab @samp{-} 37059@tab Yes 37060 37061@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} 37062@tab No 37063@tab @samp{-} 37064@tab Yes 37065 37066@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} 37067@tab No 37068@tab @samp{-} 37069@tab Yes 37070 37071@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read} 37072@tab No 37073@tab @samp{-} 37074@tab Yes 37075 37076@item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 37077@tab No 37078@tab @samp{-} 37079@tab Yes 37080 37081@item @samp{qXfer:uib:read} 37082@tab No 37083@tab @samp{-} 37084@tab Yes 37085 37086@item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read} 37087@tab No 37088@tab @samp{-} 37089@tab Yes 37090 37091@item @samp{Qbtrace:off} 37092@tab Yes 37093@tab @samp{-} 37094@tab Yes 37095 37096@item @samp{Qbtrace:bts} 37097@tab Yes 37098@tab @samp{-} 37099@tab Yes 37100 37101@item @samp{Qbtrace:pt} 37102@tab Yes 37103@tab @samp{-} 37104@tab Yes 37105 37106@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} 37107@tab Yes 37108@tab @samp{-} 37109@tab Yes 37110 37111@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} 37112@tab Yes 37113@tab @samp{-} 37114@tab Yes 37115 37116@item @samp{QNonStop} 37117@tab No 37118@tab @samp{-} 37119@tab Yes 37120 37121@item @samp{QCatchSyscalls} 37122@tab No 37123@tab @samp{-} 37124@tab Yes 37125 37126@item @samp{QPassSignals} 37127@tab No 37128@tab @samp{-} 37129@tab Yes 37130 37131@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode} 37132@tab No 37133@tab @samp{-} 37134@tab Yes 37135 37136@item @samp{multiprocess} 37137@tab No 37138@tab @samp{-} 37139@tab No 37140 37141@item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints} 37142@tab No 37143@tab @samp{-} 37144@tab No 37145 37146@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints} 37147@tab No 37148@tab @samp{-} 37149@tab No 37150 37151@item @samp{ReverseContinue} 37152@tab No 37153@tab @samp{-} 37154@tab No 37155 37156@item @samp{ReverseStep} 37157@tab No 37158@tab @samp{-} 37159@tab No 37160 37161@item @samp{TracepointSource} 37162@tab No 37163@tab @samp{-} 37164@tab No 37165 37166@item @samp{QAgent} 37167@tab No 37168@tab @samp{-} 37169@tab No 37170 37171@item @samp{QAllow} 37172@tab No 37173@tab @samp{-} 37174@tab No 37175 37176@item @samp{QDisableRandomization} 37177@tab No 37178@tab @samp{-} 37179@tab No 37180 37181@item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints} 37182@tab No 37183@tab @samp{-} 37184@tab No 37185 37186@item @samp{QTBuffer:size} 37187@tab No 37188@tab @samp{-} 37189@tab No 37190 37191@item @samp{tracenz} 37192@tab No 37193@tab @samp{-} 37194@tab No 37195 37196@item @samp{BreakpointCommands} 37197@tab No 37198@tab @samp{-} 37199@tab No 37200 37201@item @samp{swbreak} 37202@tab No 37203@tab @samp{-} 37204@tab No 37205 37206@item @samp{hwbreak} 37207@tab No 37208@tab @samp{-} 37209@tab No 37210 37211@item @samp{fork-events} 37212@tab No 37213@tab @samp{-} 37214@tab No 37215 37216@item @samp{vfork-events} 37217@tab No 37218@tab @samp{-} 37219@tab No 37220 37221@item @samp{exec-events} 37222@tab No 37223@tab @samp{-} 37224@tab No 37225 37226@item @samp{QThreadEvents} 37227@tab No 37228@tab @samp{-} 37229@tab No 37230 37231@item @samp{no-resumed} 37232@tab No 37233@tab @samp{-} 37234@tab No 37235 37236@end multitable 37237 37238These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail: 37239 37240@table @samp 37241@cindex packet size, remote protocol 37242@item PacketSize=@var{bytes} 37243The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in 37244length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk 37245transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the 37246data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum. 37247There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub 37248stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra 37249byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported, 37250@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response. 37251 37252@item qXfer:auxv:read 37253The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet 37254(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}). 37255 37256@item qXfer:btrace:read 37257The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read} 37258packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}). 37259 37260@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read 37261The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read} 37262packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}). 37263 37264@item qXfer:exec-file:read 37265The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet 37266(@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}). 37267 37268@item qXfer:features:read 37269The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet 37270(@pxref{qXfer target description read}). 37271 37272@item qXfer:libraries:read 37273The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet 37274(@pxref{qXfer library list read}). 37275 37276@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read 37277The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet 37278(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}). 37279 37280@item augmented-libraries-svr4-read 37281The remote stub understands the augmented form of the 37282@samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet 37283(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}). 37284 37285@item qXfer:memory-map:read 37286The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet 37287(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}). 37288 37289@item qXfer:sdata:read 37290The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet 37291(@pxref{qXfer sdata read}). 37292 37293@item qXfer:spu:read 37294The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet 37295(@pxref{qXfer spu read}). 37296 37297@item qXfer:spu:write 37298The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet 37299(@pxref{qXfer spu write}). 37300 37301@item qXfer:siginfo:read 37302The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet 37303(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}). 37304 37305@item qXfer:siginfo:write 37306The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet 37307(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}). 37308 37309@item qXfer:threads:read 37310The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet 37311(@pxref{qXfer threads read}). 37312 37313@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read 37314The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 37315packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}). 37316 37317@item qXfer:uib:read 37318The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read} 37319packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}). 37320 37321@item qXfer:fdpic:read 37322The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read} 37323packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}). 37324 37325@item QNonStop 37326The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet 37327(@pxref{QNonStop}). 37328 37329@item QCatchSyscalls 37330The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet 37331(@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}). 37332 37333@item QPassSignals 37334The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet 37335(@pxref{QPassSignals}). 37336 37337@item QStartNoAckMode 37338The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and 37339prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}. 37340 37341@item multiprocess 37342@anchor{multiprocess extensions} 37343@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol 37344The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote 37345protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of 37346thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and 37347add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X} 37348replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the 37349syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports 37350debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use 37351multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also 37352indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request. 37353 37354@item qXfer:osdata:read 37355The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet 37356((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}). 37357 37358@item ConditionalBreakpoints 37359The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions 37360defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers 37361when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 37362 37363@item ConditionalTracepoints 37364The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined 37365for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}). 37366 37367@item ReverseContinue 37368The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet 37369(@pxref{bc}). 37370 37371@item ReverseStep 37372The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet 37373(@pxref{bs}). 37374 37375@item TracepointSource 37376The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies 37377the source form of tracepoint definitions. 37378 37379@item QAgent 37380The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet. 37381 37382@item QAllow 37383The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet. 37384 37385@item QDisableRandomization 37386The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet. 37387 37388@item StaticTracepoint 37389@cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol 37390The remote stub supports static tracepoints. 37391 37392@item InstallInTrace 37393@anchor{install tracepoint in tracing} 37394The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing. 37395 37396@item EnableDisableTracepoints 37397The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and 37398@samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints 37399to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running. 37400 37401@item QTBuffer:size 37402The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size}) 37403packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer. 37404 37405@item tracenz 37406@cindex string tracing, in remote protocol 37407The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings. 37408See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode. 37409 37410@item BreakpointCommands 37411@cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol 37412The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself, 37413rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}. 37414 37415@item Qbtrace:off 37416The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet. 37417 37418@item Qbtrace:bts 37419The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet. 37420 37421@item Qbtrace:pt 37422The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet. 37423 37424@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size 37425The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet. 37426 37427@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size 37428The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet. 37429 37430@item swbreak 37431The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory 37432breakpoints. 37433 37434@item hwbreak 37435The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware 37436breakpoints. 37437 37438@item fork-events 37439The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events. 37440 37441@item vfork-events 37442The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events 37443and vforkdone events. 37444 37445@item exec-events 37446The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events. 37447 37448@item vContSupported 37449The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to 37450@samp{vCont?} packet. 37451 37452@item QThreadEvents 37453The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet. 37454 37455@item no-resumed 37456The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply. 37457 37458@end table 37459 37460@item qSymbol:: 37461@cindex symbol lookup, remote request 37462@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet 37463Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup 37464requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols. 37465 37466Reply: 37467@table @samp 37468@item OK 37469The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols. 37470@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name} 37471The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded). 37472@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the 37473@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described 37474below. 37475@end table 37476 37477@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} 37478Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}. 37479 37480@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the 37481target has previously requested. 37482 37483@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If 37484@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field 37485will be empty. 37486 37487Reply: 37488@table @samp 37489@item OK 37490The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols. 37491@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name} 37492The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex 37493encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols 37494(if available), until the target ceases to request them. 37495@end table 37496 37497@item qTBuffer 37498@itemx QTBuffer 37499@itemx QTDisconnected 37500@itemx QTDP 37501@itemx QTDPsrc 37502@itemx QTDV 37503@itemx qTfP 37504@itemx qTfV 37505@itemx QTFrame 37506@itemx qTMinFTPILen 37507 37508@xref{Tracepoint Packets}. 37509 37510@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id} 37511@cindex thread attributes info, remote request 37512@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet 37513Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread 37514attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax}, 37515for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This 37516string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting 37517for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is 37518displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some 37519examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or 37520@samp{Blocked on Mutex}. 37521 37522Reply: 37523@table @samp 37524@item @var{XX}@dots{} 37525Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, 37526comprising the printable string containing the extra information about 37527the thread's attributes. 37528@end table 37529 37530(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from 37531the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming 37532conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new 37533packets.) 37534 37535@item QTNotes 37536@itemx qTP 37537@itemx QTSave 37538@itemx qTsP 37539@itemx qTsV 37540@itemx QTStart 37541@itemx QTStop 37542@itemx QTEnable 37543@itemx QTDisable 37544@itemx QTinit 37545@itemx QTro 37546@itemx qTStatus 37547@itemx qTV 37548@itemx qTfSTM 37549@itemx qTsSTM 37550@itemx qTSTMat 37551@xref{Tracepoint Packets}. 37552 37553@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37554@cindex read special object, remote request 37555@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet 37556@anchor{qXfer read} 37557Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area 37558identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes 37559starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and 37560encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply 37561additional details about what data to access. 37562 37563Reply: 37564@table @samp 37565@item m @var{data} 37566Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the 37567target. There may be more data at a higher address (although 37568it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid 37569block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read). 37570It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the 37571request. 37572 37573@item l @var{data} 37574Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target. 37575There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to 37576have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request. 37577 37578@item l 37579The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data. 37580There is no more data to be read. 37581 37582@item E00 37583The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid. 37584 37585@item E @var{nn} 37586The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data. 37587The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value. 37588 37589@item @w{} 37590An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by 37591the stub, or that the object does not support reading. 37592@end table 37593 37594Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the 37595@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply 37596formats, listed above. 37597 37598@table @samp 37599@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37600@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read} 37601Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information, 37602auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty. 37603 37604This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37605by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37606 37607@item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37608@anchor{qXfer btrace read} 37609 37610Return a description of the current branch trace. 37611@xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} 37612packet may have one of the following values: 37613 37614@table @code 37615@item all 37616Returns all available branch trace. 37617 37618@item new 37619Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since 37620the last read request. 37621 37622@item delta 37623Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new 37624block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source 37625location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is 37626used to stitch traces together. 37627 37628If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow. 37629@end table 37630 37631This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it 37632by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37633 37634@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37635@anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read} 37636 37637Return a description of the current branch trace configuration. 37638@xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}. 37639 37640This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it 37641by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37642 37643@item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37644@anchor{qXfer executable filename read} 37645Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create 37646a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the 37647numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal 37648number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the 37649filename corresponding to the currently executing process. 37650 37651This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37652by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37653 37654@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37655@anchor{qXfer target description read} 37656Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The 37657annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is 37658always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex. 37659 37660This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37661by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37662 37663@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37664@anchor{qXfer library list read} 37665Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}. 37666The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 37667(@pxref{qXfer read}). 37668 37669Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do 37670not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where 37671the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries. 37672 37673This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37674by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37675 37676@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37677@anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read} 37678Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4 37679platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part 37680of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote 37681stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet 37682by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37683(@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}). 37684 37685This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets. 37686@value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise. 37687 37688This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37689by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37690 37691If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this 37692packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may 37693contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}} 37694arguments. The currently supported arguments are: 37695 37696@table @code 37697@item start=@var{address} 37698A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct 37699link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero 37700then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be 37701chosen as the starting point. 37702 37703@item prev=@var{address} 37704A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct 37705link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map} 37706specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then 37707the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map} 37708exists prior to the starting point. 37709 37710@end table 37711 37712Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently 37713ignored. 37714 37715@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37716@anchor{qXfer memory map read} 37717Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The 37718annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 37719(@pxref{qXfer read}). 37720 37721This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37722by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37723 37724@item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37725@anchor{qXfer sdata read} 37726 37727Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker 37728information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must 37729be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint 37730Action Lists}. 37731 37732This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37733by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37734(@pxref{qSupported}). 37735 37736@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37737@anchor{qXfer siginfo read} 37738Read contents of the extra signal information on the target 37739system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be 37740empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). 37741 37742This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37743by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37744(@pxref{qSupported}). 37745 37746@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37747@anchor{qXfer spu read} 37748Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The 37749annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form 37750@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID 37751in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file 37752in that context to be accessed. 37753 37754This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37755by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37756(@pxref{qSupported}). 37757 37758@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37759@anchor{qXfer threads read} 37760Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The 37761annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 37762(@pxref{qXfer read}). 37763 37764This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37765by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37766 37767@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37768@anchor{qXfer traceframe info read} 37769 37770Return a description of the current traceframe's contents. 37771@xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic 37772@samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). 37773 37774This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37775by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37776 37777@item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37778@anchor{qXfer unwind info block} 37779 37780Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used 37781on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information. 37782 37783This packet is not probed by default. 37784 37785@item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37786@anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read} 37787Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The 37788annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap}, 37789executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read. 37790 37791This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37792by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37793 37794@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37795@anchor{qXfer osdata read} 37796Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}. 37797@xref{Operating System Information}. 37798 37799@end table 37800 37801@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 37802@cindex write data into object, remote request 37803@anchor{qXfer write} 37804Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area 37805identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes 37806into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be 37807written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex} 37808is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data 37809to access. 37810 37811Reply: 37812@table @samp 37813@item @var{nn} 37814@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written. 37815This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request. 37816 37817@item E00 37818The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid. 37819 37820@item E @var{nn} 37821The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data. 37822The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value. 37823 37824@item @w{} 37825An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not 37826recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing. 37827@end table 37828 37829Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the 37830@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply 37831formats, listed above. 37832 37833@table @samp 37834@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 37835@anchor{qXfer siginfo write} 37836Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system. 37837The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be 37838empty (@pxref{qXfer write}). 37839 37840This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37841by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37842(@pxref{qSupported}). 37843 37844@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 37845@anchor{qXfer spu write} 37846Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The 37847annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form 37848@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID 37849in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file 37850in that context to be accessed. 37851 37852This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37853by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37854@end table 37855 37856@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{} 37857Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does 37858not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for 37859@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub 37860must respond with an empty packet. 37861 37862@item qAttached:@var{pid} 37863@cindex query attached, remote request 37864@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet 37865Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an 37866existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess 37867protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), 37868@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target 37869process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and 37870the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}. 37871 37872This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process 37873should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with 37874the @code{quit} command. 37875 37876Reply: 37877@table @samp 37878@item 1 37879The remote server attached to an existing process. 37880@item 0 37881The remote server created a new process. 37882@item E @var{NN} 37883A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37884@end table 37885 37886@item Qbtrace:bts 37887Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store. 37888 37889Reply: 37890@table @samp 37891@item OK 37892Branch tracing has been enabled. 37893@item E.errtext 37894A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37895@end table 37896 37897@item Qbtrace:pt 37898Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace. 37899 37900Reply: 37901@table @samp 37902@item OK 37903Branch tracing has been enabled. 37904@item E.errtext 37905A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37906@end table 37907 37908@item Qbtrace:off 37909Disable branch tracing for the current thread. 37910 37911Reply: 37912@table @samp 37913@item OK 37914Branch tracing has been disabled. 37915@item E.errtext 37916A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37917@end table 37918 37919@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value} 37920Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the 37921btrace recording method in bts format. 37922 37923Reply: 37924@table @samp 37925@item OK 37926The ring buffer size has been set. 37927@item E.errtext 37928A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37929@end table 37930 37931@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value} 37932Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the 37933btrace recording method in pt format. 37934 37935Reply: 37936@table @samp 37937@item OK 37938The ring buffer size has been set. 37939@item E.errtext 37940A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37941@end table 37942 37943@end table 37944 37945@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details 37946@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details 37947 37948This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific 37949target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for 37950details of XML target descriptions for each architecture. 37951 37952@menu 37953* ARM-Specific Protocol Details:: 37954* MIPS-Specific Protocol Details:: 37955@end menu 37956 37957@node ARM-Specific Protocol Details 37958@subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details 37959 37960@menu 37961* ARM Breakpoint Kinds:: 37962@end menu 37963 37964@node ARM Breakpoint Kinds 37965@subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds 37966@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM} 37967 37968These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets. 37969 37970@table @r 37971 37972@item 2 3797316-bit Thumb mode breakpoint. 37974 37975@item 3 3797632-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint. 37977 37978@item 4 3797932-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint. 37980 37981@end table 37982 37983@node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details 37984@subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details 37985 37986@menu 37987* MIPS Register packet Format:: 37988* MIPS Breakpoint Kinds:: 37989@end menu 37990 37991@node MIPS Register packet Format 37992@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format 37993@cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS} 37994 37995The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined. 37996In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as 37997sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) 37998to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target 37999byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred 38000most-significant -- least-significant. 38001 38002@table @r 38003 38004@item MIPS32 38005All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order: 3800632 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point 38007registers; fsr; fir; fp. 38008 38009@item MIPS64 38010All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including 38011thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same 38012as @code{MIPS32}. 38013 38014@end table 38015 38016@node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds 38017@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds 38018@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS} 38019 38020These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets. 38021 38022@table @r 38023 38024@item 2 3802516-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint. 38026 38027@item 3 3802816-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint. 38029 38030@item 4 3803132-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint. 38032 38033@item 5 3803432-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint. 38035 38036@end table 38037 38038@node Tracepoint Packets 38039@section Tracepoint Packets 38040@cindex tracepoint packets 38041@cindex packets, tracepoint 38042 38043Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement 38044tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}). 38045 38046@table @samp 38047 38048@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]} 38049@cindex @samp{QTDP} packet 38050Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena} 38051is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then 38052the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step 38053count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present, 38054then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is 38055the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room 38056for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a 38057tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed 38058by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action 38059encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present, 38060further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's 38061actions. 38062 38063Replies: 38064@table @samp 38065@item OK 38066The packet was understood and carried out. 38067@item qRelocInsn 38068@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}. 38069@item @w{} 38070The packet was not recognized. 38071@end table 38072 38073@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]} 38074Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and 38075@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for 38076this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after 38077another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the 38078trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow, 38079specifying more actions for this tracepoint. 38080 38081In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one 38082can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet 38083is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping'' 38084actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those 38085taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an 38086@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary 38087tracepoint actions. 38088 38089The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of 38090actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the 38091following forms: 38092 38093@table @samp 38094 38095@item R @var{mask} 38096Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}, 38097a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number 38098@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered 38099zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may 38100not fit in a 32-bit word. 38101 38102@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len} 38103Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register 38104number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is 38105@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the 38106address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg}, 38107@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal 38108values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case). 38109 38110@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 38111Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as 38112it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in 38113@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a 38114two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes 38115in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the 38116packet). 38117 38118@end table 38119 38120Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP} 38121packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet 38122length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R} 38123action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X} 38124actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions 38125must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The 38126``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a 38127separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.) 38128 38129Replies: 38130@table @samp 38131@item OK 38132The packet was understood and carried out. 38133@item qRelocInsn 38134@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}. 38135@item @w{} 38136The packet was not recognized. 38137@end table 38138 38139@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes} 38140@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet 38141Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}. 38142This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints 38143originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type} 38144is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the 38145tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while 38146@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal. 38147 38148@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source 38149string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string. 38150This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will 38151fit in a single packet. 38152@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated 38153@c tracepoint descriptions section. 38154 38155The available string types are @samp{at} for the location, 38156@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command. 38157@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action 38158list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list. 38159 38160The target does not need to do anything with source strings except 38161report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP} 38162query packets. 38163 38164Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it 38165if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General 38166Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files 38167much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the 38168tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to 38169the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy 38170could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not 38171be found. 38172 38173@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name} 38174@cindex define trace state variable, remote request 38175@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet 38176Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial 38177value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n} 38178and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has 38179the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the 38180target should simply create the trace state variables as they are 38181mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one) 38182if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin. 38183@value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or 38184@samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the 38185hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state 38186variable. 38187 38188@item QTFrame:@var{n} 38189@cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet 38190Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the 38191register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent 38192request packets from @value{GDBN}. 38193 38194A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the 38195requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated 38196without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has 38197one of the following forms: 38198 38199@table @samp 38200@item F @var{f} 38201The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer; 38202@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there 38203was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet. 38204 38205@item T @var{t} 38206The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t}; 38207@var{t} is a hexadecimal number. 38208 38209@end table 38210 38211@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr} 38212Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 38213currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr}; 38214@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number. 38215 38216@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t} 38217Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 38218currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t} 38219is a hexadecimal number. 38220 38221@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end} 38222Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 38223currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive) 38224and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal 38225numbers. 38226 38227@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end} 38228Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first 38229frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive). 38230 38231@item qTMinFTPILen 38232@cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet 38233This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast 38234tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on 38235the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but 38236it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in 38237the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that 38238system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to 38239arrange for that. 38240 38241Replies: 38242 38243@table @samp 38244@item 0 38245The minimum instruction length is currently unknown. 38246@item @var{length} 38247The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} 38248is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply 38249of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction 38250regardless of size. 38251@item E 38252An error has occurred. 38253@item @w{} 38254An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub. 38255@end table 38256 38257@item QTStart 38258@cindex @samp{QTStart} packet 38259Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from 38260tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the 38261@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate 38262instruction reply packet}). 38263 38264@item QTStop 38265@cindex @samp{QTStop} packet 38266End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames. 38267 38268@item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr} 38269@anchor{QTEnable} 38270@cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet 38271Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint 38272experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection 38273of data from it will resume. 38274 38275@item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr} 38276@anchor{QTDisable} 38277@cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet 38278Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint 38279experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless 38280@samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued. 38281 38282@item QTinit 38283@cindex @samp{QTinit} packet 38284Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer. 38285 38286@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{} 38287@cindex @samp{QTro} packet 38288Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub 38289will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents, 38290if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit. 38291 38292@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those 38293containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should 38294still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so 38295there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents. 38296 38297@item QTDisconnected:@var{value} 38298@cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet 38299Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN} 38300disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to 38301continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if 38302@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture. 38303 38304@item qTStatus 38305@cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet 38306Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now. 38307 38308The reply has the form: 38309 38310@table @samp 38311 38312@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{} 38313@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently 38314running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated 38315optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status. 38316 38317@end table 38318 38319If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several 38320explanations as one of the optional fields: 38321 38322@table @samp 38323 38324@item tnotrun:0 38325No trace has been run yet. 38326 38327@item tstop[:@var{text}]:0 38328The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional 38329@var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the 38330stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was 38331stopped manually). It is hex-encoded. 38332 38333@item tfull:0 38334The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up. 38335 38336@item tdisconnected:0 38337The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target. 38338 38339@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum} 38340The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count. 38341 38342@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum} 38343The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The 38344string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error 38345(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it 38346is hex encoded. 38347 38348@item tunknown:0 38349The trace stopped for some other reason. 38350 38351@end table 38352 38353Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information. 38354Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring 38355the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these 38356numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped 38357trace. 38358 38359@table @samp 38360 38361@item tframes:@var{n} 38362The number of trace frames in the buffer. 38363 38364@item tcreated:@var{n} 38365The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may 38366be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular. 38367 38368@item tsize:@var{n} 38369The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes. 38370 38371@item tfree:@var{n} 38372The number of bytes still unused in the buffer. 38373 38374@item circular:@var{n} 38375The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the 38376trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if 38377necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear 38378and may fill up. 38379 38380@item disconn:@var{n} 38381The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that 38382tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means 38383that the trace run will stop. 38384 38385@end table 38386 38387@item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr} 38388@cindex tracepoint status, remote request 38389@cindex @samp{qTP} packet 38390Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at 38391address @var{addr}. 38392 38393Replies: 38394@table @samp 38395@item V@var{hits}:@var{usage} 38396The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace 38397run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that 38398@code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the 38399steps' space consumption is added into the usage number. 38400 38401@end table 38402 38403@item qTV:@var{var} 38404@cindex trace state variable value, remote request 38405@cindex @samp{qTV} packet 38406Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}. 38407 38408Replies: 38409@table @samp 38410@item V@var{value} 38411The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current 38412value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a 38413saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the 38414user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in 38415different reply values, such as when requesting values while the 38416program is running. 38417 38418@item U 38419The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example, 38420if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable 38421was not collected. 38422@end table 38423 38424@item qTfP 38425@cindex @samp{qTfP} packet 38426@itemx qTsP 38427@cindex @samp{qTsP} packet 38428These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by 38429the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece 38430of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies 38431to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets 38432that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax) 38433 38434@item qTfV 38435@cindex @samp{qTfV} packet 38436@itemx qTsV 38437@cindex @samp{qTsV} packet 38438These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the 38439target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data, 38440and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to 38441these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define 38442trace state variables. 38443 38444@item qTfSTM 38445@itemx qTsSTM 38446@anchor{qTfSTM} 38447@anchor{qTsSTM} 38448@cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet 38449@cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet 38450These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist 38451in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the 38452first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional 38453pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form: 38454 38455Reply: 38456@table @samp 38457@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra} 38458A single marker 38459@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{} 38460a comma-separated list of markers 38461@item l 38462(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list. 38463@item E @var{nn} 38464An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 38465@item @w{} 38466An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the 38467stub. 38468@end table 38469 38470The @var{address} is encoded in hex; 38471@var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex. 38472 38473In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or 38474more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each 38475reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the 38476query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for 38477@dfn{last}). 38478 38479@item qTSTMat:@var{address} 38480@anchor{qTSTMat} 38481@cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet 38482This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the 38483target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the 38484syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static 38485tracepoint markers. 38486 38487@item QTSave:@var{filename} 38488@cindex @samp{QTSave} packet 38489This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name 38490@var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded 38491as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs 38492absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target. 38493 38494@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len} 38495@cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet 38496Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer, 38497starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were 38498a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format. 38499The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver 38500in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for. 38501A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are 38502available. 38503 38504@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value} 38505This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if 38506@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0. 38507 38508@item QTBuffer:size:@var{size} 38509@anchor{QTBuffer-size} 38510@cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet 38511This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size 38512@var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to 38513use whatever size it prefers. 38514 38515@item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{} 38516@cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet 38517This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable 38518types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the 38519@var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded. 38520 38521@end table 38522 38523@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet 38524When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to 38525relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a 38526different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is 38527enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the 38528return address on the stack, and relative branches or other 38529PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect 38530of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if 38531it had executed in the original location. 38532 38533In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also 38534respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request 38535packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle 38536this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its 38537documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above 38538descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The 38539format of the request is: 38540 38541@table @samp 38542@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to} 38543 38544This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from} 38545to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the 38546instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at 38547@var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target 38548memory starting at @var{to}. 38549@end table 38550 38551Replies: 38552@table @samp 38553@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size} 38554Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is 38555the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence. 38556@item E @var{NN} 38557A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while 38558relocating the instruction. 38559@end table 38560 38561@node Host I/O Packets 38562@section Host I/O Packets 38563@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol 38564@cindex file transfer, remote protocol 38565 38566The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O 38567operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is 38568used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own 38569filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure 38570layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the 38571Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated 38572protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers. 38573Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the 38574target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol 38575Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol. 38576 38577The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with 38578its arguments. They have this format: 38579 38580@table @samp 38581 38582@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{} 38583@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target 38584should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking 38585for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on 38586the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative 38587numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not 38588used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of 38589hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a 38590buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}). 38591 38592@end table 38593 38594The valid responses to Host I/O packets are: 38595 38596@table @samp 38597 38598@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}] 38599@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually 38600non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured, 38601@var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a 38602value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For 38603operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a 38604binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the 38605normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet 38606documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and 38607@var{attachment}. 38608 38609@item @w{} 38610An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized. 38611 38612@end table 38613 38614These are the supported Host I/O operations: 38615 38616@table @samp 38617@item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode} 38618Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or 38619return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string, 38620@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags 38621(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask 38622of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}). 38623@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values. 38624 38625@item vFile:close: @var{fd} 38626Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or 38627-1 if an error occurs. 38628 38629@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset} 38630Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to 38631@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset} 38632relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes; 38633common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file 38634condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be 38635returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if 38636@var{count} was zero. 38637 38638The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success. 38639If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary 38640attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the 38641number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if 38642some characters were escaped. 38643 38644@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data} 38645Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding 38646to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the 38647file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no 38648separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the 38649packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written, 38650which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an 38651error occurred. 38652 38653@item vFile:fstat: @var{fd} 38654Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. 38655On success the information is returned as a binary attachment 38656and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes. 38657If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the 38658returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}. 38659 38660@item vFile:unlink: @var{filename} 38661Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0, 38662or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string. 38663 38664@item vFile:readlink: @var{filename} 38665Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return 38666the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs. 38667 38668The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success. 38669If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary 38670attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the 38671number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if 38672some characters were escaped. 38673 38674@item vFile:setfs: @var{pid} 38675Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with 38676@var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for 38677@value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where 38678the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the 38679inferior(s). 38680 38681If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process 38682@var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by 38683the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs. 38684If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem 38685remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:} 38686operation. 38687 38688@end table 38689 38690@node Interrupts 38691@section Interrupts 38692@cindex interrupts (remote protocol) 38693@anchor{interrupting remote targets} 38694 38695In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running, 38696@value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, 38697@code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which 38698is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}. 38699 38700The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport 38701mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not 38702currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network 38703interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the 38704@code{telnet} BREAK sequence. 38705 38706@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all 38707transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte 38708@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in 38709the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is 38710transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data 38711and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet 38712(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped 38713@code{0x03} as part of its packet. 38714 38715@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g. 38716When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port, 38717it stops execution and connects to gdb. 38718 38719In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous 38720(@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote 38721command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that 38722reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC 38723packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte 38724@code{0x03}. 38725 38726Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the 38727precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is 38728implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple 38729threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all 38730currently-executing threads and processes. 38731If the stub is successful at interrupting the 38732running program, it should send one of the stop 38733reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result 38734of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply 38735for each stopped thread in non-stop mode. 38736Interrupts received while the 38737program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when 38738it is resumed next time. 38739 38740@node Notification Packets 38741@section Notification Packets 38742@cindex notification packets 38743@cindex packets, notification 38744 38745The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications}, 38746packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub 38747may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at 38748present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information 38749without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so 38750are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss 38751is not a problem. 38752 38753A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} # 38754@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification, 38755and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted 38756as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data} 38757never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon 38758receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-} 38759to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption. 38760 38761Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no 38762colon characters, followed by a colon character. 38763 38764Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and 38765notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart 38766timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or 38767not they understand it. 38768 38769Senders should only send the notifications described here when this 38770protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the 38771future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in 38772new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer 38773recipients. 38774 38775(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see 38776the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may 38777transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There 38778are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we 38779assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.) 38780 38781Each notification is comprised of three parts: 38782@table @samp 38783@item @var{name}:@var{event} 38784The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the 38785exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event} 38786carrying the specific information about the notification, and 38787@var{name} specifying the name of the notification. 38788@item @var{ack} 38789The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to 38790acknowledge the exchange and request the event. 38791@end table 38792 38793The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to 38794@value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub. 38795 38796The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event} 38797at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when 38798appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN} 38799acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if 38800additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the 38801previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later 38802synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from 38803@value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable, 38804the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes 38805@value{GDBN} may not have received it. 38806 38807Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not 38808otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is 38809expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a 38810@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent. 38811Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from 38812the stub so there is no ambiguity. 38813 38814After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by 38815sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the 38816stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as 38817@value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the 38818stub first, which the stub should process normally. 38819 38820Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued 38821events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a 38822normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack} 38823packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send 38824other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process 38825normally. 38826 38827If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional 38828@var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response. 38829At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification 38830and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN} 38831won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is 38832received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send 38833a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and 38834the process shall be repeated. 38835 38836The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the 38837following example: 38838@smallexample 38839<- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;} 38840@code{...} 38841-> @code{vStopped} 38842<- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;} 38843-> @code{vStopped} 38844<- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;} 38845-> @code{vStopped} 38846<- @code{OK} 38847@end smallexample 38848 38849The following notifications are defined: 38850@multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38 38851 38852@item Notification 38853@tab Ack 38854@tab Event 38855@tab Description 38856 38857@item Stop 38858@tab vStopped 38859@tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as 38860described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, 38861for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by 38862@value{GDBN}. 38863@tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode. 38864 38865@end multitable 38866 38867@node Remote Non-Stop 38868@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode 38869 38870@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of 38871multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub 38872supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including 38873@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 38874 38875@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when 38876establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode 38877does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets 38878must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering 38879all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to 38880probe the target state after a mode change. 38881 38882In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that 38883would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the 38884asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to 38885inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads 38886in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop 38887mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is, 38888when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion 38889of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the 38890affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue 38891to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running 38892threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run. 38893 38894In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as 38895follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped} 38896sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new 38897sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not 38898it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first 38899stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and 38900subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets 38901using the mechanism described above. The target must not send 38902asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete. 38903If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet, 38904or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond 38905@samp{OK}. 38906 38907If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the 38908@samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and 38909the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported 38910(@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous 38911nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint 38912and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the 38913breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to 38914this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was 38915caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as 38916opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user. 38917Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible 38918for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if 38919necessary, such as on the x86 architecture. 38920 38921@node Packet Acknowledgment 38922@section Packet Acknowledgment 38923 38924@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote 38925@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote 38926By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet, 38927the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate 38928the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission). 38929This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over 38930unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line. 38931 38932In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or 38933TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant. 38934It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication 38935overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the 38936@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}. 38937 38938When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or 38939expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet 38940and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in 38941@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver. 38942 38943If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in 38944no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} 38945by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported}; 38946@pxref{qSupported}. 38947If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been 38948disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command 38949(@pxref{Remote Configuration}), 38950@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub. 38951Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments. 38952@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK} 38953response, which can be safely ignored by the stub. 38954 38955Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation 38956between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made; 38957it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current 38958connection. 38959Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a 38960new connection is established, 38961there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments 38962for the current connection, once disabled. 38963 38964@node Examples 38965@section Examples 38966 38967Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart 38968does not get any direct output: 38969 38970@smallexample 38971-> @code{R00} 38972<- @code{+} 38973@emph{target restarts} 38974-> @code{?} 38975<- @code{+} 38976<- @code{T001:1234123412341234} 38977-> @code{+} 38978@end smallexample 38979 38980Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction: 38981 38982@smallexample 38983-> @code{G1445@dots{}} 38984<- @code{+} 38985-> @code{s} 38986<- @code{+} 38987@emph{time passes} 38988<- @code{T001:1234123412341234} 38989-> @code{+} 38990-> @code{g} 38991<- @code{+} 38992<- @code{1455@dots{}} 38993-> @code{+} 38994@end smallexample 38995 38996@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension 38997@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension 38998@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension 38999 39000@menu 39001* File-I/O Overview:: 39002* Protocol Basics:: 39003* The F Request Packet:: 39004* The F Reply Packet:: 39005* The Ctrl-C Message:: 39006* Console I/O:: 39007* List of Supported Calls:: 39008* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes:: 39009* Constants:: 39010* File-I/O Examples:: 39011@end menu 39012 39013@node File-I/O Overview 39014@subsection File-I/O Overview 39015@cindex file-i/o overview 39016 39017The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the 39018target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various 39019system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a 39020remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed 39021actions and returns a response packet to the target system. 39022This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems. 39023 39024The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems. 39025It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both 39026@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for 39027translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal 39028protocol representations when data is transmitted. 39029 39030The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when 39031@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} 39032or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call, 39033the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's 39034memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On 39035the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt 39036(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}. 39037 39038The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish 39039the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means, 39040after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the 39041previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step 39042request from @value{GDBN} is required. 39043 39044@smallexample 39045(@value{GDBP}) continue 39046 <- target requests 'system call X' 39047 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call 39048 -> @value{GDBN} returns result 39049 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target 39050 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet 39051@end smallexample 39052 39053The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on 39054the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes, 39055named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host 39056system are not supported by this protocol. 39057 39058File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode. 39059 39060@node Protocol Basics 39061@subsection Protocol Basics 39062@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o 39063 39064The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well 39065as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when 39066@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target, 39067the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result 39068of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet. 39069This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN} 39070to call the appropriate host system call: 39071 39072@itemize @bullet 39073@item 39074A unique identifier for the requested system call. 39075 39076@item 39077All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses 39078in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as 39079pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are. 39080Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation. 39081 39082@end itemize 39083 39084At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions. 39085 39086@itemize @bullet 39087@item 39088If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a 39089system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a 39090standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be 39091expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m} 39092packet. 39093 39094@item 39095@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host 39096representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types. 39097 39098@item 39099@value{GDBN} calls the system call. 39100 39101@item 39102It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation. 39103 39104@item 39105If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified 39106by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the 39107target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected 39108by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X} 39109packet. 39110 39111@end itemize 39112 39113Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all 39114necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains 39115 39116@itemize @bullet 39117@item 39118Return value. 39119 39120@item 39121@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call. 39122 39123@item 39124``Ctrl-C'' flag. 39125 39126@end itemize 39127 39128After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues 39129the latest continue or step action. 39130 39131@node The F Request Packet 39132@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet 39133@cindex file-i/o request packet 39134@cindex @code{F} request packet 39135 39136The @code{F} request packet has the following format: 39137 39138@table @samp 39139@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}} 39140 39141@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called. 39142This is just the name of the function. 39143 39144@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call. 39145Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case 39146of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound 39147datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case 39148of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a 39149comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII 39150string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash. 39151 39152@end table 39153 39154 39155 39156@node The F Reply Packet 39157@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet 39158@cindex file-i/o reply packet 39159@cindex @code{F} reply packet 39160 39161The @code{F} reply packet has the following format: 39162 39163@table @samp 39164 39165@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment} 39166 39167@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value. 39168 39169@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific 39170representation. 39171This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful. 39172 39173@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this 39174case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful. 39175The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}: 39176 39177@smallexample 39178F0,0,C 39179@end smallexample 39180 39181@noindent 39182or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed: 39183 39184@smallexample 39185F-1,4,C 39186@end smallexample 39187 39188@noindent 39189assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}. 39190 39191@end table 39192 39193 39194@node The Ctrl-C Message 39195@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message 39196@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol 39197 39198If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN} 39199reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}), 39200the target should behave as if it had 39201gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call 39202interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop 39203(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02} 39204packet. 39205 39206It's important for the target to know in which 39207state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases: 39208 39209@itemize @bullet 39210@item 39211The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet. 39212 39213@item 39214The system call on the host has been finished. 39215 39216@end itemize 39217 39218These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the 39219returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system 39220call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling 39221on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the 39222system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave 39223as if the break message arrived right after the system call. 39224 39225@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called 39226yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as 39227@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished 39228before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by 39229@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary. 39230The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened 39231or the full action has been completed. 39232 39233@node Console I/O 39234@subsection Console I/O 39235@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o 39236 39237By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file 39238descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output 39239on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation 39240(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled 39241by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor 392420 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following 39243conditions is met: 39244 39245@itemize @bullet 39246@item 39247The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the 39248@code{read} 39249system call is treated as finished. 39250 39251@item 39252The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing 39253newline. 39254 39255@item 39256The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing 39257character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input. 39258 39259@end itemize 39260 39261If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to 39262the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until 39263either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging 39264is stopped at the user's request. 39265 39266 39267@node List of Supported Calls 39268@subsection List of Supported Calls 39269@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls 39270 39271@menu 39272* open:: 39273* close:: 39274* read:: 39275* write:: 39276* lseek:: 39277* rename:: 39278* unlink:: 39279* stat/fstat:: 39280* gettimeofday:: 39281* isatty:: 39282* system:: 39283@end menu 39284 39285@node open 39286@unnumberedsubsubsec open 39287@cindex open, file-i/o system call 39288 39289@table @asis 39290@item Synopsis: 39291@smallexample 39292int open(const char *pathname, int flags); 39293int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode); 39294@end smallexample 39295 39296@item Request: 39297@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}} 39298 39299@noindent 39300@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values: 39301 39302@table @code 39303@item O_CREAT 39304If the file does not exist it will be created. The host 39305rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps 39306are concerned. 39307 39308@item O_EXCL 39309When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is 39310an error and open() fails. 39311 39312@item O_TRUNC 39313If the file already exists and the open mode allows 39314writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be 39315truncated to zero length. 39316 39317@item O_APPEND 39318The file is opened in append mode. 39319 39320@item O_RDONLY 39321The file is opened for reading only. 39322 39323@item O_WRONLY 39324The file is opened for writing only. 39325 39326@item O_RDWR 39327The file is opened for reading and writing. 39328@end table 39329 39330@noindent 39331Other bits are silently ignored. 39332 39333 39334@noindent 39335@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values: 39336 39337@table @code 39338@item S_IRUSR 39339User has read permission. 39340 39341@item S_IWUSR 39342User has write permission. 39343 39344@item S_IRGRP 39345Group has read permission. 39346 39347@item S_IWGRP 39348Group has write permission. 39349 39350@item S_IROTH 39351Others have read permission. 39352 39353@item S_IWOTH 39354Others have write permission. 39355@end table 39356 39357@noindent 39358Other bits are silently ignored. 39359 39360 39361@item Return value: 39362@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error 39363occurred. 39364 39365@item Errors: 39366 39367@table @code 39368@item EEXIST 39369@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used. 39370 39371@item EISDIR 39372@var{pathname} refers to a directory. 39373 39374@item EACCES 39375The requested access is not allowed. 39376 39377@item ENAMETOOLONG 39378@var{pathname} was too long. 39379 39380@item ENOENT 39381A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist. 39382 39383@item ENODEV 39384@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket. 39385 39386@item EROFS 39387@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and 39388write access was requested. 39389 39390@item EFAULT 39391@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value. 39392 39393@item ENOSPC 39394No space on device to create the file. 39395 39396@item EMFILE 39397The process already has the maximum number of files open. 39398 39399@item ENFILE 39400The limit on the total number of files open on the system 39401has been reached. 39402 39403@item EINTR 39404The call was interrupted by the user. 39405@end table 39406 39407@end table 39408 39409@node close 39410@unnumberedsubsubsec close 39411@cindex close, file-i/o system call 39412 39413@table @asis 39414@item Synopsis: 39415@smallexample 39416int close(int fd); 39417@end smallexample 39418 39419@item Request: 39420@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}} 39421 39422@item Return value: 39423@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred. 39424 39425@item Errors: 39426 39427@table @code 39428@item EBADF 39429@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor. 39430 39431@item EINTR 39432The call was interrupted by the user. 39433@end table 39434 39435@end table 39436 39437@node read 39438@unnumberedsubsubsec read 39439@cindex read, file-i/o system call 39440 39441@table @asis 39442@item Synopsis: 39443@smallexample 39444int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count); 39445@end smallexample 39446 39447@item Request: 39448@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}} 39449 39450@item Return value: 39451On success, the number of bytes read is returned. 39452Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read 39453returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned. 39454 39455@item Errors: 39456 39457@table @code 39458@item EBADF 39459@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for 39460reading. 39461 39462@item EFAULT 39463@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39464 39465@item EINTR 39466The call was interrupted by the user. 39467@end table 39468 39469@end table 39470 39471@node write 39472@unnumberedsubsubsec write 39473@cindex write, file-i/o system call 39474 39475@table @asis 39476@item Synopsis: 39477@smallexample 39478int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count); 39479@end smallexample 39480 39481@item Request: 39482@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}} 39483 39484@item Return value: 39485On success, the number of bytes written are returned. 39486Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1 39487is returned. 39488 39489@item Errors: 39490 39491@table @code 39492@item EBADF 39493@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for 39494writing. 39495 39496@item EFAULT 39497@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39498 39499@item EFBIG 39500An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the 39501host-specific maximum file size allowed. 39502 39503@item ENOSPC 39504No space on device to write the data. 39505 39506@item EINTR 39507The call was interrupted by the user. 39508@end table 39509 39510@end table 39511 39512@node lseek 39513@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek 39514@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call 39515 39516@table @asis 39517@item Synopsis: 39518@smallexample 39519long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag); 39520@end smallexample 39521 39522@item Request: 39523@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}} 39524 39525@var{flag} is one of: 39526 39527@table @code 39528@item SEEK_SET 39529The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes. 39530 39531@item SEEK_CUR 39532The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset} 39533bytes. 39534 39535@item SEEK_END 39536The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset} 39537bytes. 39538@end table 39539 39540@item Return value: 39541On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from 39542the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a 39543value of -1 is returned. 39544 39545@item Errors: 39546 39547@table @code 39548@item EBADF 39549@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor. 39550 39551@item ESPIPE 39552@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console. 39553 39554@item EINVAL 39555@var{flag} is not a proper value. 39556 39557@item EINTR 39558The call was interrupted by the user. 39559@end table 39560 39561@end table 39562 39563@node rename 39564@unnumberedsubsubsec rename 39565@cindex rename, file-i/o system call 39566 39567@table @asis 39568@item Synopsis: 39569@smallexample 39570int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath); 39571@end smallexample 39572 39573@item Request: 39574@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}} 39575 39576@item Return value: 39577On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 39578 39579@item Errors: 39580 39581@table @code 39582@item EISDIR 39583@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a 39584directory. 39585 39586@item EEXIST 39587@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory. 39588 39589@item EBUSY 39590@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some 39591process. 39592 39593@item EINVAL 39594An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory 39595of itself. 39596 39597@item ENOTDIR 39598A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new 39599path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory 39600and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory. 39601 39602@item EFAULT 39603@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values. 39604 39605@item EACCES 39606No access to the file or the path of the file. 39607 39608@item ENAMETOOLONG 39609 39610@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long. 39611 39612@item ENOENT 39613A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist. 39614 39615@item EROFS 39616The file is on a read-only filesystem. 39617 39618@item ENOSPC 39619The device containing the file has no room for the new 39620directory entry. 39621 39622@item EINTR 39623The call was interrupted by the user. 39624@end table 39625 39626@end table 39627 39628@node unlink 39629@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink 39630@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call 39631 39632@table @asis 39633@item Synopsis: 39634@smallexample 39635int unlink(const char *pathname); 39636@end smallexample 39637 39638@item Request: 39639@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}} 39640 39641@item Return value: 39642On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 39643 39644@item Errors: 39645 39646@table @code 39647@item EACCES 39648No access to the file or the path of the file. 39649 39650@item EPERM 39651The system does not allow unlinking of directories. 39652 39653@item EBUSY 39654The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's 39655being used by another process. 39656 39657@item EFAULT 39658@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39659 39660@item ENAMETOOLONG 39661@var{pathname} was too long. 39662 39663@item ENOENT 39664A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist. 39665 39666@item ENOTDIR 39667A component of the path is not a directory. 39668 39669@item EROFS 39670The file is on a read-only filesystem. 39671 39672@item EINTR 39673The call was interrupted by the user. 39674@end table 39675 39676@end table 39677 39678@node stat/fstat 39679@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat 39680@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call 39681@cindex stat, file-i/o system call 39682 39683@table @asis 39684@item Synopsis: 39685@smallexample 39686int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf); 39687int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf); 39688@end smallexample 39689 39690@item Request: 39691@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@* 39692@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}} 39693 39694@item Return value: 39695On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 39696 39697@item Errors: 39698 39699@table @code 39700@item EBADF 39701@var{fd} is not a valid open file. 39702 39703@item ENOENT 39704A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the 39705path is an empty string. 39706 39707@item ENOTDIR 39708A component of the path is not a directory. 39709 39710@item EFAULT 39711@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39712 39713@item EACCES 39714No access to the file or the path of the file. 39715 39716@item ENAMETOOLONG 39717@var{pathname} was too long. 39718 39719@item EINTR 39720The call was interrupted by the user. 39721@end table 39722 39723@end table 39724 39725@node gettimeofday 39726@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday 39727@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call 39728 39729@table @asis 39730@item Synopsis: 39731@smallexample 39732int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz); 39733@end smallexample 39734 39735@item Request: 39736@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}} 39737 39738@item Return value: 39739On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise. 39740 39741@item Errors: 39742 39743@table @code 39744@item EINVAL 39745@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer. 39746 39747@item EFAULT 39748@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39749@end table 39750 39751@end table 39752 39753@node isatty 39754@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty 39755@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call 39756 39757@table @asis 39758@item Synopsis: 39759@smallexample 39760int isatty(int fd); 39761@end smallexample 39762 39763@item Request: 39764@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}} 39765 39766@item Return value: 39767Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. 39768 39769@item Errors: 39770 39771@table @code 39772@item EINTR 39773The call was interrupted by the user. 39774@end table 39775 39776@end table 39777 39778Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns 397791 to the target if the file descriptor is attached 39780to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls 39781would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than 39782needed. 39783 39784 39785@node system 39786@unnumberedsubsubsec system 39787@cindex system, file-i/o system call 39788 39789@table @asis 39790@item Synopsis: 39791@smallexample 39792int system(const char *command); 39793@end smallexample 39794 39795@item Request: 39796@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}} 39797 39798@item Return value: 39799If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is 39800available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available. 39801For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the 39802return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the 39803command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system} 39804return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case 39805@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned. 39806 39807@item Errors: 39808 39809@table @code 39810@item EINTR 39811The call was interrupted by the user. 39812@end table 39813 39814@end table 39815 39816@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls 39817to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on 39818the host is simplified before it's returned 39819to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process 39820is discarded, and the return value consists 39821entirely of the exit status of the called command. 39822 39823Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused 39824by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the 39825@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command. 39826 39827@table @code 39828@item set remote system-call-allowed 39829@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 39830Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O 39831protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled). 39832 39833@item show remote system-call-allowed 39834@kindex show remote system-call-allowed 39835Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O 39836protocol. 39837@end table 39838 39839@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes 39840@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes 39841@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol 39842 39843@menu 39844* Integral Datatypes:: 39845* Pointer Values:: 39846* Memory Transfer:: 39847* struct stat:: 39848* struct timeval:: 39849@end menu 39850 39851@node Integral Datatypes 39852@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes 39853@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol 39854 39855The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int}, 39856@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long}, 39857@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}. 39858 39859@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are 39860implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol. 39861 39862@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types. 39863 39864@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those 39865in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target. 39866 39867@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch. 39868 39869All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a 39870structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian 39871byte order. 39872 39873@node Pointer Values 39874@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values 39875@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol 39876 39877Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception 39878is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't 39879transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings 39880are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@: 39881 39882@smallexample 39883@code{1aaf/12} 39884@end smallexample 39885 39886@noindent 39887which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf. 39888The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including 39889the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"} 39890at address 0x123456 is transmitted as 39891 39892@smallexample 39893@code{123456/d} 39894@end smallexample 39895 39896@node Memory Transfer 39897@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer 39898@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol 39899 39900Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for 39901example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format 39902with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to 39903this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F} 39904packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before 39905it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured 39906data should point to the already-coerced data at any time. 39907 39908 39909@node struct stat 39910@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat 39911@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol 39912 39913The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN} 39914is defined as follows: 39915 39916@smallexample 39917struct stat @{ 39918 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */ 39919 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */ 39920 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */ 39921 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */ 39922 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */ 39923 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */ 39924 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */ 39925 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */ 39926 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */ 39927 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */ 39928 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */ 39929 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */ 39930 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */ 39931@}; 39932@end smallexample 39933 39934The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the 39935appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this 39936structure is of size 64 bytes. 39937 39938The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or 39939range of values. 39940 39941@table @code 39942 39943@item st_dev 39944A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console. 39945 39946@item st_ino 39947No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged. 39948 39949@item st_mode 39950Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other 39951bits have currently no meaning for the target. 39952 39953@item st_uid 39954@itemx st_gid 39955@itemx st_rdev 39956No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged. 39957 39958@item st_atime 39959@itemx st_mtime 39960@itemx st_ctime 39961These values have a host and file system dependent 39962accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not 39963support exact timing values. 39964@end table 39965 39966The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is 39967responsible for coercing it to the target representation before 39968continuing. 39969 39970Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol 39971representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually 39972get truncated on the target. 39973 39974@node struct timeval 39975@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval 39976@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol 39977 39978The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol 39979is defined as follows: 39980 39981@smallexample 39982struct timeval @{ 39983 time_t tv_sec; /* second */ 39984 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */ 39985@}; 39986@end smallexample 39987 39988The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the 39989appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this 39990structure is of size 8 bytes. 39991 39992@node Constants 39993@subsection Constants 39994@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol 39995 39996The following values are used for the constants inside of the 39997protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these 39998values before and after the call as needed. 39999 40000@menu 40001* Open Flags:: 40002* mode_t Values:: 40003* Errno Values:: 40004* Lseek Flags:: 40005* Limits:: 40006@end menu 40007 40008@node Open Flags 40009@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags 40010@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol 40011 40012All values are given in hexadecimal representation. 40013 40014@smallexample 40015 O_RDONLY 0x0 40016 O_WRONLY 0x1 40017 O_RDWR 0x2 40018 O_APPEND 0x8 40019 O_CREAT 0x200 40020 O_TRUNC 0x400 40021 O_EXCL 0x800 40022@end smallexample 40023 40024@node mode_t Values 40025@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values 40026@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol 40027 40028All values are given in octal representation. 40029 40030@smallexample 40031 S_IFREG 0100000 40032 S_IFDIR 040000 40033 S_IRUSR 0400 40034 S_IWUSR 0200 40035 S_IXUSR 0100 40036 S_IRGRP 040 40037 S_IWGRP 020 40038 S_IXGRP 010 40039 S_IROTH 04 40040 S_IWOTH 02 40041 S_IXOTH 01 40042@end smallexample 40043 40044@node Errno Values 40045@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values 40046@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol 40047 40048All values are given in decimal representation. 40049 40050@smallexample 40051 EPERM 1 40052 ENOENT 2 40053 EINTR 4 40054 EBADF 9 40055 EACCES 13 40056 EFAULT 14 40057 EBUSY 16 40058 EEXIST 17 40059 ENODEV 19 40060 ENOTDIR 20 40061 EISDIR 21 40062 EINVAL 22 40063 ENFILE 23 40064 EMFILE 24 40065 EFBIG 27 40066 ENOSPC 28 40067 ESPIPE 29 40068 EROFS 30 40069 ENAMETOOLONG 91 40070 EUNKNOWN 9999 40071@end smallexample 40072 40073 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns 40074 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers. 40075 40076@node Lseek Flags 40077@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags 40078@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol 40079 40080@smallexample 40081 SEEK_SET 0 40082 SEEK_CUR 1 40083 SEEK_END 2 40084@end smallexample 40085 40086@node Limits 40087@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits 40088@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol 40089 40090All values are given in decimal representation. 40091 40092@smallexample 40093 INT_MIN -2147483648 40094 INT_MAX 2147483647 40095 UINT_MAX 4294967295 40096 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808 40097 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807 40098 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615 40099@end smallexample 40100 40101@node File-I/O Examples 40102@subsection File-I/O Examples 40103@cindex file-i/o examples 40104 40105Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target 40106address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written: 40107 40108@smallexample 40109<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6} 40110@emph{request memory read from target} 40111-> @code{m1234,6} 40112<- XXXXXX 40113@emph{return "6 bytes written"} 40114-> @code{F6} 40115@end smallexample 40116 40117Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target 40118address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read: 40119 40120@smallexample 40121<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 40122@emph{request memory write to target} 40123-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX} 40124@emph{return "6 bytes read"} 40125-> @code{F6} 40126@end smallexample 40127 40128Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid 40129file descriptor (@code{EBADF}): 40130 40131@smallexample 40132<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 40133-> @code{F-1,9} 40134@end smallexample 40135 40136Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on 40137host is called: 40138 40139@smallexample 40140<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 40141-> @code{F-1,4,C} 40142<- @code{T02} 40143@end smallexample 40144 40145Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on 40146host is called: 40147 40148@smallexample 40149<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 40150-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX} 40151<- @code{T02} 40152@end smallexample 40153 40154@node Library List Format 40155@section Library List Format 40156@cindex library list format, remote protocol 40157 40158On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the 40159same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case, 40160@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory 40161operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other 40162platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries. 40163@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries 40164through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} 40165packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub 40166queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries 40167are loaded. 40168 40169The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which 40170lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an 40171associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses, 40172which report where the library was loaded in memory. 40173 40174For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the 40175library should have a list of segments. If the target supports 40176dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element 40177should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or 40178section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not 40179depend on the library's link-time base addresses. 40180 40181@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40182library lists. @xref{Expat}. 40183 40184A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single 40185offset, looks like this: 40186 40187@smallexample 40188<library-list> 40189 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6"> 40190 <segment address="0x10000000"/> 40191 </library> 40192</library-list> 40193@end smallexample 40194 40195Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three 40196allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this: 40197 40198@smallexample 40199<library-list> 40200 <library name="sharedlib.o"> 40201 <section address="0x10000000"/> 40202 <section address="0x20000000"/> 40203 <section address="0x30000000"/> 40204 </library> 40205</library-list> 40206@end smallexample 40207 40208The format of a library list is described by this DTD: 40209 40210@smallexample 40211<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning --> 40212<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*> 40213<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40214<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)> 40215<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED> 40216<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY> 40217<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED> 40218<!ELEMENT section EMPTY> 40219<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED> 40220@end smallexample 40221 40222In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a 40223single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or 40224section for each library. 40225 40226@node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets 40227@section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets 40228@cindex library list format, remote protocol 40229 40230On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader 40231(e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of 40232shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is 40233more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol. 40234 40235The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists 40236loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4 40237target, the following parameters are reported: 40238 40239@itemize @minus 40240@item 40241@code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of 40242@code{struct link_map}. 40243@item 40244@code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS 40245(Thread Local Storage) access. 40246@item 40247@code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of 40248@code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute 40249memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against 40250address the file was prelinked to during the library load. 40251@item 40252@code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment 40253@end itemize 40254 40255Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of 40256@code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used 40257for TLS access and its presence is optional. 40258 40259@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40260SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}. 40261 40262A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink), 40263looks like this: 40264 40265@smallexample 40266<library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8"> 40267 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000" 40268 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/> 40269 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000" 40270 l_ld="0x152350"/> 40271</library-list-svr> 40272@end smallexample 40273 40274The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD: 40275 40276@smallexample 40277<!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning --> 40278<!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*> 40279<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40280<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED> 40281<!ELEMENT library EMPTY> 40282<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED> 40283<!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED> 40284<!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED> 40285<!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED> 40286@end smallexample 40287 40288@node Memory Map Format 40289@section Memory Map Format 40290@cindex memory map format 40291 40292To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a 40293memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the 40294memory map. 40295 40296The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} 40297(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that 40298lists memory regions. 40299 40300@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40301memory maps. @xref{Expat}. 40302 40303The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 40304 40305@smallexample 40306<?xml version="1.0"?> 40307<!DOCTYPE memory-map 40308 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN" 40309 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd"> 40310<memory-map> 40311 region... 40312</memory-map> 40313@end smallexample 40314 40315Each region can be either: 40316 40317@itemize 40318 40319@item 40320A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length} 40321bytes from there: 40322 40323@smallexample 40324<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 40325@end smallexample 40326 40327 40328@item 40329A region of read-only memory: 40330 40331@smallexample 40332<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 40333@end smallexample 40334 40335 40336@item 40337A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize} 40338bytes in length: 40339 40340@smallexample 40341<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"> 40342 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property> 40343</memory> 40344@end smallexample 40345 40346@end itemize 40347 40348Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered 40349by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X} 40350packets to write to addresses in such ranges. 40351 40352The formal DTD for memory map format is given below: 40353 40354@smallexample 40355<!-- ................................................... --> 40356<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ --> 40357<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. --> 40358<!-- .................................... .............. --> 40359<!-- memory-map.dtd --> 40360<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning --> 40361<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)> 40362<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0"> 40363<!ELEMENT memory (property)> 40364<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region, 40365 and its type, or device. --> 40366<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED 40367 start CDATA #REQUIRED 40368 length CDATA #REQUIRED 40369 device CDATA #IMPLIED> 40370<!-- property: Generic attribute tag --> 40371<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*> 40372<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED> 40373@end smallexample 40374 40375@node Thread List Format 40376@section Thread List Format 40377@cindex thread list format 40378 40379To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes, 40380@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet 40381(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with 40382the following structure: 40383 40384@smallexample 40385<?xml version="1.0"?> 40386<threads> 40387 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name"> 40388 ... description ... 40389 </thread> 40390</threads> 40391@end smallexample 40392 40393Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that 40394identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The 40395@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core 40396the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if 40397present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content 40398of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable 40399auxiliary information. 40400 40401@node Traceframe Info Format 40402@section Traceframe Info Format 40403@cindex traceframe info format 40404 40405To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when 40406inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of 40407memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been 40408collected in a traceframe. 40409 40410This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 40411(@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document. 40412 40413@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40414traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}. 40415 40416The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 40417 40418@smallexample 40419<?xml version="1.0"?> 40420<!DOCTYPE traceframe-info 40421 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN" 40422 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd"> 40423<traceframe-info> 40424 block... 40425</traceframe-info> 40426@end smallexample 40427 40428Each traceframe block can be either: 40429 40430@itemize 40431 40432@item 40433A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for 40434@var{length} bytes from there: 40435 40436@smallexample 40437<memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 40438@end smallexample 40439 40440@item 40441A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been 40442collected: 40443 40444@smallexample 40445<tvar id="@var{number}"/> 40446@end smallexample 40447 40448@end itemize 40449 40450The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below: 40451 40452@smallexample 40453<!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* > 40454<!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40455 40456<!ELEMENT memory EMPTY> 40457<!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED 40458 length CDATA #REQUIRED> 40459<!ELEMENT tvar> 40460<!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED> 40461@end smallexample 40462 40463@node Branch Trace Format 40464@section Branch Trace Format 40465@cindex branch trace format 40466 40467In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread, 40468@value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is 40469represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via 40470branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially. 40471 40472This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read} 40473(@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document. 40474 40475@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40476traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}. 40477 40478The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 40479 40480@smallexample 40481<?xml version="1.0"?> 40482<!DOCTYPE btrace 40483 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN" 40484 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd"> 40485<btrace> 40486 block... 40487</btrace> 40488@end smallexample 40489 40490@itemize 40491 40492@item 40493A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin} 40494and ending at @var{end}: 40495 40496@smallexample 40497<block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/> 40498@end smallexample 40499 40500@end itemize 40501 40502The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below: 40503 40504@smallexample 40505<!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) > 40506<!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40507 40508<!ELEMENT block EMPTY> 40509<!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED 40510 end CDATA #REQUIRED> 40511 40512<!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)> 40513 40514<!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)> 40515 40516<!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY> 40517<!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED 40518 family CDATA #REQUIRED 40519 model CDATA #REQUIRED 40520 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED> 40521 40522<!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)> 40523@end smallexample 40524 40525@node Branch Trace Configuration Format 40526@section Branch Trace Configuration Format 40527@cindex branch trace configuration format 40528 40529For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace 40530configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read} 40531(@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet. 40532 40533The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration 40534settings for that format. The following information is described: 40535 40536@table @code 40537@item bts 40538This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format. 40539@table @code 40540@item size 40541The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes. 40542@end table 40543@item pt 40544This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel 40545PT}) format. 40546@table @code 40547@item size 40548The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes. 40549@end table 40550@end table 40551 40552@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40553branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}. 40554 40555The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below: 40556 40557@smallexample 40558<!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)> 40559<!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40560 40561<!ELEMENT bts EMPTY> 40562<!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED> 40563 40564<!ELEMENT pt EMPTY> 40565<!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED> 40566@end smallexample 40567 40568@include agentexpr.texi 40569 40570@node Target Descriptions 40571@appendix Target Descriptions 40572@cindex target descriptions 40573 40574One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems 40575is that there are so many minor variants of each processor 40576architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with 40577a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example --- 40578and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some 40579architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of 40580vendors. This leads to a number of problems: 40581 40582@itemize @bullet 40583@item 40584With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for 40585the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes. 40586@item 40587Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited 40588audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every 40589variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree. 40590@item 40591When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system 40592at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the 40593@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone. 40594@end itemize 40595 40596To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a 40597target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to 40598actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support 40599processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the 40600descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them. 40601 40602@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40603target descriptions. @xref{Expat}. 40604 40605@menu 40606* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target. 40607* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description. 40608* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target 40609 descriptions. 40610* Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types. 40611* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about. 40612@end menu 40613 40614@node Retrieving Descriptions 40615@section Retrieving Descriptions 40616 40617Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or 40618specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the 40619description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote 40620protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets, 40621qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be 40622@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an 40623XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description 40624Format}. 40625 40626Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description. 40627If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to 40628specify a file are: 40629 40630@table @code 40631@cindex set tdesc filename 40632@item set tdesc filename @var{path} 40633Read the target description from @var{path}. 40634 40635@cindex unset tdesc filename 40636@item unset tdesc filename 40637Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN} 40638will use the description supplied by the current target. 40639 40640@cindex show tdesc filename 40641@item show tdesc filename 40642Show the filename to read for a target description, if any. 40643@end table 40644 40645 40646@node Target Description Format 40647@section Target Description Format 40648@cindex target descriptions, XML format 40649 40650A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML} 40651document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in 40652the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This 40653means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to 40654check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid. 40655However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for 40656their targets, we also describe the grammar here. 40657 40658Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target 40659and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register 40660sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target. 40661@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your 40662target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target. 40663 40664Here is a simple target description: 40665 40666@smallexample 40667<target version="1.0"> 40668 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture> 40669</target> 40670@end smallexample 40671 40672@noindent 40673This minimal description only says that the target uses 40674the x86-64 architecture. 40675 40676A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking 40677optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements 40678are explained further below. 40679 40680@smallexample 40681<?xml version="1.0"?> 40682<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd"> 40683<target version="1.0"> 40684 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]} 40685 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]} 40686 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]} 40687 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]} 40688</target> 40689@end smallexample 40690 40691@noindent 40692The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line 40693breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version 40694declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted 40695(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be 40696useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for 40697@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend 40698including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible 40699revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report 40700the version mismatch. 40701 40702@subsection Inclusion 40703@cindex target descriptions, inclusion 40704@cindex XInclude 40705@ifnotinfo 40706@cindex <xi:include> 40707@end ifnotinfo 40708 40709It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into 40710several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to 40711share files between different possible target descriptions. You can 40712divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of 40713the target description with an inclusion directive of the form: 40714 40715@smallexample 40716<xi:include href="@var{document}"/> 40717@end smallexample 40718 40719@noindent 40720When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve 40721the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with 40722the contents of that document. If the current description was read 40723using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document; 40724@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the 40725current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for 40726@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the 40727original description. 40728 40729@subsection Architecture 40730@cindex <architecture> 40731 40732An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form: 40733 40734@smallexample 40735 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture> 40736@end smallexample 40737 40738@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by 40739@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 40740 40741@subsection OS ABI 40742@cindex @code{<osabi>} 40743 40744This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0. 40745Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it. 40746 40747An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form: 40748 40749@smallexample 40750 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi> 40751@end smallexample 40752 40753@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by 40754@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}). 40755 40756@subsection Compatible Architecture 40757@cindex @code{<compatible>} 40758 40759This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0. 40760Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it. 40761 40762A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form: 40763 40764@smallexample 40765 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible> 40766@end smallexample 40767 40768@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by 40769@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 40770 40771A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target 40772is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture 40773given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the 40774Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common} 40775or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries 40776in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this 40777capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows: 40778 40779@smallexample 40780 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture> 40781 <compatible>spu</compatible> 40782@end smallexample 40783 40784@subsection Features 40785@cindex <feature> 40786 40787Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target 40788system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU 40789registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element 40790has this form: 40791 40792@smallexample 40793<feature name="@var{name}"> 40794 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]} 40795 @var{reg}@dots{} 40796</feature> 40797@end smallexample 40798 40799@noindent 40800Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name 40801of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special 40802knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature 40803should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}. 40804 40805@subsection Types 40806 40807Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must 40808interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer, 40809but other types can be requested by name in the register description. 40810Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined 40811Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite 40812and enum types. 40813 40814Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives 40815a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type. 40816Types must be defined before they are used. 40817 40818@cindex <vector> 40819Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays 40820of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements, 40821specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements, 40822@var{count}: 40823 40824@smallexample 40825<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/> 40826@end smallexample 40827 40828@cindex <union> 40829If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it 40830with a union type containing the useful representations. The 40831@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements, 40832each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}: 40833 40834@smallexample 40835<union id="@var{id}"> 40836 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/> 40837 @dots{} 40838</union> 40839@end smallexample 40840 40841@cindex <struct> 40842@cindex <flags> 40843If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define 40844it with either a structure type or a flags type. 40845A flags type may only contain bitfields. 40846A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields. 40847If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be 40848specified. 40849 40850Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}. 40851 40852@smallexample 40853<struct id="@var{id}"> 40854 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/> 40855 @dots{} 40856</struct> 40857@end smallexample 40858 40859Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required. 40860No implicit padding is added. 40861 40862Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}. 40863 40864@smallexample 40865<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 40866 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/> 40867 @dots{} 40868</struct> 40869@end smallexample 40870 40871@smallexample 40872<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 40873 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/> 40874 @dots{} 40875</flags> 40876@end smallexample 40877 40878The @var{name} value is required. 40879Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""}, 40880in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed. 40881Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional. 40882 40883The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type} 40884is optional. 40885The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end}, 40886and zero represents the least significant bit. 40887 40888The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields, 40889and an unsigned integer otherwise. 40890 40891Which to choose? Structures or flags? 40892 40893Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over 40894defining them with @samp{struct}: 40895 40896@itemize @bullet 40897@item 40898Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers. 40899@item 40900They are printed in a more readable fashion. 40901@end itemize 40902 40903Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over 40904defining them with @samp{flags}: 40905 40906@itemize @bullet 40907@item 40908One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}. 40909 40910@smallexample 40911(gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3 40912$1 = 42 40913@end smallexample 40914 40915@end itemize 40916 40917@subsection Registers 40918@cindex <reg> 40919 40920Each register is represented as an element with this form: 40921 40922@smallexample 40923<reg name="@var{name}" 40924 bitsize="@var{size}" 40925 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]} 40926 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]} 40927 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]} 40928 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/> 40929@end smallexample 40930 40931@noindent 40932The components are as follows: 40933 40934@table @var 40935 40936@item name 40937The register's name; it must be unique within the target description. 40938 40939@item bitsize 40940The register's size, in bits. 40941 40942@item regnum 40943The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater 40944than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in 40945a preceding feature); the first register in the target description 40946defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write 40947the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P} 40948packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets 40949in order of increasing register number. 40950 40951@item save-restore 40952Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function 40953calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is 40954@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for 40955some system control registers; this is not related to the target's 40956ABI. 40957 40958@item type 40959The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type 40960defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int} 40961and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size 40962for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the 40963architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for 40964@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}. 40965 40966@item group 40967The register group to which this register belongs. It must 40968be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no 40969@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register 40970in @code{info registers}. 40971 40972@end table 40973 40974@node Predefined Target Types 40975@section Predefined Target Types 40976@cindex target descriptions, predefined types 40977 40978Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types 40979from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead, 40980standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental 40981types. The currently supported types are: 40982 40983@table @code 40984 40985@item bool 40986Boolean type, occupying a single bit. 40987 40988@item int8 40989@itemx int16 40990@itemx int32 40991@itemx int64 40992@itemx int128 40993Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits. 40994 40995@item uint8 40996@itemx uint16 40997@itemx uint32 40998@itemx uint64 40999@itemx uint128 41000Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits. 41001 41002@item code_ptr 41003@itemx data_ptr 41004Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and 41005any dedicated return address register may be marked as code 41006pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic 41007address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers 41008may be marked as data pointers. 41009 41010@item ieee_single 41011Single precision IEEE floating point. 41012 41013@item ieee_double 41014Double precision IEEE floating point. 41015 41016@item arm_fpa_ext 41017The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers. 41018 41019@item i387_ext 41020The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers. 41021 41022@item i386_eflags 4102332bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86. 41024 41025@item i386_mxcsr 4102632bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86. 41027 41028@end table 41029 41030@node Enum Target Types 41031@section Enum Target Types 41032@cindex target descriptions, enum types 41033 41034Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags} 41035register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}. 41036 41037Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs. 41038 41039@smallexample 41040<enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 41041 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/> 41042 @dots{} 41043</enum> 41044@end smallexample 41045 41046Enums must be defined before they are used. 41047 41048@smallexample 41049<enum id="levels_type" size="4"> 41050 <evalue name="low" value="0"/> 41051 <evalue name="high" value="1"/> 41052</enum> 41053<flags id="flags_type" size="4"> 41054 <field name="X" start="0"/> 41055 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/> 41056</flags> 41057<reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/> 41058@end smallexample 41059 41060Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register 41061would be printed as: 41062 41063@smallexample 41064(gdb) info register flags 41065flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ] 41066@end smallexample 41067 41068@node Standard Target Features 41069@section Standard Target Features 41070@cindex target descriptions, standard features 41071 41072A target description must contain either no registers or all the 41073target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then 41074@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on 41075the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the 41076default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be 41077described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN} 41078can recognize them. 41079 41080This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements 41081which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features 41082with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers; 41083if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required 41084feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target 41085description. You can add additional registers to any of the 41086standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if 41087they were added to an unrecognized feature. 41088 41089This section lists the known features and their expected contents. 41090Sample XML documents for these features are included in the 41091@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}. 41092 41093Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the 41094company or organization which selected the name, and the overall 41095architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature 41096containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}. 41097 41098The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose 41099of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display 41100registers using the capitalization used in the description. 41101 41102@menu 41103* AArch64 Features:: 41104* ARC Features:: 41105* ARM Features:: 41106* i386 Features:: 41107* MicroBlaze Features:: 41108* MIPS Features:: 41109* M68K Features:: 41110* NDS32 Features:: 41111* Nios II Features:: 41112* PowerPC Features:: 41113* S/390 and System z Features:: 41114* Sparc Features:: 41115* TIC6x Features:: 41116@end menu 41117 41118 41119@node AArch64 Features 41120@subsection AArch64 Features 41121@cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features 41122 41123The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64 41124targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30}, 41125@samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}. 41126 41127The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present, 41128it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr}, 41129and @samp{fpcr}. 41130 41131@node ARC Features 41132@subsection ARC Features 41133@cindex target descriptions, ARC Features 41134 41135ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number 41136are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are 41137important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required 41138that one of the core registers features is present. 41139@samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory. 41140 41141The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS 41142targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0} 41143through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, 41144@samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} 41145and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}. 41146@samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when 41147debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional. 41148 41149The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and 41150ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers 41151@samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp}, 41152@samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. 41153This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core 41154registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}. 41155 41156The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact 41157targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0} 41158through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, 41159@samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers 41160@samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} 41161through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core 41162registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only 41163difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of 41164@samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in 41165ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact. 41166 41167The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC 41168targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}. 41169 41170@node ARM Features 41171@subsection ARM Features 41172@cindex target descriptions, ARM features 41173 41174The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile 41175ARM targets. 41176It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, 41177@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}. 41178 41179For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} 41180feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain 41181registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, 41182and @samp{xpsr}. 41183 41184The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it 41185should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}. 41186 41187The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present, 41188it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and 41189@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon}, 41190@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional. 41191 41192The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it 41193should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If 41194they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included. 41195@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from 41196halves of the double-precision registers. 41197 41198The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not 41199need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the 41200VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the 41201quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers. 41202If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also 41203be present and include 32 double-precision registers. 41204 41205@node i386 Features 41206@subsection i386 Features 41207@cindex target descriptions, i386 features 41208 41209The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64 41210targets. It should describe the following registers: 41211 41212@itemize @minus 41213@item 41214@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386 41215@item 41216@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64 41217@item 41218@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es}, 41219@samp{fs}, @samp{gs} 41220@item 41221@samp{st0} through @samp{st7} 41222@item 41223@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff}, 41224@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop} 41225@end itemize 41226 41227The register sets may be different, depending on the target. 41228 41229The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should 41230describe registers: 41231 41232@itemize @minus 41233@item 41234@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386 41235@item 41236@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64 41237@item 41238@samp{mxcsr} 41239@end itemize 41240 41241The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the 41242@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should 41243describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers: 41244 41245@itemize @minus 41246@item 41247@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386 41248@item 41249@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64 41250@end itemize 41251 41252The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel 41253Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers: 41254 41255@itemize @minus 41256@item 41257@samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64. 41258@item 41259@samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64. 41260@end itemize 41261 41262The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should 41263describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}. 41264 41265The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should 41266describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}. 41267 41268The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the 41269@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should 41270describe additional @sc{xmm} registers: 41271 41272@itemize @minus 41273@item 41274@samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64. 41275@end itemize 41276 41277It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers: 41278 41279@itemize @minus 41280@item 41281@samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64. 41282@end itemize 41283 41284It should 41285describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers: 41286 41287@itemize @minus 41288@item 41289@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386. 41290@item 41291@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64. 41292@end itemize 41293 41294It should 41295describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers: 41296 41297@itemize @minus 41298@item 41299@samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64. 41300@end itemize 41301 41302The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should 41303describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register 41304valid for i386 and amd64. 41305 41306@node MicroBlaze Features 41307@subsection MicroBlaze Features 41308@cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features 41309 41310The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze 41311targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, 41312@samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr}, 41313@samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid}, 41314@samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}. 41315 41316The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional. 41317If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr} 41318 41319@node MIPS Features 41320@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features 41321@cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features 41322 41323The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets. 41324It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo}, 41325@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending 41326on the target. 41327 41328The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should 41329contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause} 41330registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41331 41332The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though 41333it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should 41334contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and 41335@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41336 41337The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should 41338contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through 41339@samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should 41340be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41341 41342The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should 41343contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the 41344Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls. 41345 41346@node M68K Features 41347@subsection M68K Features 41348@cindex target descriptions, M68K features 41349 41350@table @code 41351@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core} 41352@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core} 41353@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core} 41354One of those features must be always present. 41355The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is 41356used. The feature that is present should contain registers 41357@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp}, 41358@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}. 41359 41360@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp} 41361This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers 41362@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and 41363@samp{fpiaddr}. 41364@end table 41365 41366@node NDS32 Features 41367@subsection NDS32 Features 41368@cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features 41369 41370The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32 41371targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through 41372@samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp}, 41373and @samp{pc}. 41374 41375The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present, 41376it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers 41377@samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7}, 41378@samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented. 41379 41380@emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point 41381registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision 41382floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if 41383not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the 41384overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit 41385single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the 41386support to it could be totally removed some day. 41387 41388@node Nios II Features 41389@subsection Nios II Features 41390@cindex target descriptions, Nios II features 41391 41392The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II 41393targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero}, 41394@samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}), 41395@samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through 41396@samp{mpuacc}). 41397 41398@node PowerPC Features 41399@subsection PowerPC Features 41400@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features 41401 41402The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC 41403targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, 41404@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and 41405@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41406 41407The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should 41408contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}. 41409 41410The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should 41411contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, 41412and @samp{vrsave}. 41413 41414The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should 41415contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} 41416will combine these registers with the floating point registers 41417(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} 41418through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} 41419through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7. 41420 41421The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should 41422contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and 41423@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in 41424@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in 41425@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine 41426these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the 41427user. 41428 41429@node S/390 and System z Features 41430@subsection S/390 and System z Features 41431@cindex target descriptions, S/390 features 41432@cindex target descriptions, System z features 41433 41434The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and 41435System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general 41436registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit 41437registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}. 41438S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers. 41439A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide 4144032-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general 41441register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their 41442lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}. 41443 41444The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should 41445contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and 41446@samp{fpc}. 41447 41448The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should 41449contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}. 41450 41451The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should 41452contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z 41453targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain 41454the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing 41455mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always 4145632-bit wide. 41457 41458The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should 41459contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct}, 41460@samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}. 41461 41462The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain 4146364-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be 41464combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0} 41465through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers 41466@samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should 41467contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through 41468@samp{v31}. 41469 41470@node Sparc Features 41471@subsection Sparc Features 41472@cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features 41473@cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features 41474The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64 41475targets. It should describe the following registers: 41476 41477@itemize @minus 41478@item 41479@samp{g0} through @samp{g7} 41480@item 41481@samp{o0} through @samp{o7} 41482@item 41483@samp{l0} through @samp{l7} 41484@item 41485@samp{i0} through @samp{i7} 41486@end itemize 41487 41488They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41489 41490Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64 41491targets. It should describe the following registers: 41492 41493@itemize @minus 41494@item 41495@samp{f0} through @samp{f31} 41496@item 41497@samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64 41498@end itemize 41499 41500The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64 41501targets. It should describe the following registers: 41502 41503@itemize @minus 41504@item 41505@samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, 41506@samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32 41507@item 41508@samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y} 41509for sparc64 41510@end itemize 41511 41512@node TIC6x Features 41513@subsection TMS320C6x Features 41514@cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features 41515@cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features 41516The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x 41517targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15}, 41518registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}. 41519 41520The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should 41521contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16} 41522through @samp{B31}. 41523 41524The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should 41525contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}. 41526 41527@node Operating System Information 41528@appendix Operating System Information 41529@cindex operating system information 41530 41531@menu 41532* Process list:: 41533@end menu 41534 41535Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of 41536the operating system running on the target---for example the list of 41537processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the 41538mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the 41539target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses 41540on a different aspect of target. 41541 41542Operating system information is retrived from the target via the 41543remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata 41544read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and 41545the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched. 41546 41547@node Process list 41548@appendixsection Process list 41549@cindex operating system information, process list 41550 41551When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the 41552@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is 41553an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in 41554@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}. 41555 41556An example document is: 41557 41558@smallexample 41559<?xml version="1.0"?> 41560<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd"> 41561<osdata type="processes"> 41562 <item> 41563 <column name="pid">1</column> 41564 <column name="user">root</column> 41565 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column> 41566 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column> 41567 </item> 41568</osdata> 41569@end smallexample 41570 41571Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value 41572of that column should identify the process on the target. The 41573@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be 41574displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present, 41575should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process 41576is running on. Target may provide additional columns, 41577which @value{GDBN} currently ignores. 41578 41579@node Trace File Format 41580@appendix Trace File Format 41581@cindex trace file format 41582 41583The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description 41584section, and a trace frame section with binary data. 41585 41586The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is 41587@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data, 41588while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values 41589in the future. 41590 41591The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text 41592separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a 41593variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such 41594as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will 41595ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end 41596of this section. 41597 41598@table @code 41599@item R @var{size} 41600Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the 41601size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size} 41602is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in 41603a single trace file. 41604 41605@item status @var{status} 41606Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus} 41607remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace 41608file. 41609 41610@item tp @var{payload} 41611Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as 41612@code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint 41613may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple 41614reply packets. 41615 41616@item tsv @var{payload} 41617Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as 41618@code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable 41619may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple 41620reply packets. 41621 41622@item tdesc @var{payload} 41623Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of 41624the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get 41625the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer} 41626@code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml} 41627file. Includes are not allowed. 41628 41629@end table 41630 41631The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames. 41632Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a 41633four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in 41634the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a 41635character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace 41636state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a 41637hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's 41638endianness. 41639 41640@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section 41641 41642@table @code 41643@item R @var{bytes} 41644Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a 41645@code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the 41646actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding. 41647 41648@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}... 41649Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte 41650address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by 41651@var{length} bytes. 41652 41653@item V @var{number} @var{value} 41654Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value 41655@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}. 41656 41657@end table 41658 41659Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types 41660of blocks. 41661 41662@node Index Section Format 41663@appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format 41664@cindex .gdb_index section format 41665@cindex index section format 41666 41667This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save 41668gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is 41669DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this 41670description. 41671 41672The mapped index file format is designed to be directly 41673@code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is 41674represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an 41675@code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values 41676before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is 41677laid out such that alignment is always respected. 41678 41679A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order. 41680 41681@enumerate 41682@item 41683The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type} 41684unless otherwise noted: 41685 41686@enumerate 41687@item 41688The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete. 41689Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6. 41690Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4 41691and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the 41692symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units 41693(@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the 41694compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type. 41695 41696@value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices 41697by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}. 41698GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is 41699currently not flagged as deprecated. 41700 41701@item 41702The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list. 41703 41704@item 41705The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note 41706that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal 41707to the next offset. 41708 41709@item 41710The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area. 41711 41712@item 41713The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table. 41714 41715@item 41716The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool. 41717@end enumerate 41718 41719@item 41720The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian 41721values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is 41722the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second 41723element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU 41724elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the 417250-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then 41726conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of 41727CU indices. 41728 41729@item 41730The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit 41731little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset, 41732the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is 41733the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted. 41734 41735@item 41736The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address 41737entries. Each address entry has three elements: 41738 41739@enumerate 41740@item 41741The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. 41742 41743@item 41744The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like 41745@code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end. 41746 41747@item 41748The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value. 41749@end enumerate 41750 41751@item 41752The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of 41753the hash table is always a power of 2. 41754 41755Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type} 41756values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the 41757constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the 41758constant pool. 41759 41760If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This 41761is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a 41762valid index for both a string and a CU vector. 41763 41764The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an 41765iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an 41766initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in 41767the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the 41768index version: 41769 41770@table @asis 41771@item Version 4 41772The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}. 41773 41774@item Versions 5 to 7 41775The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}. 41776@end table 41777 41778The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash. 41779 41780The step size used in the hash table is computed via 41781@code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash 41782value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size 41783is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash 41784collision. 41785 41786The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We 41787don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization 41788algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read 41789the code. 41790 41791@item 41792The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized 41793so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by 41794strings. 41795 41796A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type} 41797values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector. 41798Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in 41799the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which 41800CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used. 41801See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry. 41802 41803A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated. 41804@end enumerate 41805 41806Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7. 41807If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one 41808CU index+attributes value for each use. 41809 41810The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows 41811(bit 0 = LSB): 41812 41813@table @asis 41814 41815@item Bits 0-23 41816This is the index of the CU in the CU list. 41817@item Bits 24-27 41818These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero. 41819@item Bits 28-30 41820The kind of the symbol in the CU. 41821 41822@table @asis 41823@item 0 41824This value is reserved and should not be used. 41825By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible 41826with previous versions of the index. 41827@item 1 41828The symbol is a type. 41829@item 2 41830The symbol is a variable or an enum value. 41831@item 3 41832The symbol is a function. 41833@item 4 41834Any other kind of symbol. 41835@item 5,6,7 41836These values are reserved. 41837@end table 41838 41839@item Bit 31 41840This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static. 41841 41842The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated. 41843The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in 41844@value{GDBN} sources. 41845 41846@end table 41847 41848This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and 41849global/static attributes in the index. 41850 41851@smallexample 41852is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external); 41853language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language); 41854switch (die->tag) 41855 @{ 41856 case DW_TAG_typedef: 41857 case DW_TAG_base_type: 41858 case DW_TAG_subrange_type: 41859 kind = TYPE; 41860 is_static = 1; 41861 break; 41862 case DW_TAG_enumerator: 41863 kind = VARIABLE; 41864 is_static = language != CPLUS; 41865 break; 41866 case DW_TAG_subprogram: 41867 kind = FUNCTION; 41868 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA); 41869 break; 41870 case DW_TAG_constant: 41871 kind = VARIABLE; 41872 is_static = ! is_external; 41873 break; 41874 case DW_TAG_variable: 41875 kind = VARIABLE; 41876 is_static = ! is_external; 41877 break; 41878 case DW_TAG_namespace: 41879 kind = TYPE; 41880 is_static = 0; 41881 break; 41882 case DW_TAG_class_type: 41883 case DW_TAG_interface_type: 41884 case DW_TAG_structure_type: 41885 case DW_TAG_union_type: 41886 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type: 41887 kind = TYPE; 41888 is_static = language != CPLUS; 41889 break; 41890 default: 41891 assert (0); 41892 @} 41893@end smallexample 41894 41895@node Man Pages 41896@appendix Manual pages 41897@cindex Man pages 41898 41899@menu 41900* gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page 41901* gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page 41902* gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program 41903* gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts 41904@end menu 41905 41906@node gdb man 41907@heading gdb man 41908 41909@c man title gdb The GNU Debugger 41910 41911@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb 41912gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}] 41913[@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}] 41914[@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}] 41915 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}] 41916[@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}] 41917[@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}] 41918 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}] 41919[@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}] 41920@c man end 41921 41922@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb 41923The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is 41924going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another 41925program was doing at the moment it crashed. 41926 41927@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of 41928these) to help you catch bugs in the act: 41929 41930@itemize @bullet 41931@item 41932Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior. 41933 41934@item 41935Make your program stop on specified conditions. 41936 41937@item 41938Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped. 41939 41940@item 41941Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the 41942effects of one bug and go on to learn about another. 41943@end itemize 41944 41945You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and 41946Modula-2. 41947 41948@value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads 41949commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN} 41950command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself 41951by using the command @code{help}. 41952 41953You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most 41954usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an 41955executable program as the argument: 41956 41957@smallexample 41958gdb program 41959@end smallexample 41960 41961You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified: 41962 41963@smallexample 41964gdb program core 41965@end smallexample 41966 41967You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want 41968to debug a running process: 41969 41970@smallexample 41971gdb program 1234 41972gdb -p 1234 41973@end smallexample 41974 41975@noindent 41976would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file 41977named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first). 41978With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename. 41979 41980Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands: 41981 41982@c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines. 41983@table @env 41984@item break [@var{file}:]@var{function} 41985Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}). 41986 41987@item run [@var{arglist}] 41988Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified). 41989 41990@item bt 41991Backtrace: display the program stack. 41992 41993@item print @var{expr} 41994Display the value of an expression. 41995 41996@item c 41997Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint). 41998 41999@item next 42000Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any 42001function calls in the line. 42002 42003@item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function} 42004look at the program line where it is presently stopped. 42005 42006@item list [@var{file}:]@var{function} 42007type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped. 42008 42009@item step 42010Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any 42011function calls in the line. 42012 42013@item help [@var{name}] 42014Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information 42015about using @value{GDBN}. 42016 42017@item quit 42018Exit from @value{GDBN}. 42019@end table 42020 42021@ifset man 42022For full details on @value{GDBN}, 42023see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42024by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online 42025as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program. 42026@end ifset 42027@c man end 42028 42029@c man begin OPTIONS gdb 42030Any arguments other than options specify an executable 42031file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument 42032encountered with no 42033associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second, 42034if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file. 42035Many options have 42036both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also 42037recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is 42038present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option 42039arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the 42040more usual convention.) 42041 42042All the options and command line arguments you give are processed 42043in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x} 42044option is used. 42045 42046@table @env 42047@item -help 42048@itemx -h 42049List all options, with brief explanations. 42050 42051@item -symbols=@var{file} 42052@itemx -s @var{file} 42053Read symbol table from file @var{file}. 42054 42055@item -write 42056Enable writing into executable and core files. 42057 42058@item -exec=@var{file} 42059@itemx -e @var{file} 42060Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when 42061appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core 42062dump. 42063 42064@item -se=@var{file} 42065Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable 42066file. 42067 42068@item -core=@var{file} 42069@itemx -c @var{file} 42070Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine. 42071 42072@item -command=@var{file} 42073@itemx -x @var{file} 42074Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. 42075 42076@item -ex @var{command} 42077Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}. 42078 42079@item -directory=@var{directory} 42080@itemx -d @var{directory} 42081Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files. 42082 42083@item -nh 42084Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}. 42085 42086@item -nx 42087@itemx -n 42088Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files. 42089 42090@item -quiet 42091@itemx -q 42092``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These 42093messages are also suppressed in batch mode. 42094 42095@item -batch 42096Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command 42097files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited). 42098Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} 42099commands in the command files. 42100 42101Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to 42102download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this 42103more useful, the message 42104 42105@smallexample 42106Program exited normally. 42107@end smallexample 42108 42109@noindent 42110(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control 42111terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode. 42112 42113@item -cd=@var{directory} 42114Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory, 42115instead of the current directory. 42116 42117@item -fullname 42118@itemx -f 42119Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells 42120@value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard, 42121recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which 42122includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks 42123like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number 42124and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The 42125Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032} 42126characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame. 42127 42128@item -b @var{bps} 42129Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial 42130interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging. 42131 42132@item -tty=@var{device} 42133Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output. 42134@end table 42135@c man end 42136 42137@c man begin SEEALSO gdb 42138@ifset man 42139The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42140If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42141documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42142 42143@smallexample 42144info gdb 42145@end smallexample 42146 42147@noindent 42148should give you access to the complete manual. 42149 42150@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42151Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42152@end ifset 42153@c man end 42154 42155@node gdbserver man 42156@heading gdbserver man 42157 42158@c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger 42159@format 42160@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver 42161gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}] 42162 42163gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 42164 42165gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 42166@c man end 42167@end format 42168 42169@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver 42170@command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine 42171than the one which is running the program being debugged. 42172 42173@ifclear man 42174@subheading Usage (server (target) side) 42175@end ifclear 42176@ifset man 42177Usage (server (target) side): 42178@end ifset 42179 42180First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto 42181the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as 42182@command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by 42183the @value{GDBN} running on the host system. 42184 42185To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver} 42186program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of 42187your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is: 42188 42189@smallexample 42190target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...] 42191@end smallexample 42192 42193For example, using a serial port, you might say: 42194 42195@smallexample 42196@ifset man 42197@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>. 42198target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt 42199@end ifset 42200@ifclear man 42201target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt 42202@end ifclear 42203@end smallexample 42204 42205This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and 42206to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now 42207waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it. 42208 42209To use a TCP connection, you could say: 42210 42211@smallexample 42212target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt 42213@end smallexample 42214 42215This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are 42216going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means 42217that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port 422182345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you 42219want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP 42220ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host 42221@value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if 42222you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will 42223print an error message and exit. 42224 42225@command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs. 42226This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is: 42227 42228@smallexample 42229target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 42230@end smallexample 42231 42232@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't 42233necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 42234 42235To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 42236or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option. 42237In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start 42238the program you want to debug. 42239 42240@smallexample 42241target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 42242@end smallexample 42243 42244@ifclear man 42245@subheading Usage (host side) 42246@end ifclear 42247@ifset man 42248Usage (host side): 42249@end ifset 42250 42251You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since 42252@value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally 42253would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the 42254@option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.) 42255That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only 42256new command you need to know about is @code{target remote} 42257(or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either 42258a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT} 42259descriptor. For example: 42260 42261@smallexample 42262@ifset man 42263@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>. 42264(gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb 42265@end ifset 42266@ifclear man 42267(gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb} 42268@end ifclear 42269@end smallexample 42270 42271@noindent 42272communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and: 42273 42274@smallexample 42275(gdb) target remote the-target:2345 42276@end smallexample 42277 42278@noindent 42279communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where 42280you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for 42281TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote' 42282command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like 42283`Connection refused'. 42284 42285@command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once, 42286described in 42287@ifset man 42288the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs} 42289-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}. 42290@end ifset 42291@ifclear man 42292@ref{Inferiors and Programs}. 42293@end ifclear 42294In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant: 42295 42296@smallexample 42297(gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345 42298@end smallexample 42299 42300The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such 42301case. 42302@c man end 42303 42304@c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver 42305There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}: 42306 42307@itemize @bullet 42308 42309@item 42310Debug a specific program specified by its program name: 42311 42312@smallexample 42313gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}] 42314@end smallexample 42315 42316The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate 42317with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line), 42318a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use 42319stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to 42320debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the 42321program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the 42322connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit. 42323 42324@item 42325Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running 42326program: 42327 42328@smallexample 42329gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 42330@end smallexample 42331 42332The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID 42333of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything 42334else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits, 42335@value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit. 42336 42337@item 42338Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process: 42339 42340@smallexample 42341gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 42342@end smallexample 42343 42344In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which 42345command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not 42346close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can 42347debug several processes in the same session. 42348@end itemize 42349 42350In each of the modes you may specify these options: 42351 42352@table @env 42353 42354@item --help 42355List all options, with brief explanations. 42356 42357@item --version 42358This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit. 42359 42360@item --attach 42361@command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is: 42362 42363@smallexample 42364target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 42365@end smallexample 42366 42367@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't 42368necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 42369 42370@item --multi 42371To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 42372or process ID to attach, use this command line option. 42373Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start 42374the program you want to debug. The syntax is: 42375 42376@smallexample 42377target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 42378@end smallexample 42379 42380@item --debug 42381Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging 42382process. 42383This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to 42384the developers. 42385 42386@item --remote-debug 42387Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output. 42388This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to 42389the developers. 42390 42391@item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]} 42392Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line 42393of debugging output. 42394@xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}. 42395 42396@item --wrapper 42397Specify a wrapper to launch programs 42398for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the 42399wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then 42400@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments. 42401 42402@item --once 42403By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that 42404additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver} 42405with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further 42406connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. 42407 42408@c --disable-packet is not documented for users. 42409 42410@c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by 42411@c QDisableRandomization. 42412 42413@end table 42414@c man end 42415 42416@c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver 42417@ifset man 42418The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42419If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42420documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42421 42422@smallexample 42423info gdb 42424@end smallexample 42425 42426should give you access to the complete manual. 42427 42428@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42429Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42430@end ifset 42431@c man end 42432 42433@node gcore man 42434@heading gcore 42435 42436@c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program 42437 42438@format 42439@c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore 42440gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid} 42441@c man end 42442@end format 42443 42444@c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore 42445Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}. 42446Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process 42447crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump 42448limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains 42449running without any change. 42450@c man end 42451 42452@c man begin OPTIONS gcore 42453@table @env 42454@item -o @var{filename} 42455The optional argument 42456@var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. 42457If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, 42458where @var{pid} is the running program process ID. 42459@end table 42460@c man end 42461 42462@c man begin SEEALSO gcore 42463@ifset man 42464The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42465If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42466documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42467 42468@smallexample 42469info gdb 42470@end smallexample 42471 42472@noindent 42473should give you access to the complete manual. 42474 42475@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42476Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42477@end ifset 42478@c man end 42479 42480@node gdbinit man 42481@heading gdbinit 42482 42483@c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts 42484 42485@format 42486@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit 42487@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT 42488@value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT} 42489@end ifset 42490 42491~/.gdbinit 42492 42493./.gdbinit 42494@c man end 42495@end format 42496 42497@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit 42498These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during 42499@value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands, 42500described in 42501@ifset man 42502the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences} 42503-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}. 42504@end ifset 42505@ifclear man 42506@ref{Sequences}. 42507@end ifclear 42508 42509Please read more in 42510@ifset man 42511the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup} 42512-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}. 42513@end ifset 42514@ifclear man 42515@ref{Startup}. 42516@end ifclear 42517 42518@table @env 42519@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT 42520@item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT} 42521@end ifset 42522@ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT 42523@item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation) 42524@end ifclear 42525System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified 42526@value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}. 42527See more in 42528@ifset man 42529the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration} 42530-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}. 42531@end ifset 42532@ifclear man 42533@ref{System-wide configuration}. 42534@end ifclear 42535 42536@item ~/.gdbinit 42537User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified 42538@value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}. 42539 42540@item ./.gdbinit 42541Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with 42542@value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}. 42543See more in 42544@ifset man 42545the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory} 42546-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}. 42547@end ifset 42548@ifclear man 42549@ref{Init File in the Current Directory}. 42550@end ifclear 42551@end table 42552@c man end 42553 42554@c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit 42555@ifset man 42556gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup} 42557 42558The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42559If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42560documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42561 42562@smallexample 42563info gdb 42564@end smallexample 42565 42566should give you access to the complete manual. 42567 42568@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42569Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42570@end ifset 42571@c man end 42572 42573@include gpl.texi 42574 42575@node GNU Free Documentation License 42576@appendix GNU Free Documentation License 42577@include fdl.texi 42578 42579@node Concept Index 42580@unnumbered Concept Index 42581 42582@printindex cp 42583 42584@node Command and Variable Index 42585@unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index 42586 42587@printindex fn 42588 42589@tex 42590% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the 42591% meantime: 42592\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill 42593\centerline{The body of this manual is set in} 42594\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,} 42595\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}} 42596\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.} 42597\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},} 42598\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and} 42599\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}} 42600\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill} 42601\page\colophon 42602% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991. 42603@end tex 42604 42605@bye 42606